Recipients of this document are invited to submit, with their comments, notification of any relevant patent rights or other intellectual property rights of which they may be aware which might be infringed by the implementation of the specification set forth in this document, and to provide supporting documentation. GlobalPlatform __________________________ Card Specification Version 2.2 March 2006 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 i Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table of Contents 1 INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................................................2 1.1 Audience ...........................................................................................................................................................2 1.2 Normative References .....................................................................................................................................3 1.3 Terminology and Definitions ..........................................................................................................................4 1.4 Abbreviations and Notations ..........................................................................................................................8 1.5 Revisions History .............................................................................................................................................9 1.5.1 Open Platform Card Specification v2.0 to Open Platform Card Specification v2.0.1...............................9 1.5.2 Major Adjustments in GlobalPlatform Card Specification V2.1 .............................................................10 1.5.3 Revisions in GlobalPlatform Card Specification V2.1.1 .........................................................................12 1.5.4 Major Adjustments in GlobalPlatform Card Specification V2.2 .............................................................12 2 SYSTEM ARCHITECTURE.................................................................................................................17 3 CARD ARCHITECTURE .....................................................................................................................18 3.1 Security Domains...........................................................................................................................................19 3.2 Global Services Applications ........................................................................................................................19 3.3 Runtime Environment...................................................................................................................................19 3.4 Trusted Framework.......................................................................................................................................19 3.5 GlobalPlatform Environment (OPEN) ........................................................................................................20 3.6 GlobalPlatform API.......................................................................................................................................20 3.7 Card Content..................................................................................................................................................20 3.8 Card Manager................................................................................................................................................21 4 SECURITY ARCHITECTURE .............................................................................................................22 4.1 Goals ...............................................................................................................................................................22 4.2 Security Responsibilities and Requirements ...............................................................................................22 4.2.1 Card Issuer's Security Responsibilities ....................................................................................................22 4.2.2 Application Provider's Security Responsibilities.....................................................................................23 ii GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 4.2.3 Controlling Authority's Security Responsibilities....................................................................................23 4.2.4 On-Card Components' Security Requirements ........................................................................................23 4.2.5 Back-End System Security Requirements ...............................................................................................25 4.3 Cryptographic support..................................................................................................................................25 4.3.1 Secure Card Content Management ..........................................................................................................26 4.3.2 Secure Communication............................................................................................................................26 5 LIFE CYCLE MODELS........................................................................................................................29 5.1 Card Life Cycle..............................................................................................................................................29 5.1.1 Card Life Cycle States.............................................................................................................................29 5.1.2 Card Life Cycle State Transitions............................................................................................................31 5.2 Executable Load File/ Executable Module Life Cycle................................................................................33 5.2.1 Executable Load File Life Cycle .............................................................................................................33 5.2.2 Executable Module Life Cycle ................................................................................................................33 5.3 Application and Security Domain Life Cycle..............................................................................................33 5.3.1 Application Life Cycle States..................................................................................................................34 5.3.2 Security Domain Life Cycle States..........................................................................................................36 5.4 Sample Life Cycle Illustration......................................................................................................................39 6 GLOBALPLATFORM ENVIRONMENT (OPEN) ................................................................................41 6.1 Overview.........................................................................................................................................................41 6.2 OPEN Services ...............................................................................................................................................42 6.3 Command Dispatch .......................................................................................................................................42 6.4 Logical Channels and Application Selection ...............................................................................................43 6.4.1 Implicit Selection Assignment.................................................................................................................43 6.4.2 Basic Logical Channel.............................................................................................................................44 6.4.3 Supplementary Logical Channel..............................................................................................................47 6.5 GlobalPlatform Registry...............................................................................................................................49 6.5.1 Application/Executable Load File/Executable Module Data Elements...................................................50 6.5.2 Card-Wide Data.......................................................................................................................................51 6.6 Privileges.........................................................................................................................................................51 6.6.1 Privilege Definition .................................................................................................................................51 6.6.2 Privilege Assignment...............................................................................................................................52 6.6.3 Privilege Management.............................................................................................................................54 6.7 The GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework ...................................................................................................55 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 iii Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7 SECURITY DOMAINS.........................................................................................................................57 7.1 General Description.......................................................................................................................................57 7.1.1 Issuer Security Domain............................................................................................................................57 7.2 Security Domain Association........................................................................................................................58 7.3 Security Domain Services..............................................................................................................................59 7.3.1 Application Access to Security Domain Services....................................................................................59 7.3.2 Security Domain Access to Applications.................................................................................................60 7.3.3 Personalization Support...........................................................................................................................60 7.3.4 Runtime Messaging Support....................................................................................................................61 7.4 Security Domain Data ...................................................................................................................................62 7.4.1 Issuer Security Domain............................................................................................................................62 7.4.2 Supplementary Security Domains............................................................................................................63 7.5 Security Domain Keys...................................................................................................................................64 7.5.1 Key Information.......................................................................................................................................64 7.5.2 Key Access Conditions............................................................................................................................65 7.6 Data and Key Management ..........................................................................................................................66 8 GLOBAL PLATFORM SERVICES .....................................................................................................67 8.1 Global Services Applications ........................................................................................................................67 8.1.1 Registering Global Services.....................................................................................................................67 8.1.2 Application Access to Global Services....................................................................................................67 8.1.3 Global Service Parameters.......................................................................................................................68 8.2 CVM Application...........................................................................................................................................68 8.2.1 Application Access to CVM Services......................................................................................................69 8.2.2 CVM Management ..................................................................................................................................69 9 CARD AND APPLICATION MANAGEMENT.....................................................................................72 9.1 Card Content Management ..........................................................................................................................72 9.1.1 Overview .................................................................................................................................................72 9.1.2 OPEN Requirements................................................................................................................................72 9.1.3 Security Domain Requirements...............................................................................................................72 9.2 Authorizing and Controlling Card Content................................................................................................74 9.2.1 DAP Verification.....................................................................................................................................74 9.2.2 Load File Data Block Hash......................................................................................................................74 9.2.3 Tokens .....................................................................................................................................................74 9.3 Card Content Loading, Installation and Make Selectable.........................................................................74 iv GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9.3.1 Overview .................................................................................................................................................74 9.3.2 Card Content Loading..............................................................................................................................75 9.3.3 Card Content Installation.........................................................................................................................76 9.3.4 Card Content Combined Loading, Installation and Make Selectable ......................................................76 9.3.5 Card Content Loading Process ................................................................................................................77 9.3.6 Card Content Installation Process .........................................................................................................79 9.3.7 Card Content Make Selectable Process.................................................................................................81 9.3.8 Card Content Combined Loading, Installation and Make Selectable Process .........................................82 9.3.9 Examples of Loading and Installation Flow .........................................................................................85 9.4 Content Extradition and Registry Update...................................................................................................88 9.4.1 Content Extradition ...............................................................................................................................88 9.4.2 Registry Update.....................................................................................................................................91 9.5 Content Removal ...........................................................................................................................................92 9.5.1 Application Removal...............................................................................................................................94 9.5.2 Executable Load File Removal................................................................................................................95 9.5.3 Executable Load File and related Application Removal..........................................................................96 9.6 Security Management....................................................................................................................................98 9.6.1 Life Cycle Management...........................................................................................................................98 9.6.2 Application Locking and Unlocking........................................................................................................99 9.6.3 Card Locking and Unlocking.................................................................................................................100 9.6.4 Card Termination...................................................................................................................................101 9.6.5 Application Status Interrogation............................................................................................................102 9.6.6 Card Status Interrogation.......................................................................................................................102 9.6.7 Operational Velocity Checking..............................................................................................................102 9.6.8 Tracing and Event Logging ...................................................................................................................103 9.7 Memory Resource Management.................................................................................................................103 10 SECURE COMMUNICATION........................................................................................................105 10.1 Secure Channel ............................................................................................................................................105 10.2 Explicit / Implicit Secure Channel .............................................................................................................105 10.2.1 Explicit Secure Channel Initiation.........................................................................................................105 10.2.2 Implicit Secure Channel Initiation.........................................................................................................106 10.2.3 Secure Channel Termination .................................................................................................................106 10.3 Direct / Indirect Handling of a Secure Channel Protocol ........................................................................106 10.4 Entity Authentication..................................................................................................................................106 10.4.1 Authentication with symmetric cryptography........................................................................................107 10.4.2 Authentication with asymmetric cryptography......................................................................................107 10.5 Secure Messaging.........................................................................................................................................107 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 v Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 10.6 Security Levels .............................................................................................................................................108 10.7 Secure Channel Protocol Identifier............................................................................................................108 11 APDU COMMAND REFERENCE..................................................................................................111 11.1 General Coding Rules..................................................................................................................................112 11.1.1 Life Cycle State Coding.........................................................................................................................113 11.1.2 Privileges Coding...................................................................................................................................113 11.1.3 General Error Conditions.......................................................................................................................114 11.1.4 Class Byte Coding .................................................................................................................................115 11.1.5 APDU Message and Data Length..........................................................................................................116 11.1.6 Confirmations in Response Messages ...................................................................................................116 11.1.7 Implicit Selection Parameter Coding.....................................................................................................117 11.1.8 Key Type Coding...................................................................................................................................117 11.1.9 Key Usage Coding.................................................................................................................................118 11.1.10 Key Access Coding............................................................................................................................119 11.1.11 Tag Coding ........................................................................................................................................119 11.2 DELETE Command....................................................................................................................................121 11.2.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................121 11.2.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................121 11.2.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................123 11.3 GET DATA Command................................................................................................................................124 11.3.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................124 11.3.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................124 11.3.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................125 11.4 GET STATUS Command ...........................................................................................................................128 11.4.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................128 11.4.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................128 11.4.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................130 11.5 INSTALL Command...................................................................................................................................132 11.5.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................132 11.5.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................132 11.5.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................140 11.6 LOAD Command.........................................................................................................................................142 11.6.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................142 11.6.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................142 11.6.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................143 11.7 MANAGE CHANNEL Command .............................................................................................................145 11.7.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................145 11.7.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................145 vi GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.7.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................146 11.8 PUT KEY Command...................................................................................................................................147 11.8.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................147 11.8.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................147 11.8.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................150 11.9 SELECT Command.....................................................................................................................................151 11.9.1 Definition and Scope .............................................................................................................................151 11.9.2 Command Message................................................................................................................................151 11.9.3 Response Message.................................................................................................................................152 11.10 SET STATUS Command ........................................................................................................................153 11.10.1 Definition and Scope .........................................................................................................................153 11.10.2 Command Message............................................................................................................................153 11.10.3 Response Message.............................................................................................................................154 11.11 STORE DATA Command.......................................................................................................................155 11.11.1 Definition and Scope .........................................................................................................................155 11.11.2 Command Message............................................................................................................................155 11.11.3 Response Message.............................................................................................................................157 A GLOBALPLATFORM API.................................................................................................................160 A.1 GlobalPlatform on a Java Card .................................................................................................................160 GlobalPlatform Specific Requirements .................................................................................................................160 Class Hierarchy .......................................................................................................................................................164 Class GPSystem....................................................................................................................................................165 Interface Hierarchy .................................................................................................................................................174 Interface Application............................................................................................................................................175 Interface CVM ......................................................................................................................................................176 Interface GlobalService........................................................................................................................................183 Interface GPRegistryEntry..................................................................................................................................190 Interface SecureChannel......................................................................................................................................198 Interface SecureChannelx ....................................................................................................................................208 A.2 GlobalPlatform on MULTOSTM.................................................................................................................210 A.2.1 Glossary of Terms..................................................................................................................................210 A.2.2 GlobalPlatform Specific Requirements .................................................................................................210 A.2.3 Accessing Card Manager Services.........................................................................................................211 A.2.4 API.........................................................................................................................................................214 B ALGORITHMS (CRYPTOGRAPHIC AND HASHING).....................................................................251 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 vii Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. B.1 Data Encryption Standard (DES) ..............................................................................................................251 B.1.1 Encryption/Decryption...........................................................................................................................251 B.1.2 MACing.................................................................................................................................................251 B.2 Hashing Algorithms.....................................................................................................................................251 B.2.1 Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1)...........................................................................................................251 B.2.2 MULTOS Asymmetric Hash Algorithm................................................................................................252 B.3 Public Key Cryptography Scheme 1 (PKCS#1)........................................................................................252 B.4 DES Padding ................................................................................................................................................252 C SECURE CONTENT MANAGEMENT ..............................................................................................253 C.1 Keys...............................................................................................................................................................253 C.1.1 Token and Receipt Keys........................................................................................................................253 C.1.2 DAP Verification Keys..........................................................................................................................253 C.2 Load File Data Block Hash .........................................................................................................................254 C.3 Load File Data Block Signature (DAP Verification) ................................................................................254 C.4 Tokens...........................................................................................................................................................255 C.4.1 Load Token............................................................................................................................................255 C.4.2 Install Token..........................................................................................................................................256 C.4.3 Make Selectable Token..........................................................................................................................257 C.4.4 Extradition Token..................................................................................................................................259 C.4.5 Registry Update Token..........................................................................................................................260 C.4.6 Delete Token..........................................................................................................................................261 C.4.7 Load, Install and Make Selectable Token..............................................................................................262 C.5 Receipts.........................................................................................................................................................263 C.5.1 Load Receipt..........................................................................................................................................264 C.5.2 Install Receipt and Make Selectable Receipt.........................................................................................264 C.5.3 Extradition Receipt ................................................................................................................................265 C.5.4 Registry Update Receipt........................................................................................................................266 C.5.5 Delete Receipt........................................................................................................................................267 C.5.6 Combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt ..........................................................................267 C.6 DAP Verification..........................................................................................................................................268 C.6.1 PKC Scheme..........................................................................................................................................268 C.6.2 DES Scheme..........................................................................................................................................268 C.7 GlobalPlatform on MULTOS.....................................................................................................................269 C.7.1 Keys.......................................................................................................................................................269 C.7.2 Cryptographic Structures.......................................................................................................................269 viii GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. D SECURE CHANNEL PROTOCOL '01' (DEPRECATED).................................................................270 D.1 Secure Communication ...............................................................................................................................270 D.1.1 SCP01 Secure Channel..........................................................................................................................270 D.1.2 Mutual Authentication...........................................................................................................................270 D.1.3 Message Integrity...................................................................................................................................272 D.1.4 Message Data Confidentiality................................................................................................................272 D.1.5 ICV Encryption......................................................................................................................................272 D.1.6 Security Level........................................................................................................................................272 D.1.7 Protocol Rules........................................................................................................................................273 D.2 Cryptographic Keys.....................................................................................................................................274 D.3 Cryptographic Usage...................................................................................................................................274 D.3.1 DES Session Keys .................................................................................................................................274 D.3.2 Authentication Cryptograms..................................................................................................................276 D.3.3 APDU Command MAC Generation and Verification ...........................................................................276 D.3.4 APDU Data Field Encryption and Decryption ......................................................................................277 D.3.5 Key Sensitive Data Encryption and Decryption ....................................................................................278 D.4 Secure Channel APDU Commands............................................................................................................279 D.4.1 INITIALIZE UPDATE Command ........................................................................................................280 D.4.2 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command .........................................................................................282 E SECURE CHANNEL PROTOCOL '02' .............................................................................................284 E.1 Secure Communication ...............................................................................................................................284 E.1.1 SCP02 Secure Channel..........................................................................................................................284 E.1.2 Entity Authentication.............................................................................................................................285 E.1.3 Message Integrity...................................................................................................................................287 E.1.4 Message Data Confidentiality................................................................................................................287 E.1.5 Security Level........................................................................................................................................287 E.1.6 Protocol Rules........................................................................................................................................288 E.2 Cryptographic Keys.....................................................................................................................................290 E.3 Cryptographic Algorithms..........................................................................................................................291 E.3.1 Cipher Block Chaining (CBC)...............................................................................................................291 E.3.2 Message Integrity ICV using Explicit Secure Channel Initiation..........................................................291 E.3.3 Message Integrity ICV using Implicit Secure Channel Initiation..........................................................291 E.3.4 ICV Encryption......................................................................................................................................291 E.4 Cryptographic Usage...................................................................................................................................292 E.4.1 DES Session Keys .................................................................................................................................292 E.4.2 Authentication Cryptograms in Explicit Secure Channel Initiation.......................................................292 E.4.3 Authentication Cryptogram in Implicit Secure Channel Initiation ........................................................293 E.4.4 APDU Command C-MAC Generation and Verification .......................................................................293 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 ix Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.4.5 APDU Response R-MAC Generation and Verification.........................................................................295 E.4.6 APDU Command Data Field Encryption and Decryption.....................................................................296 E.4.7 Sensitive Data Encryption and Decryption............................................................................................297 E.5 Secure Channel APDU Commands............................................................................................................299 E.5.1 INITIALIZE UPDATE Command ........................................................................................................301 E.5.2 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command .........................................................................................303 E.5.3 BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command ..................................................................................................305 E.5.4 END R-MAC SESSION Command ......................................................................................................307 F SECURE CHANNEL PROTOCOL '10' .............................................................................................309 F.1 Secure Communication ...............................................................................................................................309 F.1.1 SCP10 Secure Channel..........................................................................................................................309 F.1.2 Certificate Verification ..........................................................................................................................310 F.1.3 Entity Authentication.............................................................................................................................320 F.1.4 Session Key and Security Level Establishment.....................................................................................325 F.1.5 Protocol Rules........................................................................................................................................326 F.2 Cryptographic Algorithms..........................................................................................................................327 F.2.1 Asymmetric cryptography .....................................................................................................................327 F.2.2 Digest Algorithm ...................................................................................................................................328 F.2.3 Message Integrity ICV...........................................................................................................................328 F.2.4 Message Integrity C-MAC and R-MAC................................................................................................328 F.2.5 APDU Encryption and Decryption for Message Confidentiality...........................................................328 F.3 Cryptographic Usage...................................................................................................................................329 F.3.1 DES Session Keys .................................................................................................................................329 F.3.2 Secure Messaging ..................................................................................................................................330 F.4 Commands....................................................................................................................................................338 F.4.1 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command .........................................................................................339 F.4.2 GET CHALLENGE Command.............................................................................................................341 F.4.3 GET DATA [certificate] Command ......................................................................................................342 F.4.4 INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command ..........................................................................................344 F.4.5 MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Command..........................................................................346 F.4.6 PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] Command..............................................................348 F.4.7 PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Command .................................................350 G TRUSTED FRAMEWORK INTER-APPLICATION COMMUNICATION ..........................................352 H GLOBALPLATFORM DATA VALUES AND CARD RECOGNITION DATA...................................353 H.1 Data Values ..................................................................................................................................................353 H.2 Structure of Card Recognition Data ..........................................................................................................353 x GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. H.3 Security Domain Management Data..........................................................................................................355 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 xi Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table of Figures and Tables Figure 2-1: GlobalPlatform Architecture.....................................................................................................................17 Figure 3-1: GlobalPlatform Card Architecture............................................................................................................18 Figure 3-2 Card Content Relationships .......................................................................................................................21 Figure 5-1: Card Life Cycle State Transitions.............................................................................................................32 Figure 5-2: Application Life Cycle State Transitions..................................................................................................36 Figure 5-3: Security Domain Life Cycle State Transitions..........................................................................................38 Figure 5-4: Sample Card Life Cycle and Application Life Cycles..............................................................................40 Figure 6-1: GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework Roles...............................................................................................56 Figure 7-1: Example of Security Domain Hierarchies.................................................................................................58 Figure 7-2: Application Personalization through Associated Security Domain ..........................................................61 Figure 7-3: Runtime Messaging Flow .........................................................................................................................62 Figure 9-1: Loading and Installation Process ..............................................................................................................75 Figure 9-2: Load and Installation Flow Diagram ........................................................................................................86 Figure 9-3: Load Flow Diagram..................................................................................................................................87 Figure 9-4: Install Flow Diagram ................................................................................................................................88 Figure 9-5: Delegated Extradition Flow......................................................................................................................90 Figure 9-6: Content Deletion Flow..............................................................................................................................93 Figure 9-7: Life Cycle Management Flow ..................................................................................................................99 Figure A-1 : Public and the "Card Manager services interface buffer".....................................................................212 Figure C-1: Load File Data Block Hash Calculation.................................................................................................254 Figure C-2: Load File Data Block Signature Calculation..........................................................................................255 Figure C-3 Load Token Calculation..........................................................................................................................255 Figure C-4: Install Token Calculation .......................................................................................................................256 Figure C-5: Make Selectable Token Calculation.......................................................................................................258 Figure C-6: Extradition Token Calculation ...............................................................................................................259 Figure C-7: Registry Update Token Calculation .......................................................................................................260 Figure C-8: Delete Token Calculation.......................................................................................................................261 Figure C-9: Load, Install and Make Selectable Token Calculation...........................................................................262 Figure C-10: Load Receipt Calculation.....................................................................................................................264 Figure C-11: Install/Make Selectable Receipt Calculation........................................................................................265 Figure C-12: Extradition Receipt Calculation ...........................................................................................................265 xii GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Figure C-13: Registry Update Receipt Calculation ...................................................................................................266 Figure C-14: Delete Receipt Calculation...................................................................................................................267 Figure C-15: Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt Calculation.......................................................................268 Figure D-1: Mutual Authentication Flow (Security Domain)....................................................................................271 Figure D-2: Mutual Authentication Flow (using services of Security Domain)........................................................272 Figure D-3: Session Key - Step 1 - Generate Derivation data...................................................................................275 Figure D-4: Session Key - Step 2 - Create S-ENC Session Key ...............................................................................275 Figure D-5: Session Key ­ Step 3 - Create S-MAC Session Key..............................................................................275 Figure D-6: APDU Command MAC Generation and Verification ...........................................................................277 Figure D-7: APDU Data Field Encryption ................................................................................................................278 Figure E-1: Explicit Secure Channel Initiation Flow ................................................................................................286 Figure E-2: Create Secure Channel Session Key from the Base Key........................................................................292 Figure E-3: C-MAC Generation on Unmodified APDU ...........................................................................................294 Figure E-4: C-MAC Generation on Modified APDU................................................................................................295 Figure E-5: R-MAC Generation ................................................................................................................................296 Figure E-6: APDU Command Data Field Encryption ...............................................................................................297 Figure F-1 - Certificate Chains - Example a..............................................................................................................312 Figure F-2 - Certificate Chains - Example b..............................................................................................................312 Figure F-3 Certificate Chains - Example c ................................................................................................................313 Figure F-4 - Certificate Verification Flow.................................................................................................................314 Figure F-5: Certificate Formation - Self Descriptive Certificate Without Message Recovery..................................317 Figure F-6: Certificate Formation - Non Self Descriptive Certificate Without Message Recovery..........................318 Figure F-7: Certificate Formation - Self Descriptive Certificate with Message Recovery........................................319 Figure F-8: Certificate Formation - Non Self Descriptive Certificate with Message Recovery................................320 Figure F-9: Entity Authentication Flow.....................................................................................................................321 Figure F-10: APDU C-MAC Generation...................................................................................................................331 Figure F-11: Secure Messaging: Command message protected for confidentiality ..................................................332 Figure F-12: Secure Messaging: Command message protected for integrity and confidentiality .............................334 Figure F-13: Secure Messaging: Response message protected for integrity .............................................................335 Figure F-14: Secure Messaging: Response message protected for confidentiality....................................................336 Figure F-15: Secure Messaging: Response message protected for integrity and confidentiality...............................337 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 xiii Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table 1-1: Normative References..................................................................................................................................4 Table 1-2: Terminology and Definitions .......................................................................................................................8 Table 1-3: Abbreviations and Notations........................................................................................................................9 Table 6-1: Privileges....................................................................................................................................................52 Table 6-2: Privilege Defaults.......................................................................................................................................53 Table 6-3: Privilege Assignment Example Use Cases.................................................................................................54 Table 10-1: Current Security Level ...........................................................................................................................108 Table 11-1: Authorized GlobalPlatform Commands per Card Life Cycle State .......................................................112 Table 11-2: Minimum Security Requirements for GlobalPlatform Commands........................................................112 Table 11-3: Executable Load File Life Cycle Coding...............................................................................................113 Table 11-4: Application Life Cycle Coding ..............................................................................................................113 Table 11-5: Security Domain Life Cycle Coding......................................................................................................113 Table 11-6: Card Life Cycle Coding .........................................................................................................................113 Table 11-7: Privileges (byte 1) ..................................................................................................................................114 Table 11-8: Privileges (byte 2) ..................................................................................................................................114 Table 11-9: Privileges (byte 3) ..................................................................................................................................114 Table 11-10: General Error Conditions .....................................................................................................................115 Table 11-11: CLA Byte Coding ................................................................................................................................115 Table 11-12: CLA Byte Coding ................................................................................................................................116 Table 11-13: Confirmation Structure.........................................................................................................................116 Table 11-14: Confirmation Data................................................................................................................................117 Table 11-15: Implicit Selection Parameter ................................................................................................................117 Table 11-16: Key Type Coding .................................................................................................................................118 Table 11-17: Key Usage............................................................................................................................................118 Table 11-18: Key Access...........................................................................................................................................119 Table 11-19: DELETE Command Message ..............................................................................................................121 Table 11-20: DELETE Reference Control Parameter P1 ..........................................................................................121 Table 11-21: DELETE Reference Control Parameter P2 ..........................................................................................122 Table 11-22: Delete [card content] Command Data Field.........................................................................................122 Table 11-23: DELETE [key] Command Data Field..................................................................................................122 Table 11-24: DELETE Response Data Field.............................................................................................................123 Table 11-25: DELETE Error Conditions...................................................................................................................123 xiv GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table 11-26: GET DATA Command Message .........................................................................................................124 Table 11-27: Key Information Data Structure - Basic...............................................................................................126 Table 11-28: Key Information Data Structure - Extended.........................................................................................126 Table 11-29: List of On-Card Applications...............................................................................................................126 Table 11-30: GET DATA Error Conditions..............................................................................................................127 Table 11-31: GET STATUS Command Message .....................................................................................................128 Table 11-32: GET STATUS Reference Control Parameter P1 .................................................................................128 Table 11-33: GET STATUS Reference Control Parameter P2 .................................................................................129 Table 11-34: GET STATUS Command Data Field...................................................................................................129 Table 11-35: Issuer Security Domain, Application and Executable Load File Information Data .............................130 Table 11-36: GlobalPlatform Registry Data (TLV)...................................................................................................130 Table 11-37: Executable Load File and Executable Module Information Data.........................................................131 Table 11-38: GET STATUS Warning Condition ......................................................................................................131 Table 11-39: GET STATUS Error Conditions..........................................................................................................131 Table 11-40: INSTALL Command Message.............................................................................................................132 Table 11-41: INSTALL Command Reference Control Parameter P1.......................................................................132 Table 11-42: INSTALL [for load] Command Data Field..........................................................................................133 Table 11-43: INSTALL [for install] Command Data Field.......................................................................................134 Table 11-44: INSTALL [for make selectable] Command Data Field .......................................................................135 Table 11-45: INSTALL [for extradition] Command Data Field ...............................................................................136 Table 11-46: INSTALL [for registry update] Command Data Field.........................................................................136 Table 11-47: INSTALL [for personalization] Command Data Field ........................................................................137 Table 11-48: Load Parameter Tags............................................................................................................................138 Table 11-49: Install Parameter Tags..........................................................................................................................138 Table 11-50: Make Selectable Parameter Tags .........................................................................................................139 Table 11-51: Extradition Parameter Tags..................................................................................................................139 Table 11-52: Registry Update Parameter Tags..........................................................................................................140 Table 11-53: Values for Restrict Parameter (Tag 'D9') .............................................................................................140 Table 11-54: INSTALL Response Data Field ...........................................................................................................141 Table 11-55: INSTALL Error Conditions .................................................................................................................141 Table 11-56: LOAD Command Message Structure...................................................................................................142 Table 11-57: LOAD Command Reference Control Parameter P1.............................................................................142 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 xv Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table 11-58: Load File Structure...............................................................................................................................143 Table 11-59: LOAD Response Data Field.................................................................................................................144 Table 11-60: LOAD Error Conditions.......................................................................................................................144 Table 11-61: MANAGE CHANNEL Command Message........................................................................................145 Table 11-62: MANAGE CHANNEL Warning Conditions.......................................................................................146 Table 11-63: MANAGE CHANNEL Error Conditions ............................................................................................146 Table 11-64: PUT KEY Command Message.............................................................................................................147 Table 11-65: PUT KEY Reference Control Parameter P1 ........................................................................................148 Table 11-66: PUT KEY Reference Control Parameter P2 ........................................................................................148 Table 11-67: Key Version Number Diagram.............................................................................................................148 Table 11-68: Key Data Field - Basic .........................................................................................................................149 Table 11-69: Key Data Field - Extended...................................................................................................................149 Table 11-70: PUT KEY Error Conditions.................................................................................................................150 Table 11-71: SELECT Command Message...............................................................................................................151 Table 11-72: SELECT Reference Control Parameter P1...........................................................................................151 Table 11-73: SELECT Reference Control Parameter P2...........................................................................................151 Table 11-74: File Control Information ......................................................................................................................152 Table 11-75: SELECT Warning Condition ...............................................................................................................152 Table 11-76: SELECT Error Conditions ...................................................................................................................152 Table 11-77: SET STATUS Command Message......................................................................................................153 Table 11-78: SET STATUS ­ Status Type................................................................................................................153 Table 11-79: SET STATUS Error Conditions...........................................................................................................154 Table 11-80: STORE DATA Command Message.....................................................................................................155 Table 11-81: STORE DATA Reference Control Parameter P1.................................................................................156 Table 11-82: STORE DATA Error Condition...........................................................................................................158 Table A-1: Glossary of Terms ...................................................................................................................................210 Table A-2 : Structure of the "Card Manager services interface buffer".....................................................................213 Table A-3 : Encoding of Service ...............................................................................................................................214 Table A-4: Types.......................................................................................................................................................215 Table C-1: Token and Receipt Keys..........................................................................................................................253 Table C-2: Additional Security Domain Key ............................................................................................................254 Table C-3: Data Elements Included in the Load Token.............................................................................................256 xvi GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table C-4: Data Elements Included in the Install Token...........................................................................................257 Table C-5: Data Elements Included in the Make Selectable Token ..........................................................................258 Table C-6: Data Elements Included in the Extradition Token...................................................................................259 Table C-7: Data Elements Included in the Registry Update Token...........................................................................260 Table C-8: Data Elements Included in the Delete Token ..........................................................................................261 Table C-9: Data Elements Included in the Load, Install and Make Selectable Token...............................................263 Table C-10: Data Elements Included in the Load Receipt.........................................................................................264 Table C-11: Data Elements Included in the Install/Make Selectable Receipt ...........................................................265 Table C-12: Data Elements Included in the Extradition Receipt...............................................................................266 Table C-13: Data Elements Included in the Registry Update Receipt.......................................................................266 Table C-14: Data Elements Included in the Delete Receipt ......................................................................................267 Table C-15: Data Elements Included in the Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt...........................................268 Table D-1: Security Domain Secure Channel Keys...................................................................................................274 Table D-2: Minimum Security Requirements for SCP01 Commands.......................................................................279 Table D-3: SCP01 Command Support per Card Life Cycle State.............................................................................279 Table D-4: INITIALIZE UPDATE Command Message...........................................................................................280 Table D-5: INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Message ............................................................................................281 Table D-6: INITIALIZE UPDATE Error Condition.................................................................................................281 Table D-7: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message............................................................................282 Table D-8: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Reference Control Parameter P1........................................................282 Table D-9: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Error Condition..................................................................................283 Table E-1: Values of Parameter "i" ...........................................................................................................................284 Table E-2: SCP02 - Security Domain Secure Channel Base Key .............................................................................290 Table E-3: SCP02 - Security Domain Secure Channel Keys.....................................................................................291 Table E-4: SCP02 Command Support.......................................................................................................................299 Table E-5: Minimum Security Requirements for SCP02 Commands .......................................................................299 Table E-6: SCP02 Command Support per card Life Cycle State ..............................................................................299 Table E-7: INITIALIZE UPDATE Command Message ...........................................................................................301 Table E-8: INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Message.............................................................................................302 Table E-9: INITIALIZE UPDATE Error Condition..................................................................................................302 Table E-10: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message ..........................................................................303 Table E-11: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Reference Control Parameter P1 ......................................................303 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 xvii Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table E-12: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE warning Code ...................................................................................304 Table E-13: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command Message....................................................................................305 Table E-14: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Reference Control Parameter P1 ...............................................................305 Table E-15: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Reference Control Parameter P2 ...............................................................305 Table E-16: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command Data Field.................................................................................306 Table E-17: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Error Conditions........................................................................................306 Table E-18: END R-MAC SESSION Command Message .......................................................................................307 Table E-19: END R-MAC SESSION Reference Control Parameter P2 ...................................................................307 Table E-20: END R-MAC SESSION Error Conditions............................................................................................308 Table F-1: Values of Parameter "i"............................................................................................................................310 Table F-2: Example of Data Included in Certificates ................................................................................................316 Table F-3: Data to Hash.............................................................................................................................................322 Table F-4: Security Domain Signature Block............................................................................................................322 Table F-5: Data to Hash.............................................................................................................................................322 Table F-6: Security Domain Signature Block............................................................................................................323 Table F-7: Data to Hash.............................................................................................................................................323 Table F-8: Off-Card Entity Signature Block .............................................................................................................324 Table F-9: Data to Hash.............................................................................................................................................324 Table F-10: Off-Card Entity Signature Block ...........................................................................................................325 Table F-11: Single CRT ............................................................................................................................................329 Table F-12: Counter Value for Session Key Calculation ..........................................................................................330 Table F-13: SCP10 Command Support .....................................................................................................................338 Table F-14: Minimum Security Requirements for SCP10 commands ......................................................................338 Table F-15: SCP10 command support per Card Life Cycle State .............................................................................339 Table F-16: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message...........................................................................340 Table F-17: Error Conditions.....................................................................................................................................340 Table F-18: GET CHALLENGE Command Message ..............................................................................................341 Table F-19: GET DATA [certificate] Command Message........................................................................................342 Table F-20: GET DATA [certificate] Command Data Message ...............................................................................343 Table F-21: GET DATA [certificate] Response Data Field - Certificate ..................................................................343 Table F-22: Error Conditions.....................................................................................................................................343 Table F-23: INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message............................................................................344 xviii GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table F-24: INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Data Field.........................................................................344 Table F-25: Warning Conditions...............................................................................................................................345 Table F-26: Error Conditions.....................................................................................................................................345 Table F-27: MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Command Message...........................................................346 Table F-28: MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Reference Control Parameter P1.......................................346 Table F-29: MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Command Data Field ........................................................347 Table F-30: Error Conditions.....................................................................................................................................347 Table F-31: PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] Command Message ...............................................348 Table F-32: Off-Card Entity Session Key Data - Clear Text before Encryption.......................................................349 Table F-33: Error Conditions.....................................................................................................................................349 Table F-34: PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Command Message...................................350 Table F-35: PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Command Data Field................................350 Table F-36: Error Conditions.....................................................................................................................................351 Table H-1: Structure of Card Recognition Data ........................................................................................................354 Table H-2: Security Domain Management Data .......................................................................................................355 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 1 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Part I Introduction 2 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 1 Introduction GlobalPlatform is an organization that has been established by leading companies from the payments and communications industries, the government sector and the vendor community, and is the first to promote a global infrastructure for smart card implementation across multiple industries. Its goal is to reduce barriers hindering the growth of cross-industry, multiple Application smart cards. The smart card issuers will continue to have the freedom to choose from a variety of cards, terminals and back-end systems. For smart cards to reach their true potential, consumers need to be able to use them for a wide variety of functions. For example, the cards can be used with mobile phones to make purchases over the Internet as well as to securely access a PC. Smart cards should also be cost effective and easily multifunctional. Beginning in the mid-1990s, a number of very significant breakthroughs occurred in the chip card industry with the introduction of open systems specifications for Application development. The leading technologies in this area are Java CardTM and MULTOSTM. These technology specifications provide an important contribution to the solution towards the multi-Application chip card vision, such as common programming standards allowing Application portability between different card specific implementations. Then in 2001 a PKI-based card content management framework was defined by NICSS (the Next generation Ic Card System Study group) especially for the governmental sector market. The concept of NICSS is to separate the application provider from card issuer in a trusted manner whereby applications providers can 'renť card memory space from the card issuer. This creates a new business model for each stakeholder. Additionally, in the mobile telecommunication sector ETSI have been addressing card content management 'over the air' for the secure management of the SIM and third generation UICC. Through the Open Platform initiative, first Visa International and now GlobalPlatform have been working with the chip card industry to deliver a missing and critically important chip card standard -- a hardware-neutral, vendorneutral, Application-independent card management specification. This new specification provides a common security and card management architecture that protects the most important aspect of a chip card system investment -- the infrastructure. GlobalPlatform defines a flexible and powerful specification for Card Issuers to create single- and multi-Application chip card systems to meet the evolution of their business needs. The specification allows them to choose the card technology that is right for them today while also ensuring that they can migrate, if necessary, to a different card technology in the future without significant impact to their infrastructure. This specification describes the GlobalPlatform Specifications that shall be implemented on GlobalPlatform smart cards. The following meanings apply to SHALL, SHOULD, and MAY in this document: * SHALL indicates that the statement containing the SHALL must be implemented as defined in this Specification. It does not mandate the implementation of the statement; * SHOULD indicates a recommendation. It is strongly recommended to implement the statement as defined in this Specification; * MAY indicates an option. 1.1 Audience This specification is intended primarily for card manufacturers and application developers developing GlobalPlatform card implementations. Although this specification defines card components, command interfaces, transaction sequences, and interfaces that can be common across many different industries, it does not detail the implementation of the lower layers security, which may vary from one industry to the other. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 3 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This specification is also intended for a more general audience as it describes the generic security concepts and the various actors involved in a multi-Application Card Management System. 1.2 Normative References Standard / Specification Description ANSI X9.52 Triple Data Encryption Algorithm Modes of Operation, draft, 1996 CWA 14890-1 CEN Workshop Agreement - Application Interface for smart cards used as Secure Signature Creation Devices - Part 1: Basic requirements, March 2004 ETSI TS 102 221 (Release 6) Smart cards; UICC - Terminal interface; Physical and logical characteristics, European Telecommunications Standards Institute Project Smart Card Platform (EP SCP), 2004 ETSI TS 102 225 (Release 6) Smart cards; Secured packet structure for UICC based applications, European Telecommunications Standards Institute Project Smart Card Platform (EP SCP), 2004 ETSI TS 102 226 (Release 6) Smart cards; Remote APDU structure for UICC based applications, European Telecommunications Standards Institute Project Smart Card Platform (EP SCP), 2004 ETSI TS 102 241 (Release 6) Smart cards; UICC Application Programming Interface (UICC API) for Java CardTM , European Telecommunications Standards Institute Project Smart Card Platform (EP SCP), 2004 FIPS PUB 180-2 Federal Information Processing Standards Publication 180-2, 2002: Specifications for the Secure Hash Standard: U.S. Department Of Commerce, Technology Administration, National Institute Of Standards And Technology FIPS PUB 197 Federal Information Processing Standards Publication 197, 2001: Specification for the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES): U.S. Department Of Commerce, Technology Administration, National Institute Of Standards And Technology FIPS PUB 198 Federal Information Processing Standards Publication 198, 2002: Standard for the Keyed-Hash Message Authentication Code (HMAC): U.S. Department Of Commerce, Technology Administration, National Institute Of Standards And Technology GlobalPlatform KMS GlobalPlatform Key Management System Functional Requirements, version 1.0 GlobalPlatform MS GlobalPlatform Messaging Specification, version 1.0 GlobalPlatform SCMS GlobalPlatform Smart Card Management System Functional Requirements, version 4.0 GlobalPlatform Systems Scripting Specification GlobalPlatform Systems Scripting Specification, version 1.1 ISO/IEC 7816-3:1997 Identification cards - Integrated circuit(s) cards with contacts - Part 3: Electronic signals and transmission protocols ISO/IEC 7816-4:2005 Identification cards ­ Integrated circuit cards - Part 4: Organization, security and commands for interchange 4 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Standard / Specification Description ISO/IEC 7816-6:2004 Identification cards - Integrated circuit(s) cards with contacts- Part 6: Interindustry data elements ISO/IEC 7816-15:2004 Identification cards - Integrated circuit cards with contacts - Part 15: Cryptographic information application ISO 8731-1:1987 [IS8731-1] Banking - Approved algorithms for message authentication Part 1: DEA ISO/IEC 8825-1:2002 | ITU-T Recommendation X.690 (2002) Information technology ­ ASN.1 encoding rules: Specification of Basic Encoding Rules (BER), Canonical Encoding Rules (CER) and Distinguished Encoding Rules (DER) ISO/IEC 9594-8 | ITU-T Recommendation X.509 (2000) Information Technology - Open Systems Interconnection - The Directory: Public-Key and Attribute Certificate Frameworks ISO/IEC 9796-2:2002 Information technology - Security techniques - Digital signature schemes giving message recovery - Part 2: Integer factorization based mechanisms ISO/IEC 9797:1994 [IS9797] Information technology ­ Security techniques - Data integrity mechanism using a cryptographic check function employing a block cipher algorithm ISO/IEC 9899:1999 Programming languages - C ISO/IEC 10116: 1997 [IS10116] Information technology - Modes of operation of an n-bit block cipher algorithm ISO/IEC 10118-3: 1998 [IS10118-3] Information technology ­ Security techniques - Hash functions ­Part 3: Dedicated hash functions ISO/IEC 14443-3:2001 Identification cards - Contactless integrated circuit(s) cards - Proximity cards - Part 3: Initialization and anticollision ISO/IEC 14443-4:2001 Identification cards - Contactless integrated circuit(s) cards - Proximity cards - Part 4: Transmission protocol ISO/IEC 18033-3:2005 Information Technology - Security techniques - Encryption algorithms Part 3: Block ciphers Java CardTM Go to the following website for Java CardTM documentation: http://java.sun.com/products/javacard MAO-DOC-REF-009 MULTOS Guide to Generating Application Load Units, version 2.51 MULTOSTM Go to the following website for MULTOSTM documentation: http://www.multos.com NICSS Framework (NICSS-F) NICSS Prerequisites, First Edition, version 1.20, April 24, 2001, The Next generation IC Card System Study group PKCS#1 (RFC 2437) PKCS #1 v2.0: RSA Cryptography Standard, RSA Laboratories, October 1998 (RFC 2437). Table 1-1: Normative References 1.3 Terminology and Definitions Table 1-2 defines the expressions used within this Specification that use an upper case first letter in each word of the expression. Expressions within this document that use a lower case first letter in each word take the common sense meaning. (Tagged data elements are also given an upper case first letter in each word of their names.) March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 5 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Term Definition Application Instance of an Executable Module after it has been installed and made selectable Application Management System An off-card application-specific system required to successfully implement an Application Provider's service to a cardholder Application Protocol Data Unit (APDU) Standard communication messaging protocol between a card accepting device and a smart card Application Provider Entity that owns an application and is responsible for the application's behavior Application Session The link between the Application and the external world on a logical channel starting with the selection of the Application and ending when another Application selection occurs on the logical channel, the logical channel is closed or the Card Session terminates Asymmetric Cryptography A cryptographic technique that uses two related transformations, a public transformation (defined by the Public Key component) and a private transformation (defined by the Private Key component); these two key components have a property so that it is computationally infeasible to discover the Private Key, even if given the Public Key Basic Logical Channel The permanently available interface between the card and an external entity. The Basic Logical Channel is numbered zero Card Content Code and Application information (but not Application data) contained in the card that is under the responsibility of the OPEN e.g. Executable Load Files, Application instances, etc Card Image Number (CIN) An identifier for a specific GlobalPlatform card Card Issuer Entity that owns the card and is ultimately responsible for the behavior of the card Card Management System An off-card system providing functions to manage various card types and their associated application(s)and specific configurations for cardholders Card Manager Generic term for the card management entities of a GlobalPlatform card i.e. the OPEN, Issuer Security Domain and a Cardholder Verification Method services provider Card Recognition Data Information that tells an external system, in particular a Smart Card Management System (SCMS), how to work with the card (including indicating that this is a GlobalPlatform card) Card Session The link between the card and the external world starting at card reset (contact cards), activation (contactless cards) or power on of the card and ending with a subsequent reset (contact cards), deactivation (contactless cards) or power off of the card Card Unique Data Data that uniquely identifies a card being the concatenation of the Issuer Identification Number and Card Image Number Cardholder The end user of a card Cardholder Verification Method (CVM) A method to ensure that the person presenting the card is the person to whom the card was issued 6 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Term Definition Certificate In this Specification, a Certificate refers to a key certificate: the public key and identity of an entity together with some other information, rendered unforgeable by signing with the private key of the certification authority which issued that Certificate. Controlling Authority A Controlling Authority has the privilege to keep the control over the Card Content through the mandating of DAP Verification Current Security Level A level of security that is to be applied to the current command-response pair in a Secure Channel Protocol using secure messaging. It is set for an individual command (APDU pair): the current incoming command APDU and the next response. DAP Block Part of the Load File used for ensuring Load File Data Block verification DAP Verification A mechanism used by a Security Domain to verify that a Load File Data Block is authentic Delegated Management Pre-authorized Card Content changes performed by an approved Application Provider Digital Signature A cryptographic transformation of data that allows the recipient of the data to prove the origin and integrity of the data; it protects the sender and the recipient of the data against forgery by third parties; it also protects the sender against forgery by the recipient Executable Load File Actual on-card container of one or more application's executable code (Executable Modules). It may reside in Immutable Persistent Memory or may be created in Mutable Persistent Memory as the resulting image of a Load File Data Block Executable Module Contains the on-card executable code of a single application present within an Executable Load File GlobalPlatform Registry A container of information related to Card Content management Host A logical term used to represent the back end systems that support the GlobalPlatform system; hosts perform functions such as authorization and authentication, administration, Post-Issuance application code and data downloading, and transactional processing Immutable Persistent Memory Memory that can only be read Issuer Security Domain The primary on-card entity providing support for the control, security, and communication requirements of the card administrator (typically the Card Issuer) Life Cycle The existence of Card Content on a GlobalPlatform card and the various stages of this existence where applicable; or the stages in the life of the card itself Life Cycle State A specific state within the Life Cycle of the card or of Card Content Load File A file transferred to a GlobalPlatform card that contains a Load File Data Block and possibly one or more DAP Blocks Load File Data Block Part of the Load File that contains one or more application(s) or libraries and support information for the application(s) as required by the specific platform Load File Data Block Hash A value providing integrity for the Load File Data Block March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 7 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Term Definition Load File Data Block Signature A value encompassing the Load File Data Block Hash and providing both integrity and authenticity of the Load File Data Block Message Authentication Code (MAC) A symmetric cryptographic transformation of data that provides data origin authentication and data integrity Mutable Persistent Memory Memory that can be modified OPEN The central on-card administrator that owns the GlobalPlatform Registry Post-Issuance Phase following the card being issued to the Cardholder Pre-Issuance Phase prior to the card being issued to the Cardholder Private Key The private component of the asymmetric key pair Public Key The public component of the asymmetric key pair Receipt An cryptographic value provided by the card (if so required by the Card Issuer) as proof that a Delegated Management operation has occurred Retry Counter A counter, used in conjunction with the Retry Limit, to determine when attempts to present a CVM value shall be prohibited Retry Limit The maximum number of times an invalid CVM value can be presented prior to the CVM prohibiting further attempts to present a CVM value Runtime Environment Functionality on a card which provides a secure environment for multiple applications to operate. Its role is complementary to that of the GlobalPlatform Card Manager Secure Channel A communication mechanism between an off-card entity and a card that provides a level of assurance, to one or both entities Secure Channel Protocol A secure communication protocol and set of security services Secure Channel Session A session, during an Application Session, starting with the Secure Channel initiation and ending with a Secure Channel termination or termination of either the Application Session or Card Session Security Domain On-card entity providing support for the control, security, and communication requirements of an off-card entity (e.g. the Card Issuer, an Application Provider or a Controlling Authority) Session Security Level A mandatory minimum level of security to be applied to protected commands in a Secure Channel Protocol using secure messaging. It is established during the initialization of the Secure Channel Session, either explicitly or implicitly. Supplementary Logical Channel Up to 19 additional interfaces (other than the permanently available Basic Logical Channel) between the card and an external entity. Each Supplementary Logical Channel is numbered from 1 up to 19 Supplementary Security Domain A Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain Symmetric Cryptography A cryptographic technique that uses the same secret key for both the originator's and the recipienťs transformation Token A cryptographic value provided by a Card Issuer as proof that a Delegated Management operation has been authorized Trust Point An authority whose public key is trusted by a Security Domain or OffCard Entity through some undefined mechanism such as a secure process that delivers the public key in a self-signed certificate. A Trust Poinťs public key is typically the 'highesť public key known to the entity. 8 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Term Definition UICC The ICC as defined by ETSI Project Smart Card Platform (EP SCP) Table 1-2: Terminology and Definitions 1.4 Abbreviations and Notations Abbreviation Meaning AES Advanced Encryption Standard AID Application Identifier APDU Application Protocol Data Unit API Application Programming Interface ASCII American Standard Code for Information Interchange ATR Answer-to-Reset ATQ Answer-to-Request (for contactless cards) BCD Binary Coded Decimal BER Basic Encoding Rules CAT Card Application Toolkit; or Cryptographic Authorization Template CBC Cipher Block Chaining CCT Control Reference Template for Cryptographic Checksum CIN Card Image Number / Card Identification Number CLA Class byte of the command message CRT Control Reference Template CT Control Reference Template for Confidentiality CVM Cardholder Verification Method DAP Data Authentication Pattern DEK Data Encryption Key DER Distinguished Encoding Rules DES Data Encryption Standard DST Control Reference Template for Digital Signature ECB Electronic Code Book EMV Europay, MasterCard, and Visa; used to refer to the ICC Specifications for Payment Systems ENC Encryption FCI File Control Information HEX Hexadecimal HMAC Keyed-Hash Message Authentication Code ICC Integrated Circuit Card ICV Initial Chaining Vector IIN Issuer Identification Number INS Instruction byte of the command message ISO International Organization for Standardization Lc Exact length of data in a case 3 or case 4 command Le Maximum length of data expected in response to a case 2 or case 4 command LV Length Value MAC Message Authentication Code March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 9 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Abbreviation Meaning MEL MULTOS Executable Language. The instruction set of the MULTOSTM runtime environment OID Object Identifier P1 Reference control parameter 1 P2 Reference control parameter 2 PIN Personal Identification Number PKI Public Key Infrastructure RAM Random Access Memory RFU Reserved for Future Use RID Registered Application Provider Identifier ROM Read-only Memory RSA Rivest / Shamir / Adleman asymmetric algorithm SCP Secure Channel Protocol; or (ETSI) Smart Card Platform SW Status Word SW1 Status Word One SW2 Status Word Two TLV Tag Length Value TP Trust Point 'xx' Hexadecimal values are expressed as hexadecimal digits between single quotation marks 'X' A value in a cell of a table whose purpose is described in the 'meaning' column of the table '-' A value (0 or 1) in a cell of a table that does not affect the 'meaning' given for that row of the table Table 1-3: Abbreviations and Notations 1.5 Revisions History 1.5.1 Open Platform Card Specification v2.0 to Open Platform Card Specification v2.0.1 This section provides a brief summary of the revisions made to the Open Platform Card Specification 2.0 Card Specification in the Open Platform Card Specification 2.0.1'. Wording and formatting of the specification had been improved. Anything relating to a specific implementation of Open Platform had been removed from the main body of the specification and was detailed in the appendices. Anything specific relating to the personalization of Open Platform or Applications had been removed. The changes relating specifically to the Java CardTM implementation of Open Platform were listed in the beginning of appendix A - GlobalPlatform API. All the issues identified in the FAQ document dated April-June 1999 and the FAQ documents dated OctoberNovember 1999 and relating strictly to Open Platform, had been included in this version. The one caveat to this was the point 3.1.20 of the FAQ document dated October-November 1999 i.e. it is now required that the Security Domain associated with an Application be the same Security Domain used to perform Delegated Management functions for this Application. 10 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The inclusion of Part V described a specific use of security and key management that was not present in Open Platform 2.0. 1.5.2 Major Adjustments in GlobalPlatform Card Specification V2.1 The following major adjustments are the modifications decided by GlobalPlatform Members. All of these modifications are intended to make the GlobalPlatform more usable for a wider number of entities while maintaining backwards compatibility. The minor editing changes and rewording for readability are not listed. 1.5.2.1 Enhancement to DAP Verification Scheme In the process of implementing GlobalPlatform cards that supported Delegated Management and DAP Verification, it was determined that the method defined in the previous version of Open Platform necessitated the verification of multiple signatures on large blocks of data (Load File and Load File Data Block) that differed only slightly. When multiple DAP Verifications and possibly Delegated Management was being performed simultaneously, multiple hash generations were required to run concurrently. This negatively impacted the performance of the load process. A new method has been defined in which instead of signing large blocks of data, a hash of the critical large block of data (Load File Data Block) may be generated and this hash signed. In this new method signatures are required on very much smaller blocks of information. Only one hash generation and check is required on the Load File Data Block. 1.5.2.2 Application Reception of Data from Security Domains The Secure Channel mechanism previously provided by Open Platform only allowed an Application to request services from its associated Security Domain. A new service is now provided that may be initiated by a Security Domain. It allows data to be passed by the Security Domain associated with an Application to the Application for further processing. The main purpose of this service is to facilitate the personalization of Applications through the Applications' associated Security Domain. A new INSTALL command has been defined to identify the Application to be personalized. 1.5.2.3 Security Domain Association and Extradition In the previous Open Platform Card Specification an Executable Load File was associated with a Security Domain and all Applications instantiated from an Executable Load file, when installed, were also associated with the same Security Domain. This method was restrictive. The new scheme provides Application Extradition. Application Extradition allows an Application that is already associated with a Security Domain to be extradited and associated with another Security Domain. Another benefit provided by this enhancement is that in addition to Executable Load Files and Applications, now applications within Executable Load Files become visible in the GlobalPlatform Registry at the time that the Executable Load File is registered. In order to avoid confusion between selectable Applications and the applications within an Executable Load File a new term has been introduced i.e. Executable Module. The term Executable Module is intended to identify the one or more applications present within an Executable Load File. 1.5.2.4 Executable Modules In the previous Open Platform Card Specification, an off-card entity could only retrieve information relating to the Executable Load Files and selectable Applications present on the card. In order to enhance the information returned by the GET STATUS command, an additional set of information will be stored in the GlobalPlatform Registry and returned in the response to the GET STATUS command. This information relates to the Executable Module and it is March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 11 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. now possible to also retrieve information relating to application code within an Executable Load File that is available for installation. 1.5.2.5 Card Recognition Data A concerted effort was made to ensure that there would be a uniform method to determine basic information about a card. The Card Recognition Data and the method for retrieving this data have been included in this version of the GlobalPlatform Card Specification. Information such as: this is a GlobalPlatform card, implemented in a particular way, and with a particular version number is now available. 1.5.2.6 Support of New Secure Channel Protocols In order to be more accommodating, the method for including additional Secure Channel Protocols has been formalized. While this was allowed in previous versions of the Open Platform Card Specification, only one Secure Channel Protocol was defined. As part of the efforts of GlobalPlatform a formal process for including Secure Channel Protocols is defined. This version of the specification details two Secure Channel Protocols and their selection process. To provide clarity a slight re-organization of the GlobalPlatform Card specification has been done. Part V of the Open Platform 2.0.1' specification has been removed. Part of its content is incorporated into Part III and the rest is moved into the appendices. 1.5.2.7 Cardholder Verification Method Services Additional services and features regarding the optional CVM have been included. In the previous versions of the Open Platform Card Specification, the CVM provided the possibility for a single PIN to be common across multiple Applications. When the PIN was changed by one Application it became visible to all Applications. However an Application could not check whether the PIN had previously been correctly presented to another Application during the same Card Session. The new Card Verification Method (CVM) services provide the ability to do this check. 1.5.2.8 Card Manager Separation Historically the Card Manager has been viewed and defined as the major on-card component with no distinction or separation between the various responsibilities encompassed within as well as not clearly defining where the runtime environment ends and the Card Manager begins. A decision has been made to separate the Card Manager into 3 distinct entities and clearly identifying what runtime environment functionality must be within each. While the term Card Manager is still present, it now encompasses the OPEN, the Issuer Security Domain and the Cardholder Verification Method Services provider. This new structure clarifies the responsibilities of the Card Manager and takes into account both Java Card and Windows Powered Smart Card. 1.5.2.9 Windows Powered Smart Card API The GlobalPlatform API for Windows Powered Smart Card is now included. 1.5.2.10 Java Card API Taking into account the various new features of the GlobalPlatform a new API providing support for these new, and all relevant existing, features has been specified for Java Card. The previous Open Platform API for Java Card defined in version 2.0.1' is deprecated and remains in this version for backward compatibility. 1.5.2.11 Appendices The body of the GlobalPlatform Card Specification only contains generic GlobalPlatform descriptions. All information specific to a particular implementation has been positioned in a set of appendices. 12 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 1.5.3 Revisions in GlobalPlatform Card Specification V2.1.1 The following modifications correct issues in the previous version and synchronize with recent evolutions of the underlying runtime environment specifications while maintaining full backwards compatibility. The minor editing changes and rewording for readability are not listed. 1.5.3.1 Errata All intermediate published errata have been incorporated into this version. There is also a small set of errata and precisions that would have been published at around the same time this version is released, and these have also been incorporated directly into this version. 1.5.3.2 Content Removal A new optional Card Content removal feature has been added that allows an Executable Load File and all its related Applications to be deleted in the same operation. 1.5.3.3 Logical Channels To meet the emerging needs of some industries and recent evolutions of the underlying runtime environment specifications, logical channel functionality is added to this version of the specification as an optional feature. 1.5.3.4 Additional Secure Channel Protocol Implementation Options An enhanced mechanism of generating a C-MAC has been added to both Secure Channel Protocol '01' and Secure Channel Protocol '02'. One new implementation option has been added for Secure Channel Protocol '01' and four new implementation options have been added for Secure Channel Protocol '02'. It is recommended that these new implementation options be used. 1.5.4 Major Adjustments in GlobalPlatform Card Specification V2.2 The following major adjustments are modifications decided by GlobalPlatform Members. All of these modifications are intended to make the GlobalPlatform more usable for a wider number of entities while maintaining full backward compatibility with previous versions. The body of the document has been reorganized to reflect these changes, to arrange it by functions and components as well as to remove excessive duplication. 1.5.4.1 PKI functionality and Card Content Management Card Content Management may now be performed by relying exclusively on asymmetric cryptography and a Public Key Infrastructure. This has resulted in the need to formalize the process of authentication and establishing ownership, so that the card can apply the relevant security and authorization rules for different off-card entities. A delete token is added as an option, so that the Card Issuer may have a PK based policy to authorize card content removal. 1.5.4.2 Over-The Air Functionality and Inter-Application Communication A mechanism for inter-application communication is formalized in terms of a general framework: Trusted Framework, which encompasses both the GlobalPlatform mechanism whereby an Application could receive its personalization data from its Security Domain as well as the SIM Toolkit and CAT frameworks defined for UICC cards by ETSI Project Smart Card Platform specifications. A new privilege - Trusted Path - between an on-card Receiving Entity and an on-card target Application is introduced. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 13 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 1.5.4.3 Contactless Cards, Implicit Selection and Logical Channels Support for contactless cards and dual interface cards (contact and contactless) is made more explicit in this version. With the introduction of a new installation parameter, different Applications can now be implicitly selected on different card I/O interfaces: contact or contactless (and potentially others), and different logical channels. The Default Selected privilege is redefined as the Card Reset privilege to modify the historical bytes. An Application is able to refuse explicit selection, e.g. because it does not support the current card I/O interface, and allow the (partial) selection process by OPEN to continue. To provide backward compatibility, the privilege confers implicit selectability if it has not been awarded to another Application. As a further option, support of logical channels is expanded up to 19 supplementary logical channels as defined by the latest version of ISO/IEC 7816-4. 1.5.4.4 Secure Channel Protocols A new Secure Channel Protocol based on asymmetric cryptography and a Public Key Infrastructure is introduced as Secure Channel Protocol '10'. Secure Channel Protocol '10' is compatible with CEN Workshop Agreement specification CWA 14890-1. It also fulfills the requirements of NICSS Framework Scheme defined by the Next Generation IC Card System Study Group (NICSS). This version references the Secure Channel Protocol defined by ETSI Project Smart Card Platform TS 102 226 specification as GlobalPlatform Secure Channel Protocol '80'. The number of recommended options for Secure Channel Protocol '02' is reduced to the most commonly used ones. The option indicator for Secure Channel Protocol '02' is defined as a bit-map and allows the support of any other option that was described in version 2.1.1 or Amendment A. Secure Channel Protocol '01' is now deprecated. The use of Security Levels associated with a secure channel session and an individual command-response pair have been made more explicit in this version. This version provides improved API support for Secure Channel Protocols. For example, an Application has the ability to increase the security level required for a (sequence of) individual command-response pair(s) using the GlobalPlatform API. 1.5.4.5 Global Services and CVMs A general framework for dynamic management of card-wide services is introduced whereby one or more Global Services Applications may be present on a card to provide services to other Applications. The Global Services Applications are distinguished by having the Global Service privilege. A new installation parameter allows the oncard registration of service parameters. Service parameters are standardized by GlobalPlatform and can be registered as unique on the card by Global Services Applications using the GlobalPlatform API. GlobalPlatform API extensions allow Applications to request and, if authorized, use the services offered by Global Services Applications. CVM functions are devolved from the OPEN to separate CVM Applications as Global Services Applications. Each CVM Application can handle one or multiple CVMs. GlobalPlatform API extensions allow CVM Applications to establish whether Applications have the authority to use and/or modify CVMs. Backward compatibility of the GlobalPlatform API is ensured for existing Applications using CVM services. 1.5.4.6 Security Domains, Privileges and Hierarchies The privileges associated with Security Domains, in particular the Issuer Security Domain, are formalized so that access rights to Card Content Management functionality are more explicit. The Issuer Security Domain now has an explicit set of privileges, including new privileges such as Authorized Management or Token Verification. Other 14 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. new privileges are introduced to formalize the access rights awarded to Security Domains and Applications such as Global Registry Access, Global Lock and Global Delete. Security Domain and Application privileges can now be modified dynamically on the card during their lifetime. CVM identifiers are standardized by GlobalPlatform. Security Domains and OPEN itself can now have their Card Content Management functionality restricted dynamically during their Life Cycle through the use of a new INSTALL command. Security Domains can now be associated with other Security Domains and so create a hierarchy of Security Domains. Association with Security Domains is made more systematic, so that a hierarchy of control can be established through association and extradition. Multiple hierarchies of Security Domains can be established, including by extraditing a Security Domain to itself and so making it the root of a new hierarchy. Access rights of Security Domains to Card Content Management functionality are expressed in regard to their association and hierarchy. Card Content Management functionality has been extended to include explicit extradition of Executable Load Files. The Token Verification privilege and the Receipt Generation privilege have been added. 1.5.4.7 On-Card APIs for Applications A GlobalPlatform API expressed in the 'C' programming language for MULTOSTM cards is now included. The GlobalPlatform API has been expanded and enhanced in order to support the new functionality introduced in this version. References to Windows Powered Smart Card, and its specific API, have been deleted from this version. The deprecated Open Platform Java Card API has also been removed from this version. 1.5.4.8 Key Management New optional attributes for cryptographic keys are added to allow for more control, and for the partitioning of keys with different purposes. The new attributes are key usage and key access condition. New key types are also added to support new cryptographic algorithms. 1.5.4.9 Amendment A Amendment A to version 2.1.1 has been incorporated into this version. It comprises a set of optional extensions in support of GlobalPlatform Scripting Specification, EMV Card Personalization Specification and ETSI Project Smart Card Platform TS 102.225 and TS 102 226 specifications. 1.5.4.10 Errata and Precisions All errata and precisions published since the release of version 2.1.1 and Amendment A have been incorporated into this version. 1.5.4.11 Other Major Changes New installation parameters are added to further card memory management and allow memory reservation. The Get Data command can now be used to retrieve a list of Applications present on the card. It is now possible to lock, and subsequently unlock, a Security Domain and all its associated Applications in a single command. It is now possible to load, install and make selectable an Application in a single combined process. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 15 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 16 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Part II Architecture March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 17 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 2 System Architecture Deploying a large number of chip cards based on dynamic, multi-application technology is not unlike deploying a very large number of workstations in a vast, semi-connected network. These card-based workstations support several different applications at any one time as well as allow for the possibility of updating or deleting those applications and installing new applications at any point in time. Card Management Systems Applications Servers Key Management Systems Personalization Systems Application Development Tools Terminal Management Systems Cards 6445677 Card Acceptance Devices GlobalPlatform Open Standards Architecture for Dynamic or Static Multi or Single Application Card Schemes Cell PhonesSet Top Boxes Figure 2-1: GlobalPlatform Architecture The GlobalPlatform architecture is designed to provide Card Issuers with the system management architecture for managing these smart cards. Although GlobalPlatform is based on the paradigm that there is one single Card Issuer for a card, it offers to the Card Issuer the flexibility for managing an ever-changing array of business partners who may want to run applications on the Card Issuer's cards. GlobalPlatform gives Card Issuers the power to manage their cards with the ultimate flexibility by enabling them to share control over part of their card with business partners. The ultimate control always rests with the Card Issuer, but through GlobalPlatform, the business partners of a Card Issuer can be allowed to manage their own Applications on the Card Issuer's cards as appropriate. 18 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 3 Card Architecture The GlobalPlatform card architecture is comprised of a number of components that ensure hardware and vendorneutral interfaces to Applications and off-card management systems. The following figure shows the components in a sample card configuration which includes one or more applications from the Card Issuer; one or more applications from one of the business partners of the Card Issuer, referred to as Application Providers; and one or more applications providing global services (e.g. CVM services) to other applications. Security Domain Runtime Environment OPEN and GP Trusted Framework Security Domain Security Domain GP API RTE API Global Services Application(s) Application Provider Application(s) Card Issuer Application(s) Application Providers' Security Domain(s) Controlling Authorities' Security Domain(s) Issuer's Security Domain Figure 3-1: GlobalPlatform Card Architecture All applications shall be implemented in a secure runtime environment that includes a hardware-neutral Application Programming Interface (API) to support application portability. GlobalPlatform does not mandate a specific runtime environment technology. The Card Manager is the primary GlobalPlatform card component that acts as the central administrator for a GlobalPlatform card. Special key and security management applications called Security Domains March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 19 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. are created to ensure complete separation of keys between the Card Issuer and multiple other Security Domain providers. 3.1 Security Domains Security Domains act as the on-card representatives of off-card authorities. There are three main types of Security Domain, reflecting the three types of off-card authority recognized by a card: * The Issuer Security Domain is the primary, mandatory on-card representative of the Card Administrator, typically the Card Issuer; * Supplementary Security Domains are additional, optional on-card representatives of Application Providers or the Card Issuer; or their agents (e.g. service bureaus); * Controlling Authority Security Domains are a special type of Supplementary Security Domain. A Controlling Authority may exist whose role is to enforce the security policy on all application code loaded to the card. If so, the Controlling Authority also uses this type of Security Domain as its on-card representative. There may be more than one such Security Domain. In the main, all three types are referred to simply as Security Domains in this Specification; Security Domains support security services such as key handling, encryption, decryption, digital signature generation and verification for their providers' (Card Issuer, Application Provider or Controlling Authority) applications. Each Security Domain is established on behalf of a Card Issuer, an Application Provider or a Controlling Authority when these off-card entities require the use of keys that are completely isolated from each other. 3.2 Global Services Applications One or more Global Services Applications may be present on the card to provide services to other Applications on the card. An example of such services are Cardholder Verification Method services. 3.3 Runtime Environment The GlobalPlatform is intended to run on top of any secure, multi-application card runtime environment. This runtime environment is responsible for providing a hardware-neutral API for applications as well as a secure storage and execution space for applications to ensure that each application's code and data can remain separate and secure from other applications on the card. The carďs runtime environment is also responsible for providing communication services between the card and off-card entities. Cards should comply with appropriate standards: ISO/IEC 7816-3, ISO/IEC 7816-4, ISO/IEC 14443-3 and ISO/IEC 14443-4 in terms of announcing options supported in the ATR/ATQ such as the communications protocol, logical channels and command chaining. 3.4 Trusted Framework GlobalPlatform cards may contain one or more Trusted Frameworks, which provide inter-application communication services between Applications. Trusted Frameworks are not Applications or Security Domains, but have a special status in that they are part of or extensions of the carďs run-time environment. They should be assessed for security similarly to the runtime environmenťs security assessment. See appendix G - Trusted Framework Inter-Application Communication for further details. 20 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 3.5 GlobalPlatform Environment (OPEN) The main responsibilities of the GlobalPlatform Environment (OPEN) are to provide an API to applications, command dispatch, Application selection, (optional) logical channel management, and Card Content management. These functions shall be implemented by the OPEN if they are not provided by the runtime environment, or if provided by the runtime environment in a way not complying with this Specification. The OPEN performs the application code loading and related Card Content management and memory management. The OPEN also manages the installation of applications loaded to the card. The OPEN is responsible for enforcing security principles defined for Card Content management. Another important function provided by the OPEN is APDU command dispatching and Application selection. When a SELECT command is successfully processed, the OPEN sets the Application referenced in the SELECT command to be the selected Application and subsequent Application commands shall be dispatched to the selected Application. The availability of logical channels introduces an additional dimension to the carďs architecture as multiple Applications may be selected concurrently. The OPEN shall rely on the runtime environment to control whether and when an individual Application can be selected concurrently with itself or another Application. When supporting logical channels, the OPEN shall allow for Applications that have no notion of logical channels as well as those that are multi-selectable. Support of logical channels is optional. Cards may support one or more (up to 19 according to ISO/IEC 7816-4) Supplementary Logical Channels. The OPEN owns and uses an internal GlobalPlatform Registry as an information resource for Card Content management. The GlobalPlatform Registry contains information for managing the card, Executable Load Files, Applications, Security Domain associations, and privileges. 3.6 GlobalPlatform API The GlobalPlatform API provides services to Applications (e.g. Cardholder verification, personalization, or security services). It also provides Card Content management services (e.g. card locking or Application Life Cycle State update) to Applications. For the specification of the Application Programming Interface (API) on a Java CardTM, see appendix A.1. For the specification of the Application Programming Interface (API) on a MULTOSTM card, see appendix A.2. 3.7 Card Content All Card Content, as defined in this specification, is first available on the card in the form of an Executable Load File. An Executable Load File can either exist in: * Immutable Persistent Memory in which case it is loaded during the manufacturing stage and cannot be altered (except being disabled); or * Mutable Persistent Memory in which case it can be loaded, or removed during Pre-Issuance or Post- Issuance. Each Executable Load File may contain one or multiple Executable Modules, being application code. The installation of an Application creates an instance from an Executable Module plus possibly Application data within Mutable Persistent Memory. Any Application instance and its related data can be removed. A GlobalPlatform card is intended to support multiple Executable Load Files and multiple Executable Modules and as such multiple Applications may co-exist on an GlobalPlatform card. Note that the foregoing description assumes that Executable Modules will be present in the Executable Load File: however, their presence is optional and depends on the requirements of the Runtime Environment. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 21 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Figure 3-2 represents the relationship between an Executable Load File, an Executable Module (in the case where Executable Modules are present) and an Application. Mutable Persistent Memory Executable Load File present in Immutable Persistent Memory or loaded into Mutable Persistent Memory Executable Module Executable Module Application instance Application instance Figure 3-2 Card Content Relationships 3.8 Card Manager The Card Manager, as the central administrator of the card, assumes multiple responsibilities. The Card Manager can be viewed as three entities: * The GlobalPlatform Environment (OPEN); * The Issuer Security Domain; and * Cardholder Verification Method Services. 22 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 4 Security Architecture Well-designed security architectures are crucial to protecting the structure and function of cards within the GlobalPlatform system. This chapter outlines: * The security goals behind the architecture; * The specific responsibilities of the Card Issuer as the owner of the card; * The Application Providers as the owners of the Applications; * The Controlling Authority; * The security requirements for the on-card components; * The cryptographic support provided by GlobalPlatform 4.1 Goals The primary goal of the GlobalPlatform is to ensure the security and integrity of the carďs components for the life of the card. These components are * The runtime environment; * The OPEN; * The Issuer Security Domain; * Supplementary Security Domains; * The Applications. To ensure card security and integrity, the GlobalPlatform is designed to support a range of secure mechanisms for: * Data integrity; * Resource availability; * Confidentiality; * Authentication. The choice of security policy and cryptography is assumed to be industry and product specific. Because the cards are only part of a larger card system involving multiple parties and off-card components, the GlobalPlatform also relies upon non-cryptographic, procedural means of protection, such as code testing and verification, physical security, and secure key handling. However, these aspects are out of scope for this card specification. 4.2 Security Responsibilities and Requirements 4.2.1 Card Issuer's Security Responsibilities The Card Issuer is responsible for: * Generating and loading the Issuer Security Domain keys; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 23 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Enforcing standards and policies for Application Providers governing all aspects of Applications to be provided to the Card Issuer or operated on the Card Issuer's cards; * Working with Application Providers to create and initialize Security Domains other than the Issuer Security Domain; * Determining policy with regards to card and Application Life Cycle management, velocity checking levels, privileges, and other security parameters; * Managing the application code loading and installing both on a Pre-Issuance and Post-Issuance basis, and * Cryptographically authorizing load, install, and extradition to be performed by Application Providers. 4.2.2 Application Provider's Security Responsibilities The Application Provider is responsible for: * Generating the keys for its own Security Domains or obtaining Security Domain keys from a trusted third party; * Working with the Card Issuer to load generated keys into the Application Provider's Security Domain; * Providing applications that meet the Card Issuer's security standards and policies; * Providing load file data block signatures according to its own security policy for integrity and source authenticity; * Obtaining pre-authorization for load, install, and extradition from the Card Issuer; * Returning receipts for load, install, delete, and extradition, according to the Card Issuer's policy. 4.2.3 Controlling Authority's Security Responsibilities A Controlling Authority is responsible for: * Generating the keys for its own Security Domain or obtaining Security Domain keys from a trusted third party; * Working with the Card Issuer to load generated keys into the Controlling Authority's Security Domain; * Providing load file data block signatures according to its own security policy for integrity and source authenticity. 4.2.4 On-Card Components' Security Requirements 4.2.4.1 Runtime Environment Security Requirements The runtime environment is responsible for: * Providing an interface to all Applications that ensures that the runtime environment security mechanisms cannot be bypassed, deactivated, corrupted or otherwise circumvented; * Performing secure memory management to ensure that: - Each application's code and data (including transient session data) as well as the runtime environment itself and its data (including transient session data) is protected from unauthorized access from within the card; 24 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. - When more than one logical channel is supported, each concurrently selected Application's code and data (including transient session data) as well as the runtime environment itself and its data (including transient session data) is protected from unauthorized access from within the card; - The previous contents of the memory is not accessible when that memory is reused; - The memory recovery process is secure and consistent in case of a loss of power or withdrawal of the card from the card reader while an operation is in progress; * Providing communication services with off-card entities that ensures the proper transmission (according to the specific communication protocol rules) of unaltered command and response messages. (See the appropriate runtime environment documentation for more details). 4.2.4.2 Trusted Framework Requirements Each Trusted Framework present on the card shall: * Check the application access rules of the inter-acting Applications according to their respective privileges; * Enforce the Trusted Framework security rules for inter-application communication, including the rules; defined in appendix G; * Ensure that incoming messages are properly routed unaltered to their intended destinations; * Ensure that any response messages are properly returned unaltered (except for any cryptographic protection) to the original receiver of the incoming message. 4.2.4.3 OPEN Security Requirements The OPEN shall: * Provide an interface to all Applications that ensures that the GlobalPlatform security mechanism cannot be bypassed, deactivated, corrupted or otherwise circumvented; * Check application access rules according to the Applications' privileges; * Manage card and Application Life Cycle (see chapter 5 - Life Cycle Models); * Ensure that the Card Content changes are authorized by the Card Issuer; * Ensure that application code has been signed by the Controlling Authority represented on the card; * Ensure that application code has been signed by Application Providers represented on the card, if required. 4.2.4.4 Security Domain Security Requirements Security Domains enforce the security policies of their off-card Security Domain Provider. When applicable a Security Domain shall: * Communicate with off-card entities in accordance with its Security Domain Provider's security policy in Pre-Issuance and Post-Issuance; * Manage on-card data securely; * Provide cryptographic protection services for its own Applications during their personalization and optionally during their subsequent operation; * Request the OPEN to load, install, extradite, and delete card content; * Return to the off-card entity any receipt for load, install, extradition, and delete; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 25 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Verify the authorization for Card Content changes initiated by an off-card authority; * Generate receipts for load, install, extradition, and delete; * Verify the load file data block signature when requested by the OPEN. 4.2.4.5 Global Services Application Security Requirements A Global Services Application shall: * Be able to provide services to other Applications, such as CVM services; * Hold the Global Services application-related data securely; * Perform internal security measures as required by the service. 4.2.4.6 Application Security Requirements Applications should: * Expose only data and resources that are necessary for proper application functionality and; * Perform internal security measures required by the Application Provider. 4.2.5 Back-End System Security Requirements Despite the best efforts of the card and the loading processes to provide a stable and secure environment, these components alone cannot ensure total security. The back-end systems (multiple back-end systems may exist for a single card), which communicate with the cards, perform the verifications, and manage the off-card key databases, also shall be trusted. Responsible personnel, secure operating systems, system security policies, and audit procedures are all essential components that secure the back-end systems. These requirements are beyond the scope of this Specification. Information on GlobalPlatform's off-card requirements relating to card management can be found in the GlobalPlatform Key Management System Functional Requirements, GlobalPlatform Smart Card Management System Functional Requirements and GlobalPlatform Messaging Specification. 4.3 Cryptographic support One of the major requirements for a GlobalPlatform card is the ability to provide a minimum level of cryptographic functionality. This cryptography is, for example, used for the generation of signatures, and is available for use by the Applications present on the card. The Issuer Security Domain shall implement one Secure Channel Protocol. A Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain shall implement [at least] one Secure Channel Protocol. A GlobalPlatform card should support symmetric cryptography such as the Data Encryption Standard (DES) algorithm. A GlobalPlatform card may also support asymmetric cryptography such as the Rivest / Shamir / Adleman (RSA) algorithm. The following cryptographic services are described in this section: * Integrity and authentication; * Secure messaging. When present, services to encrypt and decrypt any pattern of data using these algorithms shall be available to Applications. It is the responsibility of the Card Issuer or the Controlling Authority to set up the appropriate off-card procedures to comply with the governmental restrictions upon cryptography. Features to disable or restrict cryptography usage by Applications on a card are beyond the scope of this Specification. 26 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 4.3.1 Secure Card Content Management The concepts of integrity and authentication represent an additional value associated with a message or a block of data. The purpose of this additional value is to provide a method of verifying the source and/or the integrity of particular block of code or data. The following describes the different usages of integrity and authentication for Card Content management in this Specification. 4.3.1.1 Load File Data Block Hash The Load File Data Block Hash is intended to verify the integrity of a complete Load File Data Block when loaded to a GlobalPlatform card. The Load File Data Block Hash is used in the computation of: * The Load File Data Block Signature (see section 4.3.1.2 - Load File Data Block Signature); and * The Load Token (see section 4.3.1.3 - Delegated Management Tokens). 4.3.1.2 Load File Data Block Signature (DAP) The Load File Data Block Signature is an authentication value generated by an off-card entity (an Application Provider or a Controlling Authority). This is the signature of the Load File Data Block Hash and is included in the DAP Block of the Load File. One or more DAP Blocks may be included in a Load File. When present during the loading of a Load File to the card, each signature shall be verified by the appropriate Security Domain. The verification operation is referred to as Data Authentication Pattern (DAP) Verification. 4.3.1.3 Delegated Management Tokens Delegated Management Tokens are signatures of one or more Delegated Management functions (loading, installing, extraditing and deleting) generated by the Card Issuer and used to provide the Card Issuer the control over these Card Content changes. Tokens shall be verified by the appropriate Security Domain. 4.3.1.4 Receipts The appropriate Security Domain may generate Receipts during Delegated Management. A Receipt is proof that an Application Provider has modified the Card Content. 4.3.2 Secure Communication A GlobalPlatform card may provide security services related to information exchanged between the card and an offcard entity. The security level of the communication with an off-card entity does not necessarily apply to each individual message being transmitted but can only apply to the environment and/or context in which messages are transmitted. The concept of the Life Cycle of the card (see section 5.1 - Card Life Cycle) may be used to determine the security level of the communication between the card and an off-card entity. The choice of cryptographic algorithms for secure communication is assumed to be industry and product specific. A GlobalPlatform card offers the following security services associated with messages and defined within a Secure Channel Protocol (see chapter 10 - Secure Communication): * Entity authentication - in which the card or the off-card entity proves its authenticity to the other entity through a cryptographic exchange; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 27 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Integrity and authentication - in which the receiving entity (the card or off-card entity) ensures that the data being received from the sending entity (respectively the off-card entity or card) actually came from an authenticated entity in the correct sequence and has not been altered; * Confidentiality - in which data being transmitted from the sending entity (the off-card entity or card) to the receiving entity (respectively the card or off-card entity) is not viewable by an unauthenticated entity. Authentication of the off-card entity combined with the card Life Cycle State allows the card to assume its environment and/or context. 28 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Part III Implementation March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 29 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 5 Life Cycle Models The GlobalPlatform defines Life Cycle models to control the functionality and security of the following GlobalPlatform components: * Card; * Executable Load Files; * Executable Modules; * Security Domains; * Applications. The OPEN owns and maintains the Life Cycle information within the GlobalPlatform Registry and manages the requested state transitions. The Life Cycle models of each component are presented in this chapter. 5.1 Card Life Cycle The OPEN is responsible for maintaining the overall security and administration of the card and its content. As the OPEN plays this supervisory role over the entire card, its life cycle can be thought of as the life cycle of the card and is referred to as the card Life Cycle in the subsequent sections. From a GlobalPlatform perspective, the card Life Cycle begins with the state OP_READY. Although a cards life includes activities prior to the initial card Life Cycle State, these activities are considered card implementation specific and are beyond the scope of this Specification. The end of the card Life Cycle is the state TERMINATED. The Issuer Security Domain inherits the card Life Cycle State. 5.1.1 Card Life Cycle States The following card Life Cycle States shall apply: * OP_READY * INITIALIZED * SECURED * CARD_LOCKED * TERMINATED The card Life Cycle States OP_READY and INITIALIZED are intended for use during the Pre-Issuance phases of the carďs life. The states SECURED, CARD_LOCKED and TERMINATED are intended for use during the Post-Issuance phase of the card although it is possible to terminate the card at any point during its life. 5.1.1.1 Card Life Cycle State OP_READY The state OP_READY indicates that the runtime environment shall be available and the Issuer Security Domain, acting as the selected Application, shall be ready to receive, execute and respond to APDU commands. 30 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The following functionality shall be present when the card is in the state OP_READY: * The runtime environment shall be ready for execution; * The OPEN shall be ready for execution; * The Issuer Security Domain shall be the implicitly selected Application for all card interfaces; * Executable Load Files that were included in Immutable Persistent Memory shall be registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * An initial key shall be available within the Issuer Security Domain. The card shall be capable of Card Content changes, the loading of the Load Files containing applications not already present in the card may occur. The installation, from Executable Load Files, of any Application may occur. Additionally, if any personalization information is available at this stage, Applications may be personalized. The OP_READY state may be used by an off-card entity to perform the following actions: * Supplementary Security Domains may be loaded and/or installed; * The Security Domain keys may be inserted in order to maintain a cryptographic key separation from the Issuer Security Domain keys. 5.1.1.2 Card Life Cycle State INITIALIZED The state INITIALIZED is an administrative card production state. The state transition from OP_READY to INITIALIZED is irreversible. Its functionality is beyond the scope of this Specification. This state may be used to indicate that some initial data has been populated (e.g. Issuer Security Domain keys and/or data) but that the card is not yet ready to be issued to the Cardholder. 5.1.1.3 Card Life Cycle State SECURED The state SECURED is the intended operating card Life Cycle State in Post-Issuance. This state may be used by Security Domains and Applications to enforce their respective security policies. The state transition from INITIALIZED to SECURED is irreversible. The SECURED state should be used to indicate to off-card entities that the Issuer Security Domain contains all necessary keys and security elements for full functionality. 5.1.1.4 Card Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED The card Life Cycle state CARD_LOCKED is present to provide the capability to disable the selection of Security Domain and Applications. The card Life Cycle state transition from SECURED to CARD_LOCKED is reversible. Setting the card to this state means that the card shall only allow selection of the application with the Final Application privilege. Card Content changes including any type of data management (specifically Security Domain keys and data) are not allowed in this state. Either the OPEN, or a Security Domain with Card Lock privilege, or an Application with Card Lock privilege (see section 6.6 - Privileges), may initiate the transition from the state SECURED to the state CARD_LOCKED. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 31 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 5.1.1.5 Card Life Cycle State TERMINATED The state TERMINATED signals the end of the card Life Cycle and the card. The state transition from any other state to TERMINATED is irreversible. The state TERMINATED shall be used to permanently disable all card functionality with respect to any card content management and any life cycle changes. This card state is intended as a mechanism for an Application to logically 'destroy' the card for such reasons as the detection of a severe security threat or expiration of the card. If a Security Domain has the Final Application privilege only the GET DATA command shall be processed, all other commands defined in this specification shall be disabled and shall return an error. If an application has the Final Application privilege its command processing is subject to issuer policy. The OPEN itself, or a Security Domain with Card Terminate privilege, or an Application with Card Terminate privilege (see section 6.6 - Privileges), may initiate the transition from any of the previous states to the state TERMINATED. 5.1.2 Card Life Cycle State Transitions Figure 5-1 illustrates the state transition diagram for the card Life Cycle. This can typically be viewed as a sequential process with certain possibilities for reversing a state transition or skipping states. 32 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. OP_READY INITIALIZED SECURED CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED Legend Privileged Security Domain Privileged Application Figure 5-1: Card Life Cycle State Transitions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 33 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 5.2 Executable Load File/ Executable Module Life Cycle An Executable Load File is the actual on-card container of one or more application's executable code (Executable Modules). It may reside in Immutable Persistent Memory or may be created in Mutable Persistent Memory as the resulting image of a Load File Data Block. The format in which the Executable Load File is stored on the card is beyond the scope of this Specification. The OPEN owns and maintains the Executable Load File Life Cycle information within the GlobalPlatform Registry. 5.2.1 Executable Load File Life Cycle The Executable Load File Life Cycle can only have one state. 5.2.1.1 Executable Load Life Cycle LOADED The OPEN shall consider all Executable Load Files present in the card in Immutable Persistent Memory or Mutable Persistent Memory to be in the state LOADED. An Executable Load File transferred to the card through a Load File shall become an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry following the successful completion of the load process. Executable Load Files present in Immutable Persistent Memory shall automatically have entries within the GlobalPlatform Registry and initially be associated with the Issuer's Security Domain. 5.2.1.2 Executable Load File Deletion The OPEN may receive a request to delete an Executable Load File. If the Executable Load File cannot be physically deleted (e.g., because it is stored in Immutable Persistent Memory), the following behavior shall apply except that the actual space cannot be reclaimed. The space previously used to store a physically deleted Executable Load File is reclaimed and may be reused. The entries within the GlobalPlatform Registry of the Executable Load File and each Executable Module within the Executable Load File shall no longer be available, and the OPEN is not required to maintain a record of the deleted Executable Load File's or Executable Module's previous existence. If the received request is also intended to delete each of the Applications instantiated from the Executable Modules within this Executable Load File, then for each of these Applications the behavior described in section 5.3.1.4 Application Deletion or section 5.3.2.5 - Security Domain Deletion shall occur. 5.2.2 Executable Module Life Cycle The Executable Module Life Cycle is linked to the Executable Load File Life Cycle. 5.3 Application and Security Domain Life Cycle The Life Cycle of the Application or Security Domain begins when the application is instantiated from an Executable Module. The Life Cycle reflects states that are controlled by the OPEN and states that are controlled directly by the Application. The Application becomes an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry and the OPEN sets the Application Life Cycle State to the initial state of INSTALLED during the Application installation process. The OPEN is also responsible for making the Application available for selection by setting its Life Cycle State to SELECTABLE upon request during the Application installation process. Once an Application or Security Domain is available for selection, it takes control of managing its own Life Cycle. The definition of these state transitions is Application or Security Domain dependent and not controlled by the OPEN. 34 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. At any point in the Application or Security Domain Life Cycle, the OPEN may take control for security protection by setting the Life Cycle State to LOCKED. The OPEN also controls the deletion of an Application from the card. 5.3.1 Application Life Cycle States This Specification defines the following Application Life Cycle States: INSTALLED SELECTABLE LOCKED In addition to these Application Life Cycle States, the Application may define its own Application dependent states. Once the Application reaches the SELECTABLE state, it is responsible for managing the next steps of its own Life Cycle. It may use any Application specific states as long as these do not conflict with the states already defined by GlobalPlatform. The OPEN may not perform these transitions without instruction from the Application and the Application is responsible for defining state transitions and ensuring that these transitioning rules are respected. 5.3.1.1 Application Life Cycle State INSTALLED The state INSTALLED means that the Application executable code has been properly linked and that any necessary memory allocation has taken place. The Application becomes an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry and this entry is accessible to off-card entities authenticated by the associated Security Domain. The Application is not yet selectable. The installation process is not intended to incorporate personalization of the Application, which may occur as a separate step. 5.3.1.2 Application Life Cycle State SELECTABLE The state SELECTABLE means that the Application is able to receive commands from off-card entities. The state transition from INSTALLED to SELECTABLE is irreversible. The Application shall be properly installed and functional before it may be set to the state SELECTABLE. The transition to SELECTABLE may be combined with the Application installation process. The behavior of the Application in the state SELECTABLE is beyond the scope of this Specification. 5.3.1.3 Application Life Cycle State LOCKED The OPEN, the Application itself, the Application's associated Security Domain, an Application with the Global Lock privilege or a Security Domain with the Global Lock privilege uses the state LOCKED as a security management control to prevent the selection, and therefore the execution, of the Application. If the OPEN detects a threat from within the card and determines that the threat is associated with a particular Application, that Application may be prevented from further selection by the OPEN setting the state to LOCKED. Alternatively, the off-card entity may determine that a particular Application on the card needs to be locked for a business or security reason and may initiate the Application Life Cycle transition via the OPEN. Once the state is LOCKED, only the Application's associated Security Domain, an Application with Global Lock privilege or a Security Domain with Global Lock privilege is allowed to unlock the Application. The OPEN shall ensure that the Application Life Cycle returns to its previous state. 5.3.1.4 Application Deletion At any point in the Application Life Cycle, the OPEN may receive a request to delete an Application. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 35 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The space previously used to store a physically deleted Application is reclaimed and may be reused. The entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry shall no longer be available, and the OPEN is not required to maintain a record of the deleted Application's previous existence. 5.3.1.5 Application Specific Life Cycle States These states are Application specific. The behavior of the Application, while in these states, is determined by the Application itself and is beyond the scope of this Specification. The OPEN does not enforce any control on Application specific Life Cycle State transitions. 5.3.1.6 Application Life Cycle State Transitions Figure 5-2 illustrates the state transition diagram for the Application Life Cycle. This can typically be viewed as a sequential process with certain possibilities for reversing a state transition or skipping states. 36 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. INSTALLED SELECTABLE Application specific states LOCKED from application specific state Legend 1. A Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege 2. A Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege 5. The Application itself LOCKED from INSTALLED LOCKED from SELECTABLE 1 2 2 1 3 4 5 3 4 5 3 4 5 5 3. The associated Security Domain 4. A Security Domain or Application with Global Lock privilege Figure 5-2: Application Life Cycle State Transitions 5.3.2 Security Domain Life Cycle States This Specification defines the following states applicable to a Security Domain: 1. INSTALLED 2. SELECTABLE 3. PERSONALIZED March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 37 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 4. LOCKED There are no proprietary Security Domain Life Cycle States. 5.3.2.1 Security Domain Life Cycle State INSTALLED The state INSTALLED means that the Security Domain becomes an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry and this entry is accessible to off-card entities authenticated by the associated Security Domain. The Security Domain is not yet available for selection. It cannot be associated with Executable Load Files or Applications yet and therefore its Security Domain services are not available to Applications. 5.3.2.2 Security Domain Life Cycle State SELECTABLE The state SELECTABLE means that the Security Domain is able to receive commands (specifically personalization commands) from off-card entities. As they still do not have keys, the Security Domains cannot be associated with Executable Load Files or Applications and therefore their services are not available to Applications when they are in this state. The state transition from INSTALLED to SELECTABLE is irreversible. The transition to SELECTABLE may be combined with the Security Domain installation process. 5.3.2.3 Security Domain Life Cycle State PERSONALIZED The definition of what is required for a Security Domain to transition to the state PERSONALIZED is Security Domain dependent but is intended to indicate that the Security Domain has all the necessary personalization data and keys for full runtime functionality (i.e. usable in its intended environment). The transition from SELECTABLE to PERSONALIZED (initiated by the Security Domain itself) is irreversible. In the state PERSONALIZED, the Security Domain may be associated with Applications and its services become available to these associated Applications. 5.3.2.4 Security Domain Life Cycle State LOCKED The OPEN, the Security Domain itself, the Security Domain's associated Security Domain (if any), an Application with the Global Lock privilege or a Security Domain with the Global Lock privilege uses the state LOCKED as a security management control to prevent the selection of the Security Domain. If the OPEN detects a threat from within the card and determines that the threat is associated with a particular Security Domain, that Security Domain may be prevented from further selection by the OPEN setting the Security Domain's Life Cycle State to LOCKED. Alternatively, the off-card entity may determine that a particular Security Domain on the card needs to be locked for a business or security reason and may initiate the state transition via the OPEN. In this state, the Security Domain is prevented from being used for Delegated Management if applicable. Locking a Security Domain prevents this Security Domain from being associated with new Executable Load Files or Applications. In this state DAP verification, extradition and access to that Security Domain's services shall fail. Once the Life Cycle State is LOCKED, only the Security Domain's associated Security Domain (if any), an Application with Global Lock privilege or a Security Domain with Global Lock privilege is allowed to unlock the Security Domain. The OPEN shall ensure that the Security Domain's Life Cycle returns to its previous state. 5.3.2.5 Security Domain Deletion At any point in the Security Domain Life Cycle, the OPEN may receive a request to delete a Security Domain. 38 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The space previously used to store a physically deleted Security Domain is reclaimed and may be reused. The entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry shall no longer be available, and the OPEN is not required to maintain a record of the deleted Security Domain's previous existence. 5.3.2.6 Security Domain Life Cycle State Transitions Figure 5-3 illustrates the state transition diagram for the Security Domain Life Cycle. This can typically be viewed as a sequential process with certain possibilities for reversing a state transition or skipping states. INSTALLED SELECTABLE PERSONALIZED LOCKED from PERSONALIZED Legend 1. A Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege 2. A Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege 5. The Security Domain itself LOCKED from INSTALLED LOCKED from SELECTABLE 1 2 2 1 3 4 5 3 4 5 3 4 5 5 3. The associated Security Domain 4. A Security Domain or Application with Global Lock privilege Figure 5-3: Security Domain Life Cycle State Transitions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 39 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 5.4 Sample Life Cycle Illustration This section provides a description of a sample GlobalPlatform card and its Life Cycle transitions from the carďs creation to the time it is terminated. It also shows the status of several Executable Load Files, Executable Modules and Applications and their relationship with the card Life Cycle. Figure 5-4 illustrates these sample Life Cycle States: Application A: Application code is present as an Executable Module within an Executable Load File in Mutable Persistent Memory when the card is manufactured. It is installed in an implementation specific manner. It is used throughout the carďs life until the card is terminated and as long as the card is not in a CARD_LOCKED state. Application B: Application code is present as an Executable Module within an Executable Load File in Immutable Persistent Memory when the chip is manufactured. It is installed prior to the card being initialized. Application B, along with its Executable Load File, is deleted some time during the carďs life before the card is terminated. Because the Executable Load File for Application B is stored in Immutable Persistent Memory, it cannot be physically deleted from the card. Application C: Application code is present as an Executable Module within an Executable Load File and is loaded in an implementation specific manner. The Application is installed in Post-Issuance while the card is in the Life Cycle State SECURED. The Application is used for some time and then deleted along with its Executable Load File before the card is terminated. Because the Application and its Executable Load File are stored in Mutable Persistent Memory, the Application and associated Executable Load File, along with all its Executable Modules, are purged from Mutable Persistent Memory and the memory space reclaimed for reuse. Application D: Application code is present as an Executable Module within an Executable Load File and is loaded in an implementation specific manner. It is used during the full lifetime of the card until the card is terminated and as long as the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED. Application E: Application code is present as an Executable Module within an Executable Load File that is loaded and installed in Post-Issuance while in the card Life Cycle State SECURED. Application E is used until the card is terminated and as long as the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED. Application F: Application code is present as an Executable Module within the same Executable Load File as Application E. It is loaded and installed in Post-Issuance while in the card Life Cycle State SECURED. Application F is deleted some time during the carďs lifetime. Note that the following diagram is not intended to be a comprehensive description of what is permitted in each card Life Cycle State. 40 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. EXECUTABLE LOAD FILE EXECUTABLE LOAD FILE EXECUTABLE LOAD FILE EXECUTABLE LOAD FILE OP_READY CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED EXECUTABLE MODULE A Application A Application B EXECUTABLE MODULE B DELETE SECURED END-OF-LIFE INITIALIZED EXECUTABLE MODULE C EXECUTABLE MODULE D Application D install install install use Application A use Application B Application C DELETE install use Application C Application F DELETE install use Application F END-OF-LIFE use Application D EXECUTABLE MODULE E Application E install END-OF-LIFE use Application E Applications D and E Unusable Application A Unusable EXECUTABLE MODULE F EXECUTABLE LOAD FILE Figure 5-4: Sample Card Life Cycle and Application Life Cycles March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 41 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 6 GlobalPlatform Environment (OPEN) 6.1 Overview The GlobalPlatform Environment (OPEN) supports the following functions if the underlying runtime environment does not support them: * Command Dispatch Application and Security Domain selection (Optional) Logical channel management Command dispatching * Card Content Management Content verification Content loading Content installation Content removal Access control rules for card content management * Security Management Security Domain locking and unlocking Application locking and unlocking Card locking and unlocking Card termination Privilege usage Security Domain privilege usage Tracing and event logging * GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework Secure inter-application communication The OPEN architecture may be illustrated as a collection of system functions built upon a GlobalPlatform Registry. The GlobalPlatform Registry is a data store required to support the various system functions of the GlobalPlatform. The following are some examples of the use of the GlobalPlatform Registry by the OPEN. Command Dispatch: * Determine if an Application or Security Domain is present and available to respond to a SELECT command; * When supported, manage logical channels; * Dispatch commands to the selected Application for command processing. 42 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Card Content Management: * Store state and management information about newly loaded Executable Load Files, Executable Modules, and installed Applications; * Store the Security Domain to be associated with Executable Load Files being loaded; * Store the privileges and associated Security Domains of the Applications being installed; * Identify an Application's associated Security Domain to provide access for that Application to its Security Domain services. Security Management: * Allow the audit of Card Content by retrieving status information related to any Application present on the card; * Verify the integrity and request verification of the authenticity for Executable Load Files; * Verify that resource restrictions are respected during loading and installing of new content and during Application runtime execution; * Verify an Application's or a Security Domain's accessibility to functionality that requires privileges. 6.2 OPEN Services Appendix A.1 - GlobalPlatform on a Java Card provides the Java CardTM implementation of the following interfaces. Appendix A.2 - GlobalPlatform on MULTOSTM provides the MULTOSTM implementation of the following interfaces. Applications and Security Domains may access and/or modify some content known or managed by the OPEN. Depending on the relevant privileges of the requesting entity, the following services shall be provided by the OPEN: * Retrieving the Application's own Life Cycle State stored by the OPEN in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Retrieving the card Life Cycle State; * Obtaining access to the services of the Security Domain associated with the Application; * Transitioning the card Life Cycle State to CARD_LOCKED; * For contact cards according to ISO/IEC 7816-4 and for contactless cards Type A according to ISO/IEC 14443-3, setting the content of the historical bytes; * Transitioning the Application's own Application Life Cycle State stored by the OPEN in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Transitioning the card Life Cycle State to TERMINATED; * Obtaining access to GlobalPlatform Registry information; * Obtaining access to Global Services Applications. 6.3 Command Dispatch The commands received by a GlobalPlatform card shall be processed by the OPEN or dispatched to the selected Application for processing. The SELECT [by name] command is processed by the OPEN. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 43 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. One option of making the Issuer Security Domain the selected Application, is to specify its AID in a SELECT command with the [first or only occurrence] option set. As another option for making the Issuer Security Domain the selected Application, the SELECT command could contain no data in which case the AID of the Issuer Security Domain would be discovered by the off-card entity in the response to the SELECT command. The processing of the MANAGE CHANNEL command is dependant on the capabilities of the card: * If the card is aware of logical channels but only supports the Basic Logical Channel, the OPEN shall respond with the appropriate error; * If the card is aware of logical channels and supports at least one Supplementary Logical Channel, the OPEN shall process the command; or * If the card only supports the Basic Logical Channel and has no concept of logical channel support, the command shall be dispatched to the selected Application for processing. Any other type of command received shall be dispatched to the currently selected Application. Commands are either received on the Basic Logical Channel (logical channel number zero) or on a Supplementary Logical Channel (logical channel number other than zero). In compliance with ISO/IEC 7816-4, logical channel information shall be indicated in the class byte of the APDU command header. For all commands, if the command indicates a Supplementary Logical Channel that is not opened then: * If the card only supports the Basic Logical Channel and has no concept of logical channel support, the command shall be dispatched to the selected Application for processing. * If the card is aware of logical channels, the OPEN shall respond with the appropriate error. (This requirement may exclude the SELECT command, if the card supports opening of a logical channel using the SELECT command.) For commands that are dispatched to an Application, it is the responsibility of the Application to correctly reject commands that it does not recognize, expect or cannot process. The way in which an Application exhibits its multi-selection capabilities can vary according to the underlying platform and is beyond the scope of this Specification. The Issuer Security Domain shall have no multi-selection restrictions on cards that support multiple logical channels i.e. it shall be capable of being selected across multiple logical channels. 6.4 Logical Channels and Application Selection 6.4.1 Implicit Selection Assignment The following rules apply to the assignment of implicit selection to an Application: * The Issuer Security Domain is by default the implicitly selectable Application on all logical channels of all card I/O interfaces supported by the card. Implicit selection on a specific logical channel of a specific card I/O interface may be assigned only if the Issuer Security Domain is the implicitly selectable Application on that logical channel of that card I/O interface and no other Locked Application is registered as implicitly selectable for the same logical channel and card I/O interface (see 9.6.2 - Application Locking and Unlocking; * An Application installed or made selectable with a specific Implicit Selection parameter is registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry as the implicitly selectable Application on the logical channel(s) of the card I/O interface(s) indicated in the parameter if no other Application (other than the Issuer Security Domain) is already registered as implicitly selectable on that logical channel(s) of that card I/O interface(s); 44 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * An Application installed or made selectable with the Card Reset privilege and no Implicit Selection parameter is registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry as the implicitly selectable Application on the Basic Logical Channel for all card I/O interfaces supported by the card if no other Application (other than the Issuer Security Domain) is already registered as implicitly selectable on the Basic Logical Channel of any card I/O interface; * If an Application implicitly selectable on specific logical channel(s) of specific card I/O interface(s) is deleted, the Issuer Security Domain becomes the implicitly selectable Application on that logical channel(s) of that card I/O interface(s). The OPEN shall use the implicit selection registration of each Application for controlling the following runtime behavioral requirements: * Identifying the Application which is implicitly selectable on the Basic Logical Channel of the current card I/O interface during the card reset or activation sequence; * Identifying the Application which is implicitly selectable when opening on the current card I/O interface a new Supplementary Logical Channel from the Basic Logical Channel. 6.4.2 Basic Logical Channel The Basic Logical Channel is the permanently available interface to a GlobalPlatform card. This Basic Logical Channel shall be supported by the OPEN. 6.4.2.1 Application Selection on Basic Logical Channel The OPEN shall support Application selection on the Basic Logical Channel via two processes: * Implicit Selection following the card reset (see ISO/IEC 7816-3 for contact cards) or activation sequence (see ISO/IEC 14443-3 for contactless cards); * Explicit Selection through the SELECT [by name] command. The OPEN may also support additional selection processes. Partial AID selection as defined in section 6.4.2.1.2 - Explicit Selection, shall be supported. (Partial AID selection does not require knowledge of the full AID by the off-card entity.) As multiple Applications on the card may have the same partial AID, it is required that a method exists to select all Applications matching the partial AID. 6.4.2.1.1 Implicit Selection on Basic Logical Channel Once the card session has been established (for contact cards according to ISO/IEC 7816-4 after Answer-to-Reset, or after the activation sequence for contactless cards according to ISO/IEC 14443-3), and before the first command is issued to the card, the Application defined as implicitly selectable on the Basic Logical Channel and for that card I/O interface shall become the selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel for that card I/O interface. Runtime Behavior The following requirements apply for the OPEN for the implicit Application selection process: * If the card is in the Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED, the Application with the Final Application privilege is the selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel and the OPEN shall not attempt to identify the implicitly selectable Application; * In all other cases the OPEN shall search the GlobalPlatform Registry for an Application that is marked as implicitly selectable on the Basic Logical Channel for the current card I/O interface (e.g. contact or contactless), and if this Application is not in the Life Cycle State LOCKED, it shall become the selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel. If this is an Application in the Life Cycle State LOCKED, the March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 45 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Application with the Final Application privilege shall become the selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel. 6.4.2.1.2 Explicit Selection on Basic Logical Channel At any time during a Card Session the OPEN may receive a request to select an Application on the Basic Logical Channel (SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] command). The OPEN shall determine if the requested AID matches or partially matches an entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry and whether this entry is selectable. At any time during a Card Session that has already contained a SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] command, the OPEN may receive a request to select a next Application (SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] command) on the Basic Logical Channel. The OPEN shall determine if the requested AID matches or partially matches another entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry and whether this entry is selectable. For both the SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] command and the SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] command, an Application becomes the selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel if: * The requested AID matches (fully or partially) the Application's AID; * The Application being selected is in the correct Life Cycle State; * The Application has no restrictions due to multi-selection, and supports the current card interface. Runtime Behavior The following requirements apply to the OPEN in the explicit Application selection (SELECT [by name]) process on the Basic Logical Channel (This behavior does not apply if the card Life Cycle State is TERMINATED): * In the card Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED: - If the Application being selected has the Final Application privilege, this Application is re-selected and a warning is returned to the off-card entity; - If any other Application is being selected, the Application with the Final Application privilege remains selected and an error is returned to the off- card entity; * If a SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] or SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] is received and the data field of the command message is not present, the Issuer Security Domain shall become the currently selected Application and the SELECT command is dispatched to the Issuer Security Domain; * If a SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] is received, the search always begins from the start of the GlobalPlatform Registry; * If a SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] is received, the search always begins from the entry following the currently selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application is in the Life Cycle State INSTALLED, continue searching through the GlobalPlatform Registry for a subsequent full or partial match. If no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application is in the Life Cycle State LOCKED, continue searching through the GlobalPlatform Registry for a subsequent full or partial match. In the eventuality that this locked Application is already currently selected on the Basic Logical Channel, the OPEN shall terminate this Application Session. If no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application cannot be selected due to a multi-selection restriction or because the Application refuses selection (e.g. because it does not support the current card interface), continue searching through the GlobalPlatform Registry for a subsequent full or partial match. If no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; 46 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * If a full or partial match is found and this Application is selectable (i.e. in the correct Life Cycle State and has no multi-selection restrictions), then it shall become the currently selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel and the SELECT [by name] command, whether [first or only occurrence] or [next occurrence], shall be processed according to the requirements of the runtime environment (e.g. dispatched to the Application); * If no full or partial match is found at all, the currently selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel shall remain the selected Application and - If the SELECT [by name] command has the [first or only occurrence] parameter set, the SELECT command is dispatched to the Application; - If the SELECT [by name] command has the [next occurrence] parameter set, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; * In the eventuality that the current Application Session has been terminated and no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall make an attempt to select the Application that is marked as implicitly selectable on the Basic Logical Channel for the current card interface. 6.4.2.2 Logical Channel Management on Basic Logical Channel At any time during a Card Session the OPEN may receive a request on the Basic Logical Channel to either open or close a Supplementary Logical Channel. If the card only supports the Basic Logical Channel and has no concept of logical channel support, the MANAGE CHANNEL command is dispatched to the currently selected Application. In this case, when a Security Domain is the currently selected Application, the command shall be rejected. On cards that support logical channels, if a MANAGE CHANNEL [open] is received: * If an Application is designated as implicitly selectable on the new Supplementary Logical Channel for the current card interface, that Application is implicitly selected on the newly opened Supplementary Logical Channel and runtime behavior requirements apply; * Otherwise the Application designated as implicitly selectable on the Basic Logical Channel for this card interface is implicitly selected on the newly opened Supplementary Logical Channel and runtime behavior requirements apply. On cards that support logical channels, if a MANAGE CHANNEL [close] is received, terminate the Application Session currently selected on the Supplementary Logical Channel indicated by the command and then close that logical channel. The Basic Logical Channel can never be closed. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a MANAGE CHANNEL [open] command, the following requirements apply: * If the card is in the Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED, return the appropriate error. * If the number of logical channels supported by the OPEN is not sufficient to open a new Supplementary Logical Channel, return the appropriate error. * The OPEN shall search the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Application that supports the current card interface and that is marked as implicitly selectable on the new Supplementary Logical Channel (or failing that, on the Basic Logical Channel) and: - If this is an Application in the Life Cycle State LOCKED, the Application with the Final Application privilege shall become the selected Application on the Supplementary Logical Channel; - If this Application cannot be selected due to a multi-selection restriction, the new logical channel shall not be opened and the OPEN shall return the appropriate error; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 47 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. - Otherwise, the Supplementary Logical Channel is opened and this Application shall become the selected Application on the Supplementary Logical Channel. 6.4.2.3 Application Command Dispatch on Basic Logical Channel Once an Application becomes the selected Application on the Basic Logical Channel, the responsibility for subsequent command dispatching still rests with the OPEN. Processing SELECT [by name] commands and runtime behavior requirements for OPEN are described in section 6.4.2.1.2 - Explicit Selection. On cards that are aware of logical channels, the MANAGE CHANNEL commands are only processed by the OPEN and are not dispatched to an Application. All other commands (including the MANAGE CHANNEL commands on cards that are not aware of logical channels or SELECT commands not described in section 6.4.2.1.2 - Explicit Selection) are immediately dispatched to the Application currently selected on the Basic Logical Channel. The processing of the command by the Application is beyond the scope of this Specification. 6.4.3 Supplementary Logical Channel A Supplementary Logical Channel, if supported, allows an Application to be selected simultaneously to the Applications selected on other logical channels. 6.4.3.1 Application Selection on Supplementary Logical Channel The OPEN shall support Application selection on an available Supplementary Logical Channel via two processes: * Implicit Selection following a successful MANAGE CHANNEL [open] command; * Explicit Selection through the SELECT [by name] command. The OPEN may also support additional selection processes. Partial AID selection as defined in section 6.4.3.1.2 - Explicit Selection, shall be supported on Supplementary Logical Channels. 6.4.3.1.1 Implicit Selection on Supplementary Logical Channel Depending on whether a Supplementary Logical Channel is being opened from the Basic Logical Channel or from another Supplementary Logical Channel, the behavior of implicit selection differs. Refer to section 6.4.2.2 - Logical Channel Management for the behavior of implicit selection initiated from the Basic Logical Channel. Refer to section 6.4.3.2 - Logical Channel Management for the behavior of implicit selection initiated from a Supplementary Logical Channel. 6.4.3.1.2 Explicit Selection on Supplementary Logical Channel At any time on an open Supplementary Logical Channel, the OPEN may receive a request to select an Application on this Supplementary Logical Channel (SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] command). The OPEN shall determine if the requested AID matches or partially matches an entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry and whether this entry is selectable. At any time on an open Supplementary Logical Channel that has already contained a SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] command since the Supplementary Logical Channel was last opened, the OPEN may receive a 48 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. request to select a next Application (SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] command) on this Supplementary Logical Channel. The OPEN shall determine if the requested AID matches or partially matches another entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry and whether this entry is selectable. For both the SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] command and the SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] command, an Application becomes the selected Application on the Supplementary Logical Channel if: * The requested AID matches (fully or partially) the Application's AID; * The Application being selected is in the correct Life Cycle State; * The Application has no restrictions due to multi-selection, and supports the current card interface. Runtime Behavior The following requirements apply to the OPEN in the explicit Application selection (SELECT [by name]) process on a Supplementary Logical Channel: * If the card is in the Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED: - Close the Supplementary Logical Channel, if currently open; - Return the appropriate error; * If a SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] or SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] is received and the data field of the command message is not present, the Issuer Security Domain shall become the currently selected Application and the SELECT command is dispatched to the Issuer Security Domain; * If a SELECT [by name] [first or only occurrence] is received, the search always begins from the start of the GlobalPlatform Registry; * If a SELECT [by name] [next occurrence] is received, the search always begins from the entry following the currently selected Application on this Supplementary Logical Channel in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application is in the Life Cycle State INSTALLED, continue searching through the GlobalPlatform Registry for a subsequent full or partial match. If no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application is in the Life Cycle State LOCKED, continue searching through the GlobalPlatform Registry for a subsequent full or partial match. In the eventuality that this locked Application is already currently selected on the same Supplementary Logical Channel, the OPEN shall terminate this Application Session. If no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application cannot be selected due to a multi-selection restriction or because the Application refuses selection (e.g. because it does not support the current card interface), continue searching through the GlobalPlatform Registry for a subsequent full or partial match. If no subsequent full or partial match is found, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity; * If a full or partial match is found and this Application is selectable (i.e. in the correct Life Cycle State and has no multi-selection restrictions), then it shall become the currently selected Application on this Supplementary Logical Channel and the SELECT [by name] command, whether [first or only occurrence] or [next occurrence], shall be processed according to the requirements of the runtime environment (e.g. dispatched to the Application); * If no full or partial match is found at all, the currently selected Application on the Supplementary Logical Channel shall remain the selected Application and - If the SELECT [by name] command has the [first or only occurrence] parameter set, the SELECT command is dispatched to the Application; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 49 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. - If the SELECT [by name] command has the [next occurrence] parameter set, the OPEN shall return the appropriate error to the off-card entity. 6.4.3.2 Logical Channel Management on Supplementary Logical Channel At any time on an open Supplementary Logical Channel the OPEN may receive a request to either open or close a Supplementary Logical Channel. If a MANAGE CHANNEL [open] is received and the Application selected on the original Supplementary Logical Channel has no multi-selection restrictions, this Application becomes the selected Application on the newly opened Supplementary Logical Channel. If a MANAGE CHANNEL [close] is received, terminate the Application Session currently selected on the Supplementary Logical Channel indicated by the command and then close that logical channel. The Basic Logical Channel can never be closed. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a MANAGE CHANNEL [open] command, the following requirements apply: * If the card is in the Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED, return the appropriate error; * If the number of logical channels supported by the OPEN is not sufficient to open a new Supplementary Logical Channel, return the appropriate error; * If the Application currently selected on the original Supplementary Logical Channel cannot be selected on the new Supplementary Logical Channel due to a multi-selection restriction, the new logical channel shall not be opened and the OPEN shall return the appropriate error; * Otherwise, the Supplementary Logical Channel indicated by the command is opened and the Application currently selected on the original Supplementary Logical Channel shall become the selected Application on the newly opened Supplementary Logical Channel. 6.4.3.3 Application Command Dispatch on Supplementary Logical Channel Once an Application becomes the selected Application on a Supplementary Logical Channel, the responsibility for subsequent command dispatching still rests with the OPEN. Processing SELECT [by name] commands and runtime behavior requirements for OPEN are described in section 6.4.3.1.2 - Explicit Selection. The MANAGE CHANNEL commands are only processed by the OPEN and are not dispatched to an Application. All other commands (including SELECT commands not described in section 6.4.3.1.2 - Explicit Selection) are immediately dispatched to the Application currently selected on the Supplementary Logical Channel. The processing of the command by the Application is beyond the scope of this Specification. 6.5 GlobalPlatform Registry The GlobalPlatform Registry is used to: * Store card management information; * Store relevant application management information (e.g., AID, associated Security Domain and Privileges); * Support card resource management data; * Store Application Life Cycle information; 50 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Store card Life Cycle information; * Track any counters associated with logs. The contents of the GlobalPlatform Registry may be updated in response to: * An internal OPEN invoked action; * An authorized Application invoked action. All Applications including all Security Domains, and all Executable Load Files, shall have an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry. There is no mandatory format for the storage of these data elements. However, format requirements do exist for the handling of the data elements via APDU commands and GlobalPlatform services available to Applications. 6.5.1 Application/Executable Load File/Executable Module Data Elements 6.5.1.1 Application/Executable Load File/Executable Module AID Each Executable Load File or Executable Module is associated with an AID that shall be unique on the card. An Application AID may be the same as that of an Executable Module but may not be the same as that of an Executable Load File or the same as another Application already present in the GlobalPlatform Registry. This AID may be specified in a SELECT command to select the Application. It is not possible to select Executable Load Files or Executable Modules. 6.5.1.2 Application/Executable Load File/Executable Module Life Cycle The Application Life Cycle State data element contains the current Life Cycle of the Application, Executable Load File or Executable Module. 6.5.1.3 Memory Resource Management Parameters Resource management data elements contain information about the memory resources that are available to an Application. They are system-specific values and are used as a control mechanism by the OPEN to manage memory resource allocation as described in section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management. When additional resources are requested by an Application, the OPEN shall validate the request against the value of this data element in the GlobalPlatform Registry. 6.5.1.4 Privileges The Privileges data element indicates the privileges for each Application. Privileges are defined in section 6.6. 6.5.1.5 Implicit Selection Parameter The implicit selection parameter indicates whether an Application is implicitly selectable on a specific logical channel of a specific card interface: see section 11.1.7 and Table 11-50. 6.5.1.6 Associated Security Domain AID All Executable Load Files and Applications, including Security Domains, are associated with a Security Domain, whose AID is given in the registry. This AID is the AID of the Security Domain directly associated. A Security March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 51 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Domain also has an associated Security Domain: either another Security Domain or itself, hence describing an association hierarchy of Executable Load Files / Applications and Security Domains. 6.5.1.7 Application Provider ID The Registry holds the identifier of the Application Provider: the owner of the Application or Executable Load File when explicitly provided during the load or installation process. An on-card entity may use this information to enforce security policies. Establishing whether an off-card entity is also the owner of the on-card entity being managed is addressed in more detail in section 10.4 - Entity Authentication. 6.5.1.8 Service Parameter A Service Parameter identifies the service offered by the Global Services Application. The Global Services Application may register this service as a unique Global Service as described in section 8.1.1 - Registering Global Services. More than one service, hence more than one Service Parameter, may be registered for a Global Services Application. 6.5.2 Card-Wide Data The card Life Cycle State is stored in the GlobalPlatform Registry similarly to Application information. Any restriction of the Card Content Management functionality of OPEN is stored in the GlobalPlatform Registry. 6.6 Privileges 6.6.1 Privilege Definition The following table defines Security Domain and Application privileges: Privilege Number Privilege Description Notes 0 Security Domain Application is a Security Domain. Distinguishes a Security Domain from a 'normaľ Application. 1 DAP Verification Application is capable of verifying a DAP; Security Domain privilege shall also be set. For details, see section 9.2.1. 2 Delegated Management Application is capable of Delegated Card Content Management: Security Domain privilege shall also be set. For details, see section 9.1.3.3. 3 Card Lock Application has the privilege to lock the card. For details, see section 9.6.3. 4 Card Terminate Application has the privilege to terminate the card. For details, see section 9.6.4. 5 Card Reset Application has the privilege to modify historical bytes on one or more card interfaces. This privilege was previously labeled "Default Selected". For details, see section 6.6.2. 52 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Privilege Number Privilege Description Notes 6 CVM Management Application has the privilege to manage a shared CVM of a CVM Application. For details, see section 8.2.1. 7 Mandated DAP Verification Application is capable of and requires the verification of a DAP for all load operations: Security Domain privilege and DAP Verification privilege shall also be set. For details, see section 9.2.1. 8 Trusted Path Application is a Trusted Path for interapplication communication. For details, see section 6.7. 9 Authorized Management Application is capable of Card Content Management; Security Domain privilege shall also be set. For details, see section 9.1.3.2. 10 Token Verification Application is capable of verifying a token for Delegated Card Content Management. For details, see sections 9.1.3.1 and 9.2.3. 11 Global Delete Application may delete any Card Content. For details, see sections 9.1.3.4 and 9.5. 12 Global Lock Application may lock or unlock any Application. For details, see section 9.1.3.5 and 9.6.2. 13 Global Registry Application may access any entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry. For details, see section 9.6.5. 14 Final Application The only Application accessible in card Life Cycle State CARD_LOCKED and TERMINATED. For details, see section 9.6.4. 15 Global Service Application provides services to other Applications on the card. For details, see section 8.1.1. 16 Receipt Generation Application is capable of generating a receipt for Delegated Card Content Management. For details, see section 9.1.3.6 Table 6-1: Privileges 6.6.2 Privilege Assignment The following rules apply to the assignment of Privileges: * Only one Application or Security Domain in the card may be set with the Card Reset privilege at a time (e.g. the Issuer Security Domain, a current legacy Application or an Application that requires specific behavior with regards to logical channels) on a given card interface; * Once the Card Reset privilege has been assigned to an Application for a given card interface, the privilege can be reassigned to a new Application either by deleting the Application which has the privilege, or by revoking its privilege; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 53 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The Card Reset privilege is by default assigned to the Issuer Security Domain. It may be reassigned only if the Issuer Security Domain has the Card Reset privilege; * If the application with the Card Reset privilege is deleted, the privilege is reassigned to the Issuer Security Domain; * The Final Application privilege is by default assigned to the Issuer Security Domain. It may be reassigned only if the Issuer Security Domain has the Final Application privilege; * Only one Application or Security Domain in the card may be set with the Final Application privilege at a time (e.g. the Issuer Security Domain, a current legacy Application or an Application that requires specific behavior with regards to logical channels); * Once the Final Application privilege has been assigned to an Application, the privilege can be reassigned to a new Application either by deleting the Application which has the privilege, or by revoking its privilege; * If the application with the Final Application privilege is deleted, the Issuer Security Domain becomes the Application with Final Application privilege; * Authorized Management and Delegated Management privileges are mutually exclusive; * Otherwise, the privileges are not mutually exclusive; therefore, one or more privileges may be marked as set for an Application. In the OP_READY card Life Cycle State, the Issuer Security Domain shall initially have the following set of privileges clearly identifying its functionality: Security Domain, Authorized Management, Global Registry, Global Lock, Global Delete, Token Verification, Card Lock, Card Terminate, Trusted Path, CVM Management, Card Reset, Final Application and Receipt Generation. Privileges may be added or revoked during the Life Cycle of an Application or Security Domain. For backward compatibility, where a card supports only privileges 0-7, the following assumptions shall apply for the remaining privileges: Privilege Number Privilege Issuer Security Domain Supplementary Security Domain Other Application 8 Trusted Path yes yes no 9 Authorized Management yes no no 10 Token Verification yes no no 11 Global Delete yes no no 12 Global Lock yes no no 13 Global Registry yes no no 14 Final Application yes no no 15 Global Service no no no 16 Receipt Generation yes no no Table 6-2: Privilege Defaults Several use cases can be envisaged for the assignment of privileges to Security Domains, depending on the business relationships between the Card Issuer and other off-card entities: Application Providers or Controlling Authority. The following table shows four example use cases. 54 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Use case A B C D Authorized Management Privilege Delegated Management Privilege Token Verification Privilege Issuer Security Domain Receipt Generation Privilege Authorized Management Privilege Delegated Management Privilege Token Verification Privilege Supplementary Security Domain Receipt Generation Privilege Table 6-3: Privilege Assignment Example Use Cases 6.6.3 Privilege Management Runtime Behavior The OPEN shall use the Privileges data element in conjunction with the association hierarchy (see section 7.2 Security Domain Association) of the Applications for controlling the following runtime behavioral requirements: * Ensuring Token verification when required (see section 9.3.2 - Card Content Loading); * Ensuring Receipt generation when required (see section 9.3.2 - Card Content Loading); * Ensuring DAP verification when required (see section 9.3.2 - Card Content Loading); * Checking for the validity of a request to change Card Contents: load, installation, extradition, registry update, or deletion; * Checking for the validity of a request to lock or unlock the card; * Checking for the validity of a request to lock or unlock an Application, including a Security Domain; * Checking for the validity of a request to terminate the card; * Checking for the validity of a request to communicate with another on-card Application; * Checking for the validity of a request to access the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of another Application, including a Security Domain; * Identifying the Application with Final Application privilege to be default selected when the card is in CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED state. The OPEN shall use the Privileges data element and the Implicit Selection parameter for each Application (where present) for controlling the following runtime behavioral requirements: * Checking for the validity of a request to modify historical bytes; for dual interface (contact and contactless) cards, the modification applies to the historical bytes of the card interface(s) for which the requesting oncard Application is registered as implicitly selectable; this feature should preferably be used on cards that support the Basic Logical Channel only. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 55 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 6.7 The GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework An APDU command is received by the Application's Security Domain (the Receiving Entity), which may be the Issuer Security Domain or a Supplementary Security Domain, and is unwrapped by the Security Domain before being passed on to the GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework. The objective is that the GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework forwards the unwrapped command to the Target Application indicated by the Receiving Entity. The Target Application may use cryptographic services of the Security Domain available through the Secure Channel Session established by the Security Domain (e.g. sensitive data decryption). The Current Security Level viewed by the Target Application may differ from the Security Domain view depending on the Secure Channel Protocol and the authenticated off-card entity's Application Provider ID (e.g. ANY_AUTHENTICATED for the Target Application and AUTHENTICATED for the Security Domain). Runtime Behavior The GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework shall check that: * The Receiving Entity has the Trusted Path privilege; * The Receiving Entity is a Security Domain; * The Target Application exists in the GlobalPlatform Registry and has enabled its 'Process Data' entry point; * The Target Application has no multi-selection restrictions if it is already selected on another logical channel; * The Target Application is associated with the currently selected Receiving Entity Security Domain. If all checks are passed, the GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework passes the command to the Target Application through its GlobalPlatform Application interface. The GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework and the Applications involved are shown in the following diagram. The process as used in personalization is described in more detail in section 7.3.3 - Personalization Support. 56 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Security Domain Runtime Environment OPEN and GP Trusted Framework Security Domain Issuer Security Domain GP API RTE API Target Application Receiving Entity (Security Domain with Trusted Path privilege) Controlling Authorities' Security Domain(s) Figure 6-1: GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework Roles March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 57 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7 Security Domains 7.1 General Description Security Domains are privileged Applications. They hold cryptographic keys which can be used to support Secure Channel Protocol operations and/or to authorize card content management functions. Each Application and each Executable Load File is associated with a Security Domain. An Application can use the cryptographic services of its associated Security Domain. It is possible to associate Applications owned by one authority with the Security Domain of another authority. All cards have one mandatory Security Domain: the Issuer Security Domain. A card that supports multiple Security Domains can allow an Application Provider, through its own Security Domain, to manage its own Applications and provide cryptographic services using keys that are completely separate from, and not under the control of, the Card Issuer. Key Separation Security Domains are responsible for their own key management. This ensures that Applications and data from different Application Providers may coexist on the same card without violating the privacy and integrity of each Application Provider. Application Services The keys and associated cryptography for all Security Domains may be used for: * Personalization Support: Secure communication support during personalization of an Application Provider's Applications; * Runtime Messaging Support: secure communication support during runtime for an Application that does not contain its own secure messaging keys. 7.1.1 Issuer Security Domain The Issuer Security Domain primarily operates as any Security Domain, but has some special characteristics that distinguish it from any other Security Domain: * It is the first Application installed on a card. GlobalPlatform does not mandate that the Issuer Security Domain be loaded or installed in the same manner as Applications. The Issuer Security Domain, while viewed by the GlobalPlatform Registry as an Application, has implementation specific behavior relating to how it becomes an active entity on the card; * It does not have a Security Domain Life Cycle State because it inherits the card Life Cycle State; * It takes on the Card Reset privilege if the Application with that privilege is removed; * It becomes the implicitly selected Application if the Application implicitly selectable on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface is removed; * It becomes the implicitly selected Application for a card interface on a logical channel if the Application that is implicitly selectable on that logical channel for that card interface is removed; * It may be selected by use of the SELECT command with no command data field; * It takes on the Final Application privilege if the Application with that privilege is removed. 58 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7.2 Security Domain Association Applications (including Security Domains) may use the services of their associated Security Domain to provide Secure Channel Sessions and other cryptographic services. An Application need not have any prior knowledge of its Security Domain AID: the GlobalPlatform Registry contains this information and the OPEN supplies the Application with a reference to its associated Security Domain. The Application should not store this reference for future use because its associated Security Domain may change as a result of extradition. Extradition is the means by which an Application is associated with a different Security Domain. An Executable Load File is initially associated with the Security Domain which loads it, but it may immediately (implicit extradition during the load process) or subsequently (explicit extradition) be extradited to a different Security Domain. The Issuer Security Domain is effectively associated with itself, its establishment on the card is not defined by GlobalPlatform, and it is not subject to extradition. Through extradition, a Security Domain may be associated with itself. This means that if it calls on the services of its associated Security Domain, it will be using its own services. It also makes it more isolated from other Security Domains, subject to the privileges assigned to those other Security Domains. As a result, there is one or more hierarchies of association on a card. The root of each hierarchy is a Security Domain that is associated with itself. The following diagram shows two hierarchies: one starting from the Issuer Security Domain, the other from a Security Domain which has been extradited to itself; arrows indicate 'is associated with'. Issuer Security Domain Supplementary Security Domain 1 Supplementary Security Domain 2 Extradited Application A Executable Load File B Application B Executable Load File A Figure 7-1: Example of Security Domain Hierarchies March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 59 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. A Security Domain associated with another Application is said to be directly associated with it. Another Security Domain higher up the hierarchy is said to be indirectly associated with it. 7.3 Security Domain Services Appendix A.1 - GlobalPlatform on a Java Card provides the Java CardTM specification of the following interfaces. Appendix A.2 - GlobalPlatform on MULTOSTM provides the MULTOSTM specification of the following interfaces. Appendix D - Secure Channel Protocol '01' (Deprecated)-, appendix E - Secure Channel Protocol '02' and appendix F - Secure Channel Protocol '10' provide more details on Secure Channel Protocols implementing the following interfaces. 7.3.1 Application Access to Security Domain Services Applications have the ability to access the services of their associated Security Domain. By using these services, the Application may rely on cryptographic support from the Security Domain to ensure confidentiality and integrity during personalization and runtime. The Security Domain services defined in this Specification are generic and shall encompass the following possibilities. * Initiating a Secure Channel Session upon successful verification of an off-card entity; * Unwrapping a command received within a Secure Channel Session by verifying its integrity and/or decrypting the original data in the case of confidentiality; * Controlling the sequence of APDU commands; * Decrypting a secret data block; * Setting the security level: integrity and/or confidentiality, to apply to the next incoming command and/or next outgoing response; * Closing a Secure Channel Session upon request and destroying any secret(s) relating to that Secure Channel Session. Depending on the specific Secure Channel Protocol supported, the Security Domain services may also encompass the possibility of: * Wrapping a response sent within a Secure Channel Session by adding integrity and/or encrypting the original data in the case of confidentiality; * Encrypting a secret data block; * Controlling the sequence of APDU responses. A Security Domain may support the management of multiple Secure Channel Sessions concurrently (i.e. Applications selected on multiple logical channels each initiating a Secure Channel) or may limit itself to only managing one Secure Channel Session immaterial of the number of concurrently selected Applications that attempt to use its services. If a Security Domain does support the management of multiple Secure Channel Sessions concurrently, it shall be able to differentiate between the multiple Secure Channel Sessions and their respective logical channels. If a Security Domain does not support the management of multiple Secure Channel Sessions concurrently, when a request is made to open a Secure Channel Session on a logical channel different from the current Secure Channel Session, the Security Domain rejects this request to initiate a new Secure Channel Session. If a request is made by an Application to use the services of its associated Security Domain on a logical channel different from the one on which its Secure Channel Session was opened, the Security Domain shall reject this request. 60 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7.3.2 Security Domain Access to Applications The Security Domain has the facility to receive a STORE DATA command destined to one of its associated Applications. The Security Domain unwraps this command according to the Current Security Level of the current Secure Channel Session and prior to the command being forwarded to the Application. This pre-processing leaves as is the data structures of the command message as well as the eventual encryption of the data value fields of these data structures. The command is forwarded to the Application by the GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework which handles interapplication communication between Security Domains and Applications, as described in section 6.7. 7.3.3 Personalization Support After an Application is installed, the Application may need to obtain its personalization data, including its own keys and Cardholder-specific data. The Application can utilize the secure communication and key decryption services of its associated Security Domain to manage the secure loading of this personalization data. This can be achieved in two ways: one being to utilize the runtime messaging support described in section 7.3.4 - Runtime Messaging Support, the other being to utilize the Security Domain's ability to access the Application as described in section 7.3.2. This section addresses the second method. Using this second method on a card that only supports the Basic Logical Channel allows the Application to be personalized without the Application being the selected Application. Rather the Security Domain is the selected Application and the Security Domain receives commands on behalf of the Application. The Security Domain would pre-process the personalization (STORE DATA) command prior to forwarding the command to the Application via the GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework. Using this second method on a card that supports multiple logical channels differs slightly only in that the Application could have a multi-selection restriction in which case personalization would fail. If an Application does not support this second method, the Security Domain shall reject any STORE DATA command destined to this Application. Runtime Behavior On receipt of an INSTALL [for personalization] command and subsequent STORE DATA commands, the Security Domain performing the personalization of the Application shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Check that the off-card entity is authenticated as the Application Provider; * Pre-process subsequent STORE DATA commands according to the Current Security Level of the Secure Channel Session and prior to the command being forwarded to the target Application. On receipt of a request to forward commands to an Application, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restrictions for personalization (see Table 11-53); * Apply the GlobalPlatform Trusted Framework runtime requirements defined in section 6.7. Personalization Flow The following diagram is an example of an Application receiving data from its associated Security Domain during personalization. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 61 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. A P D U In te rfa c e In te rn a l A P I S e c u rity D o m a in H o s t A p p lic a tio n S E L E C T S ec u rity D om ain S E L E C T res p on s e S E L E C T O p tio n a l A u th e n tica tio n P ro ce ss S T O R E D A T A S T O R E D A T A res p on s e G P T ru s ted F ram ew ork in terfac e c h e c k p riv ile g e s a n d a c c e s s c o n d itio n s IN S T A L L [fo r p e rso n a liza tio n ] S T O R E D A T A s e c u re m e s s a g in g u n w ra p p in g IN S T A L L IN S T A L L res p on s e O P E N / G P T ru s te d F ra m e w o rk G P A p p in terfac e A p p lic a tio n p e rs o n a liz a tio n G lo b a lP la tfo rm A P I p roc es s d ata retu rn p roc es s s d ata retu rn Figure 7-2: Application Personalization through Associated Security Domain 7.3.4 Runtime Messaging Support Security Domains may provide runtime support for secure communication to their directly associated Applications. Instead of loading additional communication keys into an Application, the Application Provider may choose to use the associated Security Domain services for all Application communication throughout the life of the Application. Runtime Messaging Flow The following diagram is an example of an Application using the services of its associated Security Domain: 62 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. APDU Interface GlobalPlatform API Security DomainHost Application SELECT Application SELECT Response SELECT Authentication Process Application Specific APDU Application specific APDU Application specific APDU response unwrapping Application Functionality Application Specific APDU Application specific APDU Application specific APDU response unwrapping initiate Secure Channel Session and authenticate offcard entity Application Functionality decrypt Figure 7-3: Runtime Messaging Flow 7.4 Security Domain Data 7.4.1 Issuer Security Domain The Issuer Security Domain shall be able to handle the following data: * Issuer Identification Number (IIN); * Card Image Number (CIN); * Card Recognition Data; * Other Card Issuer's proprietary data. These data shall be available from the card using the GET DATA command. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 63 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7.4.1.1 Issuer Identification Number The Issuer Identification Number (IIN) may be used by an off-card entity to associate the card with a specific Card Management System. The IIN typically contains the ISO 7812 defined identification of the Issuer and is carried by the ISO/IEC 7816-6 tag '42'. The IIN data element is of variable length. 7.4.1.2 Card Image Number The Card Image Number (CIN) may be used by a Card Management System to uniquely identify a card within its card base. It is a unique value, carried by the ISO/IEC 7816 defined tag '45' (Card Issuer's Data), which is assigned by the Card Issuer (identified itself by the IIN). The CIN data element is of variable length. 7.4.1.3 Card Recognition Data Card Management Systems need information about a card before they can start to interact with it. This includes the kind of card it is and what Secure Channel Protocol it supports. Card Recognition Data is the mechanism for providing information about a card, and thus avoiding the vagaries of trial-and-error. See appendix H for details. Card Recognition Data shall be present and contained in a data template (tag '73'). This template shall in turn be contained in the "Card Data" data object (tag '66'), as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-6. Card Data can be retrieved using the GET DATA command. (For contact cards according to ISO/IEC 7816-4, Card Data may also be accessed through the ATR, if a suitable "command to perform" is included in the ATR historical bytes.) Note that the information provided in Card Recognition Data should be enough to enable initial communication with the card without resorting to trial and error. Information not essential for this purpose should be supplied during subsequent interaction with the card. There is no specific requirement for Card Recognition Data to be updated dynamically by the card, but additional dynamic data objects are not precluded. 7.4.2 Supplementary Security Domains Security Domains other than the Issuer Security Domain may handle their own identification data: * A Security Domain Provider Identification Number (SIN); * A Security Domain Image Number; * Security Domain Management Data; * Other Application Provider proprietary data. When present, these data shall be available from the Security Domain using the GET DATA command. 7.4.2.1 Security Domain Provider Identification Number The Security Domain Provider Identification Number (SIN) may be used by an off-card entity to associate the Security Domain with a specific Card Management System. It is an IIN, typically contains the ISO 7812 defined identification of the Security Domain provider, and is carried by the ISO/IEC 7816-6 tag '42'. The SIN data element is of variable length. 7.4.2.2 A Security Domain Image Number The Security Domain Image Number may be used by an Application Management System to uniquely identify an instance of a Security Domain on a card. If used it is a unique value, carried by the ISO/IEC 7816 defined tag '45'. 64 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7.4.2.3 Security Domain Management Data Application Management Systems need information about a Security Domain before they can start to interact with it. This includes the kind of Security Domain it is and what Secure Channel Protocol it supports. Security Domain Management Data is the mechanism for providing information about a Security Domain, and thus avoiding the vagaries of trial-and-error. Security Domain Management Data (tag `73') shall be returned in the response to the SELECT command when present. Security Domain Management Data shall also be returned in response to a GET DATA command with tag `66'. Note that the information provided in Security Domain Management Data should be enough to enable initial communication with the card without resorting to trial and error. There is no specific requirement for Security Domain Management Data to be updated dynamically by the card, but additional dynamic data objects are not precluded. For further details refer to appendix H. 7.5 Security Domain Keys 7.5.1 Key Information See the appropriate appendix D, E, or F for details of the keys used with each Secure Channel Protocol. See appendix C.1 for details of token, receipt and DAP keys. Keys have the following attributes: * A Key Identifier, which identifies each key within an on-card entity. A key may consist of one or more key components, e.g. a symmetric key has only one key component while an asymmetric key has several components. All key components share the same Key Identifier. Different Key Identifiers within one oncard entity shall be used to differentiate keys, their usage, and their functionality. There is no restriction and no pre-defined order in assigning Key Identifiers to keys, including non-sequential Key Identifiers within the same entity; * An associated Key Version Number: different key versions within an on-card entity may be used to differentiate several instances or versions of the same key. There is no restriction and no pre-defined order in assigning Key Version Numbers to keys; * An associated cryptographic algorithm: a specific key is associated with one and only one cryptographic algorithm; * A length, for cryptographic algorithms supporting several key (or key component) lengths; * Access conditions, to control and segment access to keys. These key attributes together indicate unambiguously to the on-card entity: * The identity; * The intended usage; * The functionality of cryptographic keys. The combination of a Key Identifier and a Key Version Number identifies unambiguously a key within an on-card entity. The key type identifies the cryptographic algorithm and key component. Identifying unambiguously a key and an algorithm within an entity prevent the misuse of cryptographic functionality. An off-card entity may obtain information on Security Domain key(s) with a GET DATA command for Key Information Template (tag `E0'). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 65 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. A Security Domain manages keys as follows: * A Key Identifier and Key Version Number uniquely reference each key within the on-card entity. In other words, each combination Key Identifier / Key Version Number identifies a unique key slot within that entity. * Adding a key equates to allocating a new key slot with a new key value, a new Key Identifier, or a new Key Version Number. * Replacing a key involves updating the key slot with a new key value and the associated Key Version Number. The Key Identifier remains the same. The previous key shall no longer be available. The off-card key management system shall be aware of the scheme used to identify keys held by the on-card entity. Key Identifiers and Key Version Numbers may have arbitrary values for the card (e.g. not being sequential, not starting with '01') and these values may vary from one key management scheme to the next. Off-card key management schemes are outside the scope of this specification. Any velocity checking related to a particular keys usage e.g. key try counters and limits are dependent on the Security Domain provider's security policy. The Security Domain shall store all the Key Information supplied in the PUT KEY command in association with each key. 7.5.2 Key Access Conditions The Access Conditions assigned to a Security Domain key are either: * Owner only: the Security Domain itself; * Authorized users other than the owner: e.g. the Security Domain's associated Applications; * Any authorized users, including the owner: e.g. the Security Domain and its associated Applications. This version of the Specification defines the following Access Conditions for Security Domain keys, coded on one byte as follows: * `00': any authorized user, including the owner; this is the Access Condition by default for Secure Channel Protocol Keys, when not explicitly provided in the PUT KEY command; * `01': the owner only; this is the Access Condition by default for Token and DAP Keys, when not explicitly provided in the PUT KEY command; * `02': authorized users other than the owner; * `03' to `7F': Reserved for Future Use by GlobalPlatform; * `80' to `FE': Reserved for proprietary use; * `FF': not available. The access control rules applicable to any Security Domain key are enforced as follows: * In order to use any Security Domain's cryptographic service, the Application requests to the OPEN the reference of a Secure Channel interface; the OPEN identifies the Security Domain associated with the Application and provides the corresponding Secure Channel interface reference to the Application (GlobalPlatform Registry acting as an access control list); * The Application requests cryptographic services to a Security Domain, via its Secure Channel interface; since the OPEN ensures access to associated Applications only, the Security Domain controls are simplified to enforce the Access Conditions applicable to each of its keys (e.g. rejecting requests for accessing a key with an Access Condition set to `01'). 66 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 7.6 Data and Key Management These services relate to the storing of cryptographic keys and data on the card. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a data/key management request, the corresponding Security Domain shall manage the data/key according to its own access control rules. The card Life Cycle State shall not be CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED. On receipt of a DELETE [key], PUT KEY or STORE DATA command, the Security Domain performing the data or key management shall apply its own secure communication policy. The Security Domain provider may apply its own key management policy regarding deletion of keys. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 67 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 8 Global Platform Services 8.1 Global Services Applications One or more Global Services Applications may be present on the card to provide services to other Applications on the card. Global Services Applications are distinguished from other Applications through a specific privilege: Global Service. 8.1.1 Registering Global Services During the installation of an Application (see section 9.3.6 -Card Content Installation) or during the registry update for an already installed Application (see section 9.4 - Content Extradition and Registry Update), an Application may be assigned the Global Service privilege and optionally Global Service Parameters comprising one (or more) service name(s). When present, each service name identifies a service family and optionally a specific service identifier within that service family, identifying which service(s) the Global Services Application offers to other Applications. When present, the Global Service Parameters shall be recorded in the GlobalPlatform Registry entry for the Application. Uniqueness on the card of this (these) service name(s) is not required in order to allow more than one Global Services Application to offer similar services. To offer a unique service onto a card, a Global Services Application may register a Global Service with a service name that is unique on that card. A Global Services Application may register one or more Global Service(s) with unique service name(s). OPEN is responsible for ensuring the uniqueness of each service name registered by Global Services Applications. Runtime Behavior The following runtime behavior requirements apply to the OPEN during the registration process of a Global Service with a unique service name. On receipt of unique service registration request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity has the Global Service privilege; * If one (or more) service name(s) are recorded for that on-card entity, check that the requested service name matches exactly with (one of) the service name(s) recorded for that on-card entity, or belongs to the same service family if the recorded service name(s) only identifies(y) service family(ies); * Check that the requested service name is not registered within the GlobalPlatform Registry for another oncard entity; * Register accordingly as unique the requested service name. The following runtime behavior requirements apply to the OPEN during the deregistration process of a Global Service with a unique service name. On receipt of service deregistration request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity has the Global Service privilege; * Check that the requested service name is registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of the requesting on-card entity; * Deregister accordingly the requested service name as being unique. 8.1.2 Application Access to Global Services GlobalPlatform API is the interface Applications use to access Global Services. An Application may access a uniquely registered Global Service or a specific Global Services Application. 68 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Runtime Behavior The following runtime behavior requirements apply to the OPEN during the access of a uniquely registered Global Service or a specific Global Services Application. On receipt of service access request, the OPEN shall: * If the request indicates a specific service name without any associated AID, check that the requested service name matches exactly with (one of) the service name(s) uniquely registered, or belongs to the same service family uniquely registered; * If the request indicates a specific AID, check that the on-card entity identified in the request has the Global Service privilege, and that the requested service name matches exactly with (one of) the service name(s) recorded for that on-card entity, or belongs to (one of) the same service family(ies) recorded for that oncard entity; * Identify the corresponding Global Services Application; * Obtain the GlobalPlatform Service interface of the corresponding Global Services Application and forward it to the requesting on-card entity. The requesting on-card entity can then directly invoke the GlobalPlatform Service interface of the corresponding Global Services Application and authenticate itself in order to obtain the requested service. 8.1.3 Global Service Parameters Global Service Parameters may be defined for an Application and list one or more service names. Each service name is coded on two bytes. The first byte identifies the service family, the second the service id within that family. The following values are assigned to the service family identifier: * '00' to '7F' ­ Reserved for proprietary use and not registered by GlobalPlatform, * '80' to '9F' ­ Reserved for use by GlobalPlatform - '80' ­ Not available, - '81' ­ GlobalPlatform Secure Channel, - '82' ­ GlobalPlatform CVM; * 'A0' to 'FE' ­ Reserved for use by individual schemes registered by GlobalPlatform; - 'A0' ­ USSM; * 'FF' ­ Not available; The values assigned to the service id within a service family are specific to each service family. * A service id value of '00' is typically reserved to indicate `any service id within that family'; or may be used as a default value in the case where the service family does not require a service identifier; * For the GlobalPlatform Secure Channel family, the Secure Channel Protocol identifiers (see 10.7 - Secure Channel Protocol Identifier) are the assigned service id values for that family; * For the GlobalPlatform CVM family, the CVM identifier values (see section 8.2.2.1 - Registering CVM) are the assigned service id values for that family. 8.2 CVM Application The CVM Application, if present on a card, provides a mechanism for a Cardholder Verification Method (CVM), including velocity checking, that may be used by all Applications on the card. In this version of the Specification there is one CVM standardized by GlobalPlatform: the global Personal Identification Number (global PIN). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 69 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The CVM verification services may be accessed by any Application. CVM management services shall only be accessible to privileged on-card Applications. The CVM application may also offer CVM management services to suitably authenticated off-card entities through an APDU interface that is beyond the scope of this specification. A CVM Application may support multiple CVMs, and there may be more than one CVM Application present on a card. Each CVM shall have a unique CVM identifier, which shall be unique across the whole card. The standardized CVM (global PIN), if present on a card, shall be given the CVM identifier of '11'. For each CVM supported, the CVM Application shall: * Hold securely CVM management data: CVM value, CVM State, CVM Retry Limit, and CVM Retry Counter; * Perform CVM-specific risk management, such as internal velocity checks on the CVM to prevent card and Application access violations; * Implement one or more CVM interfaces; * Request the OPEN to register the CVM identifier if that CVM is unique; * Provide the CVM services to Applications; * Manage the CVM state; * Manage the CVM Retry Limit and CVM Retry Counter. Depending on the Issuer policy, a value for the Retry Limit may be set by default. 8.2.1 Application Access to CVM Services The following CVM services shall be provided by a CVM Application to other on-card Applications: * Retrieving the CVM state (e.g. to determine if the CVM value has been submitted, verified or blocked); * Retrieving the number of remaining times the CVM value can be incorrectly presented prior to the CVM being blocked; * Setting a new value for the CVM value. This depends on the requesting Application having the CVM Management privilege; * Verifying the content of an incoming CVM value by comparing the incoming CVM value to the stored CVM value; * Setting the maximum number of times the CVM value can be incorrectly presented prior to the CVM being blocked. This depends on the requesting Application having the CVM Management privilege. 8.2.2 CVM Management 8.2.2.1 Registering CVM In order to offer unique CVM services that are accessible by other Applications, a CVM Application shall register with the OPEN the CVM identifier(s) for which it offers services. The OPEN shall ensure that the registered CVM identifiers are unique on the whole card. Reuse is only possible if the CVM identifier is deregistered or the corresponding CVM Application is deleted. The following values are assigned to CVM identifiers: * '00' - Not available; 70 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * '01' to '7F' - Reserved for use by GlobalPlatform; - '01' to '10' - PIN as defined in ETSI TS 102 221 specification; - '11' - Global PIN; - '12' to '1F' - PIN as defined in ETSI TS 102 221 specification; * '80' to 'EF' - Reserved for use by individual schemes registered by GlobalPlatform; - '81' to '9F' - PIN as defined in ETSI TS 102 221 specification; * 'F0' to 'FF' - Reserved for proprietary use and not registered by GlobalPlatform. 8.2.2.2 CVM States The CVM state may be used by a CVM Application to assist in managing CVM services. The non-atomic states of the CVM may be seen within a Card Session. The CVM state, the Retry Limit, and the Retry Counter are closely related. All CVM state transitions are immediately visible to the Application that caused the transition as well as to any Applications that may be selected on other logical channels. The CVM states are: * ACTIVE * INVALID_SUBMISSION * VALIDATED * BLOCKED 8.2.2.2.1 CVM State ACTIVE The CVM state shall first become ACTIVE when both the CVM value and the Retry Limit are set. The CVM state may also transition back to ACTIVE from any other CVM state if a privileged Application unblocks the CVM or changes the CVM value. Changing the CVM value shall also reset the Retry Counter. At the end of a Card Session the CVM state shall transition back to ACTIVE, except if the CVM state transitioned to the CVM state BLOCKED during the Card Session. The end of the Card Session shall not reset the Retry Counter. 8.2.2.2.2 CVM State INVALID_SUBMISSION During the CVM verification, the CVM state shall transition to INVALID_SUBMISSION if the CVM verification fails. The Retry Counter shall be updated. The CVM state shall remain INVALID_SUBMISSION until: * The Card Session ends; * A valid CVM verification is performed; * An Application resets the CVM state; * A privileged Application either blocks the CVM or changes the CVM value or CVM Retry Limit; * Subsequent CVM verification(s) fail causing the CVM state to transition to BLOCKED. 8.2.2.2.3 CVM State VALIDATED During CVM verification, the CVM state shall transition to VALIDATED and the Retry Counter shall be reset if the CVM verification is successful. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 71 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The CVM state shall remain VALIDATED until: * The Card Session ends; * An invalid CVM verification is performed; * An Application resets the CVM state; * A privileged Application either blocks the CVM, or changes the CVM value or CVM Retry Limit. 8.2.2.2.4 CVM State BLOCKED During CVM verification, if the CVM verification fails and the Retry Limit has been reached, the CVM state shall transition to BLOCKED. The CVM state may also transition to BLOCKED if a privileged Application initiates this transition. The BLOCKED state shall not transition when the Card Session ends. The CVM state may only transition from the BLOCKED state back to the ACTIVE state on instruction from a privileged Application, which either resets (unblocks) the CVM state or changes the CVM value or CVM Retry Limit. The CVM verification shall always fail in the BLOCKED state. 8.2.2.3 CVM Format The 3 following formats are defined for the CVM value: * Format BCD includes only numerical digits, coded on a nibble (4 bits), left justified, and eventually padded on the right with an 'F' nibble if necessary (i.e. the number of digits is odd); * Format ASCII includes all displayable characters (alphabetic, numerical, and special) and space (i.e. format ASCII ranges from `20' to `7E'), coded on one byte and left justified. * Format HEX is equivalent to a transparent mode ("as is") and includes all binary values coded on one byte. The following rules apply for the CVM format conversion: * No conversion from and to HEX format is valid; * Conversion from BCD format to ASCII format is valid: the numeric nibbles are expanded to the corresponding characters coded on one byte and the padding nibble 'F' is deleted (if present); * Conversion from ASCII format to BCD format is valid for numeric characters only: the numeric characters coded on one byte are converted to numeric nibbles, padded together in bytes, and a padding nibble 'F' is added on the right if necessary. The internal format for storing the CVM value by a CVM Application is implementation dependent and shall be transparent to any other on-card Application that uses CVM services. It shall not preclude any format used by Applications requesting CVM services. 72 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9 Card and Application Management 9.1 Card Content Management 9.1.1 Overview Card Content management on a GlobalPlatform card is the capability for the loading, installation, extradition, registry update and removal of Card Content. GlobalPlatform is designed for providing maximum flexibility to the Card Issuer and its business partners regarding Card Content management. The design of the GlobalPlatform takes into account the possibility that the Card Issuer may not necessarily want to manage all Card Content changes, especially when the Card Content does not belong to the Card Issuer. Thus the Card Issuer may delegate Card Content management to an Application Provider with or without authorization: * It may authorize all Card Content management operations performed by an Application Provider; * It may authorize an Application Provider to have full control of its Card Content; * It may authorize an Application Provider to isolate its own Security Domain(s) and Application(s) from other Application Providers, and potentially from the Card Issuer itself. Card Content changes are permitted according to the privileges that have been assigned to the various Security Domains on the card. The following sections describe the OPEN and Security Domain requirements to support the operation and authorization of Card Content management. 9.1.2 OPEN Requirements The OPEN: * Performs the physical loading and installation; * May prohibit more than one Card Content management operation occurring concurrently; * Prohibits Card Content management in the card Life Cycle States CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED. 9.1.3 Security Domain Requirements The Security Domain through which Card Content management is performed applies its own secure communication policy, which should be checked for consistency with any Card Issuer policies before the Security Domain is installed. Card Content management involves a Security Domain performing loading, installation, extradition, update to GlobalPlatform Registry and content removal operations. 9.1.3.1 Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege This privilege allows a Security Domain Provider, typically the Card Issuer, to authorize any Card Content management operation. A Security Domain with Token Verification privilege requires the knowledge of keys and algorithms used for Tokens. Note that this privilege does not provide Card Content management capability. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 73 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. In this version of the specification, one Security Domain with Token Verification privilege per card is assumed. 9.1.3.2 Security Domain with Authorized Management Privilege Having a Security Domain with this privilege allows a Security Domain provider to perform Card Content management without authorization (i.e. a token) in the case where the off-card entity is authenticated as the owner (Security Domain Provider) of the Security Domain. In that case the Security Domain that has Token Verification privilege is not involved. However, a Token is still required if the off-card entity is authenticated but is not the Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication). 9.1.3.3 Security Domain with Delegated Management Privilege. The Delegated Management privilege allows an Application Provider's Security Domain with this privilege to perform: * Delegated loading; * Delegated installation and make selectable; * Delegated extradition; * Delegated update to the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Delegated deletion. The privilege allows an Application Provider to manage Card Content with authorization. The Security Domain that has Token Verification privilege controls such authorization. Delegated Management is not a mandated feature of a GlobalPlatform card and is only necessary for Card Issuers that choose to offer this flexibility. In order to achieve it, close co-operation is required between the OPEN and the Security Domains. 9.1.3.4 Security Domain with Global Delete Privilege This privilege provides the capability to remove any Executable Load File or Application from the card even if the Executable Load File or Application does not belong to this Security Domain. Note that a Security Domain without Global Delete privilege and with Card Content management capability can only delete Executable Load Files or Applications directly or indirectly associated with it. 9.1.3.5 Security Domain with Global Lock Privilege This privilege provides the right to initiate the locking and unlocking of any Application on the card, independent of its Security Domain association and hierarchy. It also provides the capability to restrict the Card Content Management functionality of OPEN. 9.1.3.6 Security Domain with Receipt Generation Privilege This privilege allows a Security Domain Provider, typically the Card Issuer, to provide a confirmation for the performed card content management. A Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege requires the knowledge of keys and algorithms used for Receipts generation. It shall also keep track of a Confirmation Counter that is incremented when generating each Receipt. When reaching its maximum value, the Confirmation Counter shall not be reset to zero. Cards are not required to support counter values beyond 32767. Note that this privilege does not provide Card Content management capability. In this version of the specification, one Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege per card is assumed. 74 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9.2 Authorizing and Controlling Card Content The following section details the authorization and control features that may be used during Card Content loading and installation. The responsibility of ensuring that these controls are present when required rests with the OPEN. 9.2.1 DAP Verification An Application Provider may require that their Application code to be loaded on the card shall be checked for integrity and authenticity. The DAP Verification privilege of the Application Provider's Security Domain detailed in this Specification provides this service on behalf of an Application Provider. A Controlling Authority may require that all Application code to be loaded onto the card shall be checked for integrity and authenticity. The Mandated DAP Verification privilege of the Controlling Authority's Security Domain detailed in this Specification provides this service on behalf of the Controlling Authority. The key and algorithm to be used for DAP Verification or Mandated DAP Verification are implicitly known by the corresponding Security Domain. Flow control and runtime behavior as described in section 9.3.5 - Card Content Loading Process applies; more detail on DAP Blocks is provided in appendix C.3. 9.2.2 Load File Data Block Hash The Load File Data Block Hash is an integrity check across the whole Load File Data Block to be transferred to the card and is present as a field in the INSTALL [for load] command; more detail is provided in appendix C.2. The Load File Data Block Hash is mandatory when a Token or DAP Block is present in a Load File, and is optional otherwise. If a Load File Data Block Hash is present in a Load File, then it shall be checked. See appendix B.2.1 - Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1) for more details on the hash algorithm. Flow control and runtime behavior as described in section 9.3.5 - Card Content Loading Process applies. 9.2.3 Tokens Tokens relate specifically to Delegated Management, and to Authorized Management where the off-card entity is not the Security Domain Provider. They are not allowed in other cases. More detail is provided in appendix C.4. The entity owning the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege provides a Token to the Security Domain Provider performing the content management function. During the processing of the content management function the token is verified on-card by the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege. 9.3 Card Content Loading, Installation and Make Selectable 9.3.1 Overview The GlobalPlatform Card Content loading process is designed to allow the addition of code to Mutable Persistent Memory in the card. Card Content loading may be prohibited if a load process is already in progress on another logical channel. The GlobalPlatform Card Content installation process is designed to allow the Card Issuer to make previously loaded application code executable on the card. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 75 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Card Content installation is either performed simultaneously with the load process, immediately following the load process or at a later time. The Load File Data Block contains the information required in order to create an Executable Load File. The internal organization of the Load File Data Block is beyond the scope of this Specification. The Java CardTM CAP file definition and MULTOSTM Application Load Unit are examples of an expected Load File Data Block. The Load File Data Block may also contain information on the Load File Data Block attributes such as its name, version number and size. The Card Content loading and installation process may include implementation specific linking and actual verification of the executable code. Additional authentication data may also be present in the Load File. Upon the successful completion of the Card Content loading, an Executable Load File shall be present on the card and the OPEN shall create an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Executable Load File. The OPEN shall also create an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry for each Executable Module present within an Executable Load File. However, Executable Modules are not yet ready for execution. Applications may then be installed. Installing an Application results in another entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry. Figure 9-1 details the two possible phases of the Card Content loading and installation. Loading Phase Load Request Load 1 Installation Phase Install Request Load n Figure 9-1: Loading and Installation Process 9.3.2 Card Content Loading When requested to do so by the OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall verify the transmission of the Load File from the off-card entity to the card, and when applicable, Security Domains with the relevant privilege shall verify the integrity of the Load File Data Block before the OPEN commits the new content to memory. A Security Domain with Authorized Management or Delegated Management privilege may load an Executable Load File to any Security Domain. The Executable Load File is subject to acceptance by the receiving Security Domain where applicable. The load process comprises an INSTALL [for load] command and one or more LOAD commands all of which are processed by the Security Domain. The Security Domain then passes the load request and Load File information to the OPEN for additional verification and processing. 76 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The Load Token allows the OPEN, via the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege, to ensure that the Token Issuer authorized the load process and the loading of the content of the Load File Data Block. (In this version of the specification, the Token Issuer is assumed to be the same as the Card Issuer.) The Load File Data Block Hash links the Token to the actual Load File Data Block. The response to the last LOAD command identifies the end of the load process. Following the completion of the load process, an optional Load Receipt is returned to the Security Domain performing the Delegated Management operation and shall be transmitted by the Security Domain to the off-card entity. The Application Provider may then forward the Load Receipt to the corresponding off-card entity as a proof that the loading process was successfully performed. The purpose of the optional Load Receipt is to assist the Card Issuer in keeping its Card Management System synchronized with its card base. 9.3.3 Card Content Installation A Security Domain with Authorized Management or Delegated Management privilege may install an Application in the Security Domain that the Executable Load File is associated with. If the Security Domain performing the installation is not the Security Domain the Executable Load File is associated with, then this is referred to as implicit extradition of the Application and is subject to the rules in section 9.4 - Content Extradition and Registry Update. The installation process comprises an INSTALL [for install] command processed by the Security Domain. The Security Domain then passes the install request to the OPEN for additional verification and processing. The Install Token allows the OPEN, via the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege, to ensure that the Card Issuer authorized the installation process. The response to the INSTALL [for install] command identifies the end of the installation process. Following the completion of the installation process, an optional Install Receipt is returned to the Security Domain performing the Delegated Management operation and shall be transmitted by the Security Domain to the off-card entity. The Application Provider may then forward the Install Receipt to the corresponding off-card entity as a proof that the installation process was successfully performed. The purpose of the optional Install Receipt is to assist the Card Issuer in keeping its Card Management System synchronized with its card base. 9.3.4 Card Content Combined Loading, Installation and Make Selectable When requested to do so by the OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall verify the transmission of the Load File from the off-card entity to the card, and when applicable, Security Domains with the relevant privilege shall verify the integrity of the Load File Data Block before the OPEN commits the new content to memory. A Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege may load an Executable Load File to any Security Domain, install an Application from the Executable Load File and make the Application selectable. The combined load, install and make selectable process comprises a first INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command, one or more LOAD commands and a last INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command all of which are processed by the Security Domain. The Executable Load File is subject to acceptance by the receiving Security Domain where applicable. The combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token allows the OPEN, via the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege, to ensure that the Token Issuer authorized the load process and the loading of the content of the Load File Data Block as well as the installation of an Application from the previously loaded Executable Load File. (In this version of the specification, the Token Issuer is assumed to be the same as the Card Issuer.) The response to the last INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command identifies the end of the combined load and install process. Following the completion of the load and install process, an optional combined March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 77 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt is returned to the Security Domain performing the Delegated Management operation and shall be transmitted by the Security Domain to the off-card entity. The Application Provider may then forward the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt to the corresponding off-card entity as a proof that the loading process was successfully performed. The purpose of the optional combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt is to assist the Card Issuer in keeping its Card Management System synchronized with its card base. The response to the last INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command completes the combined load, install and make selectable process. 9.3.5 Card Content Loading Process The phases in Figure 9-1 use a combination of multiple occurrences of two different APDU commands (INSTALL and LOAD). The following sequence of APDU commands apply to the loading: * An INSTALL [for load] command serves as the load request for loading. The INSTALL [for load] command data field details the requirements regarding a Load File; * Multiple LOAD commands are then used to transport the Load File in blocks according to the size of the file and the communications buffer size of the card; * Each INSTALL or LOAD command is processed by the receiving Security Domain before forwarding the load request and Load File to the OPEN for processing. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the content loading process. Load Request Runtime Behavior On receipt of an INSTALL [for load] command, the Security Domain performing the load shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If a Load File Data Block Hash is present in the INSTALL [for load] command, request the OPEN to initiate the hash verification of the subsequent Load File Data Block; * If the Security Domain performing the load has Delegated Management privilege, check that a Load Token is present in the INSTALL [for load] command; * If the Security Domain performing the load has the Authorized Management privilege and the off-card entity at the origin of the load request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Load Token is present in the INSTALL [for load] command; * If a Token is present in the INSTALL [for load] command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Load Token; * If the Application Provider identifier is present in the load request, request the OPEN to save this in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Executable Load File. On receipt of a load request (arising from an INSTALL [for load] command), the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for load; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; 78 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Check that the AID of the Load File is not already present in the GlobalPlatform Registry as an Executable Load File or Application; * If an associated Security Domain AID is present, check that this AID exists within the GlobalPlatform Registry and is registered with the Security Domain privilege. As this equates to the extradition of the Load File, if the Security Domain performing the load is not directly or indirectly associated with the associated Security Domain, check that the associated Security Domain accepts this extradition. If no associated Security Domain AID is indicated, the Security Domain performing the load is by default the associated Security Domain; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the load, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to authorize the load request (e.g. to verify the Load Token). At the request of OPEN, a Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Verify the Load Token. At the request of OPEN, a Security Domain accepting an implicit extradition shall: * Apply the Security Domain Provider's policy to accept or reject this implicit extradition; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); Load Phase Runtime Behavior On receipt of the LOAD commands, the Security Domain performing the load shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Discover whether any Security Domain has the Mandated DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the required authentication data (DAP Block identifying the above Security Domain) is present in the Load File * Check if the associated Security Domain has the DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the required authentication data (DAP Block identifying the associated Security Domain) is present in the Load File; * If authentication data (one or more DAP Blocks) is present in the Load File: - Ensure that a Load File Data Block Hash was received during the load request process; - Extract the authentication data (one or more DAP Blocks) from the Load File; - For each DAP Block of the Load File, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the DAP by the Security Domain indicated in the DAP Block. On receipt of the Load File the OPEN shall: * Verify the resource requirements of the Load File (see section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management) and that sufficient card resources are available; * Check that each DAP verification request from the Security Domain performing the load relates to a Security Domain present in the GlobalPlatform Registry with DAP or Mandated DAP Verification privilege and if so request the Security Domain to verify the DAP; * Compute the hash of the Load File Data Block when verification of a DAP Block or Load Token is requested. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain(s) verifying the DAP(s) shall: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 79 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Verify that the DAP matches with the Load File Data Block Hash received in the load request. Load Completion Runtime Behavior On receipt of the last LOAD command, the Security Domain performing the load shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Request the OPEN to obtain a Load Receipt. On completion of the load process the OPEN shall: * At the request of the Security Domain performing the load, verify the Load File Data Block Hash received in the load request; * Check in the GlobalPlatform Registry if any Security Domain has the Mandated DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the above Security Domain has successfully verified a DAP; * Check in the GlobalPlatform Registry if the associated Security Domain has the DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the associated Security Domain has successfully verified a DAP; * If one or more DAP verifications were performed, verify the Load File Data Block Hash received in the load request; * If the Security Domain performing the load has Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * If a Load Token was verified, verify the Load File Data Block Hash received in the load request; * Create an Executable Load File using the Load File Data Block; * Create an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Executable Load File indicating its associated Security Domain; * Create an entry for each Executable Module within the Executable Load File in the GlobalPlatform Registry. This shall include the Application Provider identifier if requested by the Security Domain in the load request. The associated Security Domain for each Executable Module shall be the same as the associated Security Domain for the Executable Load File; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the load, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate a Load Receipt. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a Load Receipt. If, at any stage, the OPEN determines that card resources are insufficient for the loading process or that any verification step has failed, the OPEN shall terminate the loading process, shall return the appropriate error and shall reclaim any memory allocated to the load process. 9.3.6 Card Content Installation Process An INSTALL [for install] command is then used to request the installation of an application. The receiving Security Domain processes the INSTALL command before forwarding the install request to the OPEN for processing. The installation internal processing is beyond the scope of this Specification. However, it is assumed that the installation process includes the creation of instances and allocation of Application data memory. 80 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Following the installation, the OPEN shall register additional information in the GlobalPlatform Registry regarding the Application Life Cycle State, Security Domain association, and Privileges. Applications inherit the associated Security Domain of the Executable Load File from which they are installed. They may be extradited to another Security Domain. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the content installation process: Runtime Behavior (Installation) On receipt of the INSTALL [for install] command, the Security Domain performing the installation shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain performing the installation has the Authorized Management privilege and the offcard entity at the origin of the installation request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that an Install Token is present in the INSTALL [for install] command. * If a Token is present in the INSTALL [for install] command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Install Token. * If the Application Provider identifier is present in the install request, request the OPEN to save this in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Application. * Request the OPEN to obtain an Install Receipt. On receipt of the install request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for installation; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the Executable Module AID is present in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Check that the Application AID (for future selection of the Application) is not already present in the GlobalPlatform Registry as an Application or Executable Load File; * Check that the Security Domain performing the installation is the Security Domain associated with the Executable Module from which the Application is being installed; or if the Security Domain performing the installation is not the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Executable Module from which the Application is being installed, check that the Security Domain associated with the Executable Load File accepts this installation; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the installation, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to authorize the installation (e.g. to verify the Install Token); * Verify the resource requirements indicated for the Application (see section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management) and that sufficient card resources are available; * Perform the installation of the Application according to the underlying runtime environment requirements; * If the Security Domain performing the installation has Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Create an Application from the Executable Module; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 81 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Ensure that the Application, depending on the underlying runtime environment, has the knowledge of its AID, its Privileges and its Install Parameters; * Create an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Application indicating its associated Security Domain, Life Cycle State, Privileges and, when present in the install request, Implicit Selection, Service and Memory Resource Management parameters; and including the Application Provider identifier if supplied by the Security Domain in the installation request; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the installation, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate an Install Receipt. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Verify the Install Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not an Install Receipt. If the OPEN determines that card resources are insufficient for installing the Application or the runtime environment does not currently allow the installation, the OPEN shall terminate the installation process, return the appropriate error and reclaim any memory allocated to the install process. 9.3.7 Card Content Make Selectable Process An INSTALL [for make selectable] command is used to request to make selectable a previously installed application. The receiving Security Domain processes the INSTALL command before forwarding the make selectable request to the OPEN for processing. The make selectable internal processing is beyond the scope of this Specification. Following the make selectable, the OPEN shall register additional information in the GlobalPlatform Registry regarding the Application Life Cycle State and Privileges. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the content make selectable process: Runtime Behavior (Make Selectable) On receipt of the INSTALL [for make selectable] command, the Security Domain making the Application selectable shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain making the Application selectable has the Authorized Management privilege and the off-card entity at the origin of the installation request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Make Selectable Token is present in the INSTALL [for make selectable] command. * If a Token is present in the INSTALL [for make selectable] command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Make Selectable Token. * If the Application Provider identifier is present in the make selectable request, request the OPEN to save this in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Application. * Request the OPEN to obtain a Make Selectable Receipt. On receipt of the make selectable request, the OPEN shall: 82 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for make selectable; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the Application AID is present in the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Check that the Security Domain making the Application selectable is the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Application; * At the request of the Security Domain making the Application selectable, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to authorize the make selectable (e.g. to verify the Make Selectable Token); * Make the Application selectable according to the underlying runtime environment requirements; * If the Security Domain making the Application selectable has Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Update accordingly the GlobalPlatform Registry entry for the Application (e.g. Privileges, Implicit Selection parameters); * At the request of the Security Domain making the Application selectable, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate a Make Selectable Receipt. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Verify the Make Selectable Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a Make Selectable Receipt. 9.3.8 Card Content Combined Loading, Installation and Make Selectable Process The phases in Figure 9-1 are combined into a single process that uses a combination of multiple occurrences of two different APDU commands (INSTALL and LOAD). The following sequence of APDU commands apply to the loading: A first INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command serves as the combined load and install request for loading and installation. The INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command data field details the requirements regarding a Load File. Multiple LOAD commands are then used to transport the Load File in blocks according to the size of the file and the communications buffer size of the card. A last INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command serves as the combined load and install commit for loading and installation. The last INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command data field details the requirements regarding a Load File. Each INSTALL or LOAD command is processed by the receiving Security Domain before forwarding the load request and Load File Data Block to the OPEN for processing. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the content combined loading and installation process. Combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Request Runtime Behavior On receipt of an INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command, the Security Domain performing the combined load and install shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 83 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If a Load File Data Block Hash is present in the INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command, request the OPEN to initiate the hash verification of the subsequent Load File Data Block; * If the Application Provider identifier is present in the load request, request the OPEN to save this in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Executable Load File. On receipt of a combined load and installation request (arising from an INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command), the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for load, installation and make selectable; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the AID of the Load File is not already present in the GlobalPlatform Registry as an Executable Load File or Application; * If an associated Security Domain AID is present, check that this AID exists within the GlobalPlatform Registry and is registered with the Security Domain privilege. As this equates to the extradition of the Load File, if the Security Domain performing the combined load, install and make selectable is not directly or indirectly associated with the associated Security Domain, check that the associated Security Domain accepts this extradition. If no associated Security Domain AID is indicated, the Security Domain performing the load is by default the associated Security Domain. At the request of OPEN, a Security Domain accepting an implicit extradition shall: * Apply the Security Domain Provider's policy to accept or reject this implicit extradition; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain). Load Phase Runtime Behavior On receipt of the LOAD commands, the Security Domain performing the load shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Discover whether any Security Domain has the Mandated DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the required authentication data (DAP Block identifying the above Security Domain) is present in the Load File. * Check if the associated Security Domain has the DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the required authentication data (DAP Block identifying the associated Security Domain) is present in the Load File. * If authentication data (one or more DAP Blocks) is present in the Load File: - Ensure that a Load File Data Block Hash was received during the combined load, install and make selectable request process; - Extract the authentication data (one or more DAP Blocks) from the Load File; - For each DAP Block of the Load File, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the DAP by the Security Domain indicated in the DAP Block. 84 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. On receipt of the Load File the OPEN shall: * Verify the resource requirements of the Load File (see section 9.7- Memory Resource Management) and that sufficient card resources are available; * Check that each DAP verification request from the Security Domain performing the load relates to a Security Domain present in the GlobalPlatform Registry with DAP or Mandated DAP Verification privilege and if so request the Security Domain to verify the DAP; * Compute the hash of the Load File Data Block when verification of a DAP Block or a combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token is requested; At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain(s) verifying the DAP(s) shall: * Verify that the DAP matches with the Load File Data Block Hash received in the load request. On completion of the load process the OPEN shall: * At the request of the Security Domain performing the load, verify the Load File Data Block Hash received in the combined load, install and make selectable request; * Check in the GlobalPlatform Registry if any Security Domain has the Mandated DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the above Security Domain has successfully verified a DAP; * Check in the GlobalPlatform Registry if the associated Security Domain has the DAP Verification privilege and if so: - Ensure that the associated Security Domain has successfully verified a DAP; * If one or more DAP verifications were performed, verify the Load File Data Block Hash received in the load request. Combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Completion Runtime Behavior On receipt of the last INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command, the Security Domain performing the combined load and install shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * If the Security Domain performing the installation has the Authorized Management privilege and the offcard entity at the origin of the installation request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Load, Install and Make Selectable Token is present in the INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command; * If a Token is present in the INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Load, Install and Make Selectable Token; * If the Application Provider identifier is present in the combined load, install and make selectable request, request the OPEN to save this in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Executable Load File and the Application; * Request the OPEN to obtain a combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt. On completion of the load, install and make selectable process the OPEN shall: * If the Security Domain performing the combined load, install and make selectable has Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Create an Executable Load File using the Load File Data Block; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 85 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Create an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Executable Load File indicating its associated Security Domain; * Create an entry for each Executable Module within the Executable Load File in the GlobalPlatform Registry. This shall include the Application Provider identifier if requested by the Security Domain in the combined load, install and make selectable request. The associated Security Domain for each Executable Module shall be the same as the associated Security Domain for the Executable Load File; * Check that the Application AID (for future selection of the Application) is not already present in the GlobalPlatform Registry as an Application or Executable Load File; * Perform the installation of the Application according to the underlying runtime environment requirements; * Create an Application from the Executable Module; * Ensure that the Application, depending on the underlying runtime environment, has the knowledge of its AID, its Privileges and its Install Parameters; * Create an entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Application indicating its associated Security Domain, Life Cycle State, Privileges and, when present in the combined load, install and make selectable request, Implicit Selection, Service and Memory Resource Management parameters; and including the Application Provider identifier if supplied by the Security Domain in the combined load, install and make selectable request; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the combined load, install and make selectable, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to generate a Load, Install and Make selectable Receipt; * Verify the resource requirements indicated for the Application (see section 9.7- Memory Resource Management) and that sufficient card resources are available. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Verify the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt. If, at any stage, the OPEN determines that card resources are insufficient for the loading process or that any verification step has failed, the OPEN shall terminate the loading process, shall return the appropriate error and shall reclaim any memory allocated to the load process. 9.3.9 Examples of Loading and Installation Flow The following diagram is an example of the loading and installing of an Application to a GlobalPlatform card. In this example loading and installation are performed by a Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege. The Load File is loaded on the card and stored in memory as an Executable Load File. The installation phase occurs immediately following the loading phase. 86 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SELECT Security Domain SELECT Response SELECT Host Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege APDU Interface INSTALL [for load] INSTALL INSTALL Response Optional Authentication Process LOAD (final) LOAD LOAD Response INSTALL [for install] INSTALL INSTALL Response LOAD LOAD LOAD Response store Executable Load File verify Load File Data Block Hash; store Executable Load File; create and register Executable Load File and Executable Module(s) validate request validate request; install and register Application OPEN Internal interface Security Domain with DAP verification privilege verify Load File Data Block Signature Internal interface Figure 9-2: Load and Installation Flow Diagram The following diagram is an example of the loading of an Application to a GlobalPlatform card. In this example loading is performed by a Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 87 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SELECT Security Domain SELECT Response SELECT Host Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege APDU Interface INSTALL [for load] INSTALL INSTALL Response Optional Authentication Process LOAD (final) LOAD LOAD Response LOAD LOAD LOAD Response store Executable Load File store Executable Load File; verify Load File Data Block Hash; create and register Executable Load File and Executable Module(s) validate request; OPEN Internal interface Security Domain with DAP Verification privilege verify Load Token Internal interface Security Domain with Token Verification privilege assess access conditions Internal interface verify Load File Data Block Signature Figure 9-3: Load Flow Diagram The following diagram is an example of installing an Application from an Executable Load File already present on the card. In this example loading and installation are performed by a Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege. 88 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SELECT Security Domain SELECT Response SELECT Host Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege APDU Interface INSTALL INSTALL Response Optional Authentication Process INSTALL [for install] validate request; assess access conditions; OPEN Internal interface Internal interface Security Domain with Token Verification privilege verify security conditions with Security Domains; install and register Application verify Install Token Figure 9-4: Install Flow Diagram 9.4 Content Extradition and Registry Update 9.4.1 Content Extradition The GlobalPlatform Card Content extradition process is designed to allow a previously installed Application or a previously loaded Executable Load File to be associated with a different Security Domain. Delegated Extradition allows an Application Provider to extradite one of its Applications to another Security Domain, if the current Security Domain has Delegated Management privilege. The extradition may apply at any time during the Application Life Cycle. Extradition may apply for any Security Domain (in the PERSONALIZED state) or the Issuer Security Domain (in any card Life Cycle State other than CARD_LOCKED and TERMINATED), that accepts the extradited Application. The extradition process comprises an INSTALL [for extradition] command processed by the receiving Security Domain. The Security Domain then passes the extradition request to the OPEN for additional verification and processing. The Extradition Token allows the OPEN, via the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege, to ensure that the Card Issuer authorized the extradition process. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 89 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The response to the INSTALL [for extradition] command identifies the end of the extradition process. Following the completion of the extradition process, an optional Extradition Receipt is returned to the Security Domain performing the Delegated Management operation and shall be transmitted by the Security Domain to the off-card entity. The Application Provider may then forward the Extradition Receipt to the corresponding off-card entity as a proof that the extradition process was successfully performed. The purpose of the optional Extradition Receipt is to assist the Card Issuer in keeping its Card Management System synchronized with its card base. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the Card Content extradition process. Runtime Behavior On receipt of the INSTALL [for extradition] command, the Security Domain performing the extradition shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain performing the extradition has the Authorized Management privilege and the offcard entity at the origin of the extradition request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that an Extradition Token is present in the INSTALL [for extradition] command; * If a Token is present in the INSTALL [for extradition] command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Extradition Token; * Request the OPEN to obtain an Extradition Receipt. On receipt of an extradition request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for extradition; * Determine if the Application or Executable Load File being extradited exists within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the Security Domain requesting the extradition is directly or indirectly associated with the Application or Executable Load File being extradited; * Check that an on-card entity with the same AID as the Security Domain to which the Application or Executable Load File is being extradited exists within the GlobalPlatform Registry, and that this on-card entity has the Security Domain privilege; * If the Security Domain performing the extradition is not directly or indirectly associated with the Security Domain to which the Application or Executable Load File is being extradited, check that this Security Domain accepts this Card Content extradition; * If the Security Domain performing the extradition has the Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Update accordingly the GlobalPlatform Registry entry for the Application or Executable Load File; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the extradition, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate an Extradition Receipt. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: 90 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Verify the Extradition Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not an Extradition Receipt. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain accepting the explicit extradition shall: * Apply the Security Domain Provider's policy to accept or reject this Card Content extradition; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain). Extradition Flow The following figure is an example of extradition, and shows delegated extradition: OPEN validate request; assess access conditions verify Extradition Token Security Domain with Token Verification privilege SELECT Host Optional Authentication Process APDU Interface INSTALL [for extradition] Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege SELECT Security Domain Security Domain accept extradition requestverify security conditions with Security Domains; INSTALL extradite Application or Executable Load File INSTALL response SELECT response Internal interface Internal interface Internal interface Figure 9-5: Delegated Extradition Flow March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 91 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9.4.2 Registry Update 9.4.2.1 Generic Registry Update The registry update process allows GlobalPlatform Registry data associated with an Application, such as Privileges and Implicit Selection parameters, to be modified. This process also allows the restricting of Card Content Management functionality of a specific Security Domain or OPEN itself (i.e. of all existing Security Domains present on the card and any eventual Security Domain installed afterwards). The registry update may apply at any time during the Application Life Cycle or card Life Cycle (other than CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED). The registry update process comprises one or more INSTALL [for registry update] commands processed by the receiving Security Domain. To restrict Card Content Management functionality of OPEN, no Application AID is provided in the INSTALL [for registry update] command. The Security Domain then passes the registry update request to the OPEN for additional verification and processing. The Registry Update Token allows the OPEN, via the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege, to ensure that the Card Issuer authorized the update of the GlobalPlatform Registry. The response to the INSTALL [for registry update] command identifies the end of the registry update process. Following the completion of the registry update process, an optional Registry Update Receipt is returned to the Security Domain performing the Delegated Management operation and shall be transmitted by the Security Domain to the off-card entity. The Application Provider may then forward the Registry Update Receipt to the corresponding off-card entity as a proof that the registry update process was successfully performed. The purpose of the optional Registry Update Receipt is to assist the Card Issuer in keeping its Card Management System synchronized with its card base. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the registry update process. Runtime Behavior On receipt of the INSTALL [for registry update] command, the Security Domain performing the registry update shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain performing the registry update has the Authorized Management privilege and the off-card entity at the origin of the registry update request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Registry Update Token is present in the INSTALL [for registry update] command; * If a Token is present in the INSTALL [for registry update] command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Registry Update Token; * Request the OPEN to obtain a Registry Update Receipt. On receipt of a registry update request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for registry update; * When updating an Application, determine if the Application being updated exists within the GlobalPlatform Registry; 92 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * When restricting functionality of OPEN, check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Global Lock privilege; * Check that the Security Domain requesting the registry update is directly or indirectly associated with the Application being updated; * If the Security Domain performing the registry update has the Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Update accordingly the GlobalPlatform Registry entry for the Application being updated; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the registry update, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate a Registry Update Receipt. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Verify the Registry Update Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a Registry Update Receipt. 9.4.2.2 Extradition using Registry Update An extradition may be performed using the registry update process. The simultaneous extradition and registry update process is achieved by an appropriately formed INSTALL [for registry update] command. The runtime behavior requirements for an extradition using registry update are the sum of the runtime behavior requirements for extradition and the runtime behavior requirements for registry update. If a Token is required the Registry Update Token is used, and if a Receipt is to be returned the Registry Update Receipt is used; both of which allow for extradition as well as for registry update. 9.5 Content Removal This section defines the content removal process that enables a flexible management of the Mutable Persistent Memory space of the cards through the removal of Applications and/or Executable Load Files. Only code and data not referenced by another entity on the card may be deleted. Code and data that is currently being accessed by the runtime environment is deemed to be referenced by another entity. If the Application is selected on another logical channel this Application cannot be deleted. The DELETE command (see section 11.2 - DELETE Command) allows for the actual removal of content from Mutable Persistent Memory and the logical removal of content from Immutable Persistent Memory. The DELETE command is processed by the receiving Security Domain before forwarding the removal request to the OPEN for processing. Depending on the memory location of the removed Applications and/or Executable Load File, the OPEN shall perform the different actions detailed in the following sections. When the Application or Executable Load File has been successfully removed, its contents in the memory shall no longer be accessible. A Security Domain with Global Delete privilege has the privilege to delete any Application or Executable Load File from the card regardless of which Security Domain the Application or Executable Load File is associated with. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 93 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The Application Provider may instruct the OPEN to delete its associated Applications and Executable Load Files. According to the Card Issuer's policies, the OPEN may require pre-authorization from the Card Issuer, i.e. a Delete Token may be required. The response to the DELETE command identifies the end of the deletion process. Following the completion of the deletion process, an optional Delete Receipt is returned to the Security Domain performing the Delegated Management operation and shall be transmitted by the Security Domain to the off-card entity. The Application Provider may then forward the Delete Receipt to the corresponding off-card entity as a proof that the deletion process was successfully performed. The purpose of the optional Delete Receipt is to assist the Card Issuer in keeping its Card Management System synchronized with its card base. Deletion Flow The following figure is an example of deleting an Application, an Executable Load File, or both: SELECT Security Domain SELECT ResponseSELECT Host Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege APDU Interface DELETE DELETE DELETE Response Optional Authentication Process OPEN verify security conditions with Security Domains; delete Executable Load File and/or Application(s) Internal interface Security Domain with Token Verification privilege Internal interface validate request; assess access conditions verify Delete Token Figure 9-6: Content Deletion Flow 94 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9.5.1 Application Removal Application removal may involve the removal of Application instances as well as any Application data associated with the Application. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the Application removal process. Runtime Behavior On receipt of an Application deletion request (DELETE command), the Security Domain performing the deletion shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain performing the deletion has the Authorized Management privilege and the off-card entity at the origin of the delete request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Delete Token is present in the DELETE command; * If a Token is present in the DELETE command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Delete Token; * Request the OPEN to obtain a Delete Receipt. On receipt of an Application deletion request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for deletion; * Determine that the Application being deleted has an entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the Security Domain performing the delete is the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Application being deleted, or that it has Global Delete privilege. Otherwise (i.e. if the Security Domain performing the deletion is not directly or indirectly associated with the Application being deleted and does not have the Global Delete privilege), check that the Security Domain associated with the Application accepts this deletion; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the deletion, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Delete Token; * Determine that the Application is not currently selected on another logical channel; * Determine that no other Applications present in the card make references to this Application; * Determine that no other Applications present in the card make references to any data within this Application; * If a Security Domain is being deleted, determine that none of the Applications or Executable Load Files present in the card are associated with this Security Domain; * If the Security Domain performing the deletion has the Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a token; * Remove the entry for the Application from within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Re-assign the Application's privileges (if any) to the Issuer Security Domain as defined in section 6.6.2 Privilege Assignment; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 95 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * If the Application is implicitly selectable, re-assign implicit selection to the Issuer Security Domain as defined in section 6.4.1 - Implicit Selection Assignment; * Release and mark as available any Mutable Persistent Memory and when supported, apply the memory resource management rules described in section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the deletion, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate a Delete Receipt. If the OPEN determines that any of the above verification steps have failed, the OPEN shall not initiate the delete process and shall inform the Security Domain to return the appropriate response. Once this delete process begins it shall complete in the current Card Session or, in the event of an interruption, at least the updates to the GlobalPlatform Registry shall complete in a subsequent Card Session. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to accept or reject a deletion authorization request without the presence of a Delete Token; * Verify the Delete Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a Delete Receipt. 9.5.2 Executable Load File Removal An Executable Load File contains Executable Modules. The removal applies to the entire Executable Load File. Physical removal may occur in Mutable Persistent Memory while only logical removal is possible in Immutable Persistent Memory. This version of the Specification does not cover the removal of a specific Executable Module within an Executable Load File. The following runtime behavior requirements apply during the Executable Load File removal process. Runtime Behavior On receipt of an Executable Load File deletion request (DELETE command), the Security Domain performing the deletion shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain performing the deletion has the Authorized Management privilege and the off-card entity at the origin of the delete request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Delete Token is present in the DELETE command; * If a Token is present in the DELETE command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Delete Token; * Request the OPEN to obtain a Delete Receipt. On receipt of an Executable Load File removal process deletion request, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for deletion; 96 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the Security Domain performing the delete is the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Executable Load File being deleted, or that it has Global Delete privilege. Otherwise (i.e. if the Security Domain performing the deletion is not directly or indirectly associated with the Executable Load File being deleted and does not have the Global Delete privilege) check that the Security Domain associated with the Executable Load File accepts this deletion; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the deletion, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Delete Token; * Determine that the Executable Load File being deleted has an entry within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Determine that no other Applications and no other Executable Load Files present in the card maintain references to this Executable Load File; * If the Security Domain performing the deletion has the Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Remove the entry for the Executable Load File and the entries for any Executable Modules present in the Executable Load File from within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Release and mark as available any Mutable Persistent Memory and when supported, apply the memory resource management rules described in section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the deletion, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate a Delete Receipt. If the OPEN determines that any of the above verification steps have failed, the OPEN shall not initiate the delete process and shall inform the Security Domain to return the appropriate response. Once this delete process begins it shall all complete in the current Card Session or, in the event of an interruption, at least the updates to the GlobalPlatform Registry shall complete in a subsequent Card Session. Only Mutable Persistent Memory is released and marked as available. Executable Load Files contained in Immutable Persistent Memory cannot be deleted but the entry for the Executable Load File and the entries for the Executable Modules present in the Executable Load File shall be deleted from the GlobalPlatform Registry. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to accept or reject a deletion authorization request without the presence of a Delete Token; * Verify the Delete Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a Delete Receipt. 9.5.3 Executable Load File and related Application Removal An Executable Load File contains Executable Modules from which Applications have been installed. This optional feature removes the Executable Load File as well as all these related Applications. Physical removal may occur in Mutable Persistent Memory while only logical removal is possible in Immutable Persistent Memory. When supported by the card, the following runtime behavior requirements apply during the Executable Load File and related Application removal process. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 97 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Runtime Behavior On receipt of an Executable Load File deletion request (DELETE command), the Security Domain performing the deletion shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Apply its own security policy, e.g. check that its Life Cycle State is PERSONALIZED (only applicable to a Security Domain other than the Issuer Security Domain); * If the Security Domain performing the deletion has the Authorized Management privilege and the off-card entity at the origin of the delete request is not authenticated as its Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication), check that a Delete Token is present in the DELETE command; * If a Token is present in the DELETE command, request the OPEN to obtain verification of the Delete Token; * Request the OPEN to obtain a Delete Receipt. On receipt of a request to remove an Executable Load File and its related Applications, the OPEN shall: * Check that the card Life Cycle State is not CARD_LOCKED or TERMINATED; * Check that OPEN and the requesting on-card entity have no restriction for deletion; * Check that the requesting on-card entity is a Security Domain with Delegated Management or Authorized Management privilege; * Check that the Security Domain performing the delete is the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with each of the related Applications being deleted, or that it has Global Delete privilege. Otherwise (i.e. if the Security Domain performing the deletion is not directly or indirectly associated with one or more of the Applications being deleted and does not have the Global Delete privilege) check in each case that the Security Domain associated with the related Application accepts this deletion; * Check that the Security Domain performing the delete is the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Executable Load File being deleted, or that it has Global Delete privilege. Otherwise (i.e. if the Security Domain performing the deletion is not directly or indirectly associated with the Executable Load File being deleted and does not have the Global Delete privilege) check that the Security Domain associated with the Executable Load File accepts this deletion; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the deletion, request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Delete Token; * If the Security Domain performing the deletion has the Delegated Management privilege, ensure that the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege has successfully verified a Token; * Determine that the Executable Load File and Applications being deleted have entries within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Locate each Application installed from an Executable Module within this Executable Load File and for each Application: - Determine that the Application is not currently selected on another logical channel; - Determine that no other non-related Applications present in the card make reference to this Application; - Determine that no other non-related Applications present in the card maintain references to any data within this Application; - If a Security Domain is being deleted, determine that none of the non-related Applications present in the card are associated with this Security Domain; 98 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Determine that no other Applications and no other Executable Load Files present in the card maintain references to this Executable Load File; * Remove the entry for the Executable Load File and the entries for any Executable Modules present in the Executable Load File from within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Remove the entry for each related Application within the GlobalPlatform Registry; * Re-assign the privileges of all related Applications (if any) to the Issuer Security Domain as defined in section 6.6.2 - Privilege Assignment; * If any related Application is implicitly selectable, re-assign implicit selection to the Issuer Security Domain as defined in section 6.4.1 - Implicit Selection Assignment; * Release and mark as available any Mutable Persistent Memory and when supported, apply the memory resource management rules described in section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management; * At the request of the Security Domain performing the deletion, request the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to generate a series of Delete Receipts: one for the Executable Load File and one for each Application. If the OPEN determines that any of the above verification steps have failed, the OPEN shall not initiate the delete process and shall inform the Security Domain to return the appropriate response. Once the delete processes begin they shall all complete in the current Card Session or, in the event of an interruption, at least the updates to the GlobalPlatform Registry shall complete in a subsequent Card Session. Only Mutable Persistent Memory is released and marked as available. Executable Load Files contained in Immutable Persistent Memory cannot be deleted but the entry for the Executable Load File and the entries for the Executable Modules present in the Executable Load File shall be deleted from the GlobalPlatform Registry. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to accept or reject a deletion authorization request without the presence of a Delete Token; * Verify the Delete Token. At the request of OPEN, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall: * Apply the issuer's policy to generate or not a Delete Receipt. 9.6 Security Management 9.6.1 Life Cycle Management The following set of services is provided to manage the Life Cycles of on-card entities: * Application locking and unlocking; * Card locking and unlocking; * Card termination; * Application Life Cycle interrogation; * Card Life Cycle interrogation. Life Cycle Management Flow Figure 9-7 shows the flow that is common to all the Life Cycle management services: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 99 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SELECT Security Domain SELECT Response SELECT Host Security Domain APDU Interface Optional Authentication Process SET STATUS SET STATUS SET STATUS Response validate request; assess security conditions; verify security conditions; set lifecycle state OPEN OPEN API Figure 9-7: Life Cycle Management Flow 9.6.2 Application Locking and Unlocking The card has a mechanism to disable and subsequently re-enable the continued execution status of an on-card Application. This mechanism may be invoked from within the OPEN based on exceptions handled by the OPEN or from the use of externally invoked commands. An Application with Global Lock privilege, the Application itself or a directly or indirectly associated Security Domain are the only entities that may initiate the locking of an Application. Only an Application with Global Lock privilege or a directly or indirectly associated Security Domain may initiate the unlocking of an Application. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a SET STATUS command, the Security Domain performing the lifecycle management shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Check that the off-card entity at the origin of the lock/unlock request is authenticated as the Application Provider of the target Application or as the Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication). On receipt of a request to lock or unlock an Application, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity is the Application itself, or the Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Application being locked or unlocked, or that the requesting entity has the Global Lock privilege; * Check that the Application is not requesting to unlock itself; * Check that an entry for the Application being locked or unlocked is present in the GlobalPlatform Registry and does not have the Final Application privilege; 100 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * For locking, set the Application Life Cycle State to LOCKED; * For unlocking, reverse the Application Life Cycle State to its previous state; * For locking, keep a record of the previous Application Life Cycle State to ensure that the Application Life Cycle State can be transitioned back to and only to this previous state. An Application being locked that is currently selected on a logical channel shall remain the currently selected Application on that logical channel until the end of the Application Session though its Application Life Cycle State is set to LOCKED. Once the Application Life Cycle State is set to LOCKED, the Application shall not be selectable implicitly or explicitly on any logical channel. If the locked Application is implicitly selectable on any card interface(s) and logical channel(s), the application with Final Application privilege will be implicitly selected for those card interface(s) and logical channel(s). 9.6.3 Card Locking and Unlocking Once the card Life Cycle State is CARD_LOCKED, all Applications except the Application with the Final Application privilege shall be disabled. Due to the severity of this action, the card locking shall only be allowed under the most stringent conditions and shall only be performed with the proper security mechanisms and authorizations. Card locking requests may originate from two sources: Internal source-- either the OPEN, the Issuer Security Domain, or a privileged Application may initiate card locking requests from within the card. Internal requests are likely to occur in response to certain card runtime situations. For example, the OPEN or an Application with the necessary privilege may initiate the card locking process as a response to a perceived security threat based on data collected from velocity checking data. Off-card source-- explicit card locking requests may be initiated by APDU commands sent by the Card Issuer to the Issuer Security Domain or by an authorized representative to an Application with the Card Lock Privilege. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a SET STATUS command, the Security Domain performing the lifecycle management shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Check that the off-card entity at the origin of the lock/unlock request is authenticated as the Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication). On receipt of a request to lock the card, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity has the required Card Lock privilege; * Check that the current card Life Cycle State is SECURED; * Set the card Life Cycle State to CARD_LOCKED. On receipt of a request to unlock the card, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity has the required Card Lock privilege; * Reverse the card Life Cycle State to SECURED. Applications that are currently selected on any logical channel shall remain the currently selected Applications on their respective logical channels until the end of their respective Application Sessions. As soon as the current Application Session on a Supplementary Logical Channel ends, the logical channel on which the Application was selected is closed. Once all the Supplementary Logical Channels are closed the Basic Logical Channel becomes the March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 101 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. only available interface. As soon as the current Application Session on the Basic Logical Channel ends, the Application with the Final Application privilege is the only selectable Application. Attempts to modify Card Content are denied from the instant the card transitions to the CARD_LOCKED Life Cycle State. 9.6.4 Card Termination In the card Life Cycle State TERMINATED, all communication to the card are directed to the application with the Final Application privilege. If the Issuer Security Domain is the application with this privilege all commands except the GET DATA command processed by the Issuer Security Domain shall be disabled. Due to the severity of this action, the card termination shall only be allowed under the most stringent conditions and shall only be performed with the proper security mechanisms and authorizations. The decision to terminate a card may either be triggered by an internal card event that violates a policy of the Card Issuer or may be invoked externally: Internal source-- either the OPEN, the Issuer Security Domain, or a privileged Application may initiate a card termination request from within the card. An internal card termination request is likely to occur in response to certain card runtime situations. Off-card source-- explicit card termination requests can be initiated by APDU commands sent by the Card Issuer to the Issuer Security Domain or by an authorized representative to an Application with the Card Terminate privilege. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a SET STATUS command, the Security Domain performing the lifecycle management shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Check that the off-card entity at the origin of the termination request is authenticated as the Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication). On receipt of a request to terminate the card, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity has the Card Terminate privilege; * Set the card Life Cycle State to TERMINATED from its current state. Applications that are currently selected on any logical channel shall remain the currently selected Applications on their respective logical channels until the end of their respective Application Sessions. As soon as the current Application Session on a Supplementary Logical Channel ends, the logical channel on which the Application was selected is closed. Once all the Supplementary Logical Channels are closed the Basic Logical Channel becomes the only available interface. As soon as the current Application Session on the Basic Logical Channel ends, no Applications are selectable, the Application with Final Application privilege is always implicitly selected on the Basic Logical Channel. As the transition to the TERMINATED Life Cycle State can be due to the detection of a severe security threat, the security policy of the Issuer may require additional behavior such as closing the current Card Session by performing an internal card reset. Card Content management requests are denied from the instant the card transitions to the TERMINATED Life Cycle State. Depending on the security policy of the Issuer, other operations may be allowed to continue during the remaining current Application Sessions. 102 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9.6.5 Application Status Interrogation The status of an Application (or a Security Domain): its Life Cycle State, Privileges and other parameters registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry, may be accessed by suitably authorized entities. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a GET STATUS command, the Security Domain performing the lifecycle interrogation shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Check that the off-card entity at the origin of the request is authenticated as the Application Provider of the interrogated Application or as the Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication). On receipt of a request to interrogate the status of an Application, the OPEN shall: * Check that the requesting on-card entity is the entity itself being interrogated, a Security Domain directly or indirectly associated with the Application being interrogated, or that the requesting entity has the Global Registry privilege 9.6.6 Card Status Interrogation The status of the card and the Issuer Security Domain: its AID, Privileges and other parameters registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry, may be accessed by suitably authorized entities. Runtime Behavior On receipt of a GET STATUS command, the Security Domain performing the lifecycle interrogation shall: * Apply its own secure communication policy; * Check that the off-card entity at the origin of the request is authenticated as the Security Domain Provider (see section 10.4 - Entity Authentication). On receipt of a request to interrogate the card Life Cycle State, the OPEN shall respond. 9.6.7 Operational Velocity Checking The OPEN shall be implemented with a velocity checking security mechanism. For the purpose of this document, "velocity checking" is defined as the active monitoring, handling and management of security sensitive activities on the card. These activities may include, but are not limited to the following: * Content installation; * Card exceptions; * Application exceptions. Typically, velocity checking is used to counter security attacks that use repeated attempts in their schemes. These attempts can be from internal (on-card) or external (off-card) entities. Velocity checking is implemented to track the number of consecutive failures in each of the related management and security events. 9.6.7.1 Content Loading and Installation The OPEN may keep track of the number of unsuccessful consecutive attempts of the Card Content load and installation process by a particular Application and the total number of such attempts by all Applications. Actions may include such defensive measures as the locking or termination of the card. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 103 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 9.6.7.2 Exceptions Velocity checking may be implemented in cases in which the OPEN generates exceptions. However, it does not have to be implemented such that each individual exception is handled separately. A trace buffer and event log may be used to complement velocity checking. For example, an implementation of a Security Domain may enable velocity checking to enforce strict APDU command sequencing for card and application management operations (e.g., Card Content loading and installation). The OPEN may also enable velocity checking against repeated failed attempts by an Application to allocate additional memory beyond its allowed limit that is stored in the GlobalPlatform Registry. The OPEN may choose to lock an Application that is exhibiting such behavior. 9.6.8 Tracing and Event Logging Tracing and event logging functions may be enabled. These functions shall be implemented according to a Card Issuer's policy requirements. 9.7 Memory Resource Management Memory resource management is an optional feature of a GlobalPlatform card. It consists of the management by OPEN of counters associated with Executable Load Files or Applications regarding their individual allocation of memory resources, as defined in this specification. It applies to both persistent and volatile memory. Memory resource management data elements describe memory usage requirements applicable to each type of memory: volatile or persistent; and for each type of storage: code or data. Memory requirements may be defined for each Executable Load File and Application at the time of their load and installation. The OPEN, in conjunction with the Runtime Environment, is responsible for managing the memory resources of the card; including the security requirements defined in section 4.2.4.1 - Runtime Environment Security Requirements. A memory resource management data element indicates an amount of memory resources in bytes. In the INSTALL [for load] command, the System Parameters may include memory requirements specifying for each type of memory a Minimum Memory, or Reserved Memory, or both data elements. In the INSTALL [for install] command, the System Parameters may include memory requirements specifying for each type of memory a Memory Quota, or Reserved Memory, or both. When memory resource management is supported, the OPEN shall assign, if currently available, each type of memory resources as described in the corresponding memory resource management data element. Memory resources shall be assigned according to the following rules: * Assigning Minimum Memory to an Executable Load File (and its subsequent Application instance) shall not reduce the memory resources currently available on the card; * Assigning Memory Quota to an Application shall not reduce the memory resources currently available on the card; * The value of Memory Quota assigned to an Application shall not be less than the value of its Reserved Memory; * Assigning Reserved Memory to an Executable Load File / Application shall reduce the memory resources currently available on the card at the time of its successful load / installation. When memory resource management is supported, the OPEN shall manage available memory resources for each type of memory according to the following rules: * At the time of the loaďs request (INSTALL [for load] command), the Minimum Memory requirements shall be currently available on the card; 104 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * At the time of the successful load of an Executable Load File (last LOAD command), the amount of memory effectively allocated to that Executable Load File shall be charged against the Reserved Memory of that Executable Load File. If no Reserved Memory was assigned to that Executable Load File, the amount of memory shall reduce the memory resources currently available on the card; * At the time of the installation of an Application (INSTALL [for install] command), the amount of memory effectively allocated to that Application shall first be charged against the Reserved Memory of that Application until it is entirely exhausted. When the Reserved Memory (if any) is exhausted, the amount of allocated memory shall be charged against that Application's Memory Quota and shall reduce the memory resources currently available on the card. When either the Memory Quota is exceeded or the memory resources currently available on the card are exhausted, the installation of the Application shall fail; * The successful removal of an Executable Load File / Application (DELETE command) shall augment the memory resources available on the card by the amount of memory effectively released and any unused part of the Reserved Memory (if any) of that Executable Load File / Application; * The amount of memory effectively allocated to the creation of data shall first be charged against the Reserved Memory of that Application, until it is entirely exhausted. When the Reserved Memory (if any) is exhausted, the amount of allocated memory shall be charged against that Application's Memory Quota and shall reduce the memory resources currently available on the card. When either the Memory Quota is exceeded or the memory resources currently available on the card are exhausted, the resource allocation shall fail; * The results of reporting memory resources are implementation dependent; * The amount of memory effectively released by the deletion of data shall be reallocated to the Reserved Memory and Memory Quota assigned to that Application. If no Reserved Memory was assigned to that Application, the amount of released memory shall augment the memory resources available on the card. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 105 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 10Secure Communication The GlobalPlatform documentation broadly defines the notion of secure communication over and above that defined in ISO standards. Specific mention is made of secure messaging for APDU commands; an optional authentication process is implied in most of the flow diagrams and Application access to Security Domain services implies that the ability to create a Secure Channel Session exists. This chapter defines the general rules that apply to all Secure Channel Protocols. Applications that utilize the services of Security Domains can use the Secure Channel Protocol supported by their associated Security Domains. These protocols provide a means by which a Security Domain or an Application may communicate with an off-card entity within a logically secure environment. Logical channels facilitate the possibility of more than one of the above off-card entities communicating concurrently with multiple Applications on the card, each within its own logically secure environment. It is the responsibility of the Security Domain provider to define whether this is possible or not. 10.1Secure Channel The Secure Channel provides a secure communication channel between a card and an off-card entity during an Application Session. A Secure Channel Session is divided into three sequential phases: * Secure Channel Initiation ­ when the on-card Application and the off-card entity have exchanged sufficient information enabling them to perform the required cryptographic functions. The Secure Channel Session initiation always includes the authentication of the off-card entity by the on-card Application; * Secure Channel Operation ­ when the on-card Application and the off-card entity exchange data within the cryptographic protection of the Secure Channel Session. The Secure Channel services offered may vary from one Secure Channel Protocol to the other; * Secure Channel Termination ­ when either the on-card Application or the off-card entity determines that no further communication is required or allowed via an established Secure Channel Session. The 3 levels of security provided by the Secure Channel are defined in section 4.3.2 - Secure Communication. A further level of security applies to sensitive data (e.g. secret keys) that shall always be transmitted as confidential data. 10.2Explicit / Implicit Secure Channel A Secure Channel Session is open after a successful initiation, including the authentication of the off-card entity by the on-card Application. A Secure Channel Session is terminated after the last successful communication within the same Secure Channel Session. 10.2.1 Explicit Secure Channel Initiation Initiating a Secure Channel Session may be achieved by the off-card entity using appropriate APDU command(s) or by the on-card Application using the appropriate API. This method is the explicit Secure Channel creation. Appropriate APDU commands allow the off-card entity to instruct the card what level of security is required for the current Secure Channel Session (integrity and/or confidentiality). They also give the off-card entity the possibility of selecting the keys to be used. 106 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 10.2.2 Implicit Secure Channel Initiation The Secure Channel Session is initiated by the on-card Secure Channel Protocol handler, directly or through an API, when receiving the first APDU command that contains a cryptographic protection. The Secure Channel Protocol handler implicitly knows the required level of security. The Secure Channel Protocol handler may implicitly know which keys are to be used or may have been previously instructed by the off-card entity using appropriate APDU command(s) prior to initiating the Secure Channel Session. 10.2.3 Secure Channel Termination Termination of the Secure Channel Session can be achieved by the on-card Application using the appropriate API or by the off-card entity using the appropriate APDU command. Secure Channel termination causes all session data to be reset and all ICVs and session keys to be erased. The Current Security Level is set to NO_SECURITY and the Session Security Level is reset. Termination of the Secure Channel Session occurs when one of the following conditions is met: * The on-card Application Session is terminated - for instance when another Application is selected (i.e. the Application Session ends) on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface. It may be the responsibility of the Application to initiate the termination of the Secure Channel Session when this occurs; * The associated logical channel is explicitly closed; * The card is reset (see ISO/IEC 7816-3 for contact cards), deactivated (see ISO/IEC 14443-3 for contactless cards) or powered off: i.e. the Card Session ends. A Secure Channel Session is aborted but not terminated in the following cases: * The on-card Application receives the first APDU command with an erroneous cryptographic protection; * The on-card Application receives an APDU command without the required cryptographic protection set up during Secure Channel Session initiation; If a Secure Channel Session is aborted, the Current Security Level is set to NO_SECURITY, the Session Security Level is not reset and the error condition persists until the Secure Channel Session is terminated. A Secure Channel Session on a logical channel is never terminated in favor of a new Secure Channel Session being initiated on another logical channel. 10.3Direct / Indirect Handling of a Secure Channel Protocol There are two ways for the on-card Application to handle the Secure Channel Protocol. * Direct - The Application owns its Secure Channel key set and fully implements the protocol: an example is Security Domains. * Indirect ­ The Application uses the Security Domain services to handle the Secure Channel Protocol. This allows the Application using these services to be coded independently from the Secure Channel Protocol supported by the card. 10.4Entity Authentication Off-card entity authentication is achieved through the process of initiating a Secure Channel Session and provides assurance to the card that it is communicating with an authenticated entity. If any step in the authentication process fails, the process shall be restarted. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 107 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Authentication of the off-card entity is only provided for a limited time, a Secure Channel Session, and is valid only for the messages within that Secure Channel. This Secure Channel Session relates to the establishment and termination of a Secure Channel. If the Secure Channel Session is closed for any reason the off-card entity shall no longer be considered authenticated. 10.4.1 Authentication with symmetric cryptography With a symmetric key Secure Channel Protocol (e.g. SCP01 or SCP02), an authenticated off-card entity is the entity which knows the secret Secure Channel keys needed to initiate a Secure Channel Session. The card cannot distinguish between the actual Application Provider of the Security Domain and one of its agents to whom a (set of) secret Secure Channel key(s) was provided. In this case, the card cannot distinguish between the Security Domain's provider and the provider of one of its associated Applications. Both are assumed to be the same entity: the Application Provider. The Application is informed whether that unique entity, the Application Provider, has been successfully authenticated or not by examining the AUTHENTICATED indicator of the Current Security Level (see section 10.6 - Security Levels). 10.4.2 Authentication with asymmetric cryptography With an asymmetric key Secure Channel Protocol (e.g. SCP10), any off-card entity that owns a pair of asymmetric keys and obtained a certificate for its public key certified by an authority recognized by the Security Domain can be successfully authenticated by that Security Domain. An authenticated off-card entity is the subject identified in the off-card entity's public key certificate verified during the Secure Channel Initiation. The card can distinguish between the actual Application Provider of the Security Domain and any other off-card entity using the off-card entity public key certificate's subject identifier. In this case, the card can distinguish between the Security Domain's provider, the provider of one of its associated Applications, and any other off-card entity. The three are not necessarily the same entity: the Application Provider Id of each on-card entity is registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry at the time of the load or installation of that oncard entity and cannot be changed subsequently. The Application is informed whether its own Application Provider has been authenticated by examining the AUTHENTICATED indicator of the Current Security Level (see section 10.6 - Security Levels). The ANY_AUTHENTICATED indicator of the Current Security Level indicates if another off-card entity, including the Security Domain's provider, has been authenticated or if the Application Provider Id is not registered. The Current Security Level viewed by the Target Application may differ from the Security Domain's view depending on the Secure Channel Protocol and the authenticated off-card entity's Application Provider Id (e.g. ANY_AUTHENTICATED for the Target Application and AUTHENTICATED for the Security Domain). 10.5Secure Messaging Secure messaging allows a sending entity to add confidentiality and/or integrity and authentication to the composition of an APDU message prior to the message being transmitted to a receiving entity: * Integrity of an APDU command sent to the card or confidentiality of the command message and integrity of an APDU command sent to the card; * Integrity of the sequence of APDU commands sent to the card within a Secure Channel Session; * Optionally, depending on the Secure Channel Protocol, confidentiality and/or integrity of an APDU response message sent by the card, and integrity of the sequence of responses within a Secure Channel Session. In the context of secure messaging, message integrity also provides data origin authentication. 108 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 10.6Security Levels A Secure Channel Protocol operates according to the Security Level that is established. This is done at two levels: * A mandatory minimum Session Security Level is set at the initialization of the Secure Channel Session either explicitly or implicitly; * A different Current Security Level may be set for an individual command or an individual response. These Security Levels establish the minimum acceptable secure messaging protection that must be applied to protected messages, either for the whole session or for a specific command-response pair. The following table shows the coding of Current Security Level: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 1 0 - - - - - - AUTHENTICATED 0 1 - - - - - - ANY_AUTHENTICATED - - - - - - 1 - C_DECRYPTION - - - - - - - 1 C_MAC - - 1 - - - - - R_ENCRYPTION - - - 1 - - - - R_MAC - - - - X X - - RFU 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 NO_SECURITY_LEVEL Table 10-1: Current Security Level Note that the Current Security Level cannot have its AUTHENTICATED and ANY_AUTHENTICATED indicators set simultaneously. The rules for how Security Levels are handled are defined individually for Secure Channel Protocols '01', '02' and '10': see Appendices D, E and F for details. 10.7Secure Channel Protocol Identifier The Secure Channel Protocol identifies which particular secure communication protocol and set of security services are implemented in a Security Domain. The following values are assigned to the Secure Channel Protocol identifier: * '00' ­ Not available * '01' to '7F' - Reserved for use by GlobalPlatform - '01' ­ deprecated Secure Channel Protocol 1 defined in appendix D; - '02' ­ Secure Channel Protocol 2 defined in appendix E; - '10' - Secure Channel Protocol '10' defined in appendix F. * '80' to 'EF' ­ Reserved for use by individual schemes registered by GlobalPlatform - '80' - Secure Channel Protocol '80' defined in ETSI TS 102 225 and 102 226. * 'F0' to 'FF' ­ Reserved for proprietary use and not registered by GlobalPlatform The deprecated symmetric key Secure Channel Protocol '01' is backward compatible with the Open Platform Card Specification version 2.0.1'; it is deprecated in this version of the Specification. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 109 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The symmetric key Secure Channel Protocol '02' includes services in addition to those provided by Secure Channel Protocol '01' as well as optimizing the operation of some services compared to the deprecated Secure Channel Protocol '01'. The Secure Channel Protocol '80' supports the Over The Air security scheme defined in ETSI TS 102 225. The asymmetric key Secure Channel Protocol '10' offers authentication services using a Public Key Infrastructure (PKI) and secure messaging protection of commands and responses using symmetric cryptography. 110 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Part IV APDU Command Reference March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 111 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11APDU Command Reference This chapter details the GlobalPlatform APDU commands that may be implemented. The commands are listed alphabetically. The following table summarizes the APDU commands that shall be supported by a Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege, a Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege, a Security Domain with Final Application privilege and the requirements for support of these APDU commands by other Security Domains. When logical channels are supported, the MANAGE CHANNEL command is only processed by the OPEN and no Security Domain support is required for this command. Command OP_READY INITIALIZED SECURED CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD FA SD SD FA SD SD DELETE Executable Load File DELETE Executable Load File and related Application(s) DELETE Application DELETE Key GET DATA GET STATUS INSTALL [for load] INSTALL [for install] INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] INSTALL [for install and make selectable] INSTALL [for make selectable] INSTALL [for extradition] INSTALL [for registry update] 112 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Command OP_READY INITIALIZED SECURED CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD FA SD SD FA SD SD INSTALL [for personalization] LOAD PUT KEY SELECT SET STATUS STORE DATA Table 11-1: Authorized GlobalPlatform Commands per Card Life Cycle State Legend of Table 11-1: AM SD: Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege. DM SD: Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege. FA SD: Security Domain with Final Application privilege. (Note: command support for an Application with Final Application Privilege which is not a Security Domain is subject to Issuer policy, within the constraints of what is permitted according to the card Life Cycle State.) SD: Other Security Domain. : Support required. Blank cell: Support optional. Striped cell: Support prohibited. Table 11-2 summarizes the minimum security requirements for the APDU commands. Command Minimum Security DELETE Secure Channel initiation or digital signature verification GET DATA None GET STATUS Secure Channel initiation INSTALL Secure Channel initiation or digital signature verification LOAD Secure Channel initiation or digital signature verification MANAGE CHANNEL Not applicable PUT KEY Secure Channel initiation SELECT Not applicable SET STATUS Secure Channel initiation STORE DATA Secure Channel initiation Table 11-2: Minimum Security Requirements for GlobalPlatform Commands 11.1General Coding Rules The use of 'RFU' and '-' (dash) in tables in this chapter is as defined in Table 1-3: Abbreviations and Notations. If a bit is shown as RFU the bit should be set to zero by the off-card entity and the card shall ignore the value. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 113 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.1.1 Life Cycle State Coding The Executable Load File Life Cycle is coded on one byte as described in the following table: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 B2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 LOADED Table 11-3: Executable Load File Life Cycle Coding The Application Life Cycle has a bit-oriented coded value on one byte as described in the following table. Note: the application has free use of bits b4-b7, and the coding of these bits is beyond the scope of this specification. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 INSTALLED 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 SELECTABLE 0 X X X X 1 1 1 Application Specific State 1 - - - - - 1 1 LOCKED Table 11-4: Application Life Cycle Coding The Security Domain Life Cycle has a bit-oriented coded value on one byte as described in the following table: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 INSTALLED 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 SELECTABLE 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 PERSONALIZED 1 0 0 0 - - 1 1 LOCKED Table 11-5: Security Domain Life Cycle Coding The allowed Application and Security Domain Life Cycle transitions are described in chapter 5 - Life Cycle Models. The Issuer Security Domain inherits the card Life Cycle State that has a bit-oriented coded value on one byte as described in the following table: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 OP_READY 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 INITIALIZED 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 SECURED 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CARD_LOCKED 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 TERMINATED Table 11-6: Card Life Cycle Coding The allowed card Life Cycle transitions are described in chapter 5 - Life Cycle Models. 11.1.2 Privileges Coding Privileges are coded on three bytes as described in Table 11-7 and Table 11-8 (See section 6.6 - Privileges for additional details): 114 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning Privilege Number 1 - - - - - - - Security Domain 0 1 1 - - - - - 0 DAP Verification 1 1 - 1 - - - - - Delegated Management 2 - - - 1 - - - - Card Lock 3 - - - - 1 - - - Card Terminate 4 - - - - - 1 - - Card Reset 5 - - - - - - 1 - CVM Management 6 1 1 - - - - - 1 Mandated DAP Verification 7 Table 11-7: Privileges (byte 1) b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning Privilege Number 1 - - - - - - - Trusted Path 8 - 1 - - - - - - Authorized Management 9 - - 1 - - - - - Token Management 10 - - - 1 - - - - Global Delete 11 - - - - 1 - - - Global Lock 12 - - - - - 1 - - Global Registry 13 - - - - - - 1 - Final Application 14 - - - - - - - 1 Global Service 15 Table 11-8: Privileges (byte 2) b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning Privilege Number 1 - - - - - - - Receipt Generation 16 - X X X X X X X RFU Table 11-9: Privileges (byte 3) 11.1.3 General Error Conditions The following table describes the error conditions that may be returned by any command: SW1 SW2 Meaning '64' '00' No specific diagnosis '67' '00' Wrong length in Lc '68' '81' Logical channel not supported or is not active '69' '82' Security status not satisfied '69' '85' Conditions of use not satisfied '6A' '86' Incorrect P1 P2 '6Ď '00' Invalid instruction March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 115 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SW1 SW2 Meaning '6E' '00' Invalid class Table 11-10: General Error Conditions 11.1.4 Class Byte Coding The class byte of all commands shall conform to ISO/IEC 7816-4 and shall be coded according to section 11.1.4.1 for commands addressed to the Basic Logical Channel and Supplementary Logical Channels 1, 2 and 3. For cards implementing four or more Supplementary Logical Channels the class byte of all commands addressed to Supplementary Logical Channel four to nineteen shall be coded according to section 11.1.4.2. 11.1.4.1 First Interindustry Class Byte Coding The following table describes the first interindustry class byte coding: b8 b7 b6 b5(*) b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 - - - - Command defined in ISO/IEC 7816 1 0 0 0 - - - - GlobalPlatform command - 0 0 0 0 0 - - No secure messaging - 0 0 0 0 1 - - Secure messaging - GlobalPlatform proprietary - 0 0 0 1 0 - - Secure messaging - ISO/IEC 7816 standard, command header not processed (no C-MAC) - 0 0 0 1 1 - - Secure messaging - ISO/IEC 7816 standard, command header authenticated (C-MAC) - 0 0 0 - - X X Logical channel number Table 11-11: CLA Byte Coding Class byte bits b1 and b2 may be set to define the required logical channel number according to ISO/IEC 7816; * A class byte with bits b1 and b2 set to 00 indicates receipt of the command on the Basic Logical Channel; * A class byte with bits b1 and b2 set to 01 (1), 10 (2) or 11 (3) indicates receipt of the command on a Supplementary Logical Channel. Class byte bits b4 and b3 may be set to define the required secure messaging according to ISO/IEC 7816-4: * A class byte with bits b4 and b3 set to 00 indicates no secure messaging; * A class byte with bits b4 and b3 set to 01 indicates secure messaging with GlobalPlatform format; * A class byte with bits b4 and b3 set to 11 or 10 indicates secure messaging with ISO/IEC 7816-4 format. (*) Note: class byte bit b5 is always 0 except if it is coded for command chaining as defined in appendix F. 11.1.4.2 Further Interindustry Class Byte Coding The following table describes the further interindustry class byte coding. b8 b7 b6 b5(*) b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 1 - 0 - - - - Command defined in ISO/IEC 7816 1 1 - 0 - - - - GlobalPlatform command 116 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b8 b7 b6 b5(*) b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning - 1 0 0 - - - - No secure messaging - 1 1 0 - - - - Secure messaging - ISO/IEC 7816 or GlobalPlatform proprietary - 1 - 0 X X X X Logical channel number Table 11-12: CLA Byte Coding Class byte bits b1 to b4 may be set to define the required logical channel number according to ISO/IEC 7816; * A class byte with bit b7 set to 1 indicates in bits b4 to b1 (values 0000 to 1111) receipt of the command on Supplementary Logical Channel 4 to 19. Class byte bit b6 may be set to define the required secure messaging according to ISO/IEC 7816-4 or proprietary GlobalPlatform format: * A class byte with bit b6 set to 0 indicates no secure messaging; * A class byte with bit b6 set to 1 indicates secure messaging with GlobalPlatform format or with ISO/IEC 7816-4 format. 11.1.5 APDU Message and Data Length All GlobalPlatform APDU messages and data elements are counted in bytes. All GlobalPlatform commands comply with ISO/IEC 7816 short message lengths i.e. Lc and Le bytes coded on one byte. All GlobalPlatform command messages (including the APDU header) are limited to 255 bytes in length. All GlobalPlatform commands that expect response data have their Le byte set to zero, indicating that all available response data shall be returned. According to ISO/IEC 7816-4, all GlobalPlatform responses returned in APDU response messages shall have a maximum length of 256 bytes of response data. All length fields of GlobalPlatform messages and data objects defined in this specification, except for Lc and Le, are coded as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1): 1 byte for a length up to 127, 2 bytes for a length up to 255, and 3 bytes for a length up to 65535, except where otherwise stated. This version of the Specification is written as though most command functions can be handled with a single APDU command and response pair. This is done in order to simplify the description, and is not intended to preclude the use of multiple commands being used where such a mechanism is provided, as indicated for each command: such as (for GlobalPlatform commands) the 'more commands' bit in the P1 byte and status bytes controlling the return of additional data; and (for ISO commands) command and response chaining. 11.1.6 Confirmations in Response Messages The confirmation shall be structured according to the following table: Length Data Element Presence 1-2 Length of Receipt ('00' - '7F' or '81 80' - '81 FF') Mandatory 0-n Receipt Conditional 5-n Confirmation Data Mandatory Table 11-13: Confirmation Structure The length field for the Receipt is coded according to ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1). Confirmation Data is structured according to the following table: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 117 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Length Data Element Presence 1 Length of Confirmation Counter Mandatory 2 Confirmation Counter Mandatory 1 Length of Card Unique Data Mandatory 1-n Card Unique Data Mandatory 1 Length of Token identifier Optional 0-n Token identifier Optional 1 Length of Token Data digest Conditional 0-n Token Data digest Optional Table 11-14: Confirmation Data If Length of Token identifier is present, Length of Token Data digest shall also be present. The presence of Token identifier depends on whether a Token identifier was included in the original Token. Card Unique Data is the concatenation without delimiters of the IIN and the CIN. 11.1.7 Implicit Selection Parameter Coding The Implicit Selection parameter (tag 'CF') indicates that this Application is to be implicitly selected on one (or more) specific card interface(s) for one (or more) specific logical channel(s), see section 6.6.3 - Privilege Management. Setting both bits 8 and 7 to zero indicates that this Application is to be selectable only explicitly with a SELECT [by name] command and the logical channel number shall be ignored by the card. The value field is coded on one byte as follows: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 1 - - - - - - - Contactless I/O - 1 - - - - - - Contact I/O - - X - - - - - RFU - - - X X X X X Logical channel number (0 to 19) Table 11-15: Implicit Selection Parameter 11.1.8 Key Type Coding Key type may be coded on one or two bytes. When coded on two bytes, the first byte shall be set to 'FF' to indicate an extended format of the key data field. The second or only byte shall be coded according to the following table: Value Meaning '00'-'7F' Reserved for private use '80' DES ­ mode (ECB/CBC) implicitly known '81' Reserved (Triple DES) '82' Triple DES in CBC mode '83' DES in ECB mode '84' DES in CBC mode '85'-'87' RFU (symmetric algorithms) '88' AES (16, 24, or 32 long keys) '89'-'8F' RFU (symmetric algorithms) '90' HMAC-SHA1 ­ length of HMAC is implicitly known 118 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Value Meaning '91' HMAC-SHA1-160 ­ length of HMAC is 160 bits '92'-'9F' RFU (symmetric algorithms) 'A0' RSA Public Key - public exponent e component (clear text) 'A1' RSA Public Key - modulus N component (clear text) 'A2' RSA Private Key - modulus N component 'A3' RSA Private Key - private exponent d component 'A4' RSA Private Key - Chinese Remainder P component 'A5' RSA Private Key - Chinese Remainder Q component 'A6' RSA Private Key - Chinese Remainder PQ component ( q-1 mod p ) 'A7' RSA Private Key - Chinese Remainder DP1 component ( d mod (p-1) ) 'A8' RSA Private Key - Chinese Remainder DQ1 component ( d mod (q-1) ) 'A9'-'FE' RFU (asymmetric algorithms) 'FF' Extended format Table 11-16: Key Type Coding 11.1.9 Key Usage Coding The values for the Key usage parameter are set according to the following table: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 1 - - - - - - - Verification (DST, CCT, CAT), Encipherment (CT) - 1 - - - - - - Computation (DST, CCT, CAT), Decipherment (CT) - - 1 - - - - - Secure messaging in response data fields (CT, CCT) - - - 1 - - - - Secure messaging in command data fields (CT, CCT) - - - - 1 - - - Confidentiality (CT) - - - - - 1 - - Cryptographic Checksum (CCT) - - - - - 1 - Digital Signature (DST) - - - - - - - 1 Cryptographic Authorization (CAT) Table 11-17: Key Usage The following values are used by GlobalPlatform. Values are independent of the cryptographic algorithm used. * C-MAC = '14', R-MAC = '24', C-MAC + R-MAC = '34'; * C-ENC = '18', R-ENC = '28', C-ENC + R-ENC = '38'; * C-DEK = '48', R-DEK = '88', C-DEK + R-DEK = 'C8'; * PK_SD_AUT = '82'; * SK_SD_AUT = '42'; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 119 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Token = '81'; * Receipt = '44'; * DAP = '84'; * PK_SD_AUT + Token = '83'; * SK_SD_AUT + Receipt = '43'; * PK_SD_AUT + DAP = '86'; * PK_SD_AUT + Token + DAP = '87'. 11.1.10 Key Access Coding The values for the Key Access parameter are set according to the following table (see appendix 7.5.2 - Key Access Conditions for details): Value Description `00' The key may be used by the Security Domain and any associated Application `01' The key may only be used by the Security Domain `02' The key may be used by any Application associated with the Security Domain but not by the Security Domain itself `03'- '1F' RFU `20'- `FE' Proprietary usage `FF' Not available Table 11-18: Key Access 11.1.11 Tag Coding All tags of GlobalPlatform data objects are coded as defined by ASN.1 BER-TLV rules (see ISO 8825-1). For Security Domain data objects present in GlobalPlatform APDU messages, BER-TLV tags are coded according to the following rules: * '00' to '7E' ­ Reserved for use by ISO/IEC; * '80' to '9E' and 'A0' to 'BE' ­ Reserved for use depending on the context (see note); * 'C0' to 'DĎ and 'E0' to 'FĎ ­ Reserved for use by GlobalPlatform or individual schemes registered by GlobalPlatform; - 'CA' and 'EA' ­ Reserved for use by ETSI TS 102 226 specification; * 'DE' and 'FE' ­ Reserved for proprietary use and not registered by GlobalPlatform; * '1F 1F' to '7F 7F' ­ Reserved for use by ISO/IEC; * '9F 1F' to '9F 7F' and 'BF 1F' to 'BF 7F' ­ Reserved for use depending on the context (see note); 120 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * 'DF 1F' to 'DF 7F' and 'FF 1F' to 'FF 7F' ­ Reserved for use by GlobalPlatform or individual schemes registered by GlobalPlatform; - 'FF 1F' to 'FF 3F' ­ Reserved for use by ETSI TS 102 226 specification. Note: Context dependant tags are assigned by the authority defining the context, e.g. ISO/IEC for data objects embedded in other ISO/IEC data objects or GlobalPlatform for data objects embedded in other GlobalPlatform data objects. Tag allocation for any data objects embedded in the constructed tag 'FE' (reserved for proprietary use) is beyond the scope of this specification. Applying BER-TLV rules in this case is recommended. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 121 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.2DELETE Command 11.2.1 Definition and Scope The DELETE command is used to delete a uniquely identifiable object such as an Executable Load File, an Application, an Executable Load File and its related Applications or a key. In order to delete an object, the object shall be uniquely identifiable by the selected Application. 11.2.2 Command Message The DELETE command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'E4' DELETE P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xxxx...' TLV coded objects (and MAC if present) Le '00' Table 11-19: DELETE Command Message 11.2.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 allows for command data to be longer than 255 bytes and to be segmented into components of arbitrary size and transmitted in a series of DELETE commands. P1 indicates whether the command data is one of a sequence of components or the last (or only) component. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - Last (or only) command 1 - - - - - - - More DELETE commands - X X X X X X X RFU Table 11-20: DELETE Reference Control Parameter P1 11.2.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 indicates whether the object in the data field is being deleted or whether the object in the data field and its related objects are being deleted. It shall be coded according to the following table: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - Delete object 1 - - - - - - - Delete object and related object 122 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning - X X X X X X X RFU Table 11-21: DELETE Reference Control Parameter P2 11.2.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the DELETE command message shall contain the TLV coded name(s) of the object to be deleted. 11.2.2.3.1 Delete [card content] Data Field The Application or Executable Load File AID may be followed by a Control Reference Template for Digital Signature and a Delete Token, as follows: Tag Length Name Presence '4F' 5-16 Executable Load File or Application AID Mandatory 'B6' Variable Control Reference Template for Digital Signature Conditional '42' 1-n Token Issuer Id Optional '45' 1-n Card Image Number Optional '5F20' 1-n Application Provider identifier Optional '93' 1-n Token identifier/number (digital signature counter) Conditional '9E' 1-n Delete Token Conditional Table 11-22: Delete [card content] Command Data Field The identity of the Application or Executable Load File to delete shall be specified using the tag for an AID ('4F') followed by a length and the AID of the Application or Executable Load File. When simultaneously deleting an Executable Load File and all its related Applications, only the identity of the Executable Load File shall be provided. The presence of the Control Reference Template for Digital Signature and Delete Token depends on the Card Issuer's policy. The presence of the data objects in tag 'B6' and the sub-tags `42', `45', `5F20' and `93' are strongly recommended when using SCP10. The length fields for the Control Reference Template for Digital Signature and the Delete Token are coded according to ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1). 11.2.2.3.2 Delete (Key) Data Field To delete one or more keys, the Key Version Number and/or the Key Identifier are included in the command data field as follows: Tag Length Meaning Presence 'D0' 1 Key Identifier Conditional 'D2' 1 Key Version Number Conditional Table 11-23: DELETE [key] Command Data Field A single key is deleted when both the Key Identifier ('D0') and the Key Version Number ('D2') are provided in the DELETE command message data field. Multiple keys may be deleted if one of these values is omitted (i.e. all keys with the specified Key Identifier or Key Version Number). The options available for omitting these values are conditional on the Issuer's policy. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 123 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.2.3 Response Message A data field shall always be returned in the response message. The content of the data field is only relevant in the case of Delegated Management i.e. if a Security Domain with the Delegated Management privilege is deleting an Application or Executable Load File, a Receipt may be present in the data field depending on the security policy of the Card Issuer. 11.2.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message For a DELETE [key] command, a single byte of '00' shall be returned indicating that no additional data is present. For a DELETE [card content] command being issued to a Security Domain with the Delegated Management privilege, the data field may contain the confirmation of the delete procedure. The overall length of the response message shall not exceed 256 bytes. The following table describes the structure of the DELETE response data field. The length field for the Delete Confirmation is coded according to ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1). Name Length Value Presence Length of delete confirmation 1-2 '00' - '7F' or '81 80' - '81 FF' Mandatory Delete confirmation 0-n 'xxxx...' - see section 11.1.6 Conditional Table 11-24: DELETE Response Data Field 11.2.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '65' '81' Memory failure '6A' '88' Referenced data not found '6A' '82' Application not found '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data Table 11-25: DELETE Error Conditions 124 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.3GET DATA Command 11.3.1 Definition and Scope The GET DATA command is used to retrieve either a single data object, which may be constructed, or a set of data objects. Reference control parameters P1 and P2 coding is used to define the specific data object tag. The data object may contain information pertaining to a key. 11.3.2 Command Message The GET DATA command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F', '60' - '6F', '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'CA' or 'CB' GET DATA - If CLA = '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F', '60' - '6F', even or odd instruction code 'CA' or 'CB'; - If CLA = '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF', even instruction code 'CA'. P1 'xx' '00' or high order tag value P2 'xx' Low order tag value Lc 'xx' Not present if no command data, or length of data field. Data 'xxxx...' Tag list and/or MAC if present. Le '00' Table 11-26: GET DATA Command Message According to ISO/IEC 7816-4, the odd instruction code `CB' in conjunction with a class byte indicating an ISO command (CLA set to '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F' or '60' - '6F') is used to retrieve the contents of a file. It may be used to retrieve the list of Applications on the card (P1-P2 set to `2F 00'). 11.3.2.1 Parameter P1 and P2 Parameters P1 and P2 define the tag of the data object to be read. The value '2F 00' indicates a request to obtain details of Applications on the card, as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. The instruction code shall be set to 'CA' if the class byte indicates a GlobalPlatform command (CLA set to '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF') or 'CB' if the class byte indicates an ISO command (CLA set to '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F' or '60' - '6F'). Security Domains shall support at least the following data object tags: * Tag '42': Issuer Identification Number (or Security Domain Provider Identification Number); * Tag '45': Card Image Number (or Security Domain Image Number); * Tag '66': Card Data (or Security Domain Management Data); March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 125 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Tag 'E0': Key Information Template. A Security Domain may support the following data object tags: * Tag 'D3': Current Security Level; * Tag `2F00': List of Applications belonging to the Security Domain, or every application on the card if the Security Domain has Global Registry Privilege; * Tag `FF21': Extended Card Resources Information available for Card Content Management, as defined in ETSI TS 102 226. If present, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall support the following additional data object tag: * Tag 'C2': Confirmation Counter. A Security Domain supporting Secure Channel Protocol '02' shall support the following data object tag: * Tag 'C1': Sequence Counter of the default Key Version Number. For a Security Domain supporting only Secure Channel Protocol '01', an attempt to retrieve the Sequence Counter of the default Key Version Number (tag 'C1') shall be rejected. Other tags as defined in section 11.1.11 - Tag Coding may be available for data objects supported by a Security Domain. 11.3.2.2 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the GET DATA command message shall be empty unless a tag list and/or a MAC is required. For retrieving a list of applications present on the card (P1-P2 set to '2F 00') a tag list shall be present and coded as '5C 00'. 11.3.3 Response Message 11.3.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message When the class byte indicates a GlobalPlatform proprietary command (bit b8 = 1), the GET DATA response data field shall contain the TLV coded data object referred to in reference control parameters P1 and P2 of the command message, except where P1-P2 are set to '2F 00'. Where the class byte indicates an ISO command (bit b8 = 0), the GET DATA response data field shall contain only the value of the TLV coded data object referred to in reference control parameters P1 and P2 of the command message, except where P1-P2 are set to '2F 00'. When retrieving key information for the currently selected Application, the key information is returned in the template 'E0' where each Key Information Data data object is introduced by the tag 'C0'. Its structure depends on the value of Key Type. If the Key Type is coded on one byte (value other than 'FF'), the Key Information Data is structured as follows: Name Length Value Presence Key Identifier 1 Key Identifier value Mandatory Key Version Number 1 Key Version Number value Mandatory Key type of first (or only) key component 1 '00' - 'FE', See section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Mandatory Length of first (or only) key component 1 '01' - 'FF' Mandatory 126 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence ... ... ... Key type of last key component 1 '00' - 'FE', See section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Conditional Length of last key component 1 '01' - 'FF' Conditional Table 11-27: Key Information Data Structure - Basic If the Key Type is coded on two bytes (first byte = 'FF'), the Key Information Data is structured as follows: Name Length Value Presence Key Identifier 1 Key Identifier value Mandatory Key Version Number 1 Key Version Number value Mandatory Key type of first (or only) key component 2 'FF xx' - see section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Mandatory Length of first (or only) key component 2 '00 01' - '7F FF' Mandatory ... ... ... Key type of last key component (if any) 2 'FF xx' - See section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Conditional Length of last key component (if any) 2 '00 01' - '7F FF' Conditional Length of Key Usage 1 '00' - '01' Mandatory Key usage 0 or 1 'xx' - See section 11.1.9 Conditional Length of Key Access 1 '00' - '01' Mandatory Key Access 0 or 1 'xx' - See section 11.1.10 Conditional Table 11-28: Key Information Data Structure - Extended The presence of Key Usage and Key Access is conditional on the data having been supplied when the key was loaded on the card. When retrieving Extended Card Resources Information with tag 'FF21', the response shall be coded as defined in ETSI TS 102 226. When retrieving the list of Applications present on the card, the response shall be coded as a series of Application Template data objects (tag '61') as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. An example of the response is as follows: Tag Length Name Presence '61' 7-n Application Template Mandatory '4F' 5-16 Application AID Mandatory ... ... '61' 7-n Application Template Mandatory '4F' 5-16 Application AID Mandatory ... ... Table 11-29: List of On-Card Applications 11.3.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 127 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table 11-30: GET DATA Error Conditions 128 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.4GET STATUS Command 11.4.1 Definition and Scope The GET STATUS command is used to retrieve Issuer Security Domain, Executable Load File, Executable Module, Application or Security Domain Life Cycle status information according to a given match/search criteria. 11.4.2 Command Message The GET STATUS command message shall be coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'F2' GET STATUS P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xx...' Search criteria (and MAC if present) Le '00' Table 11-31: GET STATUS Command Message 11.4.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 is used to select a subset of statuses to be included in the response message. It is coded as follows: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 1 - - - - - - - Issuer Security Domain - 1 - - - - - - Applications, including Security Domains - - 1 - - - - - Executable Load Files - - - 1 - - - - Executable Load Files and Executable Modules - - - - X X X X RFU Table 11-32: GET STATUS Reference Control Parameter P1 The following values of the reference control parameter shall be supported: '80' ­ Issuer Security Domain only. In this case the search criteria is ignored and the Issuer Security Domain information is returned. '40' ­ Applications and Supplementary Security Domains only. '20' ­ Executable Load Files only. '10' ­ Executable Load Files and their Executable Modules only. The ability to differentiate a Security Domain from an Application is achieved through privileges. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 129 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.4.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 controls the number of consecutive GET STATUS command and indicates the format of the response message. It shall be coded according to the following table. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning X X X X X X - - RFU - - - - - - - 0 Get first or all occurrence(s) - - - - - - - 1 Get next occurrence(s) - - - - - - 0 - Deprecated: response data structure according to Table 11-35 and Table 11-37 - - - - - - 1 - Response data structure according to Table 11-36 Table 11-33: GET STATUS Reference Control Parameter P2 The get next occurrence indicator shall be rejected if no prior GET STATUS [get first or all occurrence(s)] was received within the current Application Session. When retrieving the status of the Issuer Security Domain only, the get next occurrence indicator shall be rejected. Requesting a response coded according to Table 11-36 is recommended when interrogating a card compliant to this version of the specification or Amendment A of version 2.1.1. Note that cards compliant to previous versions of this specification may only support response data structures as defined in Table 11-35 and Table 11-37. 11.4.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field is structured as follows: Tag Length Name Presence '4F' 0-16 Application AID Mandatory 'xx' or 'xxxx' 0-n Other search criteria Optional ... ... ... ... '5C' 1-n Tag list Optional Table 11-34: GET STATUS Command Data Field The GET STATUS command message data field shall contain at least one TLV coded search qualifier: the AID (tag '4F'). It shall be possible to search for all the occurrences that match the selection criteria according to the reference control parameter P1 using a search criteria of '4F' '00'. It shall be possible to search for all occurrences with the same RID. Other search criteria may be added. In such cases, the additional search criteria shall be TLV coded and appended after the mandatory search criterion AID (tag `4F'). When not supported by the card, additional search criteria shall be ignored. The search is limited to the Executable Load Files, Applications and Security Domains that are directly or indirectly associated with the on-card entity receiving the command. When the on-card entity receiving the command has the Global Registry privilege, the search applies to all Executable Load Files, Applications and Security Domains registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry. The tag list (tag `5C') indicates to the card how to construct the response data for each on-card entity matching the search criteria. Its value field contains a concatenation of tags (without delimitation) indicating the data objects to include in the response. If an on-card entity that matches the search criteria is found in GlobalPlatform Registry without the corresponding data object, an error status shall be returned. The tag list may only be present when 130 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. reference control parameter P2 indicates a TLV-coded response (i.e. bit b2 of P2 set to 1). When not supported by the card, the tag list shall be ignored. 11.4.3 Response Message 11.4.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message Based upon the search criteria of the GET STATUS command data field and the selection criteria of reference control parameter P1 and P2, multiple occurrences of the data structure in the following tables may be returned. Responses coded according to Table 11-35 and Table 11-37 are deprecated. Name Length Value Presence Length of Application AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Application AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Life Cycle State 1 'xx' - see section 11.1.1 Mandatory Privileges (byte 1) 1 'xx' - see section 11.1.2 Mandatory Table 11-35: Issuer Security Domain, Application and Executable Load File Information Data Note for backward compatibility: when receiving Privileges coded on one byte for any Application or Security Domain, the off-card entity should consider the second and third byte as being set to the default values defined in section 6.6.2. Tag Length Name Presence 'E3' Variable GlobalPlatform Registry related data Conditional '4F' 5-16 AID Conditional '9F70' 1 Life Cycle State Conditional 'C5' 0,1,3 Privileges (byte 1 - byte 2 ­ byte 3) see section 11.1.2 Conditional 'C4' 1-n Application's Executable Load File AID Conditional 'CE' 1-n Executable Load File Version Number Conditional '84' 1-n First or only Executable Module AID Conditional ... ... ... ... '84' 1-n Last Executable Module AID Conditional 'CC' 1-n Associated Security Domain's AID Conditional Table 11-36: GlobalPlatform Registry Data (TLV) When tag lists are supported by the card, the response shall be coded according to Table 11-36 and shall only contain the data objects whose tags are listed in the tag list (tag `5C') of the command, the order of the data objects within the GlobalPlatform Registry data (template `E3') being arbitrary. When no tag list (tag `5C') is present in the command or when tag lists are not supported by the card, a response coded according to Table 11-36 shall contain the following data objects: * The AID (tag `4F') and Life Cycle State (tag `9F70') shall be present; * Privileges (tag `C5') shall be present for the Issuer Security Domain, Supplementary Security Domains and Applications and shall be absent for Executable Load Files; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 131 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The Executable Modules (tag `84') shall be present if reference control parameter P1 indicates Executable Load Files and their Executable Modules only (bit b5 of P1 set to 1) and if the Runtime Environment supports Executable Modules. Note: the Executable Load File Version Number format and contents are beyond the scope of this specification. It shall consist of the version information contained in the original Load File: on a Java Card based card, this version number represents the major and minor version attributes of the original Load File Data Block. Table 11-37: Executable Load File and Executable Module Information Data The Executable Modules shall be present if reference control parameter P1 indicates Executable Load Files and their Executable Modules only (bit b5 of P1 set to 1) and if the Runtime Environment supports Executable Modules. 11.4.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may return the following warning condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '63' '10' More data available Table 11-38: GET STATUS Warning Condition Following status '63 10' a subsequent GET STATUS [get next occurrence(s)] may be issued to retrieve additional data. This command may return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '88' Referenced data not found '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data Table 11-39: GET STATUS Error Conditions Name Length Value Presence Length of Executable Load File AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Executable Load File AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Executable Load File Life Cycle State 1 'xx' - see section 11.1.1 Mandatory Privileges 1 '00' Mandatory Number of Executable Modules 1 '01' - '7F' Conditional Length of Executable Module AID 1 '05' - '10' Conditional Executable Module AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional ... ... ... ... Length of Executable Module AID 1 '05' - '10' Conditional Executable Module AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional 132 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.5INSTALL Command 11.5.1 Definition and Scope The INSTALL command is issued to a Security Domain to initiate or perform the various steps required for Card Content management. 11.5.2 Command Message The INSTALL command message shall be coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'E6' INSTALL P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 '00', '01' or '03' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xxxx...' Install data (and MAC if present) Le '00' Table 11-40: INSTALL Command Message 11.5.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 The reference control parameter P1 of the INSTALL command defines the specific role of the INSTALL command and also allows for command data to be longer than 255 bytes and to be segmented into arbitrary components and transmitted in a series of INSTALL commands. It is coded according to the following table. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - Last (or only) command 1 - - - - - - - More INSTALL commands - 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 For registry update - 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 For personalization - 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 For extradition - 0 0 0 1 - - 0 For make selectable - 0 0 0 - 1 - 0 For install - 0 0 0 - - 1 0 For load Table 11-41: INSTALL Command Reference Control Parameter P1 Bits b8 to b1 shall be coded as follows: b8 = 1 indicates that the command data is one of a sequence of components (and not the last), b8 = 0 indicates that it is the last (or only) component. b7 = 1 indicates that the GlobalPlatform Registry is to be updated, or that functions are to be restricted. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 133 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b6 = 1 indicates that the currently selected Security Domain shall personalize one of its associated Applications and a subsequent STORE DATA command is to be expected b5 = 1 indicates that the Application shall be extradited. b4 = 1 indicates that the Application shall be made selectable. This applies to an Application being installed or an Application that is already installed. b3 = 1 indicates that the Application shall be installed. b2 = 1 indicates that the Load File shall be loaded. A subsequent LOAD command is to be expected. A combination of the [for install] and [for make selectable] options may apply. A combination of the [for load], [for install] and [for make selectable] options may also apply. 11.5.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 shall be set as follows: `00' indicates that no information is provided. `01' indicates the beginning of the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable process. `03' indicates the end of the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable process. 11.5.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message contains LV coded data. The LV coded data is represented without delimiters. 11.5.2.3.1 Data Field for INSTALL [for load] The following table details the INSTALL [for load] command data field. It also applies to the first combined INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command data field. Name Length Value Presence Length of Load File AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Load File AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length of Security Domain AID 1 '00' or '05' - '10' Mandatory Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of Load File Data Block Hash 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Load File Data Block Hash 0-n 'xxxx...' - see appendix C.2 Conditional Length of Load Parameters field 1-2 '00' - '7F', or '81 80' - '81 FF' Mandatory Load Parameters field 0-n 'xxxx...' - see section 11.5.2.3.7 Conditional Length of Load Token 1-3 '00' - '80', or '81 80' - '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Mandatory Load Token 0-n 'xxxx...' - see appendix C.4.1 Conditional Table 11-42: INSTALL [for load] Command Data Field 134 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The Load Token is mandatory for Delegated Management (except for the combined [for load, install and make selectable] command), and for Authorized Management if the off-card entity is not the Security Domain Provider. In all other cases an error status shall be returned if a Load Token is present. The length field for a Load Token is as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1) except that the length 128 may also be coded on one byte as '80'. The Load File Data Block Hash is mandatory if a Load Token is present or if the Load File contains one or more DAP Blocks. In all other cases, the Load File Data Block Hash is optional and may be verified by the card. The Load File AID and the Load Parameters shall be consistent with the information contained in the Load File Data Block (if any). 11.5.2.3.2 Data Field for INSTALL [for install] The following table details the INSTALL [for install] command data field. It also applies to the final combined [for load, install and make selectable] command data field. Name Length Value Presence Length of Executable Load File AID 1 '00' or '05' - '10' Mandatory Executable Load File AID 0 or 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of Executable Module AID 1 '00' or '05' - '10' Mandatory Executable Module AID 0 or 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of Application AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Application AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length of Privileges 1 '01', '03' Mandatory Privileges 1, 3 byte 1 - byte 2 ­ byte 3: see section 11.1.2 Mandatory Length of Install Parameters field 1-2 '01' - '7F' or '81 80' '81 FF' Mandatory Install Parameters field 2-n 'xxxx' - see section 11.5.2.3.7 Mandatory Length of Install Token 1-3 '00' - '80', or '81 80' '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Mandatory Install Token 0-n 'xxxx...' - see appendix C.4.2 or C.4.7 Conditional Table 11-43: INSTALL [for install] Command Data Field The Install Token is mandatory for Delegated Management and for Authorized Management if the off-card entity is not the Security Domain Provider. In all other cases an error status shall be returned if an Install Token is present. The length fields for the Install Token and the Install Parameters field are formatted as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1) except that the length 128 may also be coded on one byte as '80'. The presence of the Executable Load File AID is optional for the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable command. If present it shall match the Load File AID of the first combined Load, Install and Make Selectable command. The Executable Module AID is the AID of the Executable Module previously loaded. The presence of the Executable Module depends on the requirements of the Run Time Environment. GlobalPlatform cards use the instance AID to indicate the AID with which the installed Application will be selected. The presence of the Privileges is required. If an Application is only being installed and not made selectable with the same INSTALL command the Card Reset privilege cannot be set. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 135 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The instance AID, the Privileges and the Application Specific Parameters shall be made known to the Application. Note for backward compatibility: when receiving Privileges coded on one byte for any Application or Security Domain, the OPEN shall assign the second byte with the default values defined in section 6.6.2. 11.5.2.3.3 Data Field for INSTALL [for make selectable] The following table details the INSTALL [for make selectable] command data field. Name Length Value Presence Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of Application AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Application AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length of Privileges 1 '01', '03' Mandatory Privileges 1, 3 byte 1 - byte 2 ­ byte 3: see section 11.1.2 Mandatory Length of Make Selectable Parameters field 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Make Selectable Parameters field 0-n 'xxxx' - see section 11.5.2.3.7 Conditional Length of Make Selectable Token 1-3 '00' - '80', or '81 80' - '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Mandatory Make Selectable Token 0-n 'xxxx...' - see appendix C.4.3 Conditional Table 11-44: INSTALL [for make selectable] Command Data Field If the Card Reset privilege is set in the Privileges field, the GlobalPlatform Registry shall be updated according to the rules defined in section 6.6 - Privileges. Any other privilege set in the Privileges field, regardless of its length, shall be ignored by the card. The Make Selectable Token is mandatory for Delegated Management, and for Authorized Management if the offcard entity is not the Security Domain Provider. In all other cases an error status shall be returned if a Make Selectable Token is present. The length field for the Make Selectable Token is as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1) except that the length 128 may also be coded on one byte as '80'. 11.5.2.3.4 Data Field for INSTALL [for extradition] The following table details the INSTALL [for extradition] command data field. Name Length Value Presence Length of Security Domain AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Security Domain AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of Application or Executable Load File AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Application or Executable Load File AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length 1 '00' Mandatory Length of Extradition Parameters field 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Extradition Parameters field 0-n 'xxxx' - see section 11.5.2.3.7 Conditional 136 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence Length of Extradition Token 1-3 '00' - '80', or '81 80' - '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Mandatory Extradition Token 0-n 'xxxx...' - see appendix C.4.4 Conditional Table 11-45: INSTALL [for extradition] Command Data Field The Security Domain AID indicates to which Security Domain this Application or Executable Load File is being extradited. The Security Domain with which this Application or Executable Load File is currently associated is the currently selected Application. The Extradition Token is mandatory for Delegated Management, and for Authorized Management if the off-card entity is not the Security Domain Provider. In all other cases an error status shall be returned if an Extradition Token is present. The length field for the Extradition Token is as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1) except that the length 128 may also be coded on one byte as '80'. 11.5.2.3.5 Data Field for INSTALL [for registry update] The following table details the INSTALL [for registry update] command data field. Name Length Value Presence Length of Security Domain AID 1 '00' or '05' - '10' Mandatory Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of Application AID 1 '00' or '05' - '10' Mandatory Application AID 0 or 5-16 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of Privileges 1 '00', '01; '03' Mandatory Privileges 0, 1, 3 byte 1 - byte 2 byte 3: see section 11.1.2 Conditional Length of Registry Update Parameters field 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Registry Update Parameters field 0-n 'xxxx' - see section 11.5.2.3.7 Conditional Length of Registry Update Token 1-3 '00' - '80', or '81 80' - '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Mandatory Registry Update Token 0-n 'xxxx...' - see appendix 0 Conditional Table 11-46: INSTALL [for registry update] Command Data Field The Security Domain AID, if present, indicates to which Security Domain this Application is being extradited. The Security Domain with which this Application is currently associated is the currently selected Application. The Application AID shall be present except when restricting the functionality of OPEN. For updating or revoking privileges the Privileges field shall be present. For updating implicit selection parameters or service parameters the corresponding tag within the Registry Update Parameters field shall be present - see section 11.5.2.3.7. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 137 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The Registry Update Token is mandatory for Delegated Management, and for Authorized Management if the offcard entity is not the Security Domain Provider. In all other cases an error status shall be returned if a Registry Update Token is present. The length field for the Registry Update Token is as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1) except that the length 128 may also be coded on one byte as '80'. 11.5.2.3.6 Data Field for INSTALL [for personalization] The following table details the INSTALL [for personalization] command data field. Name Length Value Presence Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of Application AID 1 '05' - '10' Mandatory Application AID 5-16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Length of data 1 '00' Mandatory Table 11-47: INSTALL [for personalization] Command Data Field 11.5.2.3.7 INSTALL Command Parameters The Load and Install Parameters fields are TLV structured values including optional System Specific Parameters and Application Specific Parameters. While the presence of the System Specific Parameters is optional for both loading and installation, even if they are present, it is not required that the system take heed of these i.e. their presence shall be anticipated but the content may be ignored. In all cases, the presence of the data objects in tag 'B6' and the sub-tags '42', '45', 5F20' and '93' is strongly recommended when using asymmetric Secure Channel Protocol '10'. In this version of the specification, the Token Issuer is assumed to be the Card Issuer. The following table identifies the possible tags for use in the Load Parameters field of the INSTALL [for load] command: Tag Length Name Presence 'EF' 1-n System Specific Parameters Conditional 'C6' 2 or 4 Non volatile code Minimum Memory requirement Optional 'C7' 2 or 4 Volatile data Minimum Memory requirement Optional 'C8' 2 or 4 Non volatile data Minimum Memory requirement Optional 'CĎ 1 Load File Data Block format id Optional 'DĎ 1-n Load File Data Block Parameters Conditional 'D6' 2 or 4 Code Reserved Memory Optional 'B6' 1-n Control Reference Template for Digital Signature (Token) Conditional 138 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Tag Length Name Presence `42' 1-n Token Issuer id Optional '45' 1-n Card Image Number Optional `5F20' 1-n Application Provider identifier Optional `93' 1-n Token identifier/number (digital signature counter) Optional Table 11-48: Load Parameter Tags Some of the data objects in Load Parameters relate to memory management, which is an optional feature of a card. A Memory Management data object is a data object that represent an amount of memory resources counted in bytes. The minimum memory requirements (tags 'C6', 'C7' and 'C8') and code reserved memory (tag 'D6') are coded as a 2byte integer for values up to 32767 and a 4-byte integer above 32767 - see section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management. When present, the Provider id (tag '5F20') shall be registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry. The presence of Load File Data Block Parameters depends on the value of Load File Data Block format id. The following table identifies the possible tags for use in the Install Parameters field of the INSTALL [for install] command: Tag Length Name Presence 'C9' 1-n Application Specific Parameters Mandatory 'EF' 1-n System Specific Parameters Conditional 'C7' 2 or 4 Volatile Memory Quota Optional 'C8' 2 or 4 Non volatile Memory Quota Optional 'CB' 2-n Global Service Parameters Optional 'D7' 2 Volatile Reserved Memory Optional 'D8' 2 Non volatile Reserved Memory Optional 'CA' 1-n TS 102 226 specific parameter Optional `CF' 1-n Implicit selection parameter See note below 'EA' 1-n TS 102 226 specific template Optional 'B6' 1-n Control Reference Template for Digital Signature (Token) Conditional `42' 1-n Token Issuer id Optional '45' 1-n Card Image Number Optional `5F20' 1-n Application Provider identifier Optional `93' 1-n Token identifier/number (digital signature counter) Optional Table 11-49: Install Parameter Tags Note: tag 'CF' may be present in Install Parameters for the combined INSTALL [for install and make selectable] command and in the final combined INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 139 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Some of the data objects in Install Parameters relate to memory management, which is an optional feature of a card. A Memory Management data object is a data object that represent an amount of memory resources counted in bytes. The memory quota values (tags 'C7' and 'C8') are coded as a 2-byte integer for values up to 32767 and a 4-byte integer above 32767 - see section 9.7 - Memory Resource Management. When present, the Provider id (tag '5F20') shall be registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry. When present in the INSTALL [for install] command, the information contained in tag 'C9' (length + data) shall be passed to the Application being installed. When present in the INSTALL [for install] command, the information contained in tag 'CB' shall comprise one or more two-byte service parameters as defined in section 8.1.3 - Global Service Parameters. The following table identifies the possible tags for use in the Make Selectable Parameters field of the INSTALL [for make selectable] command: Tag Length Name Presence 'EF' 1-n System Specific Parameters Conditional `CF' 1-n Implicit selection parameter Optional 'B6' 1-n Control Reference Template for Digital Signature (Token) Conditional `42' 1-n Token Issuer id Optional '45' 1-n Card Image Number Optional `5F20' 1-n Application Provider identifier Optional `93' 1-n Token identifier/number (digital signature counter) Optional Table 11-50: Make Selectable Parameter Tags The following table identifies the possible tags for use in the Extradition Parameters field of the INSTALL [for extradition] command: Tag Length Name Presence 'B6' 1-n Control Reference Template for Digital Signature (Token) Conditional `42' 1-n Token Issuer id Optional '45' 1-n Card Image Number Optional `5F20' 1-n Application Provider identifier Optional `93' 1-n Token identifier/number (digital signature counter) Optional Table 11-51: Extradition Parameter Tags The following table identifies the possible tags for use in the Registry Update Parameters field of the INSTALL [for registry update] command: Tag Length Name Presence 'EF' 1-n System Specific Parameters Conditional 'CF' 1 Implicit selection parameter Optional 'CB' 2-n Global Service Parameters Optional 'D9' 1 Restrict Parameter (see Table 11-53) Conditional 140 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Tag Length Name Presence 'B6' 1-n Control Reference Template for Digital Signature (Token) Conditional `42' 1-n Token Issuer id Optional '45' 1-n Card Image Number Optional `5F20' 1-n Application Provider identifier Optional `93' 1-n Token identifier/number (digital signature counter) Optional Table 11-52: Registry Update Parameter Tags When no Application AID is present in the INSTALL [for registry update] command, the Restrict Parameter (tag `D9') applies to OPEN. The effects of this function shall be irreversible. When an Application AID is present in the INSTALL [for registry update] command, the Restrict Parameter (tag `D9') applies to the specific Security Domain identified by the Application AID. If the Restrict Parameter is present and the card does not implement the option the card shall reject the command. The Restrict Parameter (tag 'D9') lists the functionalities that shall be disabled. Table 11-53 indicates the functionalities that could possibly be disabled. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning X - - - - - - - RFU - 1 - - - - - - Registry Update - - 1 - - - - - Personalization - - - 1 - - - - Extradition - - - - 1 - - - Make selectable - - - - - 1 - - Install - - - - - - 1 - Load - - - - - - - 1 Delete Table 11-53: Values for Restrict Parameter (Tag 'D9') 11.5.3 Response Message A data field shall always be returned in the response message. Confirmation data or a single byte of '00' may be returned. 11.5.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message If an INSTALL [for load] command, an INSTALL [for make selectable] command alone or an INSTALL [for personalization] command is being issued, a single byte of '00' shall be returned indicating that no additional data is present. For INSTALL [for install], INSTALL [for install and make selectable] and INSTALL [for registry update] commands being issued to a Security Domain with the Delegated Management privilege, the data field may contain the confirmation of the install procedure. The overall length of the response message shall not exceed 256 bytes. The following table describes the structure of the INSTALL response data field. The length field for the Install Confirmation is coded according to ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 141 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence Length of Install Confirmation 1-2 '00' - '7F' or '81 80' - '81 FF' Mandatory Install Confirmation 0-n 'xxxx...'' see section 11.1.6 Conditional Table 11-54: INSTALL Response Data Field 11.5.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '65' '81' Memory failure '6A' '80' Incorrect parameters in data field '6A' '84' Not enough memory space '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table 11-55: INSTALL Error Conditions 142 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.6LOAD Command 11.6.1 Definition and Scope This section defines the structure of the Load File transmitted in the LOAD command data field for loading a Load File. The runtime environment internal handling or storage of the Load File is beyond the scope of this Specification. Multiple LOAD commands may be used to transfer a Load File to the card. The Load File is divided into smaller components for transmission. Each LOAD command shall be numbered starting at '00'. The LOAD command numbering shall be strictly sequential and increments by one. The card shall be informed of the last block of the Load File. After receiving the last block of the Load File, the card shall execute the internal processes necessary for the Load File and any additional processes identified in the INSTALL [for load] command that preceded the LOAD commands. 11.6.2 Command Message The LOAD command message is coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'E8' LOAD P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Block number Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xxxx..' Load data (and MAC if present) Le '00' Table 11-56: LOAD Command Message Structure 11.6.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 The following table describes the coding of the reference control parameter P1 indicating whether the block contained in the command message is one in a sequence of blocks or the last block in the sequence. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - More blocks 1 - - - - - - - Last block - X X X X X X X RFU Table 11-57: LOAD Command Reference Control Parameter P1 11.6.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 ­ Block Number Reference control parameter P2 contains the block number, and shall be coded sequentially from '00' to 'FF'. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 143 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.6.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message contains a portion of the Load File. A complete GlobalPlatform Load File is structured as defined in the following table: Tag Length Name Presence 'E2' 1-n DAP Block Conditional '4F' 5-16 Security Domain AID Conditional 'C3' 1-n Load File Data Block Signature Conditional : : : : : : 'E2' 1-n DAP Block Conditional '4F' 5-16 Security Domain AID Conditional 'C3' 1-n Load File Data Block Signature Conditional 'C4' 1-n Load File Data Block Mandatory Table 11-58: Load File Structure The data objects defined in Table 11-58 shall be coded according to ASN.1 Basic Encoding Rules, and in particular, the length fields (e.g. one byte for length values up to 127). A DAP Block is optional within a Load File unless the associated Security Domain has the DAP Verification privilege or a Security Domain with the Mandated DAP Verification privilege is present. A Load File may contain multiple DAP Blocks; each DAP Block being introduced by tag 'E2' and preceding the Load File Data Block. 11.6.3 Response Message A data field shall always be returned in the response message. The content of the data field is only relevant in the case of Delegated Management i.e. if a last LOAD command is being issued to a Security Domain with the Delegated Management privilege, a Receipt may be present in the data field depending on the security policy of the Card Issuer. 11.6.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message If the LOAD command does not contain the last block in the sequence, a single byte of '00' shall be returned indicating that no additional data is present. If the Issuer Security Domain processes the LOAD command containing the last block in the sequence, a single byte of '00' shall be returned indicating that no additional data is present. For a LOAD command containing the last block in the sequence being issued to a Security Domain with the Delegated Management privilege, the data field may contain the confirmation of the load procedure. The overall length of the response message shall not exceed 256 bytes. The following table describes the structure of the LOAD response data field. The length field for the Load Confirmation is coded according to ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1). Name Length Value Presence Length of Load Confirmation 1-2 '00' - '7F' or '81 80' - '81 FF' Mandatory 144 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence Load Confirmation 0-n 'xxxx...' - see section 11.1.6 Conditional Table 11-59: LOAD Response Data Field 11.6.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '65' '81' Memory failure '6A' '84' Not enough memory space Table 11-60: LOAD Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 145 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.7MANAGE CHANNEL Command 11.7.1 Definition and Scope The MANAGE CHANNEL command is processed by the OPEN on cards that are aware of logical channels. It is used to open and close Supplementary Logical Channels. The Basic Logical Channel (channel number zero) can never be closed. 11.7.2 Command Message The MANAGE CHANNEL command message shall be coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03' or '40' - '4F' See section 11.1.4 INS '70' MANAGE CHANNEL P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Reference control parameter P2 Lc Not present Le '01' if P1 = '00' and not present if P1 = '80' Table 11-61: MANAGE CHANNEL Command Message 11.7.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 is used to indicate whether a Supplementary Logical Channel is being opened or closed. The following values of the reference control parameter may apply: '80' ­ Close the Supplementary Logical Channel identified in reference control parameter P2. '00' ­ Open the next available Supplementary Logical Channel. 11.7.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 If a Supplementary Logical Channel is being closed (reference control parameter P1 is '80'), the reference control parameter P2 identifies the Supplementary Logical Channel to be closed (i.e. '01', '02' or '03'). For a card supporting further interindustry logical channels, the reference control parameter may identify further interindustry Supplementary Logical Channels (i.e. `04' to `13'). If a Supplementary Logical Channel is being opened (reference control parameter P1 is '00'), the reference control parameter P2 indicates that the next available Supplementary Logical Channel is being opened (i.e. '00'). A card supporting logical channel assignment by off-card entities may accept a reference control parameter P2 indicating the Supplementary Logical Channel number to be opened (i.e. '01', '02' or '03'). A card supporting further interindustry logical channel assignment by off-card entities may accept a reference control parameter P2 indicating the further interindustry Supplementary Logical Channel number to be opened (i.e. `04' to `13'). 11.7.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message is not present. 146 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.7.3 Response Message 11.7.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message is only present if a Supplementary Logical Channel is being opened. Depending on the number of logical channels supported by the card, the following values of the data field of the response message may apply: '01', '02' or '03' ­ Supplementary Logical Channel opened. For a card supporting further interindustry logical channels, and depending on the number of Supplementary Logical Channels supported by the card, the following values of the data field of the response message may apply: '04' to '13' ­ Supplementary Logical Channel opened. 11.7.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may return the following warning: SW1 SW2 Meaning '62' '00' Logical Channel already closed Table 11-62: MANAGE CHANNEL Warning Conditions This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '68' '82' Secure messaging not supported '6A' '81' Function not supported e.g. card Life Cycle State is CARD_LOCKED Table 11-63: MANAGE CHANNEL Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 147 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.8PUT KEY Command 11.8.1 Definition and Scope The PUT KEY command is used to either: * Replace an existing key with a new key: The new key has the same or a different Key Version Number but the same Key Identifier as the key being replaced; * Replace multiple existing keys with new keys: The new keys have the same or a different Key Version Number (identical for all new keys) but the same Key Identifiers as the keys being replaced; * Add a single new key: The new key has a different combination Key Identifier / Key Version Number than that of the existing keys; * Add multiple new keys: The new keys have different combinations of Key Identifiers / Key Version Number (identical to all new keys) than that of the existing keys; When the key management operation requires multiple PUT KEY commands, chaining of the multiple PUT KEY commands is recommended to ensure integrity of the operation. In this version of the Specification the public values of asymmetric keys are presented in clear text. 11.8.2 Command Message The PUT KEY command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'D8' PUT KEY P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xxxx..' Key data (and MAC if present) Le '00' Table 11-64: PUT KEY Command Message 11.8.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 defines a Key Version Number and whether more PUT KEY commands will follow this one. The Key Version Number identifies a key or group of keys that is already present on the card. A value of '00' indicates that a new key or group of keys is being added. (The new Key Version Number is indicated in the data field of the command message). The Key Version Number is coded from '01' to '7F'. The reference control parameter P1 of the PUT KEY command message is coded according to the following table: 148 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - Last (or only) command 1 - - - - - - - More PUT KEY commands - X X X X X X X Key Version Number Table 11-65: PUT KEY Reference Control Parameter P1 11.8.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 Reference control parameter P2 defines a Key Identifier and whether one or multiple keys are contained in the data field. When one key is contained in the command message data field, reference control parameter P2 indicates the Key Identifier of this key. When multiple keys are contained in the command message data field, reference control parameter P2 indicates the Key Identifier of the first key in the command data field. Each subsequent key in the command message data field has an implicit Key Identifier that is sequentially incremented by one, starting from this first Key Identifier. The Key Identifier is coded from '00' to '7F'. The reference control parameter P2 of the PUT KEY command message is coded according to the following table: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - Single key 1 - - - - - - - Multiple keys - X X X X X X X Key Identifier Table 11-66: PUT KEY Reference Control Parameter P2 11.8.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The command message data field contains a new Key Version Number (coded from '01' to '7F') followed by one or multiple key data fields as represented in the following diagram (with optionally a second and third keys): New version number key data field (implicit key id P2+0) key data field (implicit key id P2+2) key data field (implicit key id P2+1) Table 11-67: Key Version Number Diagram The new Key Version Number defines either: * The version number of a new key or group of keys to be created on the card (Key Version Number indicated in P1 is set to zero); or * The version number of a new key or group of keys that will replace an existing key or group of keys (Key Version Number indicated in P1 is different from zero). If the data field contains multiple keys, the keys all share the same Key Version Number and the sequence in the command data field reflects the incremental sequence of the Key Identifiers. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 149 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The format of the key data field depends on the value of the first data element, Key Type. 11.8.2.3.1 Format 1 If the Key Type is coded on one byte (value other than 'FF'), the key data field is structured according to the following table: Name Length Value Presence Key type 1-2 '00' - 'FE' - see section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Mandatory Length of key or key component 1-3 '01' - '80', or '81 80' '81 FF', or '82 01 00' '82 FF FF' Mandatory Key or key component data value 1-n 'xxxx...' Mandatory Length of key check value 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Key check value 0-n 'xxxx...' Conditional Table 11-68: Key Data Field - Basic 11.8.2.3.2 Format 2 If the Key Type is coded on two bytes (first byte = 'FF'), the key data field is structured according to the following table: Name Length Value Presence Key type of the first or only key component 2 'FF xx' - see section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Mandatory Length of first or only key component 1-3 '01' - '80', or '81 80' - '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Mandatory Key or first key component data value 1-n 'xxxx...' Mandatory ... Key type of the last key component, if more than one 2 'FF xx' - see section 11.1.8 - Key Type Coding Conditional Length of last key component 1-3 '01' - '80', or '81 80' - '81 FF', or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Conditional Last key component data value 1-n 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of key check value 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Key check value (if present) 0-n 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of key usage 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Key usage 0-n 'xxxx...' Conditional Length of key access 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory Key access 0-n 'xxxx...' Conditional Table 11-69: Key Data Field - Extended The length of each key component is coded as defined for ASN.1 BER-TLV (see ISO 8825-1) except that the length 128 may also be coded on one byte as '80'. 150 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.8.2.3.3 Processing rules When replacing keys, the new keys shall be presented to the card in the same format as they are already present on the card: in other words, it is not possible to change the size and the associated cryptographic algorithm of an existing key slot. When using this command to load or replace secret or private keys, the key values shall be encrypted and the reference of the encrypting key and algorithm to be used is known implicitly according to the current context. Public key values may be presented in clear text. When chaining is used to load or replace a key comprised of more than one component, the subsequent commands must refer to the same Key Identifier and the same Key Version Number as the first PUT KEY command used for the first key component. A key component shall not be split across two PUT KEY commands. If the data field contains multiple keys or key components, the card must handle the multiple keys or key components in an atomic manner. When PUT KEY commands are chained (i.e. bit b8 of P1 set to 1), the card must handle the multiple key components transferred in the chain of PUT KEY commands (until and including the first PUT KEY command with bit b8 of P1 = 0) in an atomic manner. The PUT KEY command creates or updates the Key Information Data which may later be returned in tag 'C0', structured as shown in Table 11-27 or Table 11-28. The modulus component of an RSA key should be the first key component. It is the responsibility of the receiving on-card entity to verify the key check value when present. 11.8.3 Response Message 11.8.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message contains in clear text the Key Version Number followed by the key check value(s) not preceded by a length, if any, as presented in the command message data field. The personalization server may use the returned Key Version Number and key check value(s) to verify the correct loading of the key(s). 11.8.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '65' '81' Memory failure '6A' '84' Not enough memory space '6A' '88' Referenced data not found '94' '84' Algorithm not supported '94' '85' Invalid key check value Table 11-70: PUT KEY Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 151 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.9SELECT Command 11.9.1 Definition and Scope The SELECT command is used for selecting an Application. The OPEN only processes SELECT commands indicating the SELECT [by name] option. All options other than SELECT [by name] shall be passed to the currently selected Security Domain or Application on the indicated logical channel. 11.9.2 Command Message The SELECT command is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03' or '40' - '4F' See section 11.1.4 INS 'A4' SELECT P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of AID Data 'xxxx..' AID of Application to be selected Le '00' Table 11-71: SELECT Command Message 11.9.2.1 Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 shall be coded according to the following table. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 Select by name Table 11-72: SELECT Reference Control Parameter P1 A Security Domain or Application may support other values as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. 11.9.2.2 Reference Control Parameter P2 Reference control parameter P2 shall be coded according to the following table. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 First or only occurrence 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 Next occurrence Table 11-73: SELECT Reference Control Parameter P2 OPEN or the underlying runtime environment may support other values as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. 152 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.9.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command shall contain the AID of the Application to be selected. The Lc and data field of the SELECT command may be omitted if the Issuer Security Domain is being selected. In this case, Le shall be set to '00' and the command is a case 2 command according to ISO/IEC 7816-4. 11.9.3 Response Message 11.9.3.1 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The SELECT response data field consists of information specific to the selected Application. The coding of the File Control Information for the Issuer Security Domain and Security Domains shall be according to the following table. Tag Description Presence '6F' File Control Information (FCI template) Mandatory '84' Application / file AID Mandatory 'A5' Proprietary data Mandatory '73' Security Domain Management Data (see appendix H.3 for detailed coding) Optional '9F6E' Application production Life Cycle data Optional '9F65' Maximum length of data field in command message Mandatory Table 11-74: File Control Information Additional data objects may be returned within the FCI template. 11.9.3.2 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may return the following warning condition when the Security Domain with the Final Application privilege is being selected. SW1 SW2 Meaning '62' '83' Card Life Cycle State is CARD_LOCKED Table 11-75: SELECT Warning Condition This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '68' '82' Secure messaging not supported '6A' '81' Function not supported e.g. card Life Cycle State is CARD_LOCKED '6A' '82' Selected Application / file not found Table 11-76: SELECT Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 153 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.10SET STATUS Command 11.10.1 Definition and Scope The SET STATUS command shall be used to modify the card Life Cycle State or the Application Life Cycle State. 11.10.2 Command Message The SET STATUS command message is coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'F0' SET STATUS P1 'xx' Status type P2 'xx' State control Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xxxxx...' AID of Application (and MAC if present) Le Not present Table 11-77: SET STATUS Command Message 11.10.2.1Reference Control Parameter P1 - Status Type The status type of the SET STATUS command message indicates if the change in the Life Cycle State applies to the Issuer Security Domain, Supplementary Security Domains or an Application. The status type can also indicate that the command applies to a Security Domain and all its associated Applications: this only applies for transition to, and back from, the LOCKED state. The status type shall be coded according to the following table. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 1 0 0 - - - - - Indicate Issuer Security Domain 0 1 0 - - - - - Indicate Application or Supplementary Security Domain 0 1 1 - - - - - Indicate Security Domain and its associated Applications - - - X X X X X RFU Table 11-78: SET STATUS ­ Status Type 11.10.2.2Reference Control Parameter P2 - State Control The state control of the SET STATUS command message indicates the state transition required and shall be coded according to section 11.1.1 - Life Cycle State Coding. For the Issuer Security Domain (which inherits the card Life Cycle State), the parameter shall be coded according to Table 11-6 and abide by the transitioning rules as diagrammed in Figure 5-1. For a Security Domain setting its own Life Cycle State using this command, the only possible transitions are to the PERSONALIZED or LOCKED state: The parameter shall be coded according to Table 11-5. For an Application setting its own Life Cycle State using this command, the parameter shall be coded according to Table 11-4 and abide by the transitioning rules as depicted in Figure 5-2. 154 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. For a Security Domain setting the Life Cycle State of another Application or Security Domain, the only possible transitions are to the LOCKED state and subsequently back to the previous state. The only relevant bit of this parameter would therefore be bit b8 (all other bits are ignored): * b8 = 1 indicates a transition to the LOCKED state; * b8 = 0 indicates a transition (from LOCKED) back to the previous state. A request to transition a Security Domain or an Application to its current Life Cycle State shall be rejected. 11.10.2.3Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field shall contain the AID of the target Application or Security Domain for which a Life Cycle change is requested. The on-card entity receiving the command shall be directly or indirectly associated with this target Application or Security Domain or shall have the relevant privilege. If reference control parameter P1 is '80' the content of the command data field shall be ignored. If the command relates to a Security Domain and all its associated Applications, the data field shall contain the AID of the Security Domain. 11.10.3 Response Message 11.10.3.1Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message shall not be present. 11.10.3.2Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following error conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table 11-79: SET STATUS Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 155 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. 11.11STORE DATA Command 11.11.1 Definition and Scope The STORE DATA command is used to transfer data to an Application or the Security Domain processing the command. The Security Domain determines if the command is intended for itself or an Application depending on a previously received command. If a preceding command was an INSTALL [for personalize] command, the STORE DATA command is destined for an Application. Multiple STORE DATA commands transfer data to the Application or Security Domain by breaking the data into smaller components for transmission. Each STORE DATA command is numbered starting at '00'. The STORE DATA command numbering shall be strictly sequential and increments by one. The Security Domain shall be informed of the last block. 11.11.2 Command Message The STORE DATA command message shall be coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS 'E2' STORE DATA P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 'xx' Block number Lc 'xx' Length of data field Data 'xxxxx...' Application data and MAC (if present) Le Not present Table 11-80: STORE DATA Command Message 11.11.2.1Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 shall be coded according to the following table. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning 0 - - - - - - - More blocks 1 - - - - - - - Last block - 0 0 - - - - - No general encryption information or nonencrypted data - 0 1 - - - - - Application dependent encryption of the data - 1 0 - - - - - RFU (encryption indicator) - 1 1 - - - - - Encrypted data - - - 0 0 - - - No general data structure information - - - 0 1 - - - DGI format of the command data field - - - 1 0 - - - BER-TLV format of the command data field - - - 1 1 - - - RFU (data structure information) 156 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Meaning - - - - - X X X RFU Table 11-81: STORE DATA Reference Control Parameter P1 Bits b5 and b4 provide information on the data structure of the command message data field. * b5 - b4 = 00 indicate that no general information on the data structure is provided, i.e. the data structure is Application dependent; * b5 - b4 = 01 indicate that the command message data field is coded as one or more DGI structures, according to GlobalPlatform Systems Scripting Specification; * b5 - b4 = 10 indicate that the command message data field is coded as one or more BER-TLV structures, according to ISO 8825. Bits b7 and b6 provide information on the encryption of the value fields of the data structure present in the command message data field. * b7 ­ b6 = 00 indicate that no general information on the data encryption is provided, i.e. the encryption (or non-encryption) of the data is Application dependent, or that the data value fields of all the data structures present in the current command message are not encrypted; * b7 ­ b6 = 01 indicate that the encryption (or non-encryption) of the data structure value fields is Application dependent, e.g. when multiple data structures are present in the current command message, some may have encrypted data value fields and other data value fields may be non-encrypted; * b7 ­ b6 = 11 indicate that the data value fields of all the data structures present in the current command message are encrypted. The decryption of application-specific data is the responsibility of the Application. 11.11.2.2Reference Control Parameter P2 - Block number Reference control parameter P2 shall contain the block number coded sequentially from '00' to 'FF'. The Security Domain shall check the sequence of commands. 11.11.2.3Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field shall contain data in a format expected by the Security Domain or the Application. If the data is intended for an Application, it is sent to the Application as described in section 7.3.3. Three data structuring modes can be defined: * Application dependent format applies when no information is available on the format of the incoming command data: bits b5-b4 of reference control parameter P1 are set to `00'. In this case, information on the encryption (or non-encryption) of the incoming command data is usually not available (parameter P1 bits b7-b6 set to `00'): the format and eventual encryption of the incoming command data are implicitly known by the Application; * DGI formatting applies when all data structures that are present in the command data field are formatted as DGI structures (as defined in the Scripting Specification): bits b5-b4 of reference control parameter P1 are set to `01'. In this case, some information may be available on the encryption (or non-encryption) of the value fields of the DGI data structures: reference control parameter P1 bits b7-b6 are set accordingly; * BER-TLV formatting applies when all data structures that are present in the command data field are formatted as BER-TLV structures (as defined in ISO 8825): bits b5-b4 of reference control parameter P1 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 157 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. are set to `10'. In this case, some information may be available on the encryption (or non-encryption) of the value fields of the TLV data structures: reference control parameter P1 bits b7-b6 are set accordingly. If the overall length of the intended command message exceeds 255 bytes, the individual (or group of) data shall be sent in multiple consecutive STORE DATA commands. Whether the data format is a DGI or BER-TLV data structure, the following rules shall apply: * The data structure length indicators shall always reflect the actual full length of the data structure value field; * The data structure value field shall be truncated in the STORE DATA command message containing the data structure length indicator (e.g. at the maximum length of the command message); * The subsequent STORE DATA command shall contain the remainder of the data structure value field (that may be followed by one or more data structure(s) in this same command message) ­ note: for very large data, more than one subsequent STORE DATA command message may be required for the remainder of the data structure value field; * The Target Application or Security Domain shall use the last data structure length indicator of a STORE DATA command message to determine whether a subsequent STORE DATA command is expected to contain the remainder of the data structure value field. The Issuer Security Domain shall support at least the following TLV coded data objects: * Issuer Identification Number (tag '42') * Card Image Number (tag '45') * Issuer Security Domain AID (tag '4F') * Card Data (tag '66') A Supplementary Security Domain should support the following TLV coded data objects: * Security Domain Provider Identification Number (tag '42') * Security Domain Image Number (tag '45') * Security Domain Management Data (tag '66') When DGI formatting is supported, these data objects may be included in a DGI. In that case, the DGI `0070' shall be used. Otherwise, these data objects shall be presented in their BER-TLV format. 11.11.3 Response Message 11.11.3.1Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message shall not be present. 11.11.3.2Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition. SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data 158 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SW1 SW2 Meaning `6A' `88' Referenced data not found Table 11-82: STORE DATA Error Condition March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 159 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Appendices 160 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. A GlobalPlatform API A.1 GlobalPlatform on a Java Card This section contains only the API required for GlobalPlatform 2.2.x Java Cards. Use of the Open Platform 2.0.1' API is still allowed for supporting older versions of Applications but is deprecated. It is defined in version 2.1.1 of this Specification. The deprecated API and new API both access the same objects where applicable. While this may seem obvious for methods that have the same name across both classes (e.g. setATRHistBytes(), setCardContentState() and getCardContentState()) it shall also be noted as for example that an application that uses the update() method in the new API to change the value of the global PIN will affect the same global PIN of an application that uses the setPIN() method in the deprecated API to verify the global PIN. GlobalPlatform Specific Requirements In order to ensure the highest level of interoperability of GlobalPlatform implementations, GlobalPlatform also adopts the order defined in section 6.2 - Java CardTM 2.2.x Virtual Machine Specification. Some of the minor modifications to the standard functionality defined in the Java CardTM 2.1.1 Runtime Environment (JCRE) Specifications and the Java CardTM 2.1.1 Application Programming Interface are no longer relevant with the Java CardTM 2.2.x specifications. GPRegistryEntry objects shall be implemented as Shareable Interface Objects as defined in section 6.2.4 'Shareable Interfaces' of the Java CardTM 2.2.x Runtime Environment (JCRE) Specification in order to ensure shared access. GlobalPlatform package AID Each GlobalPlatform package AID will be a concatenation of a RID and a PIX. The AID value of the Java Card Export File for the new GlobalPlatform API (identical for both GlobalPlatform 2.1 and 2.1.1) based on the RID specified in appendix H - GlobalPlatform Data Values and Card Recognition Data is 'A00000015100'. Installation In section 3.1 - The Method install of the Java CardTM 2.2.x Runtime Environment (JCRE) Specifications, the parameters passed to the method are defined to be initialization parameters from the contents of the incoming byte array parameter. This specification expands on this requirement and further defines the content of the Install Parameters. This expansion affects both the implementation of an OPEN and the behavior of a Java Card applet developed for a GlobalPlatform card. It does not affect the definition of the install method of the Class Applet of the Java CardTM 2.2.x Application Programming Interface specification. The Install Parameters shall identify the following data, present in the INSTALL [for install] command (see section 11.5.2.3.2 - Data Field for INSTALL [for install]): * The instance AID; * The Privileges; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 161 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The Application Specific Parameters1 . The OPEN is responsible for ensuring that the parameters (bArray, bOffset and bLength) contain the following information: The array, bArray, shall contain the following consecutive LV coded data: * Length of the instance AID; * The instance AID; * Length of the Privileges; * The Privileges; * Length of the Application Specific Parameters; * The Application Specific Parameters. The byte, bOffset, shall contain an offset within the array pointing to the length of the instance AID. The byte, bLength, shall contain a length indicating the total length of the above-defined data in the array. The applet is required to utilize the instance AID as a parameter when invoking the register (byte [] bArray, short bOffset, byte bLength) method of the Class Applet of the Java CardTM 2.2.x Application Programming Interface specification. T=0 Transmission Protocol GlobalPlatform cards are intended to be functional in the widest range of environments (i.e. Card Acceptance Devices). Currently the Java CardTM 2.2.x Runtime Environment (JCRE) Specifications describe the behavior for case 2 commands (when using the T=0 protocol) in contradiction to EMV 2000. GlobalPlatform mandates that the JCRE shall handle this case of command in accordance with ISO/IEC 7816: An applet receiving a case 2 command builds the response and invokes the appropriate API to output the data. If the data is less than the data expected by the terminal, the OPEN will store the data and output a '6Cxx' response code and wait for the CAD to re-issue the command with the correct length. When the re-issued command is received the JCRE will manage the outputting of the stored data. Atomicity Unless otherwise specified all internal persistent objects of the GlobalPlatform API must conform to a transaction in progress. All operations performed by this API, except the Application.processData() method shall be executed atomically. Objects used to enforce the implementation of velocity checking shall not conform to a transaction in progress. Logical channels The following logical channel restrictions apply to Java CardTM 2.2.x (see the Java CardTM 2.2.x Runtime Environment (JCRE) Specifications for more detail): Selection of an Application on a logical channel as defined in section 6.3 - Command Dispatch will be unsuccessful if this same Application, or any other Application instantiated from code in the same package from which the 1 While the APDU command contains Install Parameters representing TLV coded system and Application Specific Parameters, the application only requires knowledge of the Application Specific Parameters i.e. only LV of the TLV coded structure `C9' are present as parameters. 162 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Application being selected was instantiated, is currently selected on another logical channel but the application code does not implement the MultiSelectable interface. Changing context from a Security Domain to an Application as defined in section 7.3.3 - Personalization Support will be unsuccessful if this same Application, or any other Application instantiated from code in the same package from which the Application being personalized was instantiated, is currently selected on another logical channel but the application code does not implement the MultiSelectable interface. An Application that has the Card Reset privilege and is intended for a card that supports Supplementary Logical Channels should implement the MultiSelectable interface. GlobalPlatform only defines the assignment of logical channel numbers by the card. Optionally and as defined in Java Card 2.2, a card may also support assignment of logical channel numbers by the terminal. Cryptographic Algorithms GlobalPlatform cards supporting RSA cryptography should support key sizes not defined as constants in the Key Builder class. More specifically support for key sizes being a multiple of 4 bytes (32 bits), and being within the allowed key lengths defined by the implementation, should be available. Level of trust The Java Card 2.2.x specifications assume that the RID of the AID of packages, applets and instances will be utilized to ensure a level of trust between these entities. In section 4.2.2 - AID Usage of the Java CardTM 2.2.1 Application Programming Interface it is defined that the RID of an AID of a component must match the RID of the AID of the package and in the definition of the register (byte [] bArray, short bOffset, byte bLength) method of the Java CardTM 2.2.x Application Programming Interface specification it is defined that an exception must be thrown if the RID portion of the AID bytes in the bArray parameter does not match the RID portion of the Java Card name of the applet. From a real world implementation point of view, mandating that the RID of the instance AID must be the same as the RID of the component from which it was instantiated, is not practical. GlobalPlatform implementations shall not mandate that there be any link through the AID of an instance to its original package. It does however assume that all applications in the same package share the same level of trust. Invocation of GlobalPlatform methods The Application Programming Interface defined herein is accessible to any Java Card applet developed with the intention of being present on a GlobalPlatform card. One limitation does exist relating to the constructor of the applet and to the install() method of the Class Applet of the Java CardTM 2.2.x Application Programming Interface. As this specification does not define exactly when the instance of an applet becomes an entry in the carďs GlobalPlatform Registry, an applet developer can only assume that this has occurred following the successful completion of the install method. To ensure interoperability, GlobalPlatform API methods that require access to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of the applet invoking the method, shall not be invoked before registering the applet. The following is a list of methods that may be invoked from within the constructor or the install() method: * getCardState; * getCVM; * getService. The required behavior of the card in the event that an Application incorrectly invokes a method of the org.globalplatform.GPSystem class other than those listed above is undefined. For example, an exception may be thrown and the processing of the install() method may be aborted. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 163 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Selection On GlobalPlatform cards, Java Card applets are requested not to fail processing the select() method (e.g. throwing an exception) nor return false from the select() method. If an error occurs during the processing of the select() method, the selection process under progress is aborted by the JCRE and a Java Card specific error is returned to the off-card entity as specified in the Java Card Runtime Environment Specifications. Such situation leaves the corresponding logical channel open with no currently selected Application. Since no Application is currently selected, any subsequent command, other than a MANAGE CHANNEL or SELECT [by name] command, will be rejected. It is expected that the off-card entity will take appropriate action on such an error, e.g. select another Application, close the corresponding logical channel, reset or power off the card. The exception is where an applet may fail the select() method if it does not support the current card interface. 164 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Class Hierarchy * class java.lang.Object - class org.globalplatform.GPSystem March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 165 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.globalplatform Class GPSystem java.lang.Object | +-org.globalplatform.GPSystem public class GPSystem extends java.lang.Object This class exposes a subset of the behavior of the OPEN to the outside world. The OPEN implements and enforces a Card Issuer's security policy relating to these services. This OPEN class provides functionality at the same level as the JCRE i.e. the "system" context with special privileges. This class's public interface is composed of static methods visible to all applets importing the globalplatform package. Field Summary final static byte APPLICATION_INSTALLED The applet Life Cycle State is INSTALLED (0x03). final static byte APPLICATION_LOCKED The applet Life Cycle State is LOCKED (0x80). final static byte APPLICATION_SELECTABLE The applet Life Cycle State is SELECTABLE (0x07). final static byte CARD_INITIALIZED The card is in the Life Cycle State of INITIALIZED (0x07). final static byte CARD_LOCKED The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_LOCKED (0x7F). final static byte CARD_OP_READY The card is in the Life Cycle State of OP_READY (0x01). final static byte CARD_SECURED The card is in the Life Cycle State of SECURED (0x0F). final static byte CARD_TERMINATED The card is in the Life Cycle State of TERMINATED (0xFF). final static byte CVM_GLOBAL_PIN Indicates that the CVM interface required is a global PIN (0x11). 166 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. final static byte FAMILY_SECURE_CHANNEL Indicates the family of the Secure Channel Global Service Identifier (0x81). final static byte FAMILY_CVM Indicates the family of the CVM Global Service Identifier (0x82). final static byte FAMILY_USSM Indicates the family of the USSM Global Service Identifier (0xA0). final static byte GLOBAL_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER Indicates the generic Global Service Identifier (0x80). final static byte SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED The current Security Domain is in the Life Cycle State of PERSONALIZED (0x0F). Method Summary static byte getCardContentState() This method returns the Life Cycle State of the current applet context. static byte getCardState() This method returns the Life Cycle State for the card. static org.globalplatform.CVM getCVM(byte bCVMIdentifier) This method returns a handle to the CVM interface. static org.globalplatform.GPRegistryEntry getRegistryEntry(javacard.framework.AID reqAID) This method returns a handle to the GPRegistryEntry interface. static org.globalplatform.SecureChannel getSecureChannel() This method returns a handle to the SecureChannel interface. static org.globalplatform.GlobalService getService(javacard.framework.AID serverAID, short sServiceName) This method returns a handle to the Global Services interface of a Global Services Application. static boolean lockCard() This method locks the card. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 167 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Method Summary static boolean setATRHistBytes(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, byte bLength) This method sets the historical bytes. static boolean setCardContentState(byte bState) This method sets the Application specific Life Cycle State of the current applet context. static boolean terminateCard() This method terminates the card. Field Detail APPLICATION_INSTALLED public static final byte APPLICATION_INSTALLED The current applet context is in the Life Cycle State of INSTALLED (0x03). Note: The Life Cycle State INSTALLED could be indicated along with another Application specific Life Cycle State e.g. a value of (0x07) indicates that the applet has been made selectable. APPLICATION_LOCKED public static final byte APPLICATION_LOCKED The current applet context is in the Life Cycle State of LOCKED (0x7F). APPLICATION_SELECTABLE public static final byte APPLICATION_SELECTABLE The current applet context is in the Life Cycle State of SELECTABLE (0x07). Note: The Life Cycle State SELECTABLE could be indicated along with another Application specific Life Cycle State. CARD_INITIALIZED 168 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. public static final byte CARD_INITIALIZED The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_INITIALIZED (0x07). CARD_LOCKED public static final byte CARD_LOCKED The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_LOCKED (0x7F). CARD_OP_READY public static final byte CARD_OP_READY The card is in the Life Cycle State of OP_READY (0x01). CARD_SECURED public static final byte CARD_SECURED The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_SECURED (0x0F). CARD_TERMINATED public static final byte CARD_TERMINATED The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_TERMINATED (0xFF). CVM_GLOBAL_PIN public static final byte CVM_GLOBAL_PIN Indicates that the CVM interface required is a global PIN (0x11). FAMILY_SECURE_CHANNEL public static final byte FAMILY_SECURE CHANNEL Indicates the family of the Secure Channel Global Service Identifier (0x81). FAMILY_CVM public static final byte FAMILY_CVM Indicates the family of the CVM Global Service Identifier (0x82). FAMILY_USSM March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 169 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. public static final byte FAMILY_USSM Indicates the family of the USSM Global Service Identifier (0XA0). GLOBAL_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER public static final byte GLOBAL_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER Indicates the generic Global Service Identifier (0x80). SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED public static final byte SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED The current Security Domain is in the Life Cycle State of PERSONALIZED (0x0F). Method Detail getCardContentState public static byte getCardContentState() This method returns the Life Cycle State of the current applet context. Notes: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current applet context in the GlobalPlatform Registry and retrieves the Life Cycle State. Returns: the Life Cycle State of the current applet context. See Also: APPLICATION_INSTALLED, APPLICATION_SELECTABLE, APPLICATION_LOCKED, SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED getCardState public static byte getCardState() This method returns the Life Cycle State of the card. Returns: the Life Cycle State of the card See Also: CARD_OP_READY, CARD_INITIALIZED, CARD_SECURED, CARD_LOCKED, CARD_TERMINATED 170 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. getCVM public static org.globalplatform.CVM getCVM(byte bCVMIdentifier) This method returns a handle to the appropriate CVM interface of a CVM Application. Notes * OPEN searches the GlobalPlatform Registry for the CVM Application that has the Global Service privilege and is uniquely registered with FAMILY_CVM and this bCVMIdentifier or is uniquely registered for the entire FAMILY_CVM; * OPEN invokes the Applet.getShareableInterfaceObject() method of the corresponding CVM Application . OPEN provides the following parameters to the Applet.getShareableInterfaceObject() method: `clientAIĎ is set to the AID of the current applet context (i.e. the requesting on-card entity) and `parameter' is set to GLOBAL_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER; * The CVM Application returns the reference of the Shareable Interface Object implementing the GlobalService interface. OPEN invokes the GlobalService.getServiceInterface() method with the following parameters: `GPRegistryEntry' is set to the GPRegistryEntry interface of the current applet context (i.e. the requesting on-card entity), `sServiceName' first byte is set to FAMILY_CVM and second byte to bCVMIdentifier, baBuffer is set to null (indicating no buffer), sOffset and sLength are set to zero; * The CVM Application returns the reference of the Shareable Interface Object implementing the CVM interface corresponding to bCVMIdentifier. This handle is then returned by OPEN to the requesting applet. Parameters: bCVMIdentifier - identifies the required CVM interface. Returns: the CVM interface object reference or Null if there is no matching CVM Interface in the GlobalPlatform Registry. See Also: CVM_GLOBAL_PIN getRegistryEntry public static org.globalplatform.GPRegistryEntry getRegistryEntry(javacard.framework.AID reqAID) This method allows an Application (e.g. a CVM) to access the GP Registry entry of another Application. If no AID is input, this method provides the GP Registry entry of the requesting Application. It returns a handle to the GPRegistryEntry interface. Notes: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 171 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The OPEN verifies that the requesting Application has the Global Registry privilege, or is the Security Domain associated with the Application being investigated, or is the investigated Application itself. Parameters: reqAID the AID object of the investigated Application, or null Returns: The GPRegistryEntry interface reference corresponding to the input AID, or null if there is no Application in the GP Registry that corresponds to the input AID or if the requesting Application is not authorized to access the corresponding GP Registry entry. getSecureChannel public static org.globalplatform.SecureChannel getSecureChannel() This method returns a handle to the SecureChannel interface. Notes: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current applet context in the GlobalPlatform Registry to determine the Application's associated Security Domain, regardless of the Security Domain Life Cycle State; * This method may be implemented using a similar mechanism as described for the getCVM method. Returns: the SecureChannel interface object reference. getService public static org.globalplatform.GlobalService getService(javacard.framework.AID serverAID, short sServiceName) This method returns a handle to the Global Services interface of a Global Services Application. Notes: * The serverAID parameter is optional: if not known by the requesting on-card entity, it is set to null; * The sServiceName parameter is mandatory. When the serverAID is Null, the OPEN searches the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Global Services Application corresponding to this unique sServiceName or to this entire service family. When the serverAID is not Null, the OPEN checks that the sServiceName or to this entire service family is recorded in the GP Registry for this serverAID; * OPEN invokes the Applet.getShareableInterfaceObject() method of the corresponding Global Services Application. OPEN provides the following parameters to the 172 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Applet.getShareableInterfaceObject() method: clientAID is set to the AID of the current applet context (i.e. the requesting on-card entity) and parameter is set to GLOBAL_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER; * The Global Services Application returns the reference of the Shareable Interface Object implementing the GlobalService interface. This handle to the GlobalService interface is then returned by OPEN to the requesting applet. Parameters: serverAID the requested Global Services Application AID or null sServiceName the requested service name Returns: the Global Service interface reference or null if there is no matching Global Services Application. lockCard public static boolean lockCard() This method locks the card. Notes: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current applet context in the GlobalPlatform Registry and verifies that the Application has the Card Lock privilege. Returns: true if card locked, false otherwise setATRHistBytes public static boolean setATRHistBytes(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, byte bLength) For contact cards according to ISO/IEC 7816-4 and Type A contactless cards according to ISO/IEC 14443-3, this method sets the historical bytes. The sequence of bytes will be visible on a subsequent power-up or reset. Notes: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current applet context in the GlobalPlatform Registry and verifies that the Application has the Card Reset privilege for the current card I/O interface; * The OPEN is responsible for synchronizing the length of historical bytes in Format Character T0 of the ATR. Parameters: baBuffer - the source byte array containing the historical bytes. Must be a global array. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 173 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. sOffset - offset of the historical bytes within the source byte array. bLength - the number of historical bytes. Returns: true if historical bytes set, false if the Application does not have the required privilege setCardContentState public static boolean setCardContentState(byte bState) This method sets the Application specific Life Cycle State of the current applet context. Application specific Life Cycle States range from 0x07 to 0x7F as long as the 3 low order bits are set. Notes: * The OPEN shall reject any transition request to the Life Cycle State INSTALLED; * The OPEN shall reject any transition request from the Life Cycle State LOCKED; * The OPEN locates the entry of the current applet context in the GlobalPlatform Registry and modifies the value of the Life Cycle State. Parameters: bState - the application specific state. Returns: true if the operation is successful, false otherwise See Also: SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED, APPLICATION_LOCKED terminateCard public static boolean terminateCard() This method terminates the card. Notes: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current applet context in the GlobalPlatform Registry and verifies that the Application has the Card Terminate privilege. Returns: true if card terminated, false otherwise 174 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Interface Hierarchy * interface javacard.framework.Shareable - interface org.globalplatform.Application - interface org.globalplatform.CVM - interface org.globalplatform.GlobalService - interface org.globalplatform.GPRegistryEntry - interface org.globalplatform.SecureChannel - interface org.globalplatform.SecureChannelx March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 175 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.globalplatform Interface Application public interface Application extends javacard.framework.Shareable This defines the interface that represents an applet method accessible through the OPEN to the Application's associated Security Domain. This interface must be implemented by the Applet class that will use the additional functionality that allows a Security Domain to pass data to the applet. Method Summary void processData(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method processes Application specific data received from another entity on the card. Method Detail processData public void processData(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method processes Application specific data received from another entity on the card. If this other entity is the Application's associated Security Domain, this data is the APDU buffer. Notes: * During the invocation the Java Card VM performs a context switch; * The applet is responsible for managing the atomicity of its own data; * As this method can be invoked by a Security Domain immaterial of the Application Life Cycle State, it is the responsibility of the applet to ensure that its current Life Cycle State is valid for this operation; * As the applet is not the selected Application, it should not use the CLEAR_ON_DESELECT when creating transient arrays. Parameters: baBuffer - the source byte array containing the data expected by the applet. This buffer must be global. sOffset - starting offset within source byte array. sLength - length of data. Throws: exceptions thrown are Application specific. 176 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.globalplatform Interface CVM public interface CVM extends javacard.framework.Shareable This defines the interface of a Global Services Application implementing one or more Cardholder Verification Methods. This class offers basic Cardholder Verification Method services (e.g. CVM verification, CVM state interrogation) to any of the Applications present on the card, while some of the services (e.g. unblock CVM, change CVM value) are restricted to Applications with the privilege to change the CVM values. Prior to using this interface, an Application is required to obtain a handle to the CVM services. The CVM application shall expose the GlobalService interface object(s) through applet.getShareableInterfaceObject() according to this specification. Field Summary final static short CVM_FAILURE The CVM value comparison failed (-1). final static short CVM_SUCCESS The CVM value comparison was successful (0). final static byte FORMAT_ASCII The CVM value is formatted as ASCII bytes (0x01). final static byte FORMAT_BCD The CVM value is formatted as numerical digits, coded on a nibble (4 bits) and left justified (0x02). final static byte FORMAT_HEX The CVM value is formatted as hexadecimal (binary) data (0x03). Method Summary boolean blockState() This method sets the state of the CVM to BLOCKED. byte getTriesRemaining() This method returns the number of tries remaining for the CVM. boolean isActive() This method indicates whether the CVM is present and activated. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 177 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. boolean isBlocked() This method indicates whether the CVM is currently BLOCKED. boolean isSubmitted() This method indicates whether an attempt has been made to compare the CVM value. boolean isVerified() This method indicates whether a successful comparison of the CVM value has occurred (CVM state of VALIDATED). boolean resetAndUnblockState() This method resets the state of the CVM from BLOCKED to ACTIVE. boolean resetState() This method resets the state of the CVM to ACTIVE. boolean setTryLimit(byte bTryLimit) This method sets the maximum number of tries for the CVM. boolean update(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, byte bLength, byte bFormat) This method changes the value of the CVM. short verify(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, byte bLength, byte bFormat) This method compares the CVM value with the value passed as a parameter. Field Detail CVM_FAILURE public static final short CVM_FAILURE The CVM value comparison failed (-1). CVM_SUCCESS public static final short CVM_SUCCESS The CVM value comparison was successful (0). FORMAT_ASCII public static final byte FORMAT_ASCII 178 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The CVM value is formatted as ASCII bytes (0x01). Note: * If the CVM value is stored in a format other than ASCII, it is the responsibility of the interface to convert to the expected format. FORMAT_BCD public static final byte FORMAT_BCD The CVM value is formatted as numerical digits, coded on a nibble (4 bits) and left justified (0x02). Note: * If the CVM value is stored in a format other than BCD, it is the responsibility of the interface to convert to the expected format; * If the length of the CVM value is uneven, the right most nibble of the CVM value shall be high values ('F'). FORMAT_HEX public static final byte FORMAT_HEX The CVM value is formatted as hexadecimal (binary) data (0x03). Note: * If the CVM value is stored in a format other than HEX, it is the responsibility of the interface to convert to the expected format. Method Detail blockState public boolean blockState() This method sets the state of the CVM to BLOCKED. Note: * The CVM Application shall verify the CVM Management privilege using the GPRegistryEntry interface of the invoking applet. Returns: true if the CVM state was set to BLOCKED, false otherwise. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 179 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. getTriesRemaining public byte getTriesRemaining() This method returns the number of tries remaining for the CVM. This indicates the number of times the CVM value can be incorrectly presented prior to the CVM reaching the state of BLOCKED. Returns: Tries remaining. isActive public boolean isActive() This method indicates whether the CVM is present and activated. If active the CVM could be in any one of the following states: ACTIVE, INVALID_SUBMISSION, VALIDATED or BLOCKED). Returns: true if the CVM state is either ACTIVE, INVALID_SUBMISSION, VALIDATED or BLOCKED, false otherwise. isBlocked public boolean isBlocked() This method indicates whether the CVM is currently BLOCKED. Returns: true if the CVM state is BLOCKED, false otherwise. isSubmitted public boolean isSubmitted() This method indicates whether an attempt has been made to compare the CVM value. Note: * This method does not differentiate whether the CVM value has been successfully verified or not i.e. CVM states of VALIDATED or INVALID_SUBMISSION. Returns: true if the CVM state is INVALID_SUBMISSION or VALIDATED, false otherwise. isVerified public boolean isVerified() 180 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This method indicates whether a successful comparison of the CVM value has occurred (CVM state of VALIDATED). Returns: true if the CVM state is VALIDATED, false otherwise. resetAndUnblockState public boolean resetAndUnblockState() This method resets the state of the CVM from BLOCKED to ACTIVE. Notes: * The CVM Application shall verify the CVM Management privilege using the GPRegistryEntry interface of the invoking applet; * The CVM Retry Counter is reset when unblocking the CVM. Returns: true if the CVM state was reset to ACTIVE, false otherwise. resetState public boolean resetState() This method resets the state of the CVM to ACTIVE. Notes: * The state of the CVM can only be set to ACTIVE from the states INVALID_SUBMISSION or VALIDATED. * The state of the CVM cannot be set to ACTIVE from the state BLOCKED. Returns: true if the CVM state was reset, false otherwise. setTryLimit public boolean setTryLimit(byte bTryLimit) This method sets the Retry Limit for the CVM. Notes: * The CVM Application shall verify the CVM Management privilege using the GPRegistryEntry interface of the invoking applet; * The CVM Retry Counter is reset when setting the maximum number of tries; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 181 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The CVM state is reset to ACTIVE when changing the maximum number of tries. When setting the maximum number of tries before the CVM state is ACTIVE, the CVM state transitions to ACTIVE only if the CVM value is already set. Parameters: bTryLimit - the Retry Limit for the CVM. Returns: true if the Retry Limit was set, false otherwise. update public boolean update(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, byte bLength, byte bFormat) This method changes the content of the CVM value. Notes: * The CVM Application shall verify the CVM Management privilege using the GPRegistryEntry interface of the invoking applet; * The invoking applet is responsible for specifying the format of the CVM value; * The CVM Retry Counter is reset when changing the CVM value; * The CVM state is reset to ACTIVE when changing the CVM value. When setting the CVM value before the CVM state is ACTIVE, the CVM state transitions to ACTIVE only if the Retry Limit is already set; * Data presented always replaces the previous data regardless of its format or length. The CVM shall remember the format, length, and value of the CVM data. The CVM may (or may not) do editing checks on the data and reject the CVM update if the data fails the editing checks (e.g. reject data that is presented as BCD that is not numerical). Parameters: baBuffer - the source byte array containing the CVM value. This buffer must be global. sOffset - the offset of the CVM value within source byte array bLength - the length of the CVM value bFormat - the format of the CVM value Returns: true if the CVM value was changed, false otherwise. 182 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. verify public short verify(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, byte bLength, byte bFormat) This method compares the stored CVM value with the CVM value passed as a parameter. Notes: * If the value passed as a parameter is not in the same format as the CVM is stored, the value passed as a parameter must be converted prior to comparing; * If HEX format is presented for CVM verification and ASCII or BCD format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails; * If HEX format is presented for CVM verification and HEX format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison succeeds when the length and the data value match exactly; * If BCD or ASCII format is presented for CVM verification and HEX format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails; * If ASCII format is presented for CVM verification and BCD format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails if the ASCII characters presented for verification are not all numerical (zero to nine). If all the ASCII characters are numerical, format conversion occurs and the comparison succeeds when the length and the data value match exactly; * If BCD format is presented for CVM verification and ASCII format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails if the CVM value contains non-numerical ASCII characters. If the CVM value contains only numerical ASCII characters, format conversion occurs and the comparison succeeds when the length and the data value match exactly; * If the comparison is successful, the Retry Counter must be reset and the CVM state must be set to VALIDATED; * If the comparison is unsuccessful, the Retry Counter must be updated and the CVM state must be set to INVALID_SUBMISSION; * The Retry Counter object and the CVM states VALIDATED and INVALID_SUBMISSION shall not conform to a transaction in progress, i.e. they shall not revert to a previous value if a transaction in progress is aborted; * If the maximum number of tries has been reached, the CVM state must be set to BLOCKED. Parameters: baBuffer - the source byte array containing the CVM. This buffer must be global. sOffset - the offset of the CVM value within source byte array bLength - the length of the CVM value bFormat - the format of the CVM value Returns: value indicating whether the comparison was successful or not. Values other than CVM_SUCCESS (0) or CVM_FAILURE (-1) are Reserved for Future Use. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 183 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.globalplatform Interface GlobalService public interface GlobalService extends javacard.framework.Shareable This defines the interface for requesting a Global Services Application to provide its actual service interface. The Global Services Application uses this interface to check the validity of the request presented by an on-card entity. Field Summary final static byte KEY_ACCESS_ANY Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain and any associated application (0x00). final static byte KEY_ACCESS_SECURITY_DOMAIN Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain but not by any associated application (0x01). final static byte KEY_ACCESS_APPLICATION Key access indicating key may be used by any associated application but not by the Security Domain (0x02). final static byte KEY_TYPE_AES Key type indicating AES (0x88). final static byte KEY_TYPE_3DES Key type indicating Triple DES reserved for specific implementations (0x81). final static byte KEY_TYPE_3DES_CBC Key type indicating Triple DES in CBC mode (0x82). final static byte KEY_TYPE_DES Key type indicating DES with ECB/CBC implicitly known (0x80). final static byte KEY_TYPE_DES_CBC Key type indicating DES in CBC mode (0x84). final static byte KEY_TYPE_DES_ECB Key type indicating DES in ECB mode (0x83). final static byte KEY_TYPE_EXTENDED Key type indicating extended key format (0xFF). 184 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. final static byte KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC implicitly known (0x90). final static byte KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1_160 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC is 160 bits (0x91). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_P Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder p component (0xA4). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_PQ Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder pq component (0xA6). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_Q Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder q component (0xA5). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DP1 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dp1 component (0xA7). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dq1 component (0xA8). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_EXPONENT Key type indicating RSA Private exponent (0xA3). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_MODULUS Key type indicating RSA Private Key modulus (0xA2). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PUBLIC_EXPONENT Key type indicating RSA Public Key exponent (0xA0). final static byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PUBLIC_MODULUS Key type indicating RSA Public Key modulus (0xA1). final static byte KEY_USAGE_COMPUTATION_DECIPHERMENT Key usage indicating computation and decipherment (0x40). final static byte KEY_USAGE_CONFIDENTIALITY Key usage indicating sensitive data confidentiality (0x08). final static byte KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_AUTHORIZATION Key usage indicating cryptographic authorization (0x01). final static byte KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_CHECKSUM Key usage indicating cryptographic checksum e.g. MAC (0x04). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 185 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. final static byte KEY_USAGE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE Key usage indicating Digital Signature (0x02). final static byte KEY_USAGE_SM_COMMAND Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in command data field (0x10). final static byte KEY_USAGE_SM_RESPONSE Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in response data field (0x20). final static byte KEY_USAGE_VERIFICATION_ENCIPHERMENT Key usage indicating verification and encipherment (0x80). Method Summary javacard.framework.shareable getServiceInterface(GPRegistryEntry clientRegistryEntry, short sServiceName, byte[ ] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method returns a handle to the requested service interface. Field Detail KEY_ACCESS_ANY public static final byte KEY_ACCESS_ANY Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain and any associated application (0x00). KEY_ACCESS_SECURITY_DOMAIN public static final byte KEY_ACCESS_SECURITY_DOMAIN Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain but not by any associated application (0x01). KEY_ACCESS_APPLICATION public static final byte KEY_ACCESS_APPLICATION Key access indicating key may be used by any associated application but not by the Security Domain (0x02). 186 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. KEY_TYPE_AES public static final byte KEY_TYPE_AES Key type indicating AES (0x88). KEY_TYPE_3DES public static final byte KEY_TYPE_3DES Key type indicating Triple DES reserved for specific implementations (0x81). KEY_TYPE_3DES_CBC public static final byte KEY_TYPE_3DES_CBC Key type indicating Triple DES in CBC mode (0x82). KEY_TYPE_DES public static final byte KEY_TYPE_DES Key type indicating DES with ECB/CBC implicitly known (0x80). KEY_TYPE_DES_CBC public static final byte KEY_TYPE_DES_CBC Key type indicating DES in CBC mode (0x84). KEY_TYPE_DES_ECB public static final byte KEY_TYPE_DES_ECB Key type indicating DES in ECB mode (0x83). KEY_TYPE_EXTENDED public static final byte KEY_TYPE_EXTENDED Key type indicating extended key format (0xFF). KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1 public static final byte KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC implicitly known (0x90). KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1_160 public static final byte KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1_160 March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 187 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC is 160 bits (0x91). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_P public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_P Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder p component (0xA4). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_PQ public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_PQ Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder pq component (0xA6). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_Q public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_Q Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder q component (0xA5). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DP1 public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DP1 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dp1 component (0xA7). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dq1 component (0xA8). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_EXPONENT public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_EXPONENT Key type indicating RSA Private exponent (0xA3). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_MODULUS public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_MODULUS Key type indicating RSA Private Key modulus (0xA2). KEY_TYPE_RSA_PUBLIC_EXPONENT public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PUBLIC_EXPONENT Key type indicating RSA Public Key exponent (0xA0). 188 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PUBLIC_MODULUS public static final byte KEY_TYPE_RSA_PUBLIC_MODULUS Key type indicating RSA Public Key modulus (0xA1). KEY_USAGE_COMPUTATION_DECIPHERMENT public static final byte KEY_USAGE_COMPUTATION_DECIPHERMENT Key usage indicating computation and decipherment (0x40). KEY_USAGE_CONFIDENTIALITY public static final byte KEY_USAGE_CONFIDENTIALITY Key usage indicating sensitive data confidentiality (0x08). KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_AUTHORIZATION public static final byte KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_AUTHORIZATION Key usage indicating cryptographic authorization (0x01). KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_CHECKSUM public static final byte KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_CHECKSUM Key usage indicating cryptographic checksum e.g. MAC (0x04). KEY_USAGE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE public static final byte KEY_USAGE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE Key usage indicating Digital Signature (0x02). KEY_USAGE_SM_COMMAND public static final byte KEY_USAGE_SM_COMMAND Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in command data field (0x10). KEY_USAGE_SM_RESPONSE public static final byte KEY_USAGE_SM_RESPONSE Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in response data field (0x20). KEY_USAGE_VERIFICATION_ENCIPHERMENT March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 189 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. public static final byte KEY_USAGE_VERIFICATION_ENCIPHERMENT Key usage indicating verification and encipherment (0x80). Method Detail getServiceInterface public javacard.framework.shareable getServiceInterface(GPRegistryEntry clientRegistryEntry, short sServiceName, byte[ ] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method returns a handle to the requested service interface of a Global Services Application. Notes: * The Global Services Application verifies the validity of the request according to its own security policies for this sServiceName and based on the identity of the requesting on-card entity and its characteristics as registered in the clientRegistryEntry; * On a valid service request, the Global Service Application returns the reference of the Shareable Interface Object implementing the actual service: this Shareable Interface Object may either be this Global Service interface or another Java Card shareable interface; * Depending on its own security policy, the Global Service Application may reject an invalid service request by either throwing an exception or just returning Null. Parameters: clientRegistryEntry the GP Registry entry reference of the requesting on-card entity sServiceName the requested service name baBuffer the source byte array containing additional parameters of the service request sOffset offset of the additional request parameters within the source byte array sLength length of the additional request parameters Returns: the specific service interface reference or null Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason codes: * ISO7816.SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED * ISO7816.SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED 190 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.GlobalPlatform Interface GPRegistryEntry public interface GPRegistryEntry extends javacard.framework.Shareable This defines the interface corresponding to the GPRegistryEntry of a single Application. Field Summary final static byte PRIVILEGE_AUTHORIZED_MANAGEMENT Privilege number for Authorized Management (0x09). final static byte PRIVILEGE_CARD_LOCK Privilege number for Card Lock (0x03). final static byte PRIVILEGE_CARD_RESET Privilege number for Card Reset (0x05). final static byte PRIVILEGE_CARD_TERMINATE Privilege number for Card Terminate (0x04). final static byte PRIVILEGE_CVM_MANAGEMENT Privilege number for CVM Management (0x06). final static byte PRIVILEGE_DAP_VERIFICATION Privilege number for DAP verification (0x01). final static byte PRIVILEGE_DELEGATED_MANAGEMENT Privilege number for Delegated Management (0x02). final static byte PRIVILEGE_FINAL_APPLICATION Privilege number for Final Application (0x0E). final static byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_DELETE Privilege number for Global Delete (0x0B). final static byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_LOCK Privilege number for Global Lock (0x0C). final static byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_REGISTRY Privilege number for Global Registry (0x0D). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 191 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. final static byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_SERVICE Privilege number for Global Service (0x0F). final static byte PRIVILEGE_MANDATED_DAP Privilege number for Mandated DAP verification (0x07). final static byte PRIVILEGE_RECEIPT_GENERATION Privilege number for Receipt Generation (0x10). final static byte PRIVILEGE_SECURITY_DOMAIN Privilege number for application being a Security Domain (0x00). final static byte PRIVILEGE_TOKEN_VERIFICATION Privilege number for Token Verification (0x0A). final static byte PRIVILEGE_TRUSTED_PATH Privilege number for Trusted Path (0x08). Method Summary void deregisterService(short sServiceName) This method deregisters a service name. javacard.framework.AID getAID() This method provides the AID of the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. short getPrivileges(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset) This method retrieves the Privileges for the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. byte getState() This method retrieves the Life Cycle State for the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. boolean isAssociated(javacard.framework.AID SDAID) This method checks the association between an Application and a Security Domain. boolean isPrivileged(byte bPrivilege) This method checks the privilege of an Application. void registerService(short sServiceName) This method registers a unique service name. 192 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. boolean setState (byte bState) This method sets the Life Cycle state of an Application. Field Detail PRIVILEGE_AUTHORIZED_MANAGEMENT public static final byte PRIVILEGE_AUTHORIZED_MANAGEMENT Privilege number for Authorized Management (0x00). PRIVILEGE_CARD_LOCK public static final byte PRIVILEGE_CARD_LOCK Privilege number for Card Lock (0x03). PRIVILEGE_CARD_RESET public static final byte PRIVILEGE_CARD_RESET Privilege number for Card Reset (0x05). PRIVILEGE_CARD_TERMINATE public static final byte PRIVILEGE_CARD_TERMINATE Privilege number for Card Terminate (0x04). PRIVILEGE_CVM_MANAGEMENT public static final byte PRIVILEGE_CVM_MANAGEMENT Privilege number for CVM Management (0x06). PRIVILEGE_DAP_VERIFICATION public static final byte PRIVILEGE_DAP_VERIFICATION Privilege number for DAP verification (0x01). PRIVILEGE_DELEGATED_MANAGEMENT public static final byte PRIVILEGE_DELEGATED_MANAGEMENT March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 193 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Privilege number for Delegated Management (0x06). PRIVILEGE_FINAL_APPLICATION public static final byte PRIVILEGE_FINAL_APPLICATION Privilege number for Final Application (0x0E). PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_DELETE public static final byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_DELETE Privilege number for Global Delete (0x0B). PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_LOCK public static final byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_LOCK Privilege number for Global Lock (0x0C). PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_REGISTRY public static final byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_REGISTRY Privilege number for Global Registry (0x0D). PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_SERVICE public static final byte PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_SERVICE Privilege number for Global Service (0x0F). PRIVILEGE_MANDATED_DAP public static final byte PRIVILEGE_MANDATED_DAP Privilege number for Mandated DAP verification (0x07). PRIVILEGE_RECEIPT_GENERATION public static final byte PRIVILEGE_RECEIPT_GENERATION Privilege number for Receipt Generation (0x07). PRIVILEGE_SECURITY_DOMAIN public static final byte PRIVILEGE_SECURITY_DOMAIN Privilege number for application being a Security Domain (0x00). 194 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. PRIVILEGE_TOKEN_VERIFICATION public static final byte PRIVILEGE_TOKEN_VERIFICATION Privilege number for Token Verification (0x0A). PRIVILEGE_TRUSTED_PATH public static final byte PRIVILEGE_TRUSTED_PATH Privilege number for Trusted Path (0x08). Method Detail deregisterService public void deregisterService(short sServiceName) This method allows a Global Services Application (e.g. a CVM Application) to deregister a service name. Notes: * The OPEN checks that the requesting on-card entity has the Global Service Privilege and is associated with this registry entry; * The OPEN checks that the service name is registered as unique for the requesting on-card entity. Parameters: serviceName the unique service name to deregister Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason codes: * ISO7816.SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED getAID public javacard.framework.AID getAID() This method returns the Application's AID registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry's entry. Returns: the AID object March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 195 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. getPrivileges public short getPrivileges (byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset) This method returns all the Privileges bytes registered in the current GlobalPlatform registry entry. Parameters: baBuffer The byte array where Privileges bytes are to be stored sOffset The offset in baBuffer at which to begin the Privileges bytes Returns: sOffset + Length of the Privileges. Throws: java.lang.ArrayIndexOutOfBoundsException - if storing the Privileges bytes would cause access outside array bounds or the sOffset is negative. getState public byte getState () This method returns the Life Cycle State registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry. Returns: The Life Cycle State as defined in section 11.1.1. isAssociated public boolean isAssociated(javacard.framework.AID SDAID) This method allows to verify if the entity whose AID is provided in the input parameters is registered as the associated Security Domain of this GPRegistryEntry. Notes: * The OPEN determines if the SDAID is registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry's entry as the associated Security Domain. Parameters: SDAID the AID object of the investigated Security Domain 196 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Returns: True if the GP Registry references the Security Domain as being associated with this GPRegistryEntry, or False otherwise. isPrivileged public boolean isPrivileged(byte bPrivilege) This method allows an Application (e.g. a CVM Application) to verify if a given Privilege is registered in this GPRegistryEntry (e.g. check the CVM Management privilege of another Application invoking the CVM.update() method). Parameters: bPrivilege the privilege number to verify, as defined in Table 6-1. Returns: True if at least the referenced Privilege is registered in the GP Registry entry, or False if the referenced Privilege is not registered in the GP Registry entry. registerService public void registerService(short sServiceName) This method allows a Global Services Application (e.g. a CVM Application) to register a unique service name. Notes: * The OPEN checks that the requesting on-card entity has the Global Service Privilege and is associated with the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry; * The OPEN checks that the requested service name matches with (one of) the Service Parameter(s) recorded in the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry; * The OPEN checks that the service name is not already registered as unique by any other entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry. Parameters: sServiceId the unique service identifier to register Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason codes: * ISO7816.SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 197 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. setState public boolean setState(byte bState) This method allows the Life Cycle state of this GPRegistryEntry to be transitioned to the requested target state. Notes: * A transition request to the Life Cycle State INSTALLED shall be rejected; * A transition request to Life Cycle state other than APPLICATION_LOCKED and APPLICATION_UNLOCKED shall be accepted only if the invoking Application corresponds to this GPRegistryEntry; * An Application shall be able to lock and shall not be able to unlock itself; * Only an Application with GlobalLock privilege or the directly or indirectly associated Security Domain of this GPRegistryEntry shall be able to lock or unlock this GPRegistry Entry; * This method shall fail if this GPRegistryEntry corresponds to the Issuer Security Domain. Parameters: bState the target state for this GPRegistryEntry Returns: True if the transition is successful, or False otherwise. 198 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.globalplatform Interface SecureChannel public interface SecureChannel extends javacard.framework.Shareable This defines an interface to be used by an Application that may want to delegate the handling of entity authentication and APDU security to its associated Security Domain. This interface is designed to offer interoperability to the Application in that it requires no knowledge of the mechanisms used to perform the authentication or of the scheme used for APDU security and shall allow an Application to interface correctly with a Security Domain immaterial of the mechanisms or schemes used. Prior to using this interface, an Application is required to obtain a handle to its associated Security Domain's SecureChannel interface object by invoking the GPSystem.getSecureChannel() method. The SecureChannel interface shall only be exposed through the GPSystem.getSecureChannel() method. In all cases where the Application passes the APDU buffer as a parameter to the Security Domain, the class byte of the APDU shall not be modified. This ensures that the Security Domain knows the logical channel number. If the card supports logical channels, it is the responsibility of the Security Domain to correctly manage the logical channel information when processing the APDU. See also SecureChannelx interface. Field Summary final static byte ANY_AUTHENTICATED The off-card entity has been authenticated but not as the provider of this Application (0x40) final static byte AUTHENTICATED The off-card entity has been authenticated as the provider of this Application (0x80). final static byte C_DECRYPTION The unwrap method will decrypt incoming command data (0x02). final static byte C_MAC The unwrap method will verify the MAC on an incoming command (0x01). final static byte NO_SECURITY_LEVEL Entity Authentication has not occurred (0x00). final static byte R_ENCRYPTION The wrap method will encrypt the outgoing response data (0x20). final static byte R_MAC The wrap method will generate a MAC for outgoing response data (0x10). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 199 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Method Summary short decryptData(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method is used to decrypt data located in the input buffer. short encryptData(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method is used to encrypt data located in the input buffer. byte getSecurityLevel() This method is used to determine whether the Security Domain has performed authentication and to determine what level of security will be applied by the wrap() and unwrap() methods. short processSecurity(javacard.framework.APDU apdu) Processes security related APDU commands. void resetSecurity() This method is used to reset information relating to the current Secure Channel Session. short unwrap(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method is used to process and verify the secure messaging of an incoming command according to the security level. short wrap(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) This method is used to apply additional security processing to outgoing response data and status bytes according to the security level. Field Detail ANY_AUTHENTICATED public static final byte ANY_AUTHENTICATED The off-card entity has been authenticated but not as the provider of this Application (0x40). Note: * Entity authentication and the level of security that will be applied by the wrap and unwrap methods are not necessarily related. A Security Domain, by default, could verify the MAC on any command passed as a parameter in the unwrap() method without entity authentication previously having occurred AUTHENTICATED 200 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. public static final byte AUTHENTICATED The off-card entity has been authenticated as the provider of this Application (0x80). Note: * Entity authentication and the level of security that will be applied by the wrap and unwrap methods are not necessarily related. A Security Domain, by default, could verify the MAC on any command passed as a parameter in the unwrap() method without entity authentication previously having occurred C_DECRYPTION public static final byte C_DECRYPTION The unwrap method will decrypt incoming command data (0x02). Note: * Command data decryption could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security. C_MAC public static final byte C_MAC The unwrap method will verify the MAC on an incoming command (0x01). Note: * MAC verification could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security e.g. a value of '03' indicates that while entity authentication has not occurred, the unwrap() method will decrypt the command data of incoming commands and verify the MAC on incoming commands. NO_SECURITY_LEVEL public static final byte NO_SECURITY_LEVEL Entity authentication has not occurred (0x00). Notes: * This indicates that no Secure Channel Session is active, or that a security error has occurred during the current Secure Channel Session, or that the previous Secure Channel Session was aborted during the same Application Session; * Entity authentication and the level of security that will be applied by the wrap and unwrap methods are not necessarily related. A Security Domain, by default, could verify the MAC on any command passed as a parameter in the unwrap() method without entity authentication previously having occurred; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 201 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The wrap and unwrap methods will not apply any cryptographic processing to command or response data. R_ENCRYPTION public static final byte R_ENCRYPTION The wrap method will encrypt the outgoing response data (0x20). Note: * Response data encryption could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security. R_MAC public static final byte R_MAC The wrap method will generate a MAC for the outgoing response data (0x10). Note: * MAC generation could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security e.g. a value of '91' indicates that entity authentication has occurred and that the unwrap() method will verify the MAC on incoming commands and that the wrap() method will generate a MAC on outgoing response data Method Detail decryptData public short decryptData(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) throws javacard.framework.ISOException This method is used to decrypt data located in the input buffer. Notes: * Processing this method shall comply to the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * The Security Domain implicitly knows the key used for decryption; * The Security Domain is implicitly aware of any padding that may be present in the decrypted data according to the Secure Channel Protocol and the eventual padding is discarded; * The clear text data replaces the ciphered data within the byte array; * The applet is responsible for checking the integrity of the decrypted data; 202 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * A Secure Channel Session shall be opened and a sensitive data decryption key shall be available; * This method fails if a Secure Channel Session is not open (i.e. Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL) or if the corresponding session keys are not available. Parameters: baBuffer - the source byte array. This buffer must be global. sOffset - offset within the source byte array to start the decryption. sLength - the number of bytes to decrypt. Returns: The length of the clear text data. Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason codes: * ISO7816.SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED if a Secure Channel Session has not been opened. * ISO7816.SW_WRONG_LENGTH if the length of data to be decrypted is not valid. encryptData public short encryptData(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) throws java.lang.ArrayIndexOutOfBoundsException javacard.framework.ISOException This method is used to encrypt data located in the input buffer. Notes: * Processing this method shall comply to the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * The Security Domain is implicitly aware of any padding that must be applied to the clear text data prior to encryption according to the Secure Channel Protocol; * The Security Domain implicitly knows the key used for encryption; * The ciphered data replaces the clear text data within the byte array; * A Secure Channel Session shall be opened and a sensitive data encryption key shall be available; * This method fails if a Secure Channel Session is not open (i.e. Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL) or if the corresponding session keys are not available. Parameters: baBuffer - the source byte array. This buffer must be global. sOffset - offset within the source byte array to start the encryption. sLength - the number of bytes to encrypt. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 203 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Returns: The length of the encrypted data. Throws: * java.lang.ArrayIndexOutOfBoundsException - if enciphering would cause access outside array bounds. * ISO7816.SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED if a Secure Channel Session is not open. getSecurityLevel public byte getSecurityLevel() This method returns, from the requester's standpoint, the Current Security Level coded as a bit-map according to Table 10-1 indicating whether entity authentication has occurred and what level of security is currently applicable to command and response messages processed by the unwrap() and wrap() methods. Notes: * Applets must invoke this method to ensure that application specific security requirements have been previously met or will be enforced by the Security Domain; * More than one level of security may be active and these may change during a Secure Channel Session e.g. an R_MAC session may be initiated during a C_MAC session; * The Current Security Level may be different at the same time for an Application invoking the method and its associated Security Domain depending on the Secure Channel Protocol and the authenticated off-card entity's Application Provider ID (e.g. it may be ANY_AUTHENTICATED for the application and AUTHENTICATED for its associated Security Domain). Returns: * The Current Security Level. processSecurity public short processSecurity(javacard.framework.APDU apdu) throws javacard.framework.ISOException Processes security related APDU commands. This method is used by an applet to process APDU commands that possibly relate to the security mechanism used by the Security Domain. As the intention is to allow an Application to be associated with a Security Domain without having any knowledge of the security mechanisms used by the Security Domain, the applet assumes that APDU commands that it does not recognize are part of the security mechanism and will be recognized by the Security Domain. The applet can either invoke this method prior to determining if it recognizes the command or only invoke this method for commands it does not recognize. The method sets the compulsory Session Security Level that is established at Secure Channel initiation and which is required for the whole Secure Channel Session. On successful initialization of the Secure Channel Session, the Current Security Level is set to the same value as the compulsory Session Security Level. The Current Security 204 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Level is updated (R-MAC or not) on the successful processing of the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION / END R-MAC SESSION commands. Notes: * Processing this method shall comply to the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * The method is responsible for receiving the data field of commands that are recognized; * The applet is responsible for recognizing commands that the method refused to process ('6E00' and '6D00'); * The applet is responsible for outputting status bytes returned due to the processing of instructions recognized by the method; * If response data is present, this data will be placed in the APDU buffer at offset ISO7816.OFFSET_CDATA. The return code indicates the length and the applet is responsible for outputting this data. Parameters: apdu - the incoming APDU object Returns: the number of bytes to be output Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason codes (other security mechanism related status bytes may be returned): * ISO7816.SW_CLA_NOT_SUPPORTED if class byte is not recognized by the method; * ISO7816.SW_INS_NOT_SUPPORTED if instruction byte is not recognized by the method. resetSecurity public void resetSecurity() This method is used to reset all information relating to the current Secure Channel Session. It resets both the compulsory Session Security Level and the Current Security Level to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, terminates the current Secure Channel Session and erases all session keys. Notes: * It is strongly recommended that applets using the services of a Security Domain invoke this method in the Applet.deselect() method; * The Security Domain will reset all information relating to the current Secure Channel Session i.e. all Secure Channel session keys, state information and security level information will be erased; * This method shall not fail if no Secure Channel Session is open (i.e. Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 205 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. unwrap public short unwrap(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) throws javacard.framework.ISOException This method is used to process and verify the secure messaging of an incoming command according to the Current Security Level and Session Security Level of the current Secure Channel Session. Notes: * Processing this method shall comply to the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * If NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED only is indicated, when complying to the Secure Channel Protocol rules, this method will not attempt any secure messaging processing on the incoming command, the incoming command will remain as is within the incoming APDU object and the returned length of the "unwrapped" data is set to the value of the sLength parameter, otherwise a security error is returned; * If the class byte does not indicate secure messaging (according to ISO/IEC 7816-4), this method will not attempt any secure messaging processing on the incoming command and the incoming command will remain as is within the incoming APDU object. When complying with the Secure Channel Protocol rules, the returned length of the "unwrapped" data is set to the value of the sLength parameter otherwise a security error is returned; * The applet is responsible for receiving the data field of the command; * Correct secure messaging processing of the unwrap() will result in the incoming command being reformatted within the incoming APDU object with all data relating to the secure messaging removed. A reformatted case 1 or case 2 command will include an Lc byte set to zero; * If R_MAC is indicated in the Current Security Level of the Secure Channel Session, once secure messaging processing of the incoming command has successfully completed, R-MAC computation on the reformatted command (i.e. after all the data relating to secure messaging has been removed) will be initiated. If no secure messaging processing was required for the incoming command, R-MAC computation will be initiated on the unmodified incoming command, appended with a Lc byte of zero in event of a case 1 or case 2 command; * Incorrect processing of the unwrap() will result in the information relating to the current Secure Channel being reset; * This method does not fail if a Secure Channel Session is not open (that is, when Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL) or if the corresponding session keys are not available; * The method fails if the secure messaging of the incoming command is not successfully verified or does not match the Current Security Level (as defined either as the compulsory Session Security Level set at initialization of the Secure Channel Session or as the Current Security Level set by the setSecurityLevel() method). If the method fails, the Current Security Level is reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, but not the compulsory Session Security Level. Parameters: baBuffer - the source of the data to be wrapped. This buffer must be global sOffset - the offset within the source buffer of the data to unwrap sLength - the length of the data to unwrap 206 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Returns: the length of the unwrapped data i.e. the length of the command header and data field Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason code (other security mechanism related status bytes may be returned): * ISO7816.SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED if secure messaging verification failed. * ISO7816.SW_CLA_NOT_SUPPORTED if class byte is not recognized by the method. wrap public short wrap(byte[] baBuffer, short sOffset, short sLength) throws java.lang.ArrayIndexOutOfBoundsException, javacard.framework.ISOException. This method applies secure messaging to the current outgoing response according to the Current Security Level and Session Security Level of the Secure Channel Session. Notes: * Processing this method shall comply to the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * This method attempts secure messaging processing of the current outgoing response when the Current Security Level indicates R_MAC and/or R_ENCRYPTION; * If the Current Security Level does not indicate R_MAC and/or R_ENCRYPTION, when complying with the Secure Channel Protocol rules, this method will do no processing and the outgoing response message will remain as is in the APDU object. The returned length of the "wrapped" data is set to the value of the sLength parameter minus 2 (indicating the status bytes are no longer present at the end of the returned data); * The applet is responsible for appending the expected status bytes at the end of the response data in order for them to be protected by secure messaging; * The returned data does not include the status bytes; * The method fails if the secure messaging of the incoming command is not successfully verified or does not match the Current Security Level (as defined either as the compulsory Session Security Level set at initialization of the Secure Channel Session or as the Current Security Level set by the setSecurityLevel() method). If the method fails, the Current Security Level is reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, but not the compulsory Session Security Level; * This method does not fail if a Secure Channel Session is not open (that is, when Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL) or if the corresponding session keys are not available. Parameters: baBuffer - the source of the data to be wrapped, with the status bytes included at the end. This buffer must be global. sOffset - the offset within the source buffer of the data to wrap March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 207 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. sLength - the length of the data to wrap Note: * The length Li of the Response Data Field is automatically calculated by the Security Domain and prepended to the Response Data Field for computation of the R-MAC. Returns: new length of wrapped data (i.e. the length of the response data field to be transmitted) Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException ­ if security mechanism related status bytes might be returned java.lang.ArrayIndexOutOfBoundsException - if wrapping would cause access of data outside array bounds 208 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. org.globalplatform Interface SecureChannelx public interface SecureChannelx extends org.globalplatform.SecureChannel This defines an interface which extends SecureChannel Interface and includes a supplementary method. See SecureChannel interface for a description of the underlying interface. Prior to using this interface, an Application is required to obtain a handle to its associated Security Domain's SecureChannelx interface object by invoking the GPSystem.getSecureChannel() method and casting the returned object to type SecureChannelx. The SecureChannelx Interface shall be implemented by a Security Domain compliant to this version of the specification and the corresponding object reference shall be exposed through the GPSystem.getSecureChannel() method. Method Summary void setSecurityLevel(byte bSecurityLevel) This method updates the Current Security Level for all subsequent invocations of the wrap() and unwrap() methods, except when a Secure Channel Session is not active or was aborted during the same Application session. Method Detail setSecurityLevel public void setSecurityLevel(byte bSecurityLevel) This method updates the Current Security Level for all subsequent invocations of the wrap() and unwrap() methods, except when a Secure Channel Session is not active or was aborted during the same Application session. Current Security Level is coded as a bit-map according to Table 10-1. The Current Security Level cannot be set below the compulsory Session Security Level, but only equal or above. The Current Security Level may be increased or decreased during a Secure Channel Session as long as it is at least equal to the compulsory Session Security Level. Notes: * The method fails if a Secure Channel Session is not open, if the corresponding session keys are not available or if the Current Security Level is equal to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. Parameters: SecurityLevel - the Current Security Level to be set Throws: javacard.framework.ISOException - with the following reason codes: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 209 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * ISO7816.SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED 210 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. A.2 GlobalPlatform on MULTOSTM A.2.1 Glossary of Terms Term Definition AAM Application Abstract Machine, another term for runtime environment. The AAM is the virtual machine that executes MEL applications. Application Load Certificate A digital certificate that provides card issuers with the authority to load an Application onto a MULTOS smart card. Public The name of a memory segment provided by the MULTOS AAM to MEL Applications. Public is visible to all Applications on a MULTOS smart card. On receiving a command MULTOS places the command APDU in Public prior to invoking an Application; Applications place their response APDU in Public for transmission by MULTOS. The bottom of Public is pointed to by the address register Public Base, normally abbreviated to PB; the top of Public is pointed to by the address register Public Top, normally abbreviated to PT. The byte at the bottom of Public has the tagged address PB[0]; the byte at the top of Public has the tagged address PT[-1]. The top seventeen bytes of Public (i.e. the addresses PT[-17] ... PT[-1]) are reserved for storing the command APDU header, response status bytes and other information related to APDU exchange. Segment address The sixteen-bit virtual address assigned to an item of data by the MULTOS AAM (q.v. tagged address). Tagged address The address of an item of data when represented using the syntax Address register[Offset from address register] (q.v. segment address). Table A-1: Glossary of Terms A.2.2 GlobalPlatform Specific Requirements A.2.2.1 Environment A GlobalPlatform on MULTOS smart card contains a minimum of two applications: * A "Command Dispatcher" application. This application provides the command dispatch services specified in section 6.3. This application has the AID `A000000144475031'; * A "Card Manager Services Provider" application. This application provides the Card Manager services specified in section 6.2. This application has the AID `A000000144475032'. These two applications provide MEL Applications loaded by card issuers with a GlobalPlatform runtime environment. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 211 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. A.2.2.2 Application Life Cycle States When an Application is loaded onto a GlobalPlatform for MULTOS smart card its initial Life Cycle State is SELECTABLE. This reflects the fact that a MEL Application is able to receive commands from off-card entities as soon as it has been loaded onto a card. When a Security Domain is loaded onto a GlobalPlatform for MULTOS smart card its initial Life Cycle State is SELECTABLE. A.2.2.3 Privileges When an Application is loaded onto a GlobalPlatform for MULTOS smart card it does not have any privileges. Once an Application has been loaded its privileges can be changed using the INSTALL [for registry update] command. A.2.2.4 Registration An Application should register itself with the Card Manager. This registration is performed using the registerApplication() function. A.2.3 Accessing Card Manager Services A.2.3.1 Introduction This section describes the mechanism used by MEL Applications to access Card Manager services. The description assumes the existence of a generic Card Manager service S having N input parameters p1 ... pN and returning a value r. The interface to this service can be described using the following C programming language syntax: tr S (tp1 p1, tp2 p2, ..., tpN-1 pN-1, tpN pN); Parameters: p1 ­ A parameter of type tp1. The size of this parameter is sp1 bytes. p2 ­ A parameter of type tp2. The size of this parameter is sp2 bytes. . . . pN-1 - A parameter of type tpN-1. The size of this parameter is spN-1 bytes. pN - A parameter of type tpN. The size of this parameter is spN bytes. Returns: A value of type tr. The size of this value is sr bytes. If the type represented by tr is void then sr is zero. A.2.3.2 The "Card Manager services interface buffer" A MEL Application must be able to exchange data with the Card Manager when requesting a service. Therefore, an area of the MULTOS Public memory segment is reserved in order to allow: * A MEL Application requesting Card Manager services to specify both the requested service and the value of any associated parameters; 212 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The Card Manager to return the SCode status condition for the requested service and any return value. Figure A-1 : Public and the "Card Manager services interface buffer" illustrates the relationship of this reserved area of Public, the "Card Manager services interface buffer", to the rest of Public. APDU command header, Lc field, Le field, response status and other fields related to APDU exchange PT [ 0 ] 17 bytes PT [ -17 ] PB [ Lc ] Lc bytes PB [ 0 ] APDU command data Card Manager services interface buffer Figure A-1 : Public and the "Card Manager services interface buffer" When a MEL Application requests a Card Manager service the "Card Manager services interface buffer" is structured according to the following table. Name Description Address Source Size (bytes) Service The Card Manager service requested by the Application. PT[-19] Application 2 SCode The status condition reported by the Card Manager as a result of its attempt to provide the service requested by the Application. PT[-21] Card Manager 2 pN The value of the Nth parameter associated with the service. PT[-21 - spN] Application spN March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 213 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Description Address Source Size (bytes) pN-1 The value of the N-1th parameter associated with the service. PT[-21 - spN - spN-1] Application spN-1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p2 The value of the second parameter associated with the service. PT[-21 - spN - spN-1 - ... - sp2] Application Sp2 p1 The value of the first parameter associated with the service. PT[-21 - spN - spN-1 - ... - sp2 - sp1] Application Sp1 r The return value for the service. PT[-21 - sr] Card Manager Sr Table A-2 : Structure of the "Card Manager services interface buffer" The field Service in the "Card Manager services interface buffer" identifies the Card Manager service requested by the MEL Application. The Card Manager services are exposed to an Application via the interfaces described in section A.2.4. The mapping of these interfaces to values of Service is shown in the following table. Card Manager Service Module Function Service decryptData() `0101' encryptData() `0102' getSecurityLevel() `0103' processSecurity() `0104' resetSecurity() `0105' unwrap() `0106' wrap() `0107' Secure Channel setSecurityLevel() `0108' getCardContentState() `0201' getCardState() `0202' getCVM() `0203' lockCard() `0204' registerApplication() `0205' setATRHistBytes() `0206' setCardContentState() `0207' GPSystem terminateCard() `0208' 214 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Card Manager Service Module Function Service getRegistryEntry() `0209' getService() `020A' blockState() `0301' getTriesRemaining() `0302' isActive() `0303' isBlocked() `0304' isSubmitted() `0305' isVerified() `0306' resetState() `0307' resetAndUnblockState() `0308' setTryLimit() `0309' update() `030A' CVM verify() `030B' deregisterService() `0401' getAID() `0402' getPrivileges() `0403' getState() `0404' isAssociated() `0405' isPrivileged() `0406' registerService() `0407' GPRegistryEntry setState() '0408' GlobalService getServiceInterface() `0501' Table A-3 : Encoding of Service A.2.3.3 Requesting Card Manager services In order for a MEL Application to request a Card Manager service the Application must: * Populate the "Card Manager services interface buffer" with arguments that identify the requested Card Manager service and the value of any associated parameters p1 ... pN; * Invoke the MULTOS Delegate primitive, specifying the AID of the "Card Manager Services Provider" application as the identifier of the delegate application; * Where necessary, examine the value SCode returned in the "Card Manager services interface buffer"; * Where appropriate, examine the value r returned in the "Card Manager services interface buffer". A.2.4 API A.2.4.1 Programming Language The API to the Card Manager services is specified using the syntax of the programming language C as defined by [9899]; the API is presented as a set of C function prototype declarators. Within this API: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 215 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The elements bool, false and true are assumed to have the definitions specified in the header; * The element NULL is assumed to have the definition specified in the header. A.2.4.2 Header file The function prototype declarators specified in this chapter shall be declared in a header globalplatform.h. A.2.4.3 Representation of Types The API makes some assumptions regarding the representation of types. These assumptions are stated in the following table. Type, T sizeof (T) Other Assumptions bool 1 unsigned short int 2 ­ AID Objects of this type do not contain any padding, either within or at the end of the object *AID 2 The type "pointer to AID" represents a MULTOS AAM segment address. CVM_HANDLE Objects of this type do not contain any padding, either within or at the end of the object *CVM_HANDLE 2 The type "pointer to CVM_HANDLE" represents a MULTOS AAM segment address. Table A-4: Types A.2.4.4 Location of APDUs The API assumes that command and response APDUs reside in the MULTOS Public memory segment. This memory segment may be regarded as being defined as: static unsigned char ucaPublic[PUBLICSIZE]; where: * The element PUBLICSIZE represents the size in bytes of the MULTOS Public memory segment for a particular MULTOS implementation; * The expression &ucaPublic[0] has the value of the MULTOS AAM segment address corresponding to the tagged address PB[0]. A.2.4.5 Module Summary The following modules implement the individual functions: 216 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Status * SecureChannel * GPSystem * CVM * GPRegistryEntry * GlobalService A.2.4.6 Status This module defines an interface to allow an Application to interrogate the status condition of the most recent API function invocation. Function Summary SCode unsigned short int SCode(void); This function returns the status condition of the API function most recently invoked by the Application. SetSCode void SetSCode(unsigned short int usStatusCode); This function may be used by an Application or API function to set the status condition returned by a subsequent invocation of the SCode() function. Enumeration Detail ISO7816 enum ISO7816 { SW_CLA_NOT_SUPPORTED = 0x6E00, SW_COMMAND_NOT_ALLOWED = 0x6986, SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED = 0x6985, SW_CORRECT_LENGTH_00 = 0x6C00, SW_DATA_INVALID = 0x6984, SW_FILE_FULL = 0x6A84, SW_FILE_INVALID = 0x6983, SW_FILE_NOT_FOUND = 0x6A82, SW_FUNC_NOT_SUPPORTED = 0x6A81, SW_INCORRECT_P1P2 = 0x6A86, SW_INS_NOT_SUPPORTED = 0x6D00, SW_LOGICAL_CHANNEL_NOT_SUPPORTED = 0x6881, SW_NO_ERROR = 0x9000, March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 217 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SW_RECORD_NOT_FOUND = 0x6A83, SW_SECURE_MESSAGING_NOT_SUPPORTED = 0x6882, SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED = 0x6982, SW_UNKNOWN = 0x6F00, SW_WARNING_STATE_UNCHANGED = 0x6200, SW_WRONG_DATA = 0x6A80, SW_WRONG_LENGTH = 0x6700, SW_WRONG_P1P2 = 0x6B00 }; This enumeration defines enumeration constants used to represent ISO/IEC 7816 response status values defined in this specification. Function Detail SCode unsigned short int SCode(void); This function returns the status condition of the API function most recently invoked by the Application. Notes: * An invocation of this function does not affect the status condition returned by subsequent invocations of this function; * The status condition returned by this function may have the same value as an enumeration constant of the enumeration ISO7816. Returns: If the Application has not invoked an API function since it was selected then SW_NO_ERROR otherwise the status condition of the API function most recently invoked by the Application. SetSCode void SetSCode(unsigned short int usStatusCode); This function may be used by an Application or API function to set the status condition returned by a subsequent invocation of the SCode() function. Parameter: usStatusCode ­ Status condition. A.2.4.7 SecureChannel This module defines an interface to be used by an Application that may want to delegate the handling of entity authentication and APDU security to its associated Security Domain. This interface is designed to offer interoperability to the Application in that it requires no knowledge of the mechanisms used to perform the authentication or of the scheme used for APDU security and shall allow an Application to interface correctly with a Security Domain immaterial of the mechanisms or schemes used. If the card supports logical channels, it is the responsibility of the Security Domain to correctly manage the logical channel information when processing the APDU. 218 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Constant Summary #define ANY_AUTHENTICATED 0x40 The off-card entity has been authenticated but not as the provider of this Application. #define AUTHENTICATED 0x80 The off-card entity has been authenticated as the provider of this Application. #define C_DECRYPTION 0x02 The unwrap() function will decrypt incoming command data. #define C_MAC 0x01 The unwrap() function will verify the MAC on an incoming command. #define NO_SECURITY_LEVEL 0x00 Entity Authentication has not occurred. #define R_ENCRYPTION 0x20 The wrap() function will encrypt the outgoing response data. #define R_MAC 0x10 The wrap() function will generate a MAC for outgoing response data. Function Summary unsigned short int decryptData(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function is used to decrypt data located in the MULTOS Public memory segment. unsigned short int encryptData(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function is used to encrypt data located in the MULTOS Public memory segment. unsigned char getSecurityLevel(void); This function is used to determine whether the Security Domain has performed authentication and to determine what level of security will be applied by the wrap() and unwrap() functions. unsigned short int processSecurity(void); Processes security related APDU commands. void resetSecurity(void); This function is used to reset information relating to the current Secure Channel Session. void setSecurityLevel(unsigned char ucSecurityLevel); This function is used to set the level of security to be applied by the wrap() and unwrap() functions for the next command - response pair. unsigned short int unwrap(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 219 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This function is used to process and verify the secure messaging of an incoming command according to the security level. unsigned short int wrap(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function is used to apply additional security processing to outgoing response data and status bytes according to the security level. Constant Detail ANY_AUTHENTICATED #define ANY_AUTHENTICATED 0x40 Note: * Entity authentication and the level of security that will be applied by the wrap() and unwrap() functions are not necessarily related. A Security Domain, by default, could verify the MAC on any command passed as a parameter in the unwrap() function without entity authentication previously having occurred. AUTHENTICATED #define AUTHENTICATED 0x80 The off-card entity has been authenticated as the provider of this Application. Note: * Entity authentication and the level of security that will be applied by the wrap() and unwrap() functions are not necessarily related. A Security Domain, by default, could verify the MAC on any command passed as a parameter in the unwrap() function without entity authentication previously having occurred. C_DECRYPTION #define C_DECRYPTION 0x02 The unwrap() function will decrypt incoming command data. Note: * Command data decryption could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security. C_MAC #define C_MAC 0x01 The unwrap() function will verify the MAC on an incoming command. Note: * MAC verification could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security e.g. a value of '03' indicates that while entity authentication has not occurred, the unwrap() function will decrypt the command data of incoming commands and verify the MAC on incoming commands. R_ENCRYPTION #define R_ENCRYPTION 0x20 The wrap() function will encrypt the outgoing response data. 220 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Note: Response data encryption could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security. R_MAC #define R_MAC 0x10 The wrap() function will generate a MAC for the outgoing response data. Note: * MAC generation could be indicated along with entity authentication and one or more levels of security e.g. a value of '91' indicates that entity authentication has occurred and that the unwrap() function will verify the MAC on incoming commands and that the wrap() function will generate a MAC on outgoing response data. NO_SECURITY_LEVEL #define NO_SECURITY_LEVEL 0x00 Entity authentication has not occurred. Notes: * This indicates that no Secure Channel Session is active, or that a security error has occurred during the current Secure Channel Session, or that the previous Secure Channel Session was aborted during the same Application Session); * Entity authentication and the level of security that will be applied by the wrap and unwrap functions are not necessarily related. A Security Domain, by default, could verify the MAC on any command passed as a parameter in the unwrap() function without entity authentication previously having occurred; * The wrap() and unwrap() functions will not apply any cryptographic processing to command or response data. Function Detail processSecurity unsigned short int processSecurity(void); This function processes security related APDU commands. This function is used by an Application to process APDU commands that possibly relate to the security mechanism used by the Security Domain. As the intention is to allow an Application to be associated with a Security Domain without having any knowledge of the security mechanisms used by the Security Domain, the Application assumes that APDU commands that it does not recognize are part of the security mechanism and will be recognized by the Security Domain. The Application can either invoke this function prior to determining if it recognizes the command or only invoke this function for commands it does not recognize. The function sets the compulsory Session Security Level that is established at Secure Channel initiation and which is required for the whole Secure Channel Session. On successful initialization of the Secure Channel Session, the Current Security Level is set to the same value as the compulsory Session Security Level. The Current Security Level is updated (R-MAC or not) on the successful processing of the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION / END R-MAC SESSION commands. Notes: * The processing performed by this function shall comply with the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 221 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The function is responsible for receiving the data field of commands that are recognized; * The Application is responsible for recognizing commands that the function refused to process ('6E00' and '6D00'); * The Application is responsible for outputting status bytes returned due to the processing of instructions recognized by the function; * If response data is present, this data will be placed in the MULTOS Public memory segment at offset zero. The return code indicates the length and the Application is responsible for outputting this data. Returns: The number of bytes to be output. SCode(): May return one of the following status codes (other security mechanism related status codes may be returned): * SW_CLA_NOT_SUPPORTED if class byte is not recognized by the function; * SW_INS_NOT_SUPPORTED if instruction byte is not recognized by the function; * SW_NO_ERROR if the command was processed successfully by the function. wrap unsigned short int wrap(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function applies secure messaging to the current outgoing response according to the Current Security Level and Session Security Level of the Secure Channel Session. Notes: * The processing performed by this function shall comply with the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * This function attempts secure messaging processing of the current outgoing response when the Current Security Level indicates R_MAC and/or R_ENCRYPTION; * If the Current Security Level does not indicate R_MAC and/or R_ENCRYPTION, when complying with the Secure Channel Protocol rules, this function will do no processing and the outgoing response message will remain as is in the MULTOS Public memory segment. The returned length of the "wrapped" data is set to the value of the usLength parameter minus 2 (indicating the status words are no longer present at the end of the returned data); * The Application is responsible for appending the expected status words at the end of the response data in order for them to be protected by secure messaging; * The returned data does not include the status words; * The function fails if the secure messaging of the incoming command is not successfully verified or does not match the Current Security Level (as defined either as the compulsory Session Security Level set at initialization of the Secure Channel Session or as the Current Security Level set by the setSecurityLevel() function). If the function fails, the Current Security Level is reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, but not the compulsory Session Security Level; * ˇ This function does not fail if a Secure Channel Session is not open (that is, when Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL) or if the corresponding session keys are not available; 222 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Normally the MULTOS Public memory segment address range PB[0]...PT[-17] is available for outgoing response data. However, for this function the address range is restricted to PB[0]...PT[-23]. Parameters: usOffset - The offset within the MULTOS Public memory segment of the data to wrap. usLength - The length of the data to wrap. Returns: New length of wrapped data (i.e. the length of the response data field to be transmitted). SCode(): May return one of the following: * A security mechanism related status; * SW_NO_ERROR if the data was processed successfully by the wrap() function. unwrap unsigned short int unwrap(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function is used to process and verify the secure messaging of an incoming command according to the Current Security Level and Session Security Level of the current Secure Channel Session. Notes: * The processing performed by this function shall comply with the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * If NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED only is indicated, this function will not attempt any secure messaging processing on the incoming command and the incoming command will remain as is within the MULTOS Public memory segment. The returned length of the "unwrapped" data is set to the value of the usLength parameter; * If the class byte does not indicate secure messaging (according to ISO/IEC 7816-4), this function will not attempt any secure messaging processing on the incoming command and the incoming command will remain as is within the MULTOS Public memory segment. When complying with the Secure Channel Protocol rules, the returned length of the "unwrapped" data is set to the value of the usLength parameter otherwise a security error is returned; * The Application is responsible for receiving the data field of the command; * Correct secure messaging processing of the unwrap() will result in the incoming command being reformatted within the MULTOS Public memory segment with all data relating to the secure messaging removed. A reformatted case 1 or case 2 command will include an Lc byte set to zero; * If R_MAC is indicated in the Current Security Level of the Secure Channel Session, once secure messaging processing of the incoming command has successfully completed, R-MAC computation on the reformatted command (i.e. after all the data relating to secure messaging has been removed) will be initiated. If no secure messaging processing was required for the incoming command, R-MAC computation will be initiated on the unmodified incoming command, appended with a Lc byte of zero in event of a case 1 or case 2 command; * Incorrect processing of the unwrap() will result in the information relating to the current Secure Channel being reset; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 223 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Normally the MULTOS Public memory segment address range PB[0]...PT[-17] is available for incoming command data. However, for this function the address range is restricted to PB[0]...PT[-23]. Parameters: usOffset - The offset within the MULTOS Public memory segment of the data to unwrap. usLength - The length of the data to unwrap. Returns: The length of the unwrapped data i.e. the length of the command data. SCode(): May return one of the following status codes (other security mechanism related status codes may be returned): * SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED if secure messaging verification failed; * SW_CLA_NOT_SUPPORTED if class byte is not recognized by the function; * SW_NO_ERROR if the command was processed successfully by the function. decryptData unsigned short int decryptData(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function is used to decrypt data located in the MULTOS Public memory segment. Notes: * The processing performed by this function shall comply with the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * The Security Domain implicitly knows the key used for decryption; * The Security Domain is implicitly aware of any padding that may be present in the decrypted data according to the Secure Channel Protocol and the eventual padding is discarded; * The clear text data replaces the encrypted data within the MULTOS Public memory segment; * The Application is responsible for checking the integrity of the decrypted data; * No part of either the encrypted data or the decrypted data should reside outside the MULTOS Public memory segment address range PB[0]... PT[-23]. Parameters: usOffset - Offset within the MULTOS Public memory segment to start the decryption. usLength - The number of bytes to decrypt. Returns: The length of the clear text data. SCode(): May return one of the following status codes: * SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED if a Secure Channel Session has not been opened; 224 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * SW_WRONG_LENGTH if the length of data to be decrypted is not valid; * SW_NO_ERROR if the encrypted data was processed successfully by the decryptData() function. encryptData unsigned short int encryptData(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned short int usLength); This function is used to encrypt data located in the MULTOS Public memory segment. Notes: * The processing performed by this function shall comply with the rules of the Secure Channel Protocol implemented by the Security Domain; * The Security Domain is implicitly aware of any padding that must be applied to the clear text data prior to encryption according to the Secure Channel Protocol; * The Security Domain implicitly knows the key used for encryption; * The encrypted data replaces the clear text data within the MULTOS Public memory segment; * No part of either the clear text data or the encrypted data should reside outside the MULTOS Public memory segment address range PB[0]... PT[-23]. Parameters: usOffset - Offset within the MULTOS Public memory segment to start the encryption. usLength - The number of bytes to encrypt. Returns: The length of the encrypted data. SCode(): May return one of the following status codes: * SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED if a Secure Channel Session has not been opened. * SW_NO_ERROR if the data was processed successfully by the encryptData() function. resetSecurity void resetSecurity(void); This function is used to reset all information relating to the current Secure Channel Session. It resets both the compulsory Session Security Level and the Current Security Level to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, terminates the current Secure Channel Session and erases all session keys. Notes: * When an Application using the services of a Security Domain is de-selected the OPEN will invoke the resetSecurity() function on behalf of the Application; * The Security Domain will reset all information relating to the current Secure Channel Session i.e. all Secure Channel Session keys, state information and Security Level information will be erased; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 225 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * This function shall not fail if no Secure Channel Session is open (i.e. Session Security Level = NO_SECURITY_LEVEL). setSecurityLevel void setSecurityLevel(unsigned char ucSecurityLevel); This function updates the Current Security Level for all subsequent invocations of the wrap() and unwrap() functions, except when a Secure Channel Session is not active or was aborted during the same Application session. Current Security Level is coded as a bit-map according to Table 10-1. The Current Security Level cannot be set below the compulsory Session Security Level, but only equal or above. The Current Security Level may be increased or decreased during a Secure Channel Session as long as it is at least equal to the compulsory Session Security Level. Notes: * The function fails if a Secure Channel Session is not open, if the corresponding session keys are not available or if the Current Security Level is equal to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. Parameters: ucSecurityLevel - The Current Security Level to be set. SCode(): May return the following status code: * SW_CONDITIONS_OF_USE_NOT_SATISFIED getSecurityLevel unsigned char getSecurityLevel(void); This function returns the Current Security Level coded as a bit-map according to section 10.6 indicating whether entity authentication has occurred and what level of security is currently applicable to command and response messages processed by the wrap() and unwrap() functions. Notes: * Applications must invoke this function to ensure that Application specific security requirements have been previously met or will be enforced by the Security Domain; * More than one level of security may be active and these may change during a Secure Channel Session, e.g. an R_MAC session may be initiated during a C_MAC session. Returns: The Current Security Level. A.2.4.8 GPSystem The System module exposes a subset of the behavior of the OPEN to the outside world. The OPEN implements and enforces a Card Issuer's security policy relating to these services. This OPEN module provides functionality at the same level as the run-time environment i.e. the "system" context with special privileges. Constant Summary #define APPLICATION_INSTALLED 0x03 226 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The current Application is in the Life Cycle State of INSTALLED. #define APPLICATION_LOCKED 0x80 The current Application is in the Life Cycle State of LOCKED. #define APPLICATION_UNLOCKED 0x7F The current Application is in its previous State. #define APPLICATION_SELECTABLE 0x07 The current Application is in the Life Cycle State of SELECTABLE. #define CARD_OP_READY 0x01 The card is in the Life Cycle State of OP_READY. #define CARD_INITIALIZED 0x07 The card is in the Life Cycle State of INITIALIZED. #define CARD_LOCKED 0x7F The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_LOCKED. #define CARD_SECURED 0x0F The card is in the Life Cycle State of SECURED. #define CARD_TERMINATED 0xFF The card is in the Life Cycle State of TERMINATED. #define CVM_GLOBAL_PIN 0x11 Indicates that the CVM interface required is a global PIN. #define FAMILY_SECURE_CHANNEL 0x81 Indicates the family of the Secure Channel Global Service Identifier. #define FAMILY_CVM 0x82 Indicates the family of the CVM Global Service Identifier. #define FAMILY_USSM 0xA0 Indicates the family of the USSM Global Service Identifier. #define FAMILY_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER 0x80 Indicates the family of the Secure Channel Global Service Identifier. #define SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED 0x0F The current Security Domain is in the Life Cycle State of PERSONALIZED. Type Summary AID typedef struct tagAID { unsigned char ApplicationIdentifierLength; char ApplicationIdentifier[]; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 227 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. } AID; This type represents an ISO/IEC 7816-4 AID. CVM_HANDLE typedef struct tagCVM_HANDLE { unsigned char CVMIdentifierLength; char CVMIdentifier[]; } CVM_HANDLE; This type represents a handle to a CVM interface. GPRE_HANDLE typedef unsigned short GPRE_HANDLE; This type represents a handle to a GlobalPlatform Registry entry. SERVICE_HANDLE typedef unsigned short SERVICE_HANDLE; This type represents a handle to the services interface of a Global Services Application. Function Summary unsigned char getCardContentState(void) This function returns the Life Cycle State of the current Application. unsigned char getCardState(void) This function returns the Life Cycle State for the card. CVM_HANDLE *getCVM(unsigned char ucCVMIdentifier) This function returns a handle to a CVM Application. GPRE_HANDLE getRegistryEntry(const AID *reqAID) This function returns a handle to a GlobalPlatform Registry entry. AID *getService(const AID *serverAID, unsigned short usServiceName) This function returns the AID of a Global Services Application. bool lockCard(void); This function locks the card. bool registerApplication(const AID *pSDIdentifier); This function registers a MEL Application with the Card Manager. bool setATRHistBytes(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned char ucLength); This function sets the historical bytes, for contact cards according to ISO/IEC 7816-4 and for Type A contactless cards according to ISO/IEC 14443-3. bool setCardContentState(unsigned char ucState); This function sets the Application specific Life Cycle State of the current Application. bool terminateCard(void); 228 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This function terminates the card. Constant Detail APPLICATION_INSTALLED #define APPLICATION_INSTALLED 0x03 The current Application is in the Life Cycle State of INSTALLED. Note: * The Life Cycle State INSTALLED could be indicated along with another Application specific Life Cycle State e.g. a value of '07' indicates that the Application has been made selectable. APPLICATION_LOCKED #define APPLICATION_LOCKED 0x80 The current Application is in the Life Cycle State of LOCKED. APPLICATION_UNLOCKED #define APPLICATION_UNLOCKED 0x7F The current Application is in its previous State. APPLICATION_SELECTABLE #define APPLICATION_SELECTABLE 0x07 The current Application is in the Life Cycle State of SELECTABLE. Note: * The Life Cycle State SELECTABLE could be indicated along with another Application specific Life Cycle State. SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED #define SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED 0x0F The current Security Domain is in the Life Cycle State of PERSONALIZED. CARD_OP_READY #define CARD_OP_READY 0x01 The card is in the Life Cycle State of OP_READY. CARD_INITIALIZED #define CARD_INITIALIZED 0x07 The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_INITIALIZED. CARD_SECURED #define CARD_SECURED 0x0F The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_SECURED. CARD_LOCKED #define CARD_LOCKED 0x7F The card is in the Life Cycle State of CARD_LOCKED. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 229 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. CARD_TERMINATED #define CARD_TERMINATED 0xFF The card is in the Life Cycle State of TERMINATED. CVM_GLOBAL_PIN #define CVM_GLOBAL_PIN 0x11 Indicates that the CVM interface required is a global PIN. #define FAMILY_SECURE_CHANNEL 0x81 Indicates the family of the Secure Channel Global Service Identifier. #define FAMILY_CVM 0x82 Indicates the family of the CVM Global Service Identifier. #define FAMILY_USSM 0xA0 Indicates the family of the USSM Global Service Identifier. #define FAMILY_SERVICE_IDENTIFIER 0x80 Indicates the family of the Secure Channel Global Service Identifier. #define SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED 0x0F The current Security Domain is in the Life Cycle State of PERSONALIZED. Type Detail AID typedef struct tagAID { unsigned char ApplicationIdentifierLength; char ApplicationIdentifier[]; } AID; This type represents an ISO/IEC 7816-4 AID. CVM_HANDLE typedef struct tagCVM_HANDLE { unsigned char CVMIdentifierLength; char CVMIdentifier[]; } CVM_HANDLE; This type represents a handle to a CVM interface. GPRE_HANDLE typedef unsigned short GPRE_HANDLE; This type represents a handle to a GlobalPlatform Registry entry. SERVICE_HANDLE typedef unsigned short SERVICE_HANDLE; 230 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This type represents a handle to the services interface of a Global Services Application. Function Detail getCardContentState unsigned char getCardContentState(void); This function returns the Life Cycle State of the current Application. Note: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current Application in the GlobalPlatform Registry and retrieves the Life Cycle State. Returns: The Life Cycle State of the current Application. See Also: APPLICATION_INSTALLED, APPLICATION_SELECTABLE, APPLICATION_LOCKED, SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZED getCardState unsigned char getCardState(void); This function returns the Life Cycle State for the card. Returns: The Life Cycle State of the card. See Also: CARD_OP_READY, CARD_INITIALIZED, CARD_SECURED, CARD_LOCKED, CARD_TERMINATED getCVM CVM_HANDLE *getCVM(unsigned char ucCVMIdentifier) This function returns a handle to a CVM Application. Notes: * The OPEN searches the GlobalPlatform Registry for the CVM Application that has the Global Service privilege and is either: - Uniquely registered with service family FAMILY_CVM and service identifier ucCVMIdentifier; or - Registered for the entire service family FAMILY_CVM. * If the search is successful then the OPEN invokes the getServiceInterface() function of the CVM Application the with the following parameters: - hClientRegistryEntry set to identify the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of the the requesting on-card entity; - sServiceName with first byte set to FAMILY_CVM (indicating the CVM family) and second byte set to ucCVMIdentifier; - usOffset and usLength set to zero. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 231 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * If the search and the invocation of the getServiceInterface() function are successful then the OPEN returns the AID of the corresponding CVM Application as a handle. If either is unsuccessful then the OPEN returns NULL. Parameters: ucCVMIdentifier - Identifies the required CVM interface. Returns: The handle to the required CVM Application or NULL if there is no matching CVM Application. See Also: CVM_GLOBAL_PIN getRegistryEntry GPRE_HANDLE getRegistryEntry(const AID *reqAID); This function allows an Application (e.g. a CVM) to access the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of another Application. If no AID is input, this function provides the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of the requesting Application. It returns a handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. Notes: * The OPEN verifies that the requesting Application has the Global Registry privilege, or is the Security Domain associated to the Application being investigated, or is the investigated Application itself. Parameters: reqAID - The AID of the investigated Application, or NULL. Returns: The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry corresponding to the input AID, or NULL if there is no Application in the GlobalPlatform Registry that corresponds to the input AID or if the requesting Application is not authorized to access the corresponding GlobalPlatform Registry entry. getService AID *getService(const AID *serverAID, unsigned short usServiceName); This function returns the AID of a Global Services Application. Notes: * The serverAID parameter is optional: if not known by the requesting on-card entity then it is set to NULL; * The usServiceName parameter is mandatory. When serverAID is NULL the OPEN searches the GlobalPlatform Registry for the Global Services Application corresponding to either the unique service usServiceName or to this entire service family. When serverAID is not NULL the OPEN searches the GlobalPlatform Registry for a Global Services Application serverAID where usServiceName either: - Matches exactly with a service name recorded for the Global Services Application serverAID; or - Corresponds to an entire service family recorded for the Global Services Application serverAID. * If the search is successful then the OPEN returns the AID of the corresponding Global Services Application. If the search is unsuccessful then the OPEN returns NULL. Parameters: 232 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. serverAID - The requested Global Services Application AID. usServiceName - The requested service name. Returns: The AID of the Global Services Application or NULL if there is no matching Global Services Application. lockCard bool lockCard(void); This function locks the card. Note: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current Application in the GlobalPlatform Registry and verifies that the Application has the Card Lock privilege. Returns: true if card locked, false otherwise. terminateCard bool terminateCard(void); This function terminates the card. Note: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current Application in the GlobalPlatform Registry and verifies that the Application has the Card Terminate privilege. Returns: true if card terminated, false otherwise. setATRHistBytes bool setATRHistBytes(unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned char ucLength); This function sets the historical bytes, for contact cards according to ISO/IEC 7816-4 and for Type A contactless cards according to ISO/IEC 14443-3. The sequence of bytes will be visible on a subsequent power-up or reset. Notes: * The OPEN locates the entry of the current Application in the GlobalPlatform Registry and verifies that the Application has the Card Reset privilege for the current card interface; * The OPEN is responsible for synchronizing the length of historical bytes in Format Character T0 of the ATR. Parameters: usOffset - Offset of the historical bytes within the MULTOS Public memory segment. ucLength - The number of historical bytes. Returns: true if historical bytes set, false if the Application does not have the required privilege. setCardContentState bool setCardContentState(unsigned char ucState); March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 233 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This function sets the Application specific Life Cycle State of the current Application. Application specific Life Cycle States range from '07' to '80' as long as the three low order bits are set. Notes: * The OPEN shall reject any transition request to the Life Cycle States INSTALLED; * The OPEN shall reject any transition request from the Life Cycle State LOCKED; * The OPEN locates the entry of the current Application in the GlobalPlatform Registry and modifies the value of the Life Cycle State. Parameters: ucState - The Application specific state. Returns: true if the operation is successful, false otherwise. See Also: SECURITY_DOMAIN_PERSONALIZE, APPLICATION_LOCKED registerApplication bool registerApplication(const AID *pSDIdentifier); This function registers a MEL Application with the Card Manager. Note: * An Application should invoke the registerApplication() function prior to invoking any other Card Manager functions. An Application need only invoke the registerApplication() function once during its Life Cycle; * Unless and until an Application invokes the registerApplication() function the Card Manager will assume that the Application is associated with the Issuer Security Domain and does not have the Card Reset privilege. Parameters: pSDIdentifier - Identifies the Security Domain associated with the Application. Returns: true if the Application was registered successfully, false otherwise. A.2.4.9 CVM This defines the interface of a Global Services Application implementing one or more Cardholder Verification Methods. This module offers basic Cardholder Verification Method services (e.g. CVM verification, CVM state interrogation) to any of the Applications present on the card, while some of the services (e.g. unblock CVM, change CVM value) are restricted to Applications with the privilege to change the CVM values. Prior to using this interface, an Application is required to obtain a handle to the CVM services. Constant Summary #define CVM_FAILURE -1 The CVM value comparison failed. 234 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. #define CVM_SUCCESS 0 The CVM value comparison was successful. #define FORMAT_ASCII 0x01 The CVM value is formatted as ASCII bytes. #define FORMAT_BCD 0x02 The CVM value is formatted as numerical digits, coded on a nibble (four bits) and left justified. #define FORMAT_HEX 0x03 The CVM value is formatted as hexadecimal (binary) data. Function Summary bool blockState(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function sets the state of the CVM to BLOCKED. unsigned char getTriesRemaining(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function returns the number of tries remaining for the CVM. bool isActive(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether the CVM is present and activated. bool isBlocked(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether the CVM is currently BLOCKED. bool isSubmitted(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether an attempt has been made to compare the CVM value. bool isVerified(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether a successful comparison of the CVM value has occurred (CVM state of VALIDATED). bool resetState(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function resets the state of the CVM to ACTIVE. bool resetAndUnblockState(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function resets the state of the CVM from BLOCKED to ACTIVE. bool setTryLimit(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM, unsigned char ucTryLimit); This function sets the maximum number of tries for the CVM. bool update(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM, unsigned char[] ucaBuffer, unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned char ucLength, unsigned char ucFormat); This function changes the value of the CVM. unsigned short int verify(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM, unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned char ucLength, unsigned char ucFormat); This function compares the CVM value with the value passed as a parameter. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 235 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Constant Detail CVM_FAILURE #define CVM_FAILURE -1 The CVM value comparison failed. CVM_SUCCESS #define CVM_SUCCESS 0 The CVM value comparison was successful. FORMAT_ASCII #define FORMAT_ASCII 0x01 The CVM value is formatted as ASCII bytes. Note: * If the CVM value is stored in a format other than ASCII, it is the responsibility of the interface to convert to the expected format. FORMAT_BCD #define FORMAT_BCD 0x02 The CVM value is formatted as numerical digits, coded on a nibble (four bits) and left justified. Note: * If the CVM value is stored in a format other than BCD, it is the responsibility of the interface to convert to the expected format; * If the length of the CVM value is uneven, the right most nibble of the CVM value shall be high values ('F'). FORMAT_HEX #define FORMAT_HEX 0x03 The CVM value is formatted as hexadecimal (binary) data. Note: * If the CVM value is stored in a format other than HEX, it is the responsibility of the interface to convert to the expected format. Function Detail isActive bool isActive(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM) This function indicates whether the CVM is present and activated. If active the CVM could be in any one of the following states: ACTIVE, INVALID_SUBMISSION, VALIDATED or BLOCKED. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: true if the CVM state is either ACTIVE, INVALID_SUBMISSION, VALIDATED or BLOCKED, false otherwise). 236 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. isSubmitted bool isSubmitted(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether an attempt has been made to compare the CVM value. Note: * This function does not differentiate whether the CVM value has been successfully verified or not i.e. CVM states of VALIDATED or INVALID_SUBMISSION. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: true if the CVM state is (at least) INVALID_SUBMISSION, false otherwise. isVerified bool isVerified(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether a successful comparison of the CVM value has occurred (CVM state of VALIDATED). Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: true if the CVM state is VALIDATED, false otherwise. isBlocked bool isBlocked(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function indicates whether the CVM is currently BLOCKED. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: true if the CVM state is BLOCKED, false otherwise. getTriesRemaining unsigned char getTriesRemaining(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM) This function returns the number of tries remaining for the CVM. This indicates the number of times the CVM value can be incorrectly presented prior to the CVM reaching the state of BLOCKED. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: Tries remaining. update bool update(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM, unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned char ucLength, unsigned char ucFormat) March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 237 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This function changes the content of the CVM value. Notes: * The CVM Application verifies that the client Application has the CVM Management privilege; * The client Application is responsible for specifying the format of the CVM value; * The CVM Retry Counter is reset when changing the CVM value; * The CVM state is reset to ACTIVE when changing the CVM value; * Data presented always replaces the previous data regardless of its format or length. The CVM shall remember the format, length, and value of the CVM data. The CVM may (or may not) do editing checks on the data and reject the CVM update if the data fails the editing checks (e.g. reject data that is presented as BCD that is not numerical). Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. usOffset - The offset of the CVM value within the MULTOS Public memory segment. ucLength - The length of the CVM value. ucFormat - The format of the CVM value. Returns: true if the CVM value was changed, false otherwise. resetState bool resetState(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function resets the state of the CVM to ACTIVE. Notes: * The state of the CVM can only be set to ACTIVE from the states INVALID_SUBMISSION or VALIDATED; * The state of the CVM cannot be set to ACTIVE from the state BLOCKED. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: true if the CVM state was reset, false otherwise. blockState bool blockState(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function sets the state of the CVM to BLOCKED. Note: * The CVM Application verifies that the client Application has the CVM Management privilege. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: 238 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. true if the CVM state was set to BLOCKED, false otherwise. resetAndUnblockState bool resetAndUnblockState(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM); This function resets the state of the CVM from BLOCKED to ACTIVE. Notes: * The CVM Application verifies that the client Application has the CVM Management privilege; * The CVM Retry Counter is reset when unblocking the CVM. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. Returns: true if the CVM state was reset to ACTIVE, false otherwise. setTryLimit bool setTryLimit(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM, unsigned char ucTryLimit) This function sets the Retry Limit for the CVM. Notes: * The CVM Application verifies that the client Application has the CVM Management privilege; * The CVM Retry Counter is reset when setting the maximum number of tries; * The CVM state is reset to ACTIVE when setting the maximum number of tries. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. ucTryLimit - The Retry Limit for the CVM. Returns: true if the Retry Limit was set, false otherwise. verify unsigned short int verify(const CVM_HANDLE *hCVM, unsigned short int usOffset, unsigned char ucLength, unsigned char ucFormat) This function compares the stored CVM value with the CVM value passed as a parameter. Notes: * If the value passed as a parameter is not in the same format as the CVM is stored, the value passed as a parameter must be converted prior to comparing; * If HEX format is presented for CVM verification and ASCII or BCD format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails; * If HEX format is presented for CVM verification and HEX format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison succeeds when the length and the data value match exactly; * If BCD or ASCII format is presented for CVM verification and HEX format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 239 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * If ASCII format is presented for CVM verification and BCD format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails if the ASCII characters presented for verification are not all numerical (zero to nine). If all the ASCII characters are numerical, format conversion occurs and the comparison succeeds when the length and the data value match exactly; * If BCD format is presented for CVM verification and ASCII format was used for updating the CVM value, the comparison fails if the CVM value contains non-numerical ASCII characters. If the CVM value contains only numerical ASCII characters, format conversion occurs and the comparison succeeds when the length and the data value match exactly; * If the comparison is successful, the Retry Counter must be reset and the CVM state must be set to VALIDATED; * If the comparison is unsuccessful, the Retry Counter must be updated and the CVM state must be set to INVALID_SUBMISSION; * The Retry Counter object and the CVM states VALIDATED and INVALID_SUBMISSION shall not conform to a transaction in progress, i.e. they shall not revert to a previous value if a transaction in progress is aborted; * If the maximum number of tries has been reached, the CVM state must be set to BLOCKED. Parameters: hCVM - The handle to the CVM services. usOffset ­ The offset of the CVM value within the MULTOS Public memory segment. ucLength - The length of the CVM value. ucFormat - The format of the CVM value. Returns: Value indicating whether the comparison was successful or not. Values other than CVM_SUCCESS or CVM_FAILURE are Reserved for Future Use. A.2.4.10 GPRegistryEntry Constant Summary #define PRIVILEGE_AUTHORIZED_MANAGEMENT 0x09 Privilege number for Authorized Management. #define PRIVILEGE_CARD_LOCK 0x03 Privilege number for Card Lock. #define PRIVILEGE_CARD_RESET 0x05 Privilege number for Card Reset. #define PRIVILEGE_CARD_TERMINATE 0x04 Privilege number for Card Terminate. #define PRIVILEGE_CVM_MANAGEMENT 0x06 Privilege number for CVM Management. #define PRIVILEGE_DAP_VERIFICATION 0x01 Privilege number for DAP Verification. 240 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. #define PRIVILEGE_DELEGATED_MANAGEMENT 0x02 Privilege number for Delegated Management. #define PRIVILEGE_FINAL_APPLICATION 0x0E Privilege number for Final Application. #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_DELETE 0x0B Privilege number for Global Delete. #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_LOCK 0x0C Privilege number for Global Lock. #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_REGISTRY 0x0D Privilege number for Global Registry. #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_SERVICE 0x0F Privilege number for Global Service. #define PRIVILEGE_MANDATED_DAP 0x07 Privilege number for Mandated DAP verification. #define PRIVILEGE_RECEIPT_GENERATION 0x10 Privilege number for Receipt Generation. #define PRIVILEGE_SECURITY_DOMAIN 0x00 Privilege number for application is a Security Domain. #define PRIVILEGE_TOKEN_VERIFICATION 0x0A Privilege number for Token Verification. #define PRIVILEGE_TRUSTED_PATH 0x08 Privilege number for Trusted Path. Function Summary void deregisterService(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned short int usServiceName); This function deregisters a service name. AID *getAID(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE); This function provides the AID of the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. unsigned short int getPrivileges(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE,unsigned char *ucBuffer, unsigned short int usOffset); This function retrieves the Privileges for the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. unsigned char getState(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE); This function retrieves the Life Cycle State for the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. bool isAssociated(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, const AID *SDAID); This function checks the association between an Application and a Security Domain. bool isPrivileged(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned char ucPrivilege); March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 241 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This function checks the privilege of an Application. void registerService(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned short int usServiceName); This function registers a unique service name. boolean setState(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned char ucState); This method sets the Life Cycle state of an Application. Constant Detail PRIVILEGE_AUTHORIZED_MANAGEMENT #define PRIVILEGE_AUTHORIZED_MANAGEMENT 0x09 Privilege number for Authorized Management. PRIVILEGE_CARD_LOCK #define PRIVILEGE_CARD_LOCK 0x03 Privilege number for Card Lock. PRIVILEGE_CARD_RESET #define PRIVILEGE_CARD_RESET 0x05 Privilege number for Card Reset. PRIVILEGE_CARD_TERMINATE #define PRIVILEGE_CARD_TERMINATE 0x04 Privilege number for Card Terminate. PRIVILEGE_CVM_MANAGEMENT #define PRIVILEGE_CVM_MANAGEMENT 0x06 Privilege number for CVM Management. PRIVILEGE_DAP_VERIFICATION #define PRIVILEGE_DAP_VERIFICATION 0x01 Privilege number for DAP Verification. PRIVILEGE_DELEGATED_MANAGEMENT #define PRIVILEGE_DELEGATED_MANAGEMENT 0x02 Privilege number for Delegated Management. PRIVILEGE_FINAL_APPLICATION #define PRIVILEGE_FINAL_APPLICATION 0x0E Privilege number for Final Application. PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_DELETE #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_DELETE 0x0B Privilege number for Global Delete. PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_LOCK 242 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_LOCK 0x0C Privilege number for Global Lock. PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_REGISTRY #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_REGISTRY 0x0D Privilege number for Global Registry. PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_SERVICE #define PRIVILEGE_GLOBAL_SERVICE 0x0F Privilege number for Global Service. PRIVILEGE_MANDATED_DAP #define PRIVILEGE_MANDATED_DAP 0x07 Privilege number for Mandated DAP verification. PRIVILEGE_RECEIPT_GENERATION #define PRIVILEGE_RECEIPT_GENERATION 0x10 Privilege number for Receipt Generation. PRIVILEGE_SECURITY_DOMAIN #define PRIVILEGE_SECURITY_DOMAIN 0x00 Privilege number for application is a Security Domain. PRIVILEGE_TOKEN_VERIFICATION #define PRIVILEGE_TOKEN_VERIFICATION 0x0A Privilege number for Token Verification. PRIVILEGE_TRUSTED_PATH #define PRIVILEGE_TRUSTED_PATH 0x08 Privilege number for Trusted Path. Function Detail deregisterService void deregisterService(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned short int usServiceName); This function allows a Global Services Application (e.g. a CVM Application) to deregister a service name. Notes: * The OPEN checks that the requesting on-card entity has the Global Service Privilege and is associated with this registry entry; * The OPEN checks that the service name is registered as unique for the requesting on-card entity. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. usServiceName - The unique service name to deregister. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 243 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SCode(): May return the following status code: * SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED getAID AID *getAID(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE); This function returns the Application's AID registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry's entry. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. Returns: The Application's AID. getPrivileges unsigned short int getPrivileges(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned char *ucBuffer, unsigned short int usOffset); This function returns all the Privileges bytes registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. ucBuffer - The byte array where Privileges bytes are to be stored. usOffset - The offset in ucBuffer at which to begin the Privileges bytes. Returns: The offset in ucBuffer + Length of the Privileges where the Privileges bytes end. getState unsigned char getState(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE); This function returns the Life Cycle State registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. Returns: The Life Cycle State as defined in section 11.1.1. isAssociated bool isAssociated(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, const AID *SDAID); This function verifies wether the Application whose AID is provided in the input parameters is the Security Domain associated with the entity whose Global Platform Registry entry is provided in the input parameters. Notes: * The OPEN determines if SDAID is registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry's entry as the associated Security Domain. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. 244 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. SDAID - The AID object of the investigated Security Domain. Returns: true if the GlobalPlatform Registry references an association with the Security Domain, false otherwise isPrivileged bool isPrivileged(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned char ucPrivilege); This function allows an Application (e.g. a CVM Application) to verify if a given Privilege is registered in the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry of an Application (e.g. check the CVM Management privilege of another Application invoking the CVM.update() function). Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. ucPrivilege - The privilege number to verify, as defined in Table 6-1. Returns: true if at least the referenced Privilege is registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry entry, false if the referenced Privilege is not registered in the GP Registry entry. registerService void registerService(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned short int usServiceName); This function allows a Global Services Application (e.g. a CVM Application) to register a unique service name. Notes: * The OPEN checks that the requesting on-card entity has the Global Service Privilege and is associated with the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry; * The OPEN checks that the requested service name matches with (one of) the Service Parameter(s) recorded in the current GlobalPlatform Registry entry; * The OPEN checks that the service name is not already registered as unique by any other entry in the GlobalPlatform Registry. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry. usServiceName - The unique service name to register. SCode(): May return one of the following status codes (other security mechanism related status codes may be returned): * SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED setState bool setState(GPRE_HANDLE hGPRE, unsigned char ucState) This method allows the Life Cycle state of this GPRegistryEntry to be transitioned to the requested target state. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 245 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Notes: * A transition request to the Life Cycle State INSTALLED shall be rejected; * A transition request to Life Cycle state other than APPLICATION_LOCKED and APPLICATION_UNLOCKED shall be accepted only if the invoking Application corresponds to this GPRegistryEntry; * An Application shall be able to lock and shall not be able to unlock itself; * Only an Application with Global Lock privilege or the directly or indirectly associated Security Domain of this GPRegistryEntry shall be able to lock or unlock this GPRegistry Entry; * This method shall fail if this GPRegistryEntry corresponds to the Issuer Security Domain. Parameters: hGPRE - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry Entry ucState - the target state for this GlobalPlatform Registry Entry Returns: true if the transition is successful, or false otherwise. A.2.4.11 GlobalService This defines the interface for requesting a Global Services Application to provide its actual service interface. The Global Services Application uses this interface to check the validity of the request presented by an on-card entity. Constant Summary #define KEY_ACCESS_ANY -1 Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain and any associated application. #define KEY_ACCESS_SECURITY_DOMAIN 0x01 Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain but not by any associated application . #define KEY_ACCESS_APPLICATION 0x02 Key access indicating key may be used by any associated application but not by the Security Domain. #define KEY_TYPE_AES 0x88 Key type indicating AES. #define KEY_TYPE_3DES 0x81 Key type indicating Triple DES reserved for specific implementations. #define KEY_TYPE_3DES_CBC 0x82 Key type indicating Triple DES in CBC mode. #define KEY_TYPE_DES 0x80 Key type indicating DES with ECB/CBC implicitly known. #define KEY_TYPE_DES_CBC 0x84 246 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Key type indicating DES in CBC mode. #define KEY_TYPE_DES_ECB 0x83 Key type indicating DES in ECB mode. #define KEY_TYPE_EXTENDED 0xFF Key type indicating extended key format. #define KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1 0x90 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC implicitly known. #define KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1_160 0x91 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC is 160 bits. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_P 0xA4 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder p component. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_PQ 0xA6 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder pq component. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_Q 0xA5 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder q component. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DP1 0xA7 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dp1 component. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 0xA8 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dq1 component. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 0xA8 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dq1 component. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_EXPONENT 0xA3 Key type indicating RSA Private Key exponent . #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_MODULUS 0xA2 Key type indicating RSA Public Key modulus. #define KEY_USAGE_COMPUTATION_DECIPHERMENT 0x40 Key usage indicating computation and decipherment. #define KEY_USAGE_CONFIDENTIALITY 0x08 Key usage indicating sensitive data confidentiality . #define KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_AUTHORIZATION 0x01 Key usage indicating cryptographic authorization. #define KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_CHECKSUM 0x04 Key usage indicating cryptographic checksum e.g. MAC. #define KEY_USAGE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE 0x02 Key usage indicating Digital Signature. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 247 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. #define KEY_USAGE_SM_COMMAND 0x10 Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in command data field. #define KEY_USAGE_SM_RESPONSE 0x20 Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in response data field. #define KEY_USAGE_VERIFICATION_ENCIPHERMENT 0x80 Key usage indicating verification and encipherment. Function Summary SERVICE_HANDLE getServiceInterface(GPRE_HANDLE hClientRegistryEntry, unsigned short usServiceName, unsigned short usOffset, unsigned short usLength); This function returns a handle to the requested service interface. Constant Detail KEY_ACCESS_ANY #define KEY_ACCESS_ANY -1 Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain and any associated application. KEY_ACCESS_SECURITY_DOMAIN #define KEY_ACCESS_SECURITY_DOMAIN 0x01 Key access indicating key may be used by the Security Domain but not by any associated application . KEY_ACCESS_APPLICATION #define KEY_ACCESS_APPLICATION 0x02 Key access indicating key may be used by any associated application but not by the Security Domain. KEY_TYPE_AES #define KEY_TYPE_AES 0x88 Key type indicating AES. KEY_TYPE_3DES #define KEY_TYPE_3DES 0x81 Key type indicating Triple DES reserved for specific implementations. KEY_TYPE_3DES_CBC #define KEY_TYPE_3DES_CBC 0x82 Key type indicating Triple DES in CBC mode. KEY_TYPE_DES #define KEY_TYPE_DES 0x80 Key type indicating DES with ECB/CBC implicitly known. KEY_TYPE_DES_CBC #define KEY_TYPE_DES_CBC 0x84 248 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Key type indicating DES in CBC mode. KEY_TYPE_DES_ECB #define KEY_TYPE_DES_ECB 0x83 Key type indicating DES in ECB mode. KEY_TYPE_EXTENDED #define KEY_TYPE_EXTENDED 0xFF Key type indicating extended key format. KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1 #define KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1 0x90 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC implicitly known. KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1_160 #define KEY_TYPE_HMAC_SHA1_160 0x91 Key type indicating HMAC SHA1, length of HMAC is 160 bits. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_P #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_P 0xA4 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder p component. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_PQ #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_PQ 0xA6 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder pq component. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_Q #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_Q 0xA5 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder pq component. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DP1 #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DP1 0xA7 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dp1 component. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 0xA8 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dq1 component. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_CRT_DQ1 0xA8 Key type indicating RSA Private Key Chinese Remainder dq1 component. KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_EXPONENT #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_EXPONENT 0xA3 Key type indicating RSA Public Key exponent . KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_MODULUS March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 249 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. #define KEY_TYPE_RSA_PRIVATE_MODULUS 0xA2 Key type indicating RSA Public Key modulus. KEY_USAGE_COMPUTATION_DECIPHERMENT #define KEY_USAGE_COMPUTATION_DECIPHERMENT 0x40 Key usage indicating computation and decipherment. KEY_USAGE_CONFIDENTIALITY #define KEY_USAGE_CONFIDENTIALITY 0x08 Key usage indicating sensitive data confidentiality . KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_AUTHORIZATION #define KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_AUTHORIZATION 0x01 Key usage indicating cryptographic authorization. KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_CHECKSUM #define KEY_USAGE_CRYPTOGRAPHIC_CHECKSUM 0x04 Key usage indicating cryptographic checksum e.g. MAC. KEY_USAGE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE #define KEY_USAGE_DIGITAL_SIGNATURE 0x02 Key usage indicating Digital Signature. KEY_USAGE_SM_COMMAND #define KEY_USAGE_SM_COMMAND 0x10 Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in command data field. KEY_USAGE_SM_RESPONSE #define KEY_USAGE_SM_RESPONSE 0x20 Key usage indicating Secure Messaging in response data field. KEY_USAGE_VERIFICATION_ENCIPHERMENT #define KEY_USAGE_VERIFICATION_ENCIPHERMENT 0x80 Key usage indicating verification and encipherment. Function Detail getServiceInterface SERVICE_HANDLE getServiceInterface(GPRE_HANDLE hClientRegistryEntry, unsigned short usServiceName, unsigned short usOffset, unsigned short usLength); This function returns a handle to the requested service interface of a Global Services Application. Notes: * This function is implemented by each Global Services Application, not by the OPEN. However, the function is specified within this specification in order to allow each Global Services Application to present a consistent interface to client applications; 250 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Client applications should invoke this function using a similar mechanism to that described in section A.2.3.3, except that the MULTOS Delegate primitive is invoked specifying the AID of the Global Services Application instead of the AID of the "Card Manager Services Provider" application; * The Global Services Application verifies the validity of the request according to its own security policies for this usServiceName and based on the identity of the requesting on-card entity and its characteristics as registered in the GlobalPlatform Registry entry identified by the handle hClientRegistryEntry; * The Global Services Application may reject an invalid service request and return NULL. Parameters: hClientRegistryEntry - The handle to the GlobalPlatform Registry entry of the requesting on-card entity. usServiceName - The requested service name. usOffset - The offset of the additional parameters of the service request within the MULTOS Public memory segment. usLength - Length of the additional parameters of the service request. Returns: The specific service interface reference or NULL. SCode(): May return one of the following status codes (other security mechanism related status codes may be returned): * SW_CONDITIONS_NOT_SATISFIED * SW_SECURITY_STATUS_NOT_SATISFIED March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 251 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. B Algorithms (Cryptographic and Hashing) A GlobalPlatform card may support many types of security functions for use by applications. This appendix contains examples of several of the cryptographic algorithms and the hashing method that are possible for GlobalPlatform. B.1 Data Encryption Standard (DES) The Data Encryption Standard (DES) is a symmetric cryptographic algorithm that requires the use of the same secret key to encrypt and decrypt data. In its simplest form it uses an 8-byte key to encrypt an 8-byte block of data and the same 8-byte key to decrypt and retrieve the original clear text. Triple DES uses a compound operation of DES encryption and decryption. Triple DES as used in this specification uses keying option 2 as defined in ISO/IEC 18033-3. B.1.1 Encryption/Decryption For encryption two variants are defined. B.1.1.1 CBC Mode Triple DES in CBC mode, as defined in [ANSI X9.52] and [ISO 10116], is used with an Initial Chaining Value equal to '00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00'. B.1.1.2 ECB Mode Triple DES in ECB mode, as defined in [ANSI X9.52] and [ISO 10116], is used. B.1.2 MACing The chaining data encryption methods are defined in [ISO 9797]. B.1.2.1 Full Triple DES MAC The full triple DES MAC is as defined in [ISO 9797-1] as MAC Algorithm 3 with output transformation 3, without truncation, and with triple DES taking the place of the block cipher. B.1.2.2 Single DES Plus Final Triple DES MAC This is also known as the Retail MAC. It is as defined in [ISO 9797-1] as MAC Algorithm 3 with output transformation 3, without truncation, and with DES taking the place of the block cipher. B.2 Hashing Algorithms A hash is a one-way digest operation over an arbitrary length of data that returns a fixed length hash value. A hash is not a cryptographic algorithm and it only provides integrity of the data. It does not provide authentication or confidentiality. B.2.1 Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1) SHA-1 is defined in [ISO 10118-3] and FIPS PUB 180-1. 252 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. B.2.2 MULTOS Asymmetric Hash Algorithm The asymmetric hash algorithm for GlobalPlatform on MULTOS is described in MULTOS document [MAO-DOC-REF-009]. B.3 Public Key Cryptography Scheme 1 (PKCS#1) Unlike DES, which uses a shared secret key, public key cryptography employs the use of a Private Key (kept secret by one entity) and a Public Key. One public key algorithm used for GlobalPlatform is RSA (Rivest / Shamir / Adleman). The process of generating an RSA signature involves using the PKCS#1 standard. The signature scheme is RSA SSA-PKCS1-v1_5 as defined in PKCS#1. This is applied to a digest of the data being signed, generated by the SHA-1 algorithm. The resultant signature is the same size as the public key modulus. The process of verifying a signature uses the public key applied to the signature (providing the hash) and the comparison of this hash with the hash of the data being verified. B.4 DES Padding Unless specified to the contrary, padding prior to performing a DES operation across a block of data is achieved in the following manner: * Append an '80' to the right of the data block; * If the resultant data block length is a multiple of 8 bytes, no further padding is required; * Append binary zeroes to the right of the data block until the data block length is a multiple of 8 bytes. If the data is being padded with the intention of generating a MAC, the padding is discarded following the DES operation. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 253 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. C Secure Content Management This appendix defines the different methods that shall be used to secure the changes and/or modifications to the content of a GlobalPlatform card. At this point in time, these methods are the only ones specified for GlobalPlatform cards. Depending on the implementation of the card, any subset of these methods may be supported. C.1 Keys In order to perform the Card Content management operations described in the subsequent sub-sections different keys are required. C.1.1 Token and Receipt Keys The Security Domain with Token Verification privilege and the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall have knowledge of different keys if Delegated Management is supported. These keys are used to secure the management of the card and its content. Key Usage Minimum Length Remark Token Token verification (RSA Public Key) 1024 bits Delegated Management only Receipt Optional Receipt generation (DES) 16 bytes Delegated Management only Receipt Optional Receipt generation (RSA) 1024 bits Delegated Management only Table C-1: Token and Receipt Keys It is recommended that RSA keys are a multiple of 32 bits in length above the minimum length. C.1.1.1 Token key If the card supports Delegated Management, the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege shall have an RSA Public Key to be used to verify a Token. Token verification and the corresponding delegated management operation shall fail if the Token verification key is not present. C.1.1.2 Receipt Key If the card supports Delegated Management and specifically Receipt generation, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege shall either have an unambiguously recognized DES key or private RSA key to be used to generate Receipts. Receipt generation and the corresponding delegated management operation shall fail if the Receipt generation key is not present. C.1.2 DAP Verification Keys If the Security Domain supports DAP Verification, the Security Domain shall have either an RSA public key or a DES key to verify Load File Data Block Signatures. Key Usage Minimum Length Remark DAP Verification Load File Data Block Signature verification (RSA Public Key) 1024 bits DAP Verification only 254 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Key Usage Minimum Length Remark DAP Verification Load File Data Block Signature verification (DES Key) 16 Bytes DAP Verification only Table C-2: Additional Security Domain Key It is recommended that RSA keys are a multiple of 32 bits in length above the minimum length. C.2 Load File Data Block Hash The Load File Data Block Hash is a field that is required to be present in the INSTALL [for load] command if Delegated Management loading is occurring and/or the Load File contains one or more DAP Blocks. The purpose of this field is to provide a SHA-1 digest of the Load File Data Block and it is used to ensure that the contents of the Load File Data Block have not been modified in any way. While the actual hash is not secured in any manner, it is used in other secure operations that ensure that the Load File Data Block has not been modified and a new hash generated for the modified data. The OPEN shall verify the integrity of the Load File Data Block prior to creating an Executable Load File. Figure C-1 details the Load File Data Block Hash calculation performed by the Security Domain, an Application Provider and a Controlling Authority. Message Digest Calculation Load File Data Block Hash Load File Data Block Figure C-1: Load File Data Block Hash Calculation Padding of the data is as defined by the SHA-1. The digest is generated prior to the Load File Data Block being encapsulated in the TLV structure of the Load File (i.e. excluding tag 'C4' and its length). When Delegated Management is occurring the Load Token is a signature of multiple fields including this hash and is proof that the Card Issuer generated the Token for the Load File Data Block linked to the hash. If the Load File contains DAP Blocks, DAP Verification is the actual signing of this hash and is proof that the DAP Block was generated by an entity that verified the content of the Load File Data Block linked to the hash. C.3 Load File Data Block Signature (DAP Verification) The Load File Data Block Signature provides verification of the Load File Data Block prior to commencing with the processing of the actual Load File Data Block. The OPEN shall request the Security Domain linked to the Load File Data Block Signature to verify the signature. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 255 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The Load File Data Block Signature is a signature of the Load File Data Block Hash. Each Load File Data Block Signature is combined with its linked Security Domain AID in the TLV structured DAP Block. DAP Blocks are positioned in the beginning of the Load File. Figure C-2 details the Load File Data Block Signature calculation performed by an Application Provider or Controlling Authority. Signature Calculation Load File Data Block Signature Load File Data Block Hash Application Provider DAP Calculation Key Figure C-2: Load File Data Block Signature Calculation C.4 Tokens Tokens are public key signatures, generated by the Card Issuer. Tokens are the proof that the Card Issuer has authorized the Card Content Management operation being performed and they are generated and verified according to this appendix. Tokens may be generated for use on multiple cards, depending on the Card Issuer's security policy. A token is an RSA signature, being the decryption (with the token private key) of the SHA-1 message digest of the appropriate data. Padding of the data is as defined by the SHA-1 and PKCS#1 mechanisms. The signature scheme for tokens is as defined in appendix B.2.1 - Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1). C.4.1 Load Token The Load Token is a signature authorizing the transmission of application code to the card. It allows for the verification of the load request. The OPEN shall request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Load Token. The following figure shows the Load Token generation. Token Calculation INSTALL [for load] P1,P2 len, Executable Load File AID len, Security Domain AID Load Token len, load params len, Load File Data Block Hash Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data Figure C-3 Load Token Calculation Generating a Load Token ensures the following: 256 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * Only the application code (hash of the Load File Data Block) included in this signature may be loaded to the card; * The AID of the Load File Data Block may only be that included in the signature; * The Executable Load File (derived from the Load File Data Block) and all Executable Modules within the Executable Load File may only be associated with the Security Domain included in the signature; * The issuer of the Load Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). The Load Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in the actual INSTALL [for load] command to be transmitted to the card. Name Length Reference control parameter P1 1 Reference control parameter P2 1 Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) - see note below 1 Load File AID length 1 Load File AID 5-16 Security Domain AID length 1 Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 Length of the Load File Data Block Hash 1 Load File Data Block Hash 20 Load parameters field length 1-2 Load parameters field Var Table C-3: Data Elements Included in the Load Token Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. C.4.2 Install Token The Install Token allows for the verification of the installation process. The token is a signature authorizing the installation to the card of an Application (Executable Module) contained in a previously loaded file (Executable Load File). The OPEN shall request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Install Token. Figure C-4 shows the Install Token generation. Token Calculation INSTALL [for install] P1, P2 len, Executable Module AID len, instance AID Install Token len, install params len, privileges Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data len, Executable Load File AID Figure C-4: Install Token Calculation March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 257 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Generating an Install Token ensures the following: * Only the application (Executable Module) included in this signature and present in the Executable Load File may be installed on the card; * That only the instance AID included in this signature may be used as the AID to select the instance; * The Application may only be installed with the privileges included in this signature; * Only the parameters included in this signature may be used to install the Application; * The issuer of the Install Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). The Install Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in an INSTALL [for install] command. Name Length Reference control parameter P1 1 Reference control parameter P2 1 Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) - see note below 1 Executable Load File AID length 1 Executable Load File AID 5-16 Executable Module AID length 1 AID within the Executable Load File 5-16 Instance AID length 1 Instance AID 5-16 Privileges length 1 Privileges (byte 1 - byte 2 ­ byte 3) 1 or 3 Install Parameters field length 1-2 Install Parameters (system and Application) field Var Table C-4: Data Elements Included in the Install Token Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. C.4.3 Make Selectable Token The Make Selectable Token allows for the verification of the installation for make selectable process. The token is a signature authorizing the making selectable of an Application. The OPEN shall request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Make Selectable Token. The following figure shows the Make Selectable Token generation. 258 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Token Calculation INSTALL [for make selectable] P1, P2 len = 0 len, instance AID Make Selectable Token len, make selectable params len, privileges Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data len = 0 Figure C-5: Make Selectable Token Calculation Generating a Make Selectable Token ensures the following: * Only the Application included in this signature and present in the Executable Load File may be made selectable on the card; * That only the instance AID included in this signature may be used as the AID to select the instance; * The Application may only be made selectable with the privileges included in this signature; * Only the parameters included in this signature may be used to make the Application selectable; * The issuer of the Make Selectable Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). The Make Selectable Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in an INSTALL [for make selectable] command. Name Length Reference control parameter P1 1 Reference control parameter P2 1 Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) - see note below 1 Executable Load File AID length (= '00') 1 Executable Module AID length (= '00') 1 Instance AID length 1 Instance AID 5-16 Privileges length 1 Privileges (byte 1 - byte 2 - byte 3) 1 or 3 Make Selectable parameters field length 1 Make Selectable parameters field 0-n Table C-5: Data Elements Included in the Make Selectable Token Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 259 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. C.4.4 Extradition Token The Extradition Token allows for the verification of the extradition process. The token is a signature authorizing the extradition of an Application from one Security Domain to another. The OPEN shall request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Extradition Token. The following figure shows Extradition Token generation. Token Calculation INSTALL [for extradition] P1, P2 len = 0 len, Application or Executable Load File AID Extradition Token len = 0len = 0 Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data len, Security Domain AID Figure C-6: Extradition Token Calculation Generating an Extradition Token ensures the following: * Only the Application or Executable Load File included in this signature may be extradited; * The issuer of the Extradition Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). The Extradition Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in an actual INSTALL [for extradition] command to be transmitted to the card. Name Length Presence Reference control parameter P1 1 Mandatory Reference control parameter P2 1 Mandatory Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) - see note below 1 Mandatory Security Domain AID length 1 Mandatory Security Domain AID 5-16 Conditional Length = 0 1 Mandatory Application or Executable Load File AID length 1 Mandatory Application or Executable Load File AID 5-16 Mandatory Length = 0 1 Mandatory Length of Extradition Parameters field 1 Mandatory Extradition Parameters field 0-n Conditional Table C-6: Data Elements Included in the Extradition Token Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. 260 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. C.4.5 Registry Update Token The Registry Update Token allows for the verification of the registry update process. The token is a signature authorizing the updating of the GlobalPlatform Registry data for an Application, and optionally the extradition of an Application from one Security Domain to another. The OPEN shall request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the Registry Update Token. Figure C-7 shows the Registry Update Token generation. Token Calculation INSTALL [for registry update] P1, P2 len = 0 len, Application AID Registry UpdateToken len, registry update params len, privileges Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data len, Security Domain AID Figure C-7: Registry Update Token Calculation Generating a Registry Update Token ensures the following: * Only the Application included in this signature may have its GP Registry entry updated (and be extradited, in the case of extradition using registry update); * The GP Registry entry of the Application may only be updated with the privileges and/or parameters included in this signature; * The issuer of the Registry Update Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). The Registry Update Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in an actual INSTALL [for registry update] command to be transmitted to the card. Name Length Presence Reference control parameter P1 1 Mandatory Reference control parameter P2 1 Mandatory Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) - see note below 1 Mandatory Security Domain AID length 1 Mandatory Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 Conditional Length = 0 1 Mandatory Application AID length 1 Mandatory Application AID 5-16 Conditional Length of Privileges 1 Mandatory Privileges (byte 1 - byte 2 - byte 3) 0-3 Conditional Length of Registry Update Parameters 1 Mandatory Registry Update Parameters 0-n Conditional Table C-7: Data Elements Included in the Registry Update Token March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 261 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. C.4.6 Delete Token The Delete Token is a signature authorizing the deletion of card content from the card. It allows for the verification of the card content removal process The Token is a signature of selected fields within the DELETE command APDU and is appended to the DELETE command. Figure C-8 shows the Delete Token generation. Token Calculation DELETE P1,P2 Tag, Len, AID Tag, Len, Control Reference Template for Digital Signature Delete Token Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data Figure C-8: Delete Token Calculation Generating a Delete Token ensures the following: * Only the Application or Executable Load File included in this signature may be deleted; * The issuer of the Delete Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). The Delete Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in the actual DELETE [card content] command to be transmitted to the card. Name Length Reference control parameter P1 1 Reference control parameter P2 1 Length of the following data fields - see note below 1 Application or Executable Load File AID tag ('4F') 1 AID length 1 Application or Executable Load File AID 5-16 Control Reference Template for Digital Signature tag ('B6') 0 or 1 Control Reference Template for Digital Signature length 0-3 Control Reference Template for Digital Signature (Token) as defined in Table 11-22, comprising (in TLV format) Token Issuer id (tag '42'), Card Image Number (tag '45'), Application Provider id (tag '5F20') and Token identifier/number (tag '93') 0-n Table C-8: Data Elements Included in the Delete Token Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. 262 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. C.4.7 Load, Install and Make Selectable Token The combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token allows for the verification of the combined loading and installation process. The token is a signature authorizing the combined loading of an Executable Load File and installation to the card of an Application contained in a previously loaded file (Executable Load File). The OPEN shall request the Security Domain with Token Verification privilege to verify the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token. Figure C-9 shows the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token generation. Token Calculation INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] P1,P2 len, Executable Module AID len, instance AID Combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token len, install params len, privileges Issuer Token Calculation Key Length of remaining data len, Executable Load File AID INSTALL [for load] P1,P2 len, Executable Load File AID len, Security Domain AID len, load params len, Load File Data Block Hash Length of remaining data Figure C-9: Load, Install and Make Selectable Token Calculation Generating a combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token ensures the following: * Only the application code included in this signature may be loaded to the card; * The AID of the Load File Data Block may only be that included in the signature; * The Executable Load File (derived from the Load File Data Block) and all Executable Modules within the Executable Load File may only be associated with the Security Domain included in the signature; * Only the application (Executable Module) included in this signature and present in the Executable Load File may be installed on the card; * That only the instance AID included in this signature may be used as the AID to select the instance; * The Application may only be installed with the privileges included in this signature; * Only the parameters included in this signature may be used to install the Application; * The issuer of the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token may only be the Security Domain Provider of the Security Domain with Token Verification Privilege (e.g. the Card Issuer). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 263 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Token is an RSA signature of the following data that will be included in an INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command. Name Length Reference control parameter P1 1 Reference control parameter P2 1 Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) 1 Load File AID length 1 Load File AID 5-16 Security Domain AID length 1 Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 Length of the Load File Data Block Hash 1 Load File Data Block Hash 0 or 20 Load parameters field length 1 Load parameters field Var Reference control parameter P1 1 Reference control parameter P2 1 Length of the following data fields (including the length fields) 1 Executable Load File AID length 1 Executable Load File AID 0 or 5-16 Executable Module AID length 1 AID within the Executable Load File 0 or 5-16 Instance AID length 1 Instance AID 5-16 Privileges length 1 Privileges (byte 1 - byte 2 - byte 3) 1 or 3 Install Parameters field length 1 Install Parameters (system and Application) field Var Table C-9: Data Elements Included in the Load, Install and Make Selectable Token Note that 'Length of the following data fields' is the value of Lc of the INSTALL command, prior to a Token being added. It is coded on 1 byte with a value up to 255. C.5 Receipts Receipts are optional. They are generated by the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege, which requires knowledge of the appropriate receipt key. The Delete Receipt is comprised of data appropriate to the function that has been performed, together with Card Unique Data generated by the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege. Each Receipt is generated either by: * Symmetric cryptography using the receipt key, an ICV of binary zeroes and the signature method described in appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES MAC across the receipt data. Prior to generating the signature, the data shall be padded according to appendix B.4 - DES Padding; 264 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * asymmetric cryptography using the private key of the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege to decipher (sign) the SHA-1 digest of the receipt data using the signature method described in appendix B.2.1 - Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1). In addition to the appropriate cryptographic key, the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege also keeps track of a Confirmation Counter. The Confirmation Counter is a 16-bit value that is incremented by one (1) following each receipt generation. The Confirmation Counter is initialized to zero. When reaching its maximum value, the Confirmation Counter shall not be reset to zero. Cards are not required to support counter values beyond 32767. C.5.1 Load Receipt The Load Receipt provides confirmation that a successful load has occurred through the delegated loading process. A Load Receipt may be included in the response message for the last LOAD command of a sequence of LOAD commands. Figure C-10 details the Load Receipt calculation. Confirmation Data len, Executable Load File AID len, Security Domain AID Load Receipt Receipt Calculation Security Domain Receipt Generation Key Figure C-10: Load Receipt Calculation A Load Receipt is a signature of the following data: Name Length Confirmation Data as defined in section 11.1.6 1-n Executable Load File AID length 1 Executable Load File AID 5-16 Security Domain AID length 1 Security Domain AID 5-16 Table C-10: Data Elements Included in the Load Receipt C.5.2 Install Receipt and Make Selectable Receipt The Install/Make Selectable Receipt provides confirmation card that a successful installation/make selectable has occurred through the delegated installation/make selectable process. An Install/Make Selectable Receipt may be returned in the response message to the INSTALL [for install] command, the INSTALL [for make selectable] and the INSTALL [for install and make selectable] command. An Install Receipt is not returned in the response message to the INSTALL [for personalization] command. Figure C-11 details the Install/Make Selectable Receipt calculation. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 265 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Confirmation Data len, Eecutable Load File AID len, Application AID Install/Make Selectable Receipt Receipt Calculation Security Domain Receipt Generation Key Figure C-11: Install/Make Selectable Receipt Calculation An Install/Make Selectable Receipt is a signature of the following data: Name Length Confirmation Data as defined in section 11.1.6 1-n Executable Load File AID length 1 Executable Load File AID 5-16 Instance AID length indicator 1 Instance AID 5-16 Table C-11: Data Elements Included in the Install/Make Selectable Receipt C.5.3 Extradition Receipt The Extradition Receipt provides confirmation that the identified old Security Domain extradited the identified Application or Executable Load File to the identified new Security Domain, on a specific card, through the Delegated Management process. An Extradition Receipt may be returned in the response message to the INSTALL [for extradition] command. Figure C-12 details the Extradition Receipt calculation performed by the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege. Receipt Calculation Confirmation Data len, old Security Domain AID Extradition Receipt len, Application / Executable Load File AID Security Domain Receipt Generation Key len, new Security Domain AID Figure C-12: Extradition Receipt Calculation An Extradition Receipt is a signature of the following data: Name Length Presence Confirmation Data as defined in section 11.1.6 1-n Mandatory AID length indicator 1 Mandatory 266 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Presence Old Security Domain AID 5-16 Mandatory AID length indicator 1 Mandatory Application instance or Executable Load File AID 5-16 Mandatory AID length indicator 1 Mandatory New Security Domain AID 5-16 Mandatory Table C-12: Data Elements Included in the Extradition Receipt C.5.4 Registry Update Receipt The Registry Update Receipt provides confirmation that GlobalPlatform Registry data (Privileges and/or Registry Update Parameters) for the identified Application was modified to the specified values on a specific card. If registry update is used for extradition, the Registry Update Receipt also provides confirmation that the identified old Security Domain extradited the identified Application to the identified new Security Domain, on a specific card, through the Delegated Management process. The following figure details the Registry Update Receipt calculation performed by the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege. Receipt Calculation Confirmation Data len, old Security Domain AID Registry Update Receipt len, Application AID Security Domain Receipt Generation Key len, new Security Domain AID len, Privileges len, Registry Update Parameters Figure C-13: Registry Update Receipt Calculation A Registry Update Receipt is a signature of the following data: Name Length Presence Confirmation Data as defined in section 11.1.6 1-n Mandatory AID length indicator 1 Mandatory Old Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 Conditional AID length indicator 1 Mandatory Application AID 0 or 5-16 Conditional AID length indicator 1 Mandatory New Security Domain AID 0 or 5-16 Conditional Length of Privileges 1 Mandatory Privileges (byte 1 - byte 2 ­ byte 3) 0-3 Conditional Length of Registry Update Parameters 1 Mandatory Registry Update Parameters 0-n Conditional Table C-13: Data Elements Included in the Registry Update Receipt March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 267 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The presence of conditional data depends on what Registry data (Privileges and/or Registry Update Parameters) is being updated and whether registry update is being used for extradition. See sections 11.5.2.3.5 and 11.5.2.3.7 for further details and the format of data. Security Domain AIDs are present for extradition. C.5.5 Delete Receipt The Delete Receipt provides proof that the identified Security Domain deleted an Application, an Executable Load File, or an Executable Load File and all its Application instances from a specific card through the delegated deletion process. The Delete Receipt may be returned in the response message to the DELETE [card content] command. Figure C-14 details the Delete Receipt calculation performed by the Security Domain with Receipt Generation privilege. Receipt Calculation Confirmation Data Delete Receiptlen, deleted AID Security Domain Receipt Generation Key Figure C-14: Delete Receipt Calculation A Delete Receipt is a signature of the following data: Name Length Confirmation Data as defined in section 11.1.6 1-n AID length indicator 1 Application instance or Executable Load File AID 5-16 Table C-14: Data Elements Included in the Delete Receipt If the function was to delete an Executable Load File and all its Application instances, the receipt returns only the Executable Load File AID. C.5.6 Combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt The combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt provides confirmation card that a successful installation has occurred through the delegated installation process. A combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt may be returned in the response message to the INSTALL [for load, install and make selectable] command. Figure C-15 details the combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt calculation. 268 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Confirmation Data len, Eecutable Load File AID len, Application AID Combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt Receipt Calculation Security Domain Receipt Generation Key len, Security Domain AID Figure C-15: Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt Calculation A combined Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt is a signature of the following data: Name Length Confirmation Data as defined in section 11.1.6 1-n Executable Load File AID length 1 Executable Load File AID 5-16 Instance AID length indicator 1 Instance AID 5-16 Security Domain AID length 1 Security Domain AID 5-16 Table C-15: Data Elements Included in the Load, Install and Make Selectable Receipt C.6 DAP Verification Load File Data Block Signature verification is used to ensure that the Application has been validated. In order to support DAP Verification, a Security Domain with DAP Verification privileges shall be present on the card. The Security Domain shall have knowledge of the appropriate key. C.6.1 PKC Scheme An entity generates a signature of the Load File Data Block Hash as defined in appendix B.2.1 - Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA-1), i.e. computing a SHA-1 message digest of the Load File Data Block Hash and applying the DAP Verification private key to obtain the signature. This RSA signature is the decryption with the DAP Verification private key of the SHA-1 message digest of the Load File Data Block Hash (i.e. hash of a hash value). Padding of the data is as defined by SHA-1 and PKCS#1. The signature is provided to any entity responsible for loading the signed application code to a GlobalPlatform card. The AID of the Security Domain verifying the DAP along with this signature are placed in the Load File as a DAP Block to be transmitted to the card. C.6.2 DES Scheme A Security Domain's provider generates a signature of the Load File Data Block Hash. This signature is a MAC of the Load File Data Block Hash according to appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES. Padding of the data is as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. The signature is provided to any entity responsible for loading the signed application code to a GlobalPlatform card. The AID of the Security Domain verifying the DAP along with this signature are placed in the Load File as a DAP Block to be transmitted to the card. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 269 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. C.7 GlobalPlatform on MULTOS C.7.1 Keys In order to perform Card Content management operations a GlobalPlatform on MULTOS smart card requires the following key: * Issuer's key. The following keys may optionally be supplied to the card during a card content loading operation: * Application Provider's key; * Application Provider's transport keys. These keys are described in MAO-DOC-REF-009. C.7.2 Cryptographic Structures A GlobalPlatform on MULTOS smart card utilizes the following cryptographic structures: * Public Key Certificate; * Card Content Management Certificates: - Application Load Certificate; - Application Delete Certificate. * Application Provider's Signature; * Key Transformation Unit. These structures are described in MAO-DOC-REF-009. 270 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. D Secure Channel Protocol '01' (Deprecated) This Secure Channel Protocol is deprecated, and will be removed from a future version of the Specification. Use of another Secure Channel Protocol, such as Secure Channel Protocol '02' (SCP02), is recommended. D.1 Secure Communication D.1.1 SCP01 Secure Channel The 3 levels of security provided by SCP01 are: Mutual authentication - in which the card and the off-card entity each prove that they have knowledge of the same secrets; Integrity and data origin authentication - in which the card ensures that the data being received from the off-card entity actually came from an authenticated off-card entity in the correct sequence and has not been altered; Confidentiality - in which data being transmitted from the off-card entity to the card, is not viewable by an unauthorized entity. A further level of security applies to sensitive data (e.g. secret keys) that shall always be transmitted as confidential data. A maximum of 3 Supplementary Logical Channels is supported in SCP01. Only explicit Secure Channel initiation is supported in SCP01. Both implicit and explicit Secure Channel termination are supported in SCP01. In SCP01 the card shall support the following implementation options defined by "i" (see appendix H GlobalPlatform Data Values and Card Recognition Data): * "i" = '05': Initiation mode explicit, C-MAC on modified APDU, ICV set to zero, no ICV encryption, 3 Secure Channel Keys; * "i" = '15': Initiation mode explicit, C-MAC on modified APDU, ICV set to zero, ICV encryption, 3 Secure Channel Keys. Implementation option '15' is an enhancement over implementation option '05' and is therefore recommended. D.1.2 Mutual Authentication Mutual authentication is achieved through the process of initiating a Secure Channel and provides assurance to both the card and the off-card entity that they are communicating with an authenticated entity. If any step in the mutual authentication process fails, the process shall be restarted i.e. new challenges and Secure Channel Session generated. The Secure Channel is explicitly initiated by the off-card entity using the INITIALIZE UPDATE and EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE commands defined in this section. The Application may pass the APDU to the Security Domain using the appropriate API e.g. the processSecurity() method of a GlobalPlatform Java Card. The explicit Secure Channel initiation allows the off-card entity to instruct the card (see appendix D.4.2 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command) as to what level of security is required for the current Secure Channel (integrity and/or confidentiality) and apply this level of security to all the subsequent messages exchanged between the card and the off-card entity until the end of the Secure Channel Session. It also gives the off-card entity the possibility of selecting the Key Version Number and Key Identifier to be used (see the INITIALIZE UPDATE command). March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 271 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Note: The explicit Secure Channel initiation also allows the card to inform the off-card entity what Secure Channel Protocol is supported, using the returned Secure Channel Protocol identifier. The Secure Channel is always initiated (see appendix D.4.1 - INITIALIZE UPDATE Command) by the off-card entity by passing a "host" challenge (random data unique to this Secure Channel Session) to the card. The card, on receipt of this challenge, generates its own "card" challenge (again random data unique to this Secure Channel Session). The card, using the host challenge, the card challenge and its internal static keys, creates new secret Secure Channel session keys and generates a first cryptographic value (card cryptogram) using one of its newly created Secure Channel session keys (see appendix D.3.1 - DES Session Keys). This card cryptogram along with the card challenge, the Secure Channel Protocol identifier, and other data is transmitted back to the off-card entity. As the off-card entity should now have all the same information that the card used to generate the card cryptogram, it should be able to generate the same Secure Channel session keys and the same card cryptogram and by performing a comparison, it is able to authenticate the card. The off-card entity now uses a similar process to create a second cryptographic value (host cryptogram) to be passed back to the card (see appendix D.4.2 - EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command). As the card has all the same information that the host used to generate the host cryptogram, it should be able to generate the same host cryptogram and, by performing a comparison, it is able to authenticate the off-card entity. SCP01 Mutual Authentication Flow The following flow is an example of mutual authentication between a card and an off-card entity. This flow shows mutual authentication occurring between a Security Domain and an off-card entity. APDU Interface Host Security Domain SELECT Security Domain SELECT Response SELECT Mutual authentication INITIALIZE UPDATE INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Generate host challenge Generate card challenge; Generate session keys; Calculate card cryptogram Generate session keys; Verify card cryptogram; Calculate host cryptogram EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Verify host cryptogram Figure D-1: Mutual Authentication Flow (Security Domain) Expanding the authentication process shown in the flow described in section 7.3.4 - Runtime Messaging Support, it can be seen how an Application would use the services of an associated Security Domain to achieve mutual authentication. 272 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. APDU Interface Host Security Domain Mutual authentication INITIALIZE UPDATE INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Generate host challenge Generate card challenge; Generate session keys; Calculate card cryptogram Generate session keys; Verify card cryptogram; Calculate host cryptogram EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Verify host cryptogram Application GP API security processing security processing Figure D-2: Mutual Authentication Flow (using services of Security Domain) D.1.3 Message Integrity The C-MAC is generated by applying multiple chained DES operations (using a Secure Channel session key generated during the mutual authentication process) across the header and data field of an APDU command. The card, on receipt of the message containing a C-MAC, using the same Secure Channel session key, performs the same operation and by comparing its internally generated C-MAC with the C-MAC received from the off-card entity is assured of the integrity of the full command. (If message data confidentiality has also been applied to the message, the C-MAC applies to the message data field before encryption.) The integrity of the sequence of commands being transmitted to the card is achieved by using the C-MAC from the current command as the (possibly encrypted) Initial Chaining Vector (ICV) for the subsequent command. This ensures the card that all commands in a sequence have been received. D.1.4 Message Data Confidentiality The message data field is encrypted by applying multiple chained DES operations (using a Secure Channel session key generated during the mutual authentication process) across the entire data field of the command message to be transmitted to the card, regardless of its contents (clear text data and/or already protected sensitive data). D.1.5 ICV Encryption As an enhancement to the C-MAC mechanism, the ICV is encrypted before being applied to the calculation of the next C-MAC. The encryption mechanism used is triple DES with the C-MAC session key. The first ICV of a session, used to generate the C-MAC on the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, is not encrypted. D.1.6 Security Level The Current Security Level of a communication not included in a Secure Channel Session shall be set to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. For Secure Channel Protocol '01', the Current Security Level established in a Secure Channel Session is a bitmap combination of the following values: AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC, and C_DECRYPTION. The Current Security Level shall be set as follows: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 273 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * NO_SECURITY_LEVEL when a Secure Channel Session is terminated or not yet fully initiated; * AUTHENTICATED after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command: AUTHENTICATED shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated; * AUTHENTICATED and C_MAC after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command with P1 indicating C-MAC (P1='01'): AUTHENTICATED and C-MAC shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated; * AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC, and C_DECRYPTION after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command with P1 indicating C-MAC and command encryption (P1= '03'): AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC, and C_DECRYPTION shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated. D.1.7 Protocol Rules In accordance with the general rules described in chapter 10 - Secure Communication, the following protocol rules apply to Secure Channel Protocol `01': * The successful initiation of a Secure Channel Session shall set the Current Security Level to the security level indicated in the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command: it is at least set to AUTHENTICATED; * The Current Security Level shall apply to the entire Secure Channel Session unless successfully modified at the request of the Application; * When the Current Security Level is equal to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL: - If the Secure Channel Session was aborted during the same Application Session, the incoming command shall be rejected with a security error; - Otherwise no security verification of the incoming command shall be performed. The Application processing the command is responsible to apply its own security rules. * If a Secure Channel Session is active (i.e. Current Security Level at least set to AUTHENTICATED), the security of the incoming command shall be checked according to the Current Security Level regardless of the command secure messaging indicator: - When the security of the command does not match (nor exceeds) the Current Security Level, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - If a security error is found, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - In all other cases, the Secure Channel Session shall remain active and the Current Security Level unmodified. The Application is responsible for further processing the command. * If the Security Domain supports application data encryption and/or decryption, it shall decrypt or encrypt a block of secret data upon request. If the service is not supported or if (one of) the appropriate cryptographic key(s) is not available, the request shall be rejected but the Current Security Level, Session Security Level and Secure Channel Session in operation (if any) shall not be impacted; * If a Secure Channel Session is aborted, it is still considered not terminated; * The current Secure Channel Session shall be terminated (if aborted or still open) and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL on either: - Attempt to initiate a new Secure Channel Session (new INITIALIZE UPDATE command); - Termination of the Application Session (e.g. new Application selection); 274 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. - Termination of the associated logical channel; - Termination of the Card Session (card reset or power off); - Explicit termination by the Application (e.g. invoking GlobalPlatform API). D.2 Cryptographic Keys Key Usage Length Remark Secure Channel Encryption Key (S- ENC) Secure Channel Authentication & Encryption (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory Secure Channel Message Authentication Code Key (S-MAC) Secure Channel MAC Verification (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory Data Encryption Key (DEK) Sensitive Data Decryption (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory Table D-1: Security Domain Secure Channel Keys A Security Domain, including the Issuer Security Domain shall have at least one key set containing 3 keys to be used in the initiation and use of a Secure Channel. These keys are all double length DES keys and are the following: * The Secure Channel encryption key (S-ENC) and the Secure Channel MAC key (S-MAC). These keys are only used to generate Secure Channel session keys during the initiation of a Secure Channel; * The data encryption key (DEK) for decrypting sensitive data, e.g. secret or private keys. This key is a double length DES key and is used as a static key. D.3 Cryptographic Usage D.3.1 DES Session Keys DES session keys shall be generated every time a Secure Channel is initiated and are used in the mutual authentication process. These same session keys may be used for subsequent commands if the Current Security Level indicates that secure messaging is required. Session keys are generated to ensure that a different set of keys is used for each Secure Channel Session. While this is not required for key encryption operations, it is important for authentication operations, MAC generation and verification and command message encryption and decryption. It is therefore only necessary to create session keys from the static Secure Channel encryption key (S-ENC) and the Secure Channel MAC key (S-MAC). DES session keys are created using the static Secure Channel encryption key (S-ENC) and the Secure Channel MAC key (S-MAC) and the random host and card challenges. Creating session keys involves 3 steps. * Generating the session key derivation data. (The same derivation data is used to create both the Secure Channel encryption and Secure Channel MAC session keys.); * Creating the Secure Channel encryption session key; * Creating the Secure Channel MAC session key. The DES operation used to generate these keys is always triple DES in ECB mode. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 275 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Card challenge (8 bytes) Host challenge (8 bytes) Host challenge (4 byte left half) Card challenge (4 byte right half) Host challenge (4 byte right half) Card challenge (4 byte left half) Derivation data (16 bytes) Figure D-3: Session Key - Step 1 - Generate Derivation data Static S-ENC key (16 bytes) Derivation data (16 bytes) Session S-ENC key (16 bytes) ECB encryption Figure D-4: Session Key - Step 2 - Create S-ENC Session Key Static S-MAC key (16 bytes) Derivation data (16 bytes) Session S-MAC key (16 bytes) ECB encryption Figure D-5: Session Key ­ Step 3 - Create S-MAC Session Key 276 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. D.3.2 Authentication Cryptograms Both the card and the off-card entity (Host) generate an authentication cryptogram. The off-card entity verifies the card cryptogram and the card verifies the host cryptogram. Generating or verifying an authentication cryptogram uses the S-ENC session key and the signing method described in appendix B.1.2.1 - Full Triple DES. D.3.2.1 Card Authentication Cryptogram The generation and verification of the card cryptogram is performed by concatenating the 8-byte host challenge and 8-byte card challenge resulting in a 16-byte block. Applying the same padding rules defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding, the data shall be padded with a further 8byte block ('80 00 00 00 00 00 00 00'). The signature method, using the S-ENC session key and an ICV of binary zeroes, is applied across this 24-byte block and the resulting 8-byte signature is the card cryptogram. D.3.2.2 Host Authentication Cryptogram The generation and verification of the host cryptogram is performed by concatenating the 8-byte card challenge and 8-byte host challenge resulting in a 16-byte block. Applying the same padding rules defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding, the data shall be padded with a further 8byte block ('80 00 00 00 00 00 00 00'). The signature method, using the S-ENC session key and an ICV of binary zeroes, is applied across this 24-byte block and the resulting 8-byte signature is the host cryptogram. D.3.3 APDU Command MAC Generation and Verification The Secure Channel mandates the use of a MAC on the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command. Depending on the Session Security Level defined in the initiation of the Secure Channel, all other commands within the Secure Channel may require secure messaging and as such the use of a C-MAC. A C-MAC is generated by an off-card entity and applied across the full APDU command being transmitted to the card including the header (5 bytes) and the data field in the command message. (It does not include Le.) Modification of the APDU command header and padding is required prior to the MAC operation being performed. The rules for APDU command header modification are as follows: * The length of the command message (Lc) shall be incremented by 8 to indicate the inclusion of the C-MAC in the data field of the command message; * The class byte shall be modified to indicate that this APDU command includes secure messaging. This is achieved by setting bit b3 of the class byte. For all the commands defined in this specification, the class byte of commands that contain secure messaging shall be '84'. The C-MAC generation and verification does not reflect the logical channel information included in the class byte of the command: the logical channel number is always assumed to be zero in the generation or verification of the C-MAC; * The rules for MAC padding are as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. As the ICV is used to chain the commands for command sequence integrity, the value of the ICV depends on which APDU command within the sequence the MAC is being generated for: * For the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, the ICV is set to binary zeroes; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 277 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * For any command following the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, the ICV is the C-MAC value successfully verified for the previous command received by the card. (Prior to using the ICV, the ICV can be encrypted as described in appendix D.1.5 - ICV Encryption.) The signature method defined in appendix B.1.2.1 - Full Triple DES, using the MAC session key and the ICV, is applied across the padded data block and the resulting 8-byte signature is the C-MAC. The C-MAC is appended at the end of the APDU command message excluding any padding but including the modifications made to the command header (class and Lc). CLA INS P1 P2 Lc Data Field C-MAC C-MAC Generation (full triple DES) C-MAC Session Key CLA INS P1 P2 Lc CLA INS P1 P2 Setbit3 Lc=Lc+length ofC-MAC Padding Data Field Data Field Lc ICV Figure D-6: APDU Command MAC Generation and Verification If no other secure messaging is required, the message is now prepared for transmission to the card. The C-MAC shall be retained and used as the ICV for the subsequent C-MAC verification (if any). The card, in order to verify the C-MAC, shall perform the same padding mechanism to the data and use the same ICV and MAC session key employed by the off-card entity in order to verify the C-MAC. As with the off-card entity, the C-MAC shall be retained and used as the ICV for the subsequent C-MAC verification (if any). If the Secure Channel Session is occurring on a Supplementary Logical Channel, the logical channel number is added to the class byte of the message after the C-MAC has been generated and prior to the message being transmitted to the card. The card shall ignore any logical channel information in the class byte (i.e. assume the logical channel number is zero) prior to verifying the C-MAC. D.3.4 APDU Data Field Encryption and Decryption Depending on the Session Security Level defined in the initiation of the Secure Channel, all subsequent APDU commands within the Secure Channel may require secure messaging and as such the use of a C-MAC (integrity) and encryption (confidentiality). 278 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. If confidentiality is required, the off-card entity encrypts the "clear text" data field of the command message being transmitted to the card. (If the APDU command does not originally contain command data, encryption is not performed.) This excludes the header and the C-MAC but includes any data within the data field that has been protected for another purpose e.g. secret or private keys encrypted with the data encryption key (DEK). Command message encryption and decryption uses the Secure Channel encryption (S-ENC) session key and the full triple DES encryption method described in appendix B.1.1.1 ­ Encryption/Decryption CBC Mode Prior to encrypting the data, the data shall be padded. Unlike the C-MAC, this padding now becomes part of the data field and this necessitates further modification of the Lc value. Padding of the data field to be encrypted is performed according to the following rules: * The length of the original, "clear text", data field is appended to the left of, and becomes part of the command data; * If the length of the data field is now a multiple of 8, no further padding is required else continue with padding as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. The number of bytes appended to the data field in order to fulfill the above padding shall be added to Lc. This includes the mandatory length byte, the optional '80' and any optional binary zeroes. The encryption can now be performed across the padded data field using the Secure Channel encryption session key (S-ENC) and the result of each encryption becomes part of the encrypted data field in the command message. CLA INS P1 P2 Lc Data Field C-M AC Encrypted Data Field C-M AC Data Field Encryption Lc=Lc+1+lengthofpadding Padding Encryption Session Key CLA INS P1 P2 Lc L ICV Figure D-7: APDU Data Field Encryption Note: The ICV and the chaining are only used to link the blocks of the data currently being encrypted. For this reason the ICV for command data encryption is always binary zeroes. The message is now prepared for transmission to the card. The card is required to first decrypt the command message and strip off any padding prior to attempting to verify the C-MAC. This decryption uses an ICV of binary zeroes and the same encryption session key employed by the offcard entity. The padding shall be removed and Lc shall be modified to reflect the length prior to encryption i.e. original clear text data plus C-MAC length. D.3.5 Key Sensitive Data Encryption and Decryption Key data encryption is used when transmitting key sensitive data to the card and is over and beyond the security level required for the Secure Channel. For instance all DES keys transmitted to a card should be encrypted. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 279 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The key data encryption process uses the static data encryption key and the encryption method described in appendix B.1.1.2 - ECB Mode. As all DES keys are by their very nature a multiple of 8-byte lengths no padding is required for key encryption operations. Similarly the sensitive data block length shall be constructed as a multiple of 8-byte long block before the data encryption operations: the eventual padding method is application specific. The encryption is performed across the key sensitive data and the result of each encryption becomes part of the encrypted key data. This encrypted key data becomes part of the "clear text" data field in the command message. The on-card decryption of key data is the exact opposite of the above operation; in particular, no padding is removed by the decryption operation. D.4 Secure Channel APDU Commands Table D-2 provides the list of minimum security requirements for SCP01 commands. Command Minimum Security INITIALIZE UPDATE None EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE C-MAC Table D-2: Minimum Security Requirements for SCP01 Commands The following table provides the list of SCP01 command support per card Life Cycle State. OP_READY INITIALIZED SECURED CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED Command AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD FA SD SD FA SD SD INITIALIZE UPDATE EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Table D-3: SCP01 Command Support per Card Life Cycle State Legend: AM SD: Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege. DM SD: Supplementary Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege. FA SD: Security Domain with Final Application privilege. (Note: command support for an Application with Final Application Privilege which is not a Security Domain is subject to Issuer policy, within the constraints of what is permitted according to the card Life Cycle State.)SD: Supplementary Security Domain without Delegated Management privilege. SD: Other Security Domain. : Support required. Blank cell: Support optional. Striped cell: Support prohibited. 280 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. D.4.1 INITIALIZE UPDATE Command D.4.1.1 Definition and Scope The INITIALIZE UPDATE command is used to transmit card and Secure Channel Session data between the card and the host. This command initiates the initiation of a Secure Channel Session. At any time during a current Secure Channel, the INITIALIZE UPDATE command can be issued to the card in order to initiate a new Secure Channel Session. This INITIALIZE UPDATE command is not to be confused with commands of the same name in legacy applications. D.4.1.2 Command Message The INITIALIZE UPDATE command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '83 See section 11.1.4 INS '50' INITIALIZE UPDATE P1 'xx' Key Version Number P2 'xx' Key Identifier Lc '08' Length of host challenge Data 'xx xx...' Host challenge Le '00' Table D-4: INITIALIZE UPDATE Command Message D.4.1.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 - Key Version Number The Key Version Number defines the Key Version Number within the Security Domain to be used to initiate the Secure Channel Session. If this value is zero, the first available key chosen by the Security Domain will be used. D.4.1.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 - Key Identifier The Key Identifier together with the Key Version Number defined in reference control parameter P1 provide a unique reference to the set of keys to be used to initiate the Secure Channel Session. D.4.1.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message contains 8 bytes of host challenge. This challenge, chosen by the off-card entity, should be unique to this session. D.4.1.6 Response Message The data field of the response message shall contain the concatenation without delimiters of the following data elements: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 281 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Key diversification data 10 bytes Key information 2 bytes Card challenge 8 bytes Card cryptogram 8 bytes Table D-5: INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Message The key diversification data is data typically used by a backend system to derive the card static keys. The key information includes the Key Version Number and the Secure Channel Protocol identifier, here '01', used in initiating the Secure Channel Session. The card challenge is an internally generated random number. The card cryptogram is an authentication cryptogram. D.4.1.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table D-6: INITIALIZE UPDATE Error Condition 282 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. D.4.2 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command D.4.2.1 Definition and Scope The EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command is used by the card to authenticate the host and to determine the level of security required for all subsequent commands. A successful execution of the INITIALIZE UPDATE command shall precede this command. D.4.2.2 Command Message The EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '84' - '87' See section 11.1.4 INS '82' EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE P1 'xx' Security level P2 '00' Reference control parameter P2 Lc '10' Length of host cryptogram and MAC Data 'xx xx...' Host cryptogram and MAC Le Not present Table D-7: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message D.4.2.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 - Security Level The reference control parameter P1 defines the level of security for all secure messaging commands following this EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command (it does not apply to this command) and within this Secure Channel Session. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 C-DECRYPTION and C-MAC. 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 C-MAC 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 No secure messaging expected. Table D-8: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Reference Control Parameter P1 D.4.2.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 shall always be set to '00'. D.4.2.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message contains the host cryptogram and the APDU command MAC. D.4.2.6 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message is not present. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 283 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. D.4.2.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '63' '00' Authentication of host cryptogram failed Table D-9: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Error Condition 284 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E Secure Channel Protocol '02' E.1 Secure Communication Secure Channel Protocol '02' (SCP02) supports up to 19 Supplementary Logical Channels. E.1.1 SCP02 Secure Channel Either the card or the off-card entity may play the role of being the secure sending and receiving entities. SCP02 provides the three followings levels of security: Entity authentication - in which the card authenticates the off-card entity and the off-card entity may authenticate the card, proving that the off-card entity has knowledge of the same secret(s) as the card; Integrity and Data origin authentication - in which the receiving entity (the card or off-card entity) ensures that the data being received actually came from an authenticated sending entity (respectively the off-card entity or card) in the correct sequence and has not been altered; Confidentiality - in which data being transmitted from the sending entity (the off-card entity or card) to the receiving entity (respectively the card or off-card entity) is not viewable by an unauthorized entity. A further level of security applies to sensitive data (e.g. secret keys) that shall always be transmitted as confidential data. In SCP02 the "i" parameter as defined in appendix H - GlobalPlatform Data Values and Card Recognition Data) shall be formed as a bit map on one byte as follows: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description Reserved 1 3 Secure Channel Keys Reserved 0 1 Secure Channel base key Reserved 1 C-MAC on unmodified APDU Reserved 0 C-MAC on modified APDU Reserved 1 Initiation mode explicit Reserved 0 Initiation mode implicit Reserved 1 ICV set to MAC over AID Reserved 0 ICV set to zero Reserved 1 ICV encryption for C-MAC session Reserved 0 No ICV encryption Reserved 1 R-MAC support Reserved 0 No R-MAC support Reserved 1 Well-known pseudo-random algorithm (card challenge) Reserved 0 Unspecified card challenge generation method Table E-1: Values of Parameter "i" Note: "i" is a subidentifier within an object identifier, and bit b8 is reserved for use in the structure of the object identifier according to ISO/IEC 8825-1. The Security Domain shall support at least one of the following implementation options as defined by "i": March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 285 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * "i" = '15': Initiation mode explicit, C-MAC on modified APDU, ICV set to zero, ICV encryption for CMAC session, 3 Secure Channel Keys, unspecified card challenge generation method, no R-MAC; * "i" = '1A': Initiation mode implicit, C-MAC on unmodified APDU, ICV set to MAC over AID, ICV encryption for C-MAC session, 1 Secure Channel base key. no R-MAC; * "i" = '55': Initiation mode explicit, C-MAC on modified APDU, ICV set to zero, ICV encryption for CMAC session, 3 Secure Channel Keys, well-known pseudo-random algorithm (card challenge), no R-MAC. E.1.2 Entity Authentication Off-card entity authentication is achieved through the process of initiating a Secure Channel and provides assurance to the card that it is communicating with an authenticated off-card entity. If any step in the off-card authentication process fails, the process shall be restarted (i.e. new session keys generated). The Secure Channel initiation and off-card entity authentication implies the creation of session keys derived from card static key(s) using a Secure Channel Sequence Counter maintained by the Security Domain. The Security Domain shall manage one Sequence Counter per Secure Channel base key or Secure Channel keys sharing the same Key Version Number (see appendix E.2 - Cryptographic Keys). The Sequence Counter is incremented by 1 when and only when the first C-MAC of a secure channel (started implicitly or explicitly) is verified as valid. It is incremented before the processing specific for the command. The Sequence Counter is reset to zero on creation or update of the Secure Channel key(s). When the Secure Channel key set contains more than one key (see appendix E.2 - Cryptographic Keys), the Sequence Counter is reset to zero on the creation or update of any one of the keys of this key set. Note: the Sequence Counter is not updated for a C-MAC that is not the first of a Secure Channel Session or when a Secure Channel Session is started and the C-MAC is invalid. In this respect, the Sequence Counter keeps track of the number of valid Secure Channel Sessions the corresponding secure messaging key set has experienced so far. When reaching its maximum value, the Sequence Counter shall not be reset to zero. Cards are not required to support counter values beyond 32767. E.1.2.1 Explicit Secure Channel Initiation The Secure Channel may be explicitly initiated by the off-card entity using the INITIALIZE UPDATE and EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE commands. The Application may pass the APDU to the Security Domain using the appropriate API e.g. the processSecurity() method of a GlobalPlatform Java Card. The explicit Secure Channel initiation allows the off-card entity to instruct the card (see appendix E.5.2 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command) as to what level of security is required for the current Secure Channel (integrity and/or confidentiality) and apply this level of security to all the subsequent messages exchanged between the card and the off-card entity until the end of the session. It also gives the off-card entity the possibility of selecting the Key Version Number to be used (see appendix E.5.1 - INITIALIZE UPDATE Command). Note: The explicit Secure Channel Session initiation also allows the card to inform the off-card entity what Secure Channel Protocol is supported, using the returned Secure Channel Protocol identifier. The Secure Channel is always initiated (see appendix E.5.1 - INITIALIZE UPDATE Command) by the off-card entity by passing a "host" challenge (random data unique to this session) to the card. The card, on receipt of this challenge, generates its own "card" challenge (again random data unique to this session). The card, using its internal Sequence Counter and static keys, creates new secret session keys and generates a first cryptographic value (card cryptogram) using one of its newly created session keys (see appendix E.4.1 - DES Session Keys). 286 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. This card cryptogram along with the Sequence Counter, the card challenge, the Secure Channel Protocol identifier, and other data is transmitted back to the off-card entity. As the off-card entity should now have all the same information that the card used to generate the card cryptogram, it should be able to generate the same session keys and the same card cryptogram and by performing a comparison, it is able to authenticate the card. The off-card entity now uses a similar process to create a second cryptographic value (host cryptogram) to be passed back to the card (see appendix E.5.2 - EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command). As the card has all the same information that the host used to generate the host cryptogram, it should be able to generate the same cryptogram and, by performing a comparison, it is able to authenticate the off-card entity. The off-card entity also creates a MAC to be passed back to the card and verified by the card. The verified MAC is used by the card to create the Initial Chaining Vector for the verification of the subsequent C-MAC and/or R-MAC. When the off-card entity is successfully authenticated, the card increments its internal Secure Channel Sequence Counter. Explicit Secure Channel Initiation Flow The following flow is an example of explicit Secure Channel initiation between a card and an off-card entity. Expanding the authentication process shown in the flow described in section 7.3.4 - Runtime Messaging Support, it can be seen how an Application would use the services of a Security Domain to achieve the explicit Secure Channel initiation. APDU Interface Off-card Entity Security Domain Mutual authentication INITIALIZE UPDATE INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Generate host challenge Generate card challenge; Generate session keys; Calculate card cryptogram Apply Secure Channel Protocol; Generate session keys; Verify card cryptogram; Calculate host cryptogram EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Verify host cryptogram; Verify MAC & Initialize ICV Application GP API security processing security processing Figure E-1: Explicit Secure Channel Initiation Flow E.1.2.2 Implicit Secure Channel Initiation The Secure Channel is implicitly initiated when receiving the first APDU command that contains a cryptographic protection (C-MAC). The required level of security is implicitly known by both the card and off-card entity as command message integrity only. The off-card entity implicitly knows which keys are to be used and the current March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 287 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. value of the Secure Channel Sequence Counter, or may have previously retrieved the corresponding information using a GET DATA command. The off-card entity, using the information it knows about the card static keys and its Secure Channel Sequence Counter, creates new secret session keys and generates a C-MAC on an APDU command message. The Secure Channel is initiated by the off-card entity by appending a C-MAC to an APDU command. The card, on receipt of this first C-MAC, creates the C-MAC session key using its internal card static key(s) and Secure Channel Sequence Counter. The card has the same information that the host used to generate the C-MAC. It generates the same MAC and, by performing a comparison, it authenticates the off-card entity. When the off-card entity is successfully authenticated, the card increments its internal Secure Channel Sequence Counter. For sensitive data decryption, the card creates the data encryption session key using its internal card static key(s) and the newly incremented value of the Secure Channel Sequence Counter. For R-MAC generation, the card creates the R-MAC session key using its internal card static key(s) and the newly incremented value of the Secure Channel Sequence Counter. Note: In addition to command message integrity, the off-card entity may, at any moment during the Secure Channel Session, initiate response message integrity using the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command. E.1.3 Message Integrity The MAC is generated by applying multiple chained DES operations (using a session key generated prior to or when opening the Secure Channel) across an APDU message. A MAC may be generated on the following: * C-MAC for APDU command messages (generated by the off-card entity); * R-MAC for APDU response messages (generated by the card). The receiving entity, on receipt of the message containing a MAC, using the same session key, performs the same operation and by comparing its generated MAC with the MAC received from the sending entity is assured of the integrity of the full command or response. (If message data confidentiality has also been applied to the message, the MAC applies to the message data field before encryption.) The integrity of the sequence of APDU command or response messages being transmitted to the receiving entity is achieved by using the MAC from the current command or response as the (possibly encrypted) Initial Chaining Vector (ICV) for the subsequent command or response. This ensures the receiving entity that all messages in a sequence have been received. Computing the ICV is detailed in appendix E.3 - Cryptographic Algorithms. E.1.4 Message Data Confidentiality The message data field is encrypted by applying multiple chained DES operations (using a session key generated during the Secure Channel initiation process) across the entire data field of either a command message or a response, regardless of its contents (clear text data and/or already protected sensitive data). E.1.5 Security Level The Current Security Level of a communication not included in a Secure Channel Session shall be set to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. 288 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. For Secure Channel Protocol '02' with explicit initiation mode, the Current Security Level established in a Secure Channel Session is a bitmap combination of the following values: AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC, R_MAC, and C_DECRYPTION. The Current Security Level shall be set as follows: * NO_SECURITY_LEVEL when a Secure Channel Session is terminated or not yet fully initiated; * AUTHENTICATED after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command: AUTHENTICATED shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated; * C_MAC after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command with P1 indicating C-MAC (P1='x1' or 'x3'): C-MAC shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated. Note that C_MAC is always combined with AUTHENTICATED and simultaneously set and cleared; * C_DECRYPTION after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command with P1 indicating Command Encryption (P1= 'x3'): C_DECRYPTION shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated. Note that C_DECRYPTION is always combined with AUTHENTICATED and C_MAC and simultaneously set and cleared; * R_MAC after a successful processing of an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command with P1 indicating R-MAC (P1='1x'): R-MAC shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated. Note that in this case R_MAC is always combined with AUTHENTICATED and simultaneously set and cleared. R_MAC may also be combined with C_MAC or C_DECRYPTION (according to the P1 value of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command) and simultaneously set and cleared; * R_MAC after a successful processing of a BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command: R-MAC shall be cleared after a successful processing of an END R-MAC SESSION command. Note that in this case R_MAC may be combined with AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC or C_DECRYPTION depending on the pre-existing Current Security Level of the Secure Channel Session. R_MAC is set and cleared independently of AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC or C_DECRYPTION. For Secure Channel Protocol '02' with implicit initiation mode, the Current Security Level established in a Secure Channel Session is a bitmap combination of the following values: AUTHENTICATED, C_MAC, and R_MAC. The Current Security Level shall be set as follows: * NO_SECURITY_LEVEL when a Secure Channel Session is terminated or not yet initiated; * AUTHENTICATED and C_MAC after a successful verification of the C- MAC of the first command message with a C-MAC. The Session Security Level shall be set to AUTHENTICATED only. C_MAC shall be cleared after the reception of the first command message without a C-MAC. AUTHENTICATED and C_MAC shall be cleared once the Secure Channel Session is terminated; * R_MAC after a successful processing of a BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command: R-MAC shall be cleared after a successful processing of an END R-MAC SESSION command. E.1.6 Protocol Rules In accordance with the general rules described in chapter 10 - Secure Communication, the following protocol rules apply to Secure Channel Protocol `02' with explicit initiation mode: * The successful explicit initiation of a Secure Channel Session shall set the Current Security Level to the security level value indicated in the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command: it is at least set to AUTHENTICATED; * The Current Security Level shall apply to the entire Secure Channel Session unless successfully modified at the request of the Application; * When the Current Security Level is not set to AUTHENTICATED (i.e. equal to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL or R-MAC only ­ case of a R-MAC session in progress originally initiated with a BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command): March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 289 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. - If the Secure Channel Session was aborted during the same Application Session, the incoming command shall be rejected with a security error; - Otherwise no security verification of the incoming command shall be performed. The Application processing the command is responsible for applying its own security rules. * If a Secure Channel Session is active for incoming commands (i.e. Current Security Level at least set to AUTHENTICATED), the security of the incoming command shall be checked according to the Current Security Level regardless of the command secure messaging indicator: - When the security of the command does not match (nor exceeds) the Current Security Level, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - If a security error is found, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - In all other cases, the Secure Channel Session shall remain active and the Current Security Level unmodified. The Application is responsible for further processing the command. * If the Security Domain supports application data encryption and/or decryption, it shall decrypt or encrypt a block of secret data upon request. If the service is not supported or if (one of) the appropriate cryptographic key(s) is not available, the request shall be rejected but the Current Security Level, Session Security Level and Secure Channel Session in operation (if any) shall not be impacted; * If a Secure Channel Session is aborted, it is still considered not terminated; * The current Secure Channel Session shall be terminated (if aborted or still open) and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL on either: - Attempt to initiate a new Secure Channel Session (new INITIALIZE UPDATE command); - Termination of the Application Session (e.g. new Application selection); - Termination of the associated logical channel; - Termination of the Card Session (card reset or power off); - Explicit termination by the Application (e.g. invoking GlobalPlatform API). In accordance with the general rules described in chapter 10 - Secure Communication, the following protocol rules apply to Secure Channel Protocol `02' with implicit initiation mode: * The successful implicit initiation of a Secure Channel Session for incoming commands shall set the Current Security Level to AUTHENTICATED and C-MAC (the R-MAC indicator remaining as is); * The Session Security Level for incoming commands is implicit and set to AUTHENTICATED for the entire Secure Channel Session. It is reset on the normal termination or abort of a Secure Channel Session for incoming commands; * When the Current Security Level is not set to AUTHENTICATED (i.e. equal to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL or R-MAC only), no Secure Channel Session is active for incoming commands: - If no secure messaging is indicated in the incoming command, no security verification of the command shall be performed. The Application processing the command is responsible to apply its own security rules; - If secure messaging is indicated, a new Secure Channel Session initiation for incoming commands shall be attempted and the security of the incoming command verified. 290 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * If a Secure Channel Session is active for incoming commands (i.e. Current Security Level at least set to AUTHENTICATED), the security of the incoming command shall be checked according to the Current Security Level: - If no secure messaging is indicated in the command, the Secure Channel Session shall remain active, the Current Security Level set to AUTHENTICATED (the R-MAC indicator remaining as is) and no further security verification of the command performed. The Application processing the command is responsible to apply its own security rules; - If secure messaging is indicated and the Current Security Level is set to AUTHENTICATED and CMAC (ignoring the R-MAC indicator), the security of the incoming command shall be verified: If a security error is found, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL or R-MAC only (in case of a R-MAC session in progress); Otherwise, the Secure Channel Session shall remain active and the Current Security Level unmodified. The Application is responsible for further processing the command. - If secure messaging is indicated and the Current Security Level is set to AUTHENTICATED (ignoring the R-MAC indicator), the current Secure Channel Session for incoming commands shall be terminated and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL or R-MAC only (in case of a R-MAC session in progress). A new Secure Channel Session initiation for incoming commands shall be attempted and the security of the incoming command verified. * The current Secure Channel Session shall be terminated (if aborted or still open) and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL on either: - Termination of the Application Session (e.g. new Application selection); - Termination of the associated logical channel; - Termination of the Card Session (card reset or power off); - Explicit termination by the Application (e.g. invoking GlobalPlatform API). E.2 Cryptographic Keys A Security Domain, including the Issuer Security Domain, shall have at least one key set to be used in the initiation and use of a Secure Channel. This key set shall contain at least one double length DES key, the Secure Channel base key. This Secure Channel base key is only used to generate session keys during the initiation of a Secure Channel. Key Usage Length Remark Secure Channel base key Secure Channel authentication, MAC verification, & sensitive data decryption (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory Table E-2: SCP02 - Security Domain Secure Channel Base Key A Security Domain's, including the Issuer Security Domain's, Secure Channel key set may contain 3 double length DES keys: the Secure Channel encryption key (S-ENC), the Secure Channel MAC key (S-MAC), and the data encryption key (DEK) for decrypting sensitive data, e.g. secret or private keys. These keys are only used to generate session keys during the initiation of a Secure Channel. Key Usage Length Remark Secure Channel encryption key (S- ENC) Secure Channel authentication & encryption (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 291 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Key Usage Length Remark Secure Channel message authentication code key (S-MAC) Secure Channel MAC verification and generation (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory Data encryption key (DEK) Sensitive data decryption (DES) 16 bytes Mandatory Table E-3: SCP02 - Security Domain Secure Channel Keys E.3 Cryptographic Algorithms The cryptographic and hashing algorithms described in appendix B - Algorithms (Cryptographic and Hashing) apply to SCP02. This section defines the additional requirements for SCP02. E.3.1 Cipher Block Chaining (CBC) The Initial Chaining Vector (ICV) used for chained data encryption in CBC mode is always 8 bytes of binary zero ('00'). The Initial Chaining Vector (ICV) used for chained message integrity in CBC mode is always 8 bytes and initialized during the Secure Channel initiation. E.3.2 Message Integrity ICV using Explicit Secure Channel Initiation When using explicit Secure Channel initiation, SCP02 mandates the use of a MAC on the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command. For the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command MAC verification, the ICV is set to zero. Once successfully verified, the MAC of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command becomes the ICV for the subsequent C-MAC verification and/or R-MAC generation. E.3.3 Message Integrity ICV using Implicit Secure Channel Initiation When using implicit Secure Channel Session initiation, the ICV shall be a MAC computed on the AID of the selected Application. The ICV for the first C-MAC calculation of a new Secure Channel Session is calculated as follows: * Apply reversible padding to the AID of the selected Application as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding; * Calculate a MAC as defined in appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES with the C-MAC key over the padded Application AID with an ICV value of binary zeroes. The resulting MAC is the ICV for the first C-MAC of the Secure Channel Session. This ICV makes the Secure Channel Session application specific. The ICV for the first R-MAC of a Secure Channel Session is calculated the same way, except that the R-MAC key is used in step 2 for the MAC calculation. E.3.4 ICV Encryption As an enhancement to the C-MAC mechanism, the ICV is encrypted before being applied to the calculation of the next C-MAC. The encryption mechanism used is single DES with the first half of the Secure Channel C-MAC session key. The first ICV of a session is not encrypted. 292 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.4 Cryptographic Usage E.4.1 DES Session Keys DES session keys are generated every time a Secure Channel is initiated. These session keys may be used for subsequent commands if secure messaging is required. Session keys are generated to ensure that a different set of keys is used for each secure communication session. DES session keys are created using the static Secure Channel key(s), the current value of the Secure Channel Sequence Counter, a constant, and a padding of binary zeroes. Creating session keys is performed as follows: * Generating the Secure Channel C-MAC session keys using the Secure Channel base key or MAC key (SMAC) and the session keys derivation data with a constant of '0101'; * Generating the Secure Channel R-MAC session keys using the Secure Channel base key or MAC key (SMAC) and the session keys derivation data with a constant of '0102'; * Generating the Secure Channel encryption session keys using the Secure Channel base key or encryption key (S-ENC) and the session keys derivation data with a constant of '0182'; * Generating the Secure Channel data encryption session keys using the Secure Channel base key or data encryption key (DEK) and the session keys derivation data with a constant of '0181'. The DES operation used to generate these keys is always triple DES in CBC mode. R-MAC session keys are generated using the current value of the sequence counter at the time the R-MAC session is initiated. If the R-MAC session starts with the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, the same sequence counter value is used to generate the R-MAC session key as is used to generate the other session keys for the same Secure Channel Session. S ec ure C hannel bas e key (16 bytes ) D erivation data (16 bytes ) S es s ion K ey (16 bytes ) C B C enc ryption C ons tant (2 bytes ) S equenc e C ounter (2 bytes ) '00' P adding (12 bytes ) Figure E-2: Create Secure Channel Session Key from the Base Key E.4.2 Authentication Cryptograms in Explicit Secure Channel Initiation Both the card and the off-card entity (host) generate an authentication cryptogram. The off-card entity verifies the card cryptogram and the card verifies the host cryptogram. Generating or verifying an authentication cryptogram uses the S-ENC session key and the signing method described in appendix B.1.2.1 - Full Triple DES. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 293 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.4.2.1 Card Authentication Cryptogram The generation and verification of the card cryptogram is performed by concatenating the 8-byte host challenge, 2byte Sequence Counter, and 6-byte card challenge resulting in a 16-byte block. Applying the same padding rules defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding, the data shall be padded with a further 8byte block ('80 00 00 00 00 00 00 00'). The signature method, using the S-ENC session key and an ICV of binary zeroes, is applied across this 24-byte block and the resulting 8-byte signature is the card cryptogram. E.4.2.2 Host Authentication Cryptogram The generation and verification of the host cryptogram is performed by concatenating the 2-byte Sequence Counter, 6-byte card challenge, and 8-byte host challenge resulting in a 16-byte block. Applying the same padding rules defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding, the data shall be padded with a further 8byte block ('80 00 00 00 00 00 00 00'). The signature method, using the S-ENC session key and an ICV of binary zeroes, is applied across this 24-byte block and the resulting 8-byte signature is the host cryptogram. E.4.2.3 Card Challenge The card challenge is either a random or pseudo-random number that shall be unique to a Secure Channel Session. A pseudo-random card challenge may be generated as follows: * The AID of the currently selected Application is padded according to the padding rules defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding; * A MAC is calculated across the padded data as defined in appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES MAC, using the C-MAC session key and an ICV of binary zeroes; * The six leftmost bytes of the resultant MAC constitute the card challenge. E.4.3 Authentication Cryptogram in Implicit Secure Channel Initiation When using the implicit Secure Channel Session initiation, the authentication cryptogram is the first C-MAC received by the card from the off-card entity. The rules for C-MAC generation and verification are detailed in the following subsection. E.4.4 APDU Command C-MAC Generation and Verification A C-MAC is generated by an off-card entity and applied across the full APDU command being transmitted to the card including the header and the data field in the command message. It does not include Le. C-MAC generation and verification uses the Secure Channel C-MAC session key, an ICV and the signature method described in appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES. (Prior to using the ICV, the ICV can be encrypted as described in appendix E.3.4 - ICV Encryption) The ICV is used to chain the commands for command sequence integrity; the initial value of the ICV is described in appendix E.3 - Cryptographic Algorithms. For any subsequent command following the first successful C-MAC verification, the ICV is the C-MAC value successfully verified for the previous command received by the card. The signature method, using the Secure Channel C-MAC session key and the ICV, is applied across the padded command message and the resulting 8-byte signature is the C-MAC. The rules for C-MAC padding are as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. 294 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. To reflect the presence of a C-MAC in the command message, the command header shall be modified as follows: * The length of the command message (Lc) shall be incremented by 8 to indicate the inclusion of the C-MAC in the data field of the command message; * The class byte shall be modified to indicate that this APDU command includes secure messaging. This is achieved by either setting to '1' bit 3 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 0 to 4 (unprotected CLA set to '00' - '03' or '80' - '83') or by setting to '1' bit 6 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 4 to 19 (unprotected CLA set to '40' - '4F' or 'C0' - 'CF'): see section 11.1.4. The C-MAC generation and verification does not reflect the logical channel information included in the class byte of the command: the logical channel number is always assumed to be zero in the generation or verification of the C-MAC. The C-MAC is appended at the end of the APDU command message excluding any padding but including the modifications made to the command header (class and Lc). The two following methods are defined for the C-MAC generation: * C-MAC generation on unmodified APDU: padding of the APDU command is required prior to the C-MAC generation being performed, and modification of the APDU command header is required after the C-MAC generation has been performed; CLA INS P1 P2 Lc Data Field C-MAC C-MAC Generation (single DES plus final triple DES) C-MAC Session Key CLA INS P1 P2 Lc Setsecuremessagingbit Lc=Lc+lengthofC-MAC PaddingData Field ICV Figure E-3: C-MAC Generation on Unmodified APDU * C-MAC generation on modified APDU: padding of the APDU command and modification of the command header is required prior to the C-MAC generation being performed. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 295 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. C LA IN S P 1 P 2 Lc D ata Field C -M A C C -M A C G eneratio n (single D E S plus final triple D E S ) C -M A C S essio n K ey C LA IN S P 1 P 2 Lc C LA IN S P 1 P 2 Setsecure messagingbit Lc=Lc+length ofC-MAC P adding D ata Field D ata Field Lc IC V Figure E-4: C-MAC Generation on Modified APDU If no other secure messaging is required, the message is now prepared for transmission to the card. The card, in order to verify the C-MAC, shall perform the same padding mechanism to the data and use the same ICV and C-MAC session key employed by the off-card entity in order to verify the C-MAC. The verified C-MAC shall be retained and used as the ICV for any subsequent C-MAC verification. This is true regardless of whether the APDU completed successfully or not i.e. a verified C-MAC shall never be discarded in favor of a previous verified C-MAC value. If the Secure Channel Session is occurring on a Supplementary Logical Channel, the logical channel number is added to the class byte of the message after the C-MAC has been generated and prior to the message being transmitted to the card. The card shall remove any logical channel information from the class byte (i.e. assume the logical channel number is zero) prior to verifying the C-MAC. E.4.5 APDU Response R-MAC Generation and Verification When using explicit Secure Channel Session initiation, the off-card entity instructs the card whether R-MAC generation applies to all the subsequent command/response messages. The APDU response message integrity does not include the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command/response pair and lasts until the end of the Secure Channel Session. When using implicit Secure Channel Session initiation, the off-card entity instructs the card to start APDU response message integrity using the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command (see appendix E.5.3 - BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command). The APDU response message integrity includes the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command/response pair and lasts until reception of the END R-MAC SESSION command (see appendix E.5.4 - END R-MAC SESSION Command). The R-MAC is computed on the following data block: * The stripped APDU command message, i.e. without any C-MAC and modified command header (the logical channel number is always assumed to be zero). In the case of a case 1 or case 2 command, Lc is always present and set to zero; 296 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * In case of a successful execution or a warning, the response data preceded with a byte Li that codes its length modulo 256. Li is generated by the Security Domain. If there is no response data this byte is present and is set to zero; * In case of an error, a byte set to `00' indicating no response data; * The status bytes. When an R-MAC is returned in response to every command, in the event of case 1 and case 3 commands received by the card, these commands shall be processed respectively as case 2 and case 4 commands with Le set to zero. The signature method, using the Secure Channel R-MAC session key and the ICV, is applied across the padded data block and the resulting 8-byte signature is the R-MAC. The rules for R-MAC padding are as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. Header (CLA, INS, P1, P2) R-MAC R-MAC Session Key Command Data Field Response Data Field Padding Status Words Response Data Field R-MAC generation Status Words Li: Length of R-Data Lc ICV Figure E-5: R-MAC Generation The R-MAC can be retrieved from the card by sending an END R-MAC SESSION command. The END R-MAC SESSION command allows the off-card entity to instruct the card to either terminate or continue the R-MAC session. The END R-MAC SESSION command is not included in the R-MAC computation. The off-card entity, in order to verify the R-MAC, shall perform the same padding mechanism to the command/response pair and use the same ICV and R-MAC session key employed by the card in order to verify the R-MAC. The generated R-MAC shall be retained and used as the ICV for any subsequent R-MAC generation. (This is true regardless of whether the APDU command completed successfully or not.) If the Secure Channel Session is occurring on a Supplementary Logical Channel, the logical channel information is not included in any of the R-MAC computations. The R-MAC is generated with a logical channel number assumed to be zero and the off-card entity is either not aware of, or removes, any logical channel information from the class byte of the corresponding command when verifying the R-MAC. E.4.6 APDU Command Data Field Encryption and Decryption Depending on the Session Security Level defined in the explicit initiation of the Secure Channel, all subsequent APDU commands within the Secure Channel may require secure messaging and as such the use of a C-MAC (integrity) and encryption (confidentiality). Note that, with an implicit initiation of the Secure Channel, command message data field encryption does not apply. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 297 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. If confidentiality is required, the off-card entity encrypts the data field of the command message being transmitted to the card. This excludes the header and the C-MAC but includes any data within the data field that has been protected for another purpose e.g. secret or private keys encrypted with the data encryption session key. Command message encryption and decryption uses the Secure Channel encryption session key and the encryption method described in appendix B.1.1.1 ­ Encryption/Decryption CBC Mode. Prior to encrypting the data, the data shall be padded. Unlike the C-MAC, this padding now becomes part of the data field and this necessitates further modification of the Lc value. Padding of the data field to be encrypted is performed according to appendix B.4 - DES Padding. The number of bytes appended to the data field in order to fulfill the above padding shall be added to Lc. This includes the mandatory '80' and any optional binary zeroes. The encryption can now be performed across the padded data field using the Secure Channel encryption session key and the result of each encryption becomes part of the encrypted data field in the command message. Lc=Lc+lengthofpadding CLA INS P1 P2 Lc Data Field C-MAC Encrypted Data Field C-MAC Data Field Encryption Padding Encryption Session Key CLA INS P1 P2 Lc ICV Figure E-6: APDU Command Data Field Encryption Note: The ICV and the chaining are only used to link the blocks of the data currently being encrypted. For this reason the ICV for command data encryption is always binary zeroes. The message is now prepared for transmission to the card. The card is required to first decrypt the command message and strip off any padding prior to attempting to verify the C-MAC. This decryption uses an ICV of binary zeroes and the same encryption session key employed by the off-card entity. The padding shall be removed and Lc shall be modified to reflect the length prior to encryption i.e. original clear text data plus C-MAC length. E.4.7 Sensitive Data Encryption and Decryption Data encryption is used when transmitting sensitive data to the card and is over and beyond the Current Security Level required for the Secure Channel; For instance all DES keys transmitted to a card (e.g. in a PUT KEY command) should be encrypted. The data encryption process uses the data encryption session key and the encryption method described in appendix B.1.1.2 ­ Encryption/Decryption ECB Mode when using explicit initiation of the Secure Channel and appendix B.1.1.1 ­ Encryption/Decryption CBC Mode when using implicit initiation of the Secure Channel. As all DES keys are by their very nature a multiple of 8-byte lengths no padding is required for key encryption operations. Similarly the sensitive data block length shall be constructed as a multiple of 8-byte long block before the data encryption operations: the eventual padding method is application specific. 298 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The encryption is performed across the sensitive data and the result of each encryption becomes part of the encrypted data. This encrypted data becomes part of the "clear text" data field in the command message. The on-card decryption of key data, is the exact opposite of the above operation: in particular, no padding is removed by the decryption operation. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 299 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5 Secure Channel APDU Commands Secure Channel Initiation Command Explicit Implicit INITIALIZE UPDATE EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE BEGIN R-MAC SESSION END R-MAC SESSION Table E-4: SCP02 Command Support Table E-5 summarizes the minimum security requirements for the APDU commands. Minimum Security Command Explicit Implicit INITIALIZE UPDATE None EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE C-MAC BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Secure Channel initiation END R-MAC SESSION Secure Channel initiation Dependent on the Issuer security policy Table E-5: Minimum Security Requirements for SCP02 Commands Note that Table E-4 shall be used in conjunction with Table E-6 to determine SCP02 command support requirements. The following table provides the list of SCP02 command support per card Life Cycle State. OP_READY INITIALIZED SECURED CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED Command AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD FA SD SD FA SD SD INITIALIZE UPDATE EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE BEGIN R-MAC SESSION END R-MAC SESSION Table E-6: SCP02 Command Support per card Life Cycle State Legend of Table E-4 and Table E-6: AM SD: Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege. DM SD: Supplementary Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege. FA SD: Security Domain with Final Application privilege. (Note: command support for an Application with Final Application Privilege which is not a Security Domain is subject to Issuer policy, within the constraints of what is permitted according to the card Life Cycle State.) SD: Other Security Domain. 300 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. : Support required. Blank cell: Support optional. Striped cell: Support prohibited. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 301 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.1 INITIALIZE UPDATE Command E.5.1.1 Definition and Scope The INITIALIZE UPDATE command is used, during explicit initiation of a Secure Channel, to transmit card and session data between the card and the host. This command initiates the initiation of a Secure Channel Session. At any time during a current Secure Channel, the INITIALIZE UPDATE command can be issued to the card in order to initiate a new Secure Channel Session. This INITIALIZE UPDATE command is not to be confused with commands of the same name in legacy applications. E.5.1.2 Command Message The INITIALIZE UPDATE command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '83' or 'C0' - 'CF' See section 11.1.4 INS '50' INITIALIZE UPDATE P1 'xx' Key Version Number P2 '00' Reference control parameter P2 Lc '08' Length of host challenge Data 'xx xx...' Host challenge Le '00' Table E-7: INITIALIZE UPDATE Command Message E.5.1.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 - Key Version Number The Key Version Number defines the Key Version Number within the Security Domain to be used to initiate the Secure Channel Session. If this value is zero, the first available key chosen by the Security Domain will be used. E.5.1.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 shall always be set to '00'. E.5.1.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message contains 8 bytes of host challenge. This challenge, chosen by the off-card entity, should be unique to this session. E.5.1.6 Response Message The data field of the response message contains the concatenation without delimiters of the following data elements: 302 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Key diversification data 10 bytes Key information 2 bytes Sequence Counter 2 bytes Card challenge 6 bytes Card cryptogram 8 bytes Table E-8: INITIALIZE UPDATE Response Message The key diversification data is data typically used by a backend system to derive the card static keys. The key information includes the Key Version Number and the Secure Channel Protocol identifier, here '02', used in initiating the Secure Channel Session. The Sequence Counter is an internal incremental counter used for creating session keys. The card challenge is an internally generated random number. The card cryptogram is an authentication cryptogram. E.5.1.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table E-9: INITIALIZE UPDATE Error Condition March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 303 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.2 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command E.5.2.1 Definition and Scope The EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command is used by the card, during explicit initiation of a Secure Channel, to authenticate the host and to determine the level of security required for all subsequent commands. A successful execution of the INITIALIZE UPDATE command shall precede this command. E.5.2.2 Command Message The EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command message is coded according to the following table. Code Value Meaning CLA '84' - '87' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS '82' EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE P1 'xx' Security level P2 '00' Reference control parameter P2 Lc '10' Length of host cryptogram and MAC Data 'xx xx...' Host cryptogram and MAC Le Not present Table E-10: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message E.5.2.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 - Security Level The reference control parameter P1 defines the level of security for all secure messaging commands following this EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command (it does not apply to this command) and within this Secure Channel Session. Table E-11: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Reference Control Parameter P1 E.5.2.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 shall always be set to '00'. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 RFU 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 1 RFU 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 RFU 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 C-DECRYPTION, C-MAC and R-MAC 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 C-MAC and R-MAC 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 R-MAC 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 C-DECRYPTION and C-MAC 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 C-MAC 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 No secure messaging expected. 304 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.2.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message contains the host cryptogram and the C-MAC. E.5.2.6 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message is not present. E.5.2.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following warning condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '63' '00' Authentication of host cryptogram failed Table E-12: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE warning Code March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 305 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.3 BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command E.5.3.1 Definition and Scope The BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command is used to initiate a Secure Channel Session for APDU response message integrity. At any time, the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command may be issued to the card in order to initiate a RMAC session. E.5.3.2 Command Message The BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '87', 'C0' -'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS '7A' BEGIN R-MAC SESSION P1 'xx' Reference control parameter P1 P2 '01' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of data field, if any Data 'xx xx...' BEGIN R-MAC SESSION data and C-MAC, if needed Le Not present Table E-13: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command Message E.5.3.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 The reference control parameter P1 defines the level of security for all subsequent APDU response messages following this BEGIN R-MAC SESSION command (it does not apply to this command). b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description 0 0 1 1 0 0 0 0 Response Encryption and R-MAC (RFU) 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 R-MAC 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 No secure messaging expected Table E-14: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Reference Control Parameter P1 When P1 is set to '10' each APDU response message during the R-MAC session includes a R-MAC. When P1 is set to '00' only the END R-MAC SESSION response message will contain a R-MAC. E.5.3.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 defines the beginning of the session for APDU response message integrity. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 Begin R-MAC session Table E-15: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Reference Control Parameter P2 306 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.3.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION contains an LV coded `data' element and optionally a C­MAC. The card does not interpret the `data'. However since it is included in R-MAC calculation, this gives the off-card entity the possibility to include a challenge in the R-MAC. The following table details the BEGIN R-MAC SESSION data field: Length Name Presence 1 Length of data Mandatory 0-24 data Conditional Table E-16: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Command Data Field E.5.3.6 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of the response message is not present. E.5.3.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table E-17: BEGIN R-MAC SESSION Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 307 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.4 END R-MAC SESSION Command E.5.4.1 Definition and Scope The END R-MAC SESSION command is used to terminate a Secure Channel Session for APDU response message integrity or to retrieve the current R-MAC without ending the R-MAC Session. The END R-MAC SESSION command may be issued to the card at any time during an R-MAC session, . E.5.4.2 Command Message The END R-MAC SESSION command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '80' - '87', 'C0' -'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS '78' END R-MAC SESSION P1 '00' Reference control parameter P1 P2 '01' or '03' Reference control parameter P2 Lc 'xx' Length of data field, if any Data 'xx xx...' C-MAC, if needed Le '00' Table E-18: END R-MAC SESSION Command Message E.5.4.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 Reference control parameter P1 shall always be set to '00'. E.5.4.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 The reference control parameter P2 is coded according to the following table: b8 b7 b6 B5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 End R-MAC session & return R-MAC 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 Return R-MAC Table E-19: END R-MAC SESSION Reference Control Parameter P2 E.5.4.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the command message may optionally contain a C-MAC. E.5.4.6 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The data field of response message contains the R-MAC of the current R-MAC session. 308 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. E.5.4.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. This command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or the following error condition: SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table E-20: END R-MAC SESSION Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 309 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F Secure Channel Protocol '10' F.1 Secure Communication Secure Channel Protocol `10' (SCP10) supports up to 19 Supplementary Logical Channels. F.1.1 SCP10 Secure Channel SCP10 is a Secure Channel Protocol based on asymmetric cryptography and a public key infrastructure (PKI) for initiating a Secure Channel, and the use of symmetric session keys for secure messaging during subsequent operation of the Secure Channel Session. The Secure Channel Protocol operates between a Security Domain on the card (or the Issuer Security Domain) and an Off-Card Entity (OCE) which may be the Application Provider (or Card Issuer) or another party. SCP10 provides the following three levels of security: Authentication - in which the Security Domain authenticates the Off-Card Entity and the Off-Card Entity may authenticate the Security Domain. There are two aspects to this: Certificate Verification which involves establishing the validity of each other's public key (PK); and Entity Authentication which involves establishing that the other party in the Secure Channel Session is authentic owner of that public key. Integrity and data origin authentication - in which the Security Domain and the Off-Card Entity ensure that the data being received from the other entity actually came from its claimed source in the correct sequence and has not been altered. Confidentiality - in which confidential data is not viewable by an unauthorized entity. A further level of security applies to specific sensitive data (e.g. cryptographic keys) which may be encrypted using a mechanism that is not part of the Secure Channel Session security. The steps involved in initiating a Secure Channel Protocol are as follows: 1. Certificate Verification (optional) - the Security Domain and the Off-Card Entity (OCE) may need to traverse and verify a chain of certificates from established trust points down to each other's public key. The extent to which this is needed depends on what keys are currently validated by each party: the null condition is where they have both already validated each other's public key, in which case no explicit Certificate Verification is necessary; 2. Entity Authentication - the Security Domain and optionally the Off-Card Entity further check the authenticity of the other party by verifying the signature of a challenge sent to the other party; 3. Session key establishment - the two parties establish symmetric session keys for subsequent secure messaging. Only explicit Secure Channel initiation is supported in SCP10. There is no specific command to terminate a session. Some of the variations on the Secure Channel Protocol supported by the card or the Security Domain are announced in the parameter "i" in Card Recognition Data or Security Domain Management Data. See appendix H GlobalPlatform Data Values and Card Recognition Data for details of Card Recognition Data and Security Domain Management Data. The value "i" is coded on one byte as a bit map as follows: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description Not available 0 0 0 0 0 - 0 Key Transport 310 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description Not available 0 0 0 0 0 - 1 Key Agreement Not available 0 0 0 0 0 0 - Signature with message recovery Not available 0 0 0 0 0 1 - Signature without message recovery Table F-1: Values of Parameter "i" Note: "i" is a subidentifier within an object identifier, and bit b8 is reserved for use in the structure of the object identifier according to ISO/IEC 8825-1. Key transport and key agreement relate to the process of establishing session keys for the Secure Channel Session. * With key agreement the Security Domain and the Off-Card Entity exchange secret values when the Secure Channel is being initiated, and session keys are then derived from those secrets using an algorithm known to both the Off-Card Entity and the Security Domain; * With key transport the Security Domain receives session keys to be used for the Secure Channel Session from the Off-Card Entity during Secure Channel initiation. Signature with message recovery and signature without message recovery refer to the signature scheme used for digital signatures in data messages during Entity Authentication. (Note that these mechanisms apply also with the signatures on digital certificates, but the value "i" does not refer to this.) * With signature with message recovery, part or all of the message data that is signed is contained in the signature block and is recovered during the process of verifying the signature. Signature with message recovery is standardized in ISO 9796-2; * With signature without message recovery, the signature does not contain any part of the message data that is signed, but comprises an appendix to the complete message. Such a scheme is also known as a signature scheme 'with appendix'. Signature without message recovery is standardized in PKCS#1, and is also used in X.509. The Security Domain may support any combination of values of parameter "i", but shall support at least one of the following options as defined by "i": * "i" = '01': Signature with recovery, key agreement; * "i" = '02': Signature without recovery, key transport. There is no requirement for a Security Domain to support more than one certificate format. F.1.2 Certificate Verification F.1.2.1 Overview The Security Domain verifies a certificate of the Off-Card Entity to establish the validity of its public key. A certificate must be issued by the Trust Point for External Authentication (TP_EX) or a subordinate key authority of the TP_EX. On the other hand, the Off-Card Entity establishes the validity of the Security Domain's public key by verifying a certificate issued by the Key Authority of the Security Domain. The Security Domain shall hold a single (default) public key of the Trust Point for External Authentication (PK.TP_EX.AUT) and may also hold the validated public keys of other authorities in a certificate chain. The Off-Card Entity may know implicitly what other public keys have already been validated by the Security Domain, and can use this knowledge to reduce the number of certificates the Security Domain is asked to verify, potentially down to zero. By default the Security Domain expects the first certificate presented for verification to be signed by the PK.TP_EX.AUT, and each subsequent certificate to be signed by the public key validated with the previous March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 311 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. certificate. The Off-Card Entity may request the Security Domain to use a different default initial public key by indicating it with a MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command. The Off-Card Entity establishes the validity of the Security Domain's public key by checking a (chain of) certificate(s). The minimum set of keys and certificates to be stored by a Security Domain that supports asymmetric Secure Channel Protocol `10' shall be as follows: * One Public Key for Trust Point for External Authentication (PK.TP_EX.AUT); * One Security Domain Private Key (SK.SD.AUT); * One Security Domain Public Key (PK.SD.AUT); and * One Security Domain Certificate (CERT.SD.AUT) corresponding to the Security Domain Public Key and signed by the Security Domain Key Authority. The Security Domain may also hold: * The Off-Card Entity's Public Key(s) (PK.OCE.AUT) for External Authentication which has been validated; * The Key Authority's Public Key(s) (PK.KA_EX.AUT) for External Authentication in a valid certificate chain from the Trust Point for External Authentication to the Off-Card Entity; and * The Key Authority's Certificate(s) for Internal Authentication (CERT.KA_IN.AUT) in a valid certificate chain from the Trust Point for Internal Authentication to the Security Domain. The minimum set of keys and certificates to be available to an Off-Card Entity (OCE) that wishes to communicate with a specific Security Domain is assumed to be as follows: * One Public Key for Trust Point for Internal Authentication (PK.TP_IN.AUT) ); * One Off-Card Entity Public Key (PK.OCE.AUT); * One Off-Card Entity Certificate (CERT.OCE.AUT) corresponding to the Off-Card Entity Public Key and signed by the Off-Card Entity's Key Authority; * The Off-Card Entity Trust Point Certification Public Key (PK.TP_OCE.AUT) that participates in a chain of certificates down to the Security Domain's Public Key. The Off-Card Entity may also hold: * The Key Authority's Certificate(s) for External Authentication (CERT.KA_EX.AUT) in a valid certificate chain from the Trust Point for External Authentication to the Off-Card Entity. Note that the Security Domain's owner may be considered to be the Application Provider (for a Security Domain) or the Card Issuer(for the Issuer Security Domain). The first example in Figure F-1 is a simple case where the Trust Point for External Authentication (TP_EX) and the Trust Point for Internal Authentication (TP_IN) certify the public key of the Key Authority of the Off-Card Entity and the Security Domain respectively, and the Key Authority of the Off-Card Entity (KA_OCE) certifies the public key of the Off-Card Entity. 312 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Figure F-1 - Certificate Chains - Example a The second example in Figure F-2 illustrates that the Trust Point for External Authentication (TP_EX) and Internal Authentication (TP_IN) directly certifies the public key of both the Off-Card Entity and the Security Domain's Key Authority; and the Security Domain's Key Authority in turn certifies the Security Domain's public key. Figure F-2 - Certificate Chains - Example b The third example in Figure F-3 illustrates that the Trust Point for External Authentication (TP_EX) and Internal Authentication (TP_IN) cross-certify each other's public keys, and there are two certificate chains down to the Security Domain and OCE public keys. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 313 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Figure F-3 Certificate Chains - Example c F.1.2.2 Certificate Verification Process Flow The following flow is an example of the Certificate Verification stage of Secure Channel initiation. Expanding on the authentication processing shown in the flow described in section 7.3.4 - Runtime Messaging Support it can be seen how an Application would use the services of a Security Domain to perform Certificate Verification. 314 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Optionally specify SCP parameters MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Select a starting public key for certificate verification (defaults to PK.TP_EX.AUT) Off-card Entity Application Security Domain PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] GET DATA [certificate] Command and Response Supply OCE certificate(s) Request certificates or certificate information from the card Retrieve certificates from the card for verification, or information about certificates held on the card Verify certificates Receive a chain of certificates for verification, starting from the highest Supply certificate data Verify certificates Figure F-4 - Certificate Verification Flow The following commands shall be supported: * MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT containing a `cryptographic mechanism reference' designating the GlobalPlatform Secure Channel Protocol `10', see section F.4.5 for further details; * PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command, see section F.4.7 for further details; * GET DATA [certificate] command, see section F.4.3 for further details. On receipt of a MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command, any existing Secure Channel Session (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface) shall be terminated, regardless of the validity of the command: both the Current Security Level and Session Security Level are reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. The MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command may refer to a previously validated public key. If the MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command is omitted, Security Domain default values and options shall apply, in particular for the initial default public key to use in subsequent command processing. On receipt of a PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command not preceded by a MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT or another PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command, any existing Secure Channel Session (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface) shall be terminated, regardless of the result of the certificate verification: both the Current Security Level and Session Security Level are reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. Multiple PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] commands may be received. In this case, a chain of certificates is presented to the Security Domain and the certificate contained in each command is verified using the Current Public Key. The Current Public Key is the public key that the Security Domain validated when verifying the last certificate presented by the Off-Card Entity during the same Secure Channel Session initiation. The Security March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 315 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Domain shall have a default Current Public Key at the start of a Secure Channel Session initiation phase: Trust Point for External Authentication (PK.TP_EX.AUT). Any failure in verifying an Off-Card Entity's certificate aborts the current Secure Channel Session initiation phase, and any public keys validated during that initiation phase shall be discarded. Multiple GET DATA [certificate] commands may be received. They may be interleaved with PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] commands. The Security Domain makes no assumptions about whether the Off-Card Entity has obtained enough certificates in order to validate the Security Domain's public key. The Off-Card Entity may use the GET DATA [certificate] command for EF.OD to retrieve information about the different certificates the Security Domain holds, see F.1.2.3 for further details on EF.OD. F.1.2.3 Certificate Information The Security Domain shall support access to EF.OD with a 'data object iď set to '5031'. EF.OD identifies each certificate that can be retrieved by the Off-Card Entity for verification. EF.OD contains a set of Cryptographic Information Objects (CIOs) as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-15, each of which describes a certificate and gives a pointer (in the form of a 'data object iď) to the certificate data present within the Security Domain. The contents of EF.OD and its consistency with the certificates actually present within the Security Domain are the responsibility of the Security Domain's Provider and beyond the control of the card. According to ISO/IEC 7816-15, an individual CIO for a certificate may be coded as follows (xxCertificate being of type CertificateChoice): xxCertificate: { commonObjectAttributes { label Label OPTIONAL flags CommonObjectFlags OPTIONAL, authId Identifier OPTIONAL, userConsent INTEGER (1..cia-ub-userConsent) OPTIONAL, accessControlRules SEQUENCE SIZE (1..MAX) OF AccessControlRule OPTIONAL, ....}, classAttributes { id Identifier, authority BOOLEAN DEFAULT FALSE, identifier CredentialIdentifier {{KeyIdentifiers}} OPTIONAL, certHash [0] CertHash OPTIONAL, trustedUsage [1] Usage OPTIONAL identifiers [2] SEQUENCE OF CredentialIdentifier {{KeyIdentifiers}} OPTIONAL, validity [4] Validity OPTIONAL, ....}, typeAttributes { value ObjectValue {Certificate}, ....} } where typeAttributes vary per type of CertificateChoice, for instance x509CertificateAttributes are: typeAttributes { value ObjectValue {Certificate}, subject Name OPTIONAL, 316 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. issuer [0] Name OPTIONAL, serialNumber CertificateSerialNumber OPTIONAL, ....} F.1.2.4 Certificate Formats Certificate contents and encoding are outside the scope of this specification. Examples are given for illustration only. Certificates may contain various data objects and elements as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4, 7816-6 and 7816-8 (using application tagging), ITU Recommendation X.509 (universal and context-specific tagging) and elsewhere. The data objects included are defined by the certificate issuer (CA). The following table identifies some data items that appear in certificates - 'presence' indicates when the item can be expected to be present: Name as used in X.509 Name as used in 7816-8 Application Tag assigned by 7816 Presence Issuer Issuer Identification Number '42' (7816-8) Always Subject Certificate holder reference OR Cardholder name '5F20' (7816-8) Always SubjectPublicKey Cardholder public key '5F49' or '7F49' (7816-8) Always KeyUsage Certificate holder authorization '5F4C' (7816-9) As required CertificateSerialNumber Certificate serial number - Always n/a Certificate contents '5F4E' (7816-8) Non self descriptive certificates Signature Static internal authorization OR Digital signature '9E' (7816-8) Always n/a Public key remainder '5F38' (7816-6) Signature scheme with recovery Table F-2: Example of Data Included in Certificates Certificates may either be self descriptive, where the signature is across individual data objects; or non self descriptive, where the signature is across concatenated value fields, without tags and lengths. Whether the certificate to be verified by the Security Domain is self descriptive or non self descriptive must be indicated in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command. A Security Domain is only required to handle a single certificate format throughout a chain of certificates to be verified by the Security Domain. Tag '67' in Card Recognition Data or Security Domain Management Data may contain one or more OIDs identifying the Security Domain's Trust Poinťs certification policy and/or the format of certificates that can be verified by the March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 317 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Security Domain and/or the format of certificates that can be retrieved from the Security Domain. They may also identify the cryptographic algorithms used for certificates, unless they are indicated in the certificates themselves. F.1.2.4.1 Certificate without Message Recovery The data and public key to be certified are concatenated and a digest is created. A signature block is then prepared containing the digest and any necessary padding, constant and random data. The format of the signature block is defined by the certificate issuer (CA). The signature block size depends on the asymmetric algorithm and the certifying key size. The signature block is then signed using the certificate issuer's private certifying key, to form the value field of the Certificate Signature data object. The result is a certificate typically containing the data and public key to be certified and the Certificate Signature. Certificate without Message Recovery, Self Descriptive Certificate The data objects to be certified, including the public key data object, are TLV encoded and are concatenated TLVencoded before the digest is created and the signature block prepared. The result of the signing operation is the Certificate Signature. The certificate is TLV encoded as a series of data objects, containing all the data objects to be certified, including the public key data object and the Certificate Signature data object. X.509 certificates fall into this category. The formation of the certificate is shown in the following example: Data to be certifiedTLV TLV TLV TLV SHA-1 TLV TLV TLV TLV digest signature block TL V = signatureCertificate signature Certificate Signature Padding etc RSA operationprivate key Figure F-5: Certificate Formation - Self Descriptive Certificate Without Message Recovery Certificate without Message Recovery, Non-Self Descriptive Certificate The data and public key to be certified are a concatenated set of value fields. The format of the value fields included is defined by the certificate issuer (CA) and implicitly known to the recipients. A digest of the concatenated value fields is created and the signature block prepared. The result of the signing operation is the Certificate Signature. 318 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The certificate contains two data objects: the Certificate Contents, whose value is the concatenated set of value fields being certified, and the Certificate Signature. The formation of the certificate is shown in the following example: Data to be certifiedTLV TLV TLV TLV SHA-1 TL V = data values digest signature block TL V = signatureCertificate signature Certificate Contents Certificate Signature Padding etc RSA operationprivate key Figure F-6: Certificate Formation - Non Self Descriptive Certificate Without Message Recovery F.1.2.4.2 Certificate with Message Recovery The data and public key to be certified is concatenated and a digest is created. A signature block is then prepared containing the digest, as much of the concatenated set of data and public key to be certified as can be included in the block and any necessary padding, constant and random data. The format of the signature block is defined by the certificate issuer (CA). The signature block size depends on the asymmetric algorithm and the certifying key size. The signature block is then signed using the certificate issuer's private certifying key, to form the value field of the Certificate Signature data object. Any part of the public key that could not be included in the Certificate Signature is then included in the value field of a separate Public Key Remainder data object. The result is a certificate typically containing two data objects: the Public Key Remainder and the Certificate Signature. Certificate with Message Recovery, Self Descriptive Certificate The data objects to be certified, including the public key data object, are TLV encoded and are concatenated TLVencoded before the digest is created and the signature block prepared. The result of the signing operation is the Certificate Signature. The formation of the certificate is shown in the following diagram: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 319 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Data to be certifiedTLV TLV TLV TLV SHA-1 TL V = PK Remainder digest signature block TL V = signatureCertificate signature Public Key Remainder Certificate Signature Combine, with padding etc RSA operationprivate key Subject / Certificate Holder Public Key (PK) Figure F-7: Certificate Formation - Self Descriptive Certificate with Message Recovery Certificate with Message Recovery, Non-Self Descriptive Certificate The data and public key to be certified is a concatenated set of value fields. The format of the value fields included is defined by the certificate issuer (CA) and implicitly known to the recipients. A digest of the concatenated value fields is created and the signature block prepared. The result of the signing operation is the Certificate Signature. The formation of the certificate is shown in the following diagram: 320 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Data to be certifiedValue field SHA-1 TL V = PK Remainder digest signature block TL V = signatureCertificate signature Public Key Remainder Certificate Signature Combine, with padding etc RSA operationprivate key Figure F-8: Certificate Formation - Non Self Descriptive Certificate with Message Recovery F.1.3 Entity Authentication F.1.3.1 Overview of Entity Authentication Once the parties have validated each other's public key, the Security Domain shall authenticate the Off-Card Entity using a challenge / response mechanism, and the Off-Card Entity may also authenticate the Security Domain in the same way. Entity authentication of the Security Domain is optional, at the discretion of the Off-Card Entity. However, if the INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command is required for use in session key agreement, then authentication of the Security Domain is performed. F.1.3.2 Entity Authentication Process Flow The following diagram gives an overview of the flow for Entity Authentication. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 321 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. GET CHALLENGE response EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE GET CHALLENGE Request card challenge Generate card challenge Off-card Entity Application Security Domain Sign card challenge and session data Generate off-card entity challenge Verify card signature Sign off-card entity challenge and session data Verify off-card entity signature INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE response EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE response PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] response PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] Generate DES session keys Encrypt with SD public key Decrypt session keys with SD private key Store DES session keys Figure F-9: Entity Authentication Flow The following commands shall be supported: * PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command, see section F.4.6 for further details; * GET CHALLENGE command, see section F.4.2 for further details; * EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, see section F.4.1 for further details; * INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, see section F.4.4 for further details. The PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command is optional but shall be executed when value '02' of parameter "i" is supported - see section F.1.1. The successful processing of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command (i.e. successful verification of the OffCard Entity's signature) shall set both the Current Security Level and Session Security Level according to the rules described in section F.1.4.2 - Security Level Establishment. The failed processing of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command (i.e. unsuccessful verification of the Off-Card Entity's signature) shall reset both the Current Security Level and Session Security Level to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL and all the public keys previously verified within the current initiation phase shall be discarded. The INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command is optional for the key transport option and mandatory for key agreement. The INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command shall only be received and processed once during Secure Channel Session initiation. Any error in the sequence flow or signing operation must abort the current Secure 322 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Channel Session: both the Current Security Level and Session Security Level shall be reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. F.1.3.3 Security Domain Authentication The format and contents of Security Domain signature vary depending on the options chosen, as follows: Key transport, signature without message recovery The Security Domain signature is the result of generating a digest (hash) over a set of data, creating a signature block, and signing the signature block with the Security Domain private key (SK.SD.AUT). The data to be hashed and the contents of the signature block are as shown below. Name Length Value Presence Session Key(s) n x (16 or 24) 'xxxx...' Mandatory Off-Card Entity challenge 16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Table F-3: Data to Hash Session Keys shall be in the same order as provided in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command: see sections F.3.1.2 and F.4.7. Name Length Value Presence Padding 2 `0001' Mandatory Padding (`FF') 8-n `FF'...'FF' Mandatory Padding (`00') 1 `00' Mandatory DER encoded digest algorithm id - encoded as an object identifier Variable 'xxxx...' (see section F.2.2) Mandatory DER encoded Hash (length and contents depend on the digest algorithm) Variable 'xxxx...' Mandatory Table F-4: Security Domain Signature Block Key agreement, signature with message recovery The Security Domain signature is the result of generating a digest (hash) over a set of data, creating a signature block, and signing the signature block with the Security Domain private key (SK.SD.AUT). The data to be hashed and the contents of the signature block are as shown below. Name Length Value Presence Random Padding (RP) 1-n Same value as RP in Table F-6 Mandatory Card Secret (CS) 32 Same value as CS in Table F-6 Mandatory Off-Card Entity challenge 8 'xxxx...' Mandatory Off-Card Entity id 8 'xxxx...' (part of CERT.OCE.AUT) Mandatory Table F-5: Data to Hash Name Length Value Presence Padding 1 `6A' Mandatory March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 323 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence Random Padding (RP) 1-n Same value as RP in Table F-5 Mandatory Card Secret (CS) 32 Same value as CS in Table F-5 Mandatory Hash 20 'xxxx...' Mandatory Padding 1 `BC' Mandatory Table F-6: Security Domain Signature Block The Security Domain signature is encrypted to ensure that the Card Secret is not divulged. To do this, the minimum of the values SIG.SD.AUT and (N.PK.SD.AUT ­ SIG.SD.AUT) is encrypted with the Off-Card Entity public key (PK.OCE.AUT), where N.PK.SD.AUT denotes the modulus of the Security Domain public key. This ensures that the data to be encrypted is always smaller than the modulus of the Off-Card Entity public key. Note that the modulus of the Security Domain public key and modulus of the Off-Card Entity public key must have the same length in bits. See ISO/IEC 9796-2, Digital Signature scheme 1. F.1.3.4 Off-Card Entity Authentication The format and contents of Off-Card Entity signature vary depending on the option chosen, as follows: Key transport, signature without message recovery The Off-Card Entity signature is the result of generating a digest (hash) over a set of data, creating a signature block, and signing the signature block with the Off-Card Entity private key (SK.OCE.AUT). The data to be hashed and the contents of the signature block are as shown below. Name Length Value Presence Tag of Security Level 1 'D3' Mandatory Length of Security Level 1 '01' Mandatory Security Level 1 'xx' Mandatory Control reference template (CRT) tag 1 'B4' or 'B8' Mandatory Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Mandatory CRT for Session Key(s) n 'xxxx...' Mandatory ... ... ... ... CRT tag 1 `B4' or `B8' Optional Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Conditional CRT for Session Key(s) n 'xxxx...' Conditional Card challenge 16 Mandatory Table F-7: Data to Hash The control reference templates (CRTs) include session keys, and must be in the same order as provided in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command - see Table F-32. Name Length Value Presence Padding (`0001') 2 `0001' Mandatory Padding (`FF') 8-n `FF' Mandatory Padding (`00') 1 `00' Mandatory 324 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence DER encoded digest algorithm id (encoded as an object identifier) Variable 'xxxx...' (see section F.2.2) Mandatory DER encoded Hash (length and contents depend on the digest algorithm) Variable 'xxxx...' Mandatory Table F-8: Off-Card Entity Signature Block Control reference templates (CRTs) include session keys, and must be in the same order as provided in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command. The format and contents of Card Signature vary depending on the options chosen, as discussed below. Key agreement, signature with message recovery The Off-Card Entity signature is the result of generating a digest (hash) over a set of data, creating a signature block, and signing the signature block with the Off-Card Entity private key (SK.OCE.AUT). The data to be hashed and the contents of the signature block are as shown below. Name Length Value Presence Random Padding (RPD) 1-n Same value as RPD in Table F-10 Mandatory Tag of Security Level 1 'D3' Mandatory Length of Security Level 1 `01' Mandatory Security Level 1 `xx' Mandatory CRT tag 1 `B4' or `B8' Mandatory Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Mandatory CRT for session key(s) n 'xxxx...' Mandatory ... ... ... ... CRT tag 1 `B4' or `B8' Optional Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Conditional CRT for Session Key(s) n 'xxxx...' Conditional Off-Card Entity Secret (OES) 32 Same value as OES in Table F-10 Mandatory Card challenge 8 'xxxx...' Mandatory Card id: TBD (part of CERT.SD.AUT) 8 'xxxx...' Mandatory Table F-9: Data to Hash Control reference templates (CRTs) exclude session keys, and must be in the same order as provided in signature block. Name Length Value Presence Padding 1 `6A' Mandatory Random Padding (RPD) 1-n Same value as RPD in Table F-9 Mandatory Tag of Security Level 1 'D3' Mandatory Length of Security Level 1 `01' Mandatory March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 325 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Name Length Value Presence Security Level 1 `xx' Mandatory CRT tag 1 `B4' or `B8' Mandatory Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Mandatory CRT for session key(s) 1-n 'xxxx...' Mandatory ... ... ... ... CRT tag 1 `B4' or `B8' Optional Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Conditional CRT for Session Key(s) n 'xxxx...' Conditional Off-Card Entity Secret (OES) 32 Same value as OES in Table F-9 Mandatory Hash 20 'xxxx...' Mandatory Padding 1 `BC' Mandatory Table F-10: Off-Card Entity Signature Block Control reference templates (CRTs) exclude session keys, and must be in the same order as input to the hash function. The Off-Card Entity signature is encrypted to ensure that the Off-Card Entity secret is not divulged. To do this, the minimum of the values SIG.OCE.AUT and (N.PK.OCE.AUT ­ SIG.OCE.AUT) is encrypted using the Security Domain public key (PK.SD.AUT). N.PK.OCE.AUT denotes the modulus of the Off-Card Entity public key. This ensures that the data to be encrypted is always smaller than the modulus of the Security Domain public key. Note that the modulus of the Security Domain public key and modulus of the Off-Card Entity public key must have the same length in bits. See ISO/IEC 9796-2, Digital Signature scheme 1. F.1.4 Session Key and Security Level Establishment When using the key transport option, Entity Authentication is preceded by the session keys and requested Security Level being sent to the Security Domain using the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command; the Security Domain stores them until session initiation is complete. A Security Domain supporting the key transport option shall decrypt with its private key (SK.SD.AUT or if the Security Domain has more than one key pair, the private key identified in the MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command) the command data field of the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command. Any failure in the decryption operation aborts the current Secure Channel Session initiation phase, and any public keys validated during that initiation phase shall be discarded. In the key transport option the Secure Channel Session is established after successful processing of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command. An INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command can be issued immediately after the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command without secure messaging. In the key agreement option the Secure Channel Session is established after successful processing of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE and INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE commands. F.1.4.1 Session Key Establishment The Off-Card Entity supplies the Security Domain with details of what session keys are to be established. This information is in the form of 'control reference templates' (see section F.3.1.2) which are supplied either in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command (with the key transport option) or in the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command (with the key agreement option). 326 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. If the key transport option is used, then the session keys are provided by the Off-Card Entity within the 'control reference templates' (see section F.3.1.2). If the key agreement option is used, then the secrets exchanged between the Off-Card Entity and the Security Domain during the Entity Authentication process are used to establish session keys, as defined in section F.3.1 DES Session Keys. Once session keys have been established successfully, ICV sequence counter(s), used for secure messaging on subsequent commands and responses, are initialized as described in section F.3.2 - Secure Messaging. F.1.4.2 Security Level Establishment The requested Security Level is supplied in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command (with the key transport option) or in the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command (with the key agreement option). The successful initiation of a Secure Channel Session shall set the Current Security Level and Session Security Level to the requested Security Level combined with the AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED indicator (see section 10.4.2 - Authentication with asymmetric cryptography for further details). If the requested Security Level is set to zero, the successful initiation of a Secure Channel Session shall set the Current Security Level and Session Security Level to AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED only. F.1.5 Protocol Rules The Current Security Level of a communication not included in a Secure Channel Session shall be set to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL. In accordance with the general rules described in chapter 10 - Secure Communication, the following rules shall apply: * The successful initiation of a Secure Channel Session shall set the Current Security Level to the requested Security Level from the selected Application's perspective: it is at least set to AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED (see section 10.4.2 - Authentication with asymmetric cryptography for details; * The Current Security Level shall apply to the entire Secure Channel Session unless successfully modified at the request of the Application; * When the Current Security Level is set to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL, then: - If the Secure Channel Session was aborted during the same Application Session, the incoming command shall be rejected with a security error; - Otherwise no security verification of the incoming command shall be performed. The Application processing the command is responsible for applying its own security rules. * If a Secure Channel Session is active for incoming commands (i.e. Current Security Level at least set to either AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED), the security of the incoming command shall be checked according to the Current Security Level, or if the APDU class byte indicates Secure Messaging and Secure Messaging data objects are present in the command data field: - When the security of the command does not match or exceed the Current Security Level, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - If a security error is found, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - If (one of) the appropriate session key(s) is not available, the command shall be rejected with a security error, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 327 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. - In all other cases, the Secure Channel Session shall remain active and the Current Security Level shall reflect the level of security established by the current command (e.g. C-MAC and/or C-ENCRYPTION). The Application is responsible for further processing the command. * If a Secure Channel Session is active for outgoing responses (i.e. Current Security Level at least set to AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED), secure messaging protection shall be applied to the outgoing response according to the Current Security Level (i.e. R-MAC and/or R-ENCRYPTION): - If a cryptographic error occurs, a security error shall be returned, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - If (one of) the appropriate session key(s) is not available, a security error shall be returned, the Secure Channel Session aborted and the Current Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL; - Otherwise, the Secure Channel Session shall remain active and the Current Security Level unmodified. * If a Secure Channel Session is aborted, it is still considered not terminated; * If the Security Domain supports application data encryption and/or decryption, it shall decrypt or encrypt a block of secret data upon request. If the service is not supported or if (one of) the appropriate cryptographic key(s) is not available, the request shall be rejected but the Current Security Level, Session Security Level and Secure Channel Session in operation (if any) shall not be impacted; * The current Secure Channel Session shall be terminated (if aborted or still open), both the Current Security Level and Session Security Level reset to NO_SECURITY_LEVEL on either: - Attempt to initiate a new Secure Channel Session; - Termination of the Application Session (e.g. new Application selection); - Termination of the associated logical channel; - Termination of the Card Session (card reset or power off); - Explicit termination by the Application (e.g. invoking GlobalPlatform API). F.2 Cryptographic Algorithms The cryptographic and hashing algorithms described in appendix B - Algorithms (Cryptographic and Hashing) apply to SCP10. This section defines the additional requirements for SCP10. F.2.1 Asymmetric cryptography In this appendix, signing means the deciphering of a signature block using the signer's private RSA key. For certificates to be verified by the card, and message signatures signed and verified by the card, the cryptographic scheme shall be RSA. The signature block and signature are the same length as the key modulus. In Entity Authentication, Digital Signature Scheme 1 in ISO/IEC 9796-2 shall be used for signature with message recovery, and the signature scheme with appendix RSASSA-PKCS1-V1_5 in PKCS#1 v2.1 for signature without message recovery. The details of the signature scheme for certificates shall be either implicitly known by the Off-Card Entity or specified by the Security Domain Trust Point through the contents of Card Recognition Data or Security Domain Management Data in tag '67'. In the key transport option, the cryptographic scheme for encrypting the session keys and their CRT templates shall be RSA according to the encryption scheme RSAES-PKCS1-v1_5 as defined in PKCS#1 v2.1. 328 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.2.2 Digest Algorithm The default digest algorithm for use in conjunction with SCP10 asymmetric cryptography in Entity Authentication shall be SHA-1 for this version of the Specification. An alternative algorithm may be specified in Card Recognition Data or Security Domain Management Data in tag '67'. The Object Identifier for SHA-1 is: {iso(1) identified-organization(3) oiw(14) secsig(3) algorithms(2) 26} which is DER-TLV encoded as '2B 0E 03 02 1A'. F.2.3 Message Integrity ICV The ICV for the each C-MAC and R-MAC calculation is obtained by enciphering an ICV sequence counter. The ICV sequence counter is initialized during Secure Channel initiation to either: * the value supplied in tag '91' of the control reference template, for the key transport option (separate initial value for each key), or * the concatenation of the last 4 bytes of the card secret and the last 4 bytes of Off-Card Entity secret, for the key agreement option (same initial value for all keys). The ICV sequence counter is incremented by one for each C-MAC and R-MAC. For calculating a C-MAC ICV, the ICV sequence counter is single-DES enciphered using the first part of the Secure Channel C-MAC key. For calculating an R-MAC ICV, the ICV sequence counter is single-DES enciphered using the first part of the Secure Channel R-MAC key. F.2.4 Message Integrity C-MAC and R-MAC Message integrity is achieved by applying a MAC to message data. The MAC may be: * C-MAC for APDU command messages (generated by the Off-Card Entity); * R-MAC for APDU response messages (generated by the card). The receiving entity, on receipt of the message containing a MAC, using the same session key, performs the same operation and by comparing its generated MAC with the MAC received from the sending entity is assured of the integrity of the full command or response. The integrity of the sequence of APDU command or response messages being transmitted to the receiving entity is achieved by using an encrypted sequence counter as part of the MAC generation. This ensures the receiving entity that all messages in a sequence have been received. F.2.5 APDU Encryption and Decryption for Message Confidentiality Message confidentiality is achieved by encrypting the whole of the command or response data field. This includes any data within the data field that has already been protected for another purpose, such as secret or private keys encrypted with the data encryption key. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 329 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.3 Cryptographic Usage F.3.1 DES Session Keys F.3.1.1 Overview All session keys shall be double or triple length DES keys. The Off-Card Entity supplies information on cryptographic keys to be established for the session in a set of control reference templates. Each control reference template specifies the usage of the key. In the case of key transport, the templates are supplied in the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command and contain the actual key values. In the case of key agreement, the templates are supplied in the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command, and do not contain the key values. F.3.1.2 Control Reference Templates A control reference template (CRT) is structured as follows: Tag Length Name Presence `B4' or `B8' '00' - '7F' CRT tag = `B4' (CCT) or `B8' (CT) Mandatory '95' 1 Usage Qualifier = `10' (secure messaging for commands), `20' (secure messaging for responses), `30' (secure messaging for commands and responses), `40' (encipherment of sensitive data in responses), `80' (encipherment of sensitive data in commands), `C0' (encipherment of sensitive data in commands & responses) Mandatory '80' 0 or 1 Optional cryptographic mechanism. Contains Key Type, coded according to Table 11-16 Optional 'D1' 0, 16 or 24 Off-Card Entity Session Key Conditional '91' 0 or 8 Initial value of sequence counter, for use in secure messaging Conditional Table F-11: Single CRT Note: Usage Qualifier and the CRT tag together define the key usage, which is C-MAC and/or R-MAC for control reference template 'B4', and C-ENC and/or R-ENC or DEK for control reference template 'B8'. The Key Type identifies the cryptographic algorithm. The Off-Card Entity Session Key and sequence counter data objects are only present with the key transport option. The sequence counter data object is used in secure messaging as the initial value for the ICV sequence counter for this key, which is encrypted as defined in section F.2.3 - Message Integrity ICV to derive the ICV for the first MAC generated using this key. 330 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.3.1.3 Session Key Derivation With the key agreement option, session keys are derived from the secret data exchanged during Secure Channel initiation as follows: * The two 32-byte secrets Off-Card Entity Secret and Card Secret are exclusive or-ed, giving result (1); * A 32 byte binary counter is set to a value depending on the key usage and its position in the set of CRTs supplied, as shown below; * Result (1) is appended with a 32 bit binary counter with the appropriate value for this key, and the result is hashed using SHA-1, giving result (2); * Bytes 1-16 of result (2) form the double-length DES session key. Counter value Key 1 The MAC key whose CRT is first in the set of CRTs supplied by the OffCard Entity 2 The ENC key whose CRT is first in the set of CRTs supplied by the OffCard Entity 3 A subsequent MAC key, if any 4 A subsequent ENC key, if any 5 The data encryption key whose CRT is first in the set of CRTs supplied by the Off-Card Entity 6 A subsequent data encryption key, if any Table F-12: Counter Value for Session Key Calculation F.3.2 Secure Messaging F.3.2.1 APDU Command C-MAC Protection This section applies where command integrity (C-MAC) is required but not command confidentiality (C-ENC). A C-MAC is generated by an Off-Card Entity and applied across the full APDU command being transmitted to the card including the header, the command data field (if present) and Le (if present). Input data to the MAC calculation is first prepared as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4: * The following data is concatenated: - The command header CLA, INS, P1, P2 from the unprotected APDU, with the logical channel bits in the CLA byte set to zero, and appended with four bytes '80 00 00 00'; - If a command data field is present in the unprotected APDU, a BER-TLV data object with tag '81' containing the complete original command data field , regardless of its contents and format; - If Le is present in the unprotected APDU, a BER-TLV data object with tag '97' containing the original Le value; * DES padding is applied as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. A C-MAC is generated using the Secure Channel C-MAC session key, the encrypted sequence counter as the ICV as defined in section F.2.3, and the signature method described in appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES MAC across the input data. To reflect the presence of a C-MAC in the command message, the unprotected APDU shall be modified as follows: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 331 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The class byte shall be modified to indicate that this APDU command includes secure messaging. This is achieved by setting to '11' bits 4-3 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 0 to 4 (unprotected CLA set to '00' - '03' or '80' - '83') or by setting to '1' bit b6 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 4 to 19 (unprotected CLA set to '40' - '4F' or 'C0' - 'CF'): see section 11.1.4. The logical channel bits are unchanged; * The length of the command message (Lc) shall be incremented by: - 10 bytes to allow for the C-MAC data object, plus - 2 or more bytes to allow for the tag and length of the command data field data object (if command data is present - note: the length field may be longer than one byte), plus - 3 bytes to allow for the Le data object (if Le is present). * The command data, if present in the unprotected APDU, shall be encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '81' and a length field coded according to ISO 8825-1; * The Le byte, if present in the unprotected APDU, shall be contained in a BER-TLV data object with tag '97'; * The C-MAC shall be encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '8E' and appended at the end of the command data field. No padding is present in the transmitted APDU. The following diagram shows the message reformatting that is performed by the Off-Card Entity when a command is protected for integrity. Unprotected APDUCLA INS P1 P2 [ Lc ] [ Data ] [ Le ] '80 00 00 00' [ tag '81' L Data ] [ tag '97' L Le ] '80 [ 00... ]' [ tag '81' L Data ] [ tag '97' L Le ] tag '8E' L C-MAC [ Le ]CLA INS P1 P2 LC ' CLA INS P1 P2 CLA set to indicate secure messaging Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes C-MAC session keyC-MAC Protected APDU ICV = Sequence counter Figure F-10: APDU C-MAC Generation The card, in order to verify the C-MAC, shall perform the same procedure as employed by the Off-Card Entity in order to verify the C-MAC. The ICV sequence counter used in ICV calculation is then incremented. This is true regardless of whether the APDU processing completes successfully or not i.e. a new sequence counter value shall always be used for the next C-MAC or R-MAC. F.3.2.2 APDU Command C-ENC Protection This section applies where command confidentiality (C-ENC) is required but not command integrity (C-MAC). 332 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. No encryption shall be applied to a command where there is no command data field: in this case the command message (header and optional Le) is sent without modification. Otherwise the Off-Card Entity encrypts the command data field of the command message being transmitted to the card. This includes any data within the data field that has already been protected for another purpose e.g. secret or private keys encrypted with the data encryption session key. Prior to encrypting the data, DES padding is applied as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. The padded command data field is enciphered using triple DES in CBC mode as defined in appendix B.1.1.1, the CENC session key established during the Secure Channel initiation process and an ICV of zero. To reflect the C-ENC protection of the command, the unprotected APDU shall be modified as follows: * The class byte shall be modified to indicate that this APDU command includes secure messaging. This is achieved by setting to '10' bits 4-3 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 0 to 4 (unprotected CLA set to '00' - '03' or '80' - '83') or by setting to '1' bit b6 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 4 to 19 (unprotected CLA set to '40' - '4F' or 'C0' - 'CF'): see section 11.1.4. The logical channel bits are unchanged; * Lc shall be incremented by: - 4 or more bytes to allow for the tag and length of the command data field data object, the padding indicator and the variable padding (the length field may be longer than one byte), plus - 3 bytes to allow for the Le data object (if Le is present). * The encrypted command data shall be preceded by the ISO/IEC 7816 padding indicator '01' and encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '86' and a length field coded according to ISO 8825-1; * The Le byte, if present in the unprotected APDU, shall be contained in a BER-TLV data object with tag '96'. The following diagram shows the message reformatting that is performed by the Off-Card Entity when a command is protected for confidentiality. Unprotected APDUCLA INS P1 P2 Lc Data [ Le ] Data '80 [ 00 ... ] ' tag '86' L '01' ciphertext [ tag '96' L Le ]CLA INS P1 P2 Lc ' CLA set to indicate secure messaging Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes C-ENC session key Protected APDU ciphertext encipher indicates ISO/IEC 7816-4 padding [ Le ] ICV = zero Figure F-11: Secure Messaging: Command message protected for confidentiality March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 333 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.3.2.3 APDU Command C-MAC and C-ENC Protection This section applies where both command confidentiality (C-ENC) and integrity (C-MAC) are required. No encryption shall be applied to a command where there is no command data field: in this case the message shall be protected as defined in section F.3.2.1 - APDU Command C-MAC Protection. Otherwise the Off-Card Entity first encrypts the command data field of the command message being transmitted to the card as defined in section F.3.2.2. A C-MAC is generated by an Off-Card Entity as defined in section F.3.2.1. Input data to the MAC calculation is first prepared as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4: * The following data is concatenated: - The command header CLA, INS, P1, P2 from the unprotected APDU, with the logical channel bits in the CLA byte set to zero, appended with four bytes '80 00 00 00'; - If a command data field is present in the unprotected APDU, a BER-TLV data object with tag '87' containing the ISO/IEC 7816 padding indicator '01' followed by the encrypted command data; - If Le is present in the unprotected APDU, a BER-TLV data object with tag '97' containing the original Le value; * DES padding is applied as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. To reflect the presence of a C-MAC and C-ENC protection of the command, the unprotected APDU shall be modified as follows: * The class byte shall be modified to indicate that this APDU command includes secure messaging. This is achieved by setting to '11' bits 4-3 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 0 to 4 (unprotected CLA set to '00' - '03' or '80' - '83') or by setting to '1' bit b6 of a class byte indicating a logical channel number 4 to 19 (unprotected CLA set to '40' - '4F' or 'C0' - 'CF'): see section 11.1.4. The logical channel bits are unchanged;. * Lc shall be incremented by: - 10 bytes to allow for the C-MAC data object, plus - 4 or more bytes to allow for the tag and length of the command data field data object, the padding indicator and the variable padding (the length field may be longer than one byte), plus - 3 bytes to allow for the Le data object (if Le is present). * The encrypted command data shall be preceded by the ISO/IEC 7816 padding indicator '01' and encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '87' and a length field coded according to ISO 8825-1; * The Le byte, if present in the unprotected APDU, shall be contained in a BER-TLV data object with tag '97'; * The C-MAC shall be encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '8E' and appended at the end of the command data field. The following diagram shows the message reformatting that is performed by the Off-Card Entity when a command is protected for integrity and confidentiality. 334 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Unprotected APDUCLA INS P1 P2 Lc Data [ Le ] Data '80 [ 00 ... ] ' tag '87' L '01' ciphertext ' 80 [ 00 ...] 'CLA INS P1 P2 '80 00 00 00' CLA set to indicate secure messaging Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes C-ENC session key Protected APDU ciphertext encipher indicates ISO/IEC 7816-4 padding [ tag '97' L Le ] Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes C-MAC session key tag '87' L '01' ciphertext tag '8E' L C-MACCLA INS P1 P2 Lc ' [ tag '97' L Le ] [ Le ] C-MAC ICV = zero ICV = Sequence counter Figure F-12: Secure Messaging: Command message protected for integrity and confidentiality F.3.2.4 APDU Response R-MAC Protection This section applies where response integrity (R-MAC) is required but not confidentiality (R-ENC). No R-MAC shall be generated and no protection shall be applied to a response where status bytes SW1 and SW2 indicate an error: in this case only status bytes shall be returned in the response. When R-MAC protection is required for a case 1 or case 3 command, the card shall process the command as a case 2 or case 4 command respectively and treat Le as if it were present and set to zero. An R-MAC is generated by the card across the response data field (if present) and status bytes. Input data to the MAC calculation is first prepared as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4: * The following data is concatenated: - If a response data field is present in the unprotected APDU, a BER-TLV data object with tag '81' containing the complete original response data field, regardless of its contents and format; - A BER-TLV data object with tag '99', containing the original status word SW1 - SW2 value. * DES padding is applied as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. An R-MAC is generated using the Secure Channel R-MAC session key, the encrypted sequence counter as the ICV as defined in section F.2.3, and the signature method described in appendix B.1.2.2 - Single DES Plus Final Triple DES MAC across the input data. To reflect the presence of an R-MAC protection of the response, the unprotected APDU shall be modified as follows: March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 335 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The response data, if present in the unprotected APDU, shall be encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '81' and a length field coded according to ISO 8825-1; * The status word SW1 - SW2 of the unprotected APDU shall be contained in a BER-TLV data object with tag '99'; * The R-MAC shall be encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '8E' and appended at the end of the response data field. No padding is present in the transmitted APDU. The Off-Card Entity, in order to verify the R-MAC, shall perform the same processing in order to generate an R-MAC and compare it with the transmitted R-MAC. The following diagram shows the message reformatting that is performed by the card when a response message is protected for integrity. Unprotected APDU[ Response Data ] SW1 SW2 [ tag '81' L Response Data ] ' 80 [ 00 ...] ' Protected APDU tag '99' L SW1 SW2 Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes R-MAC session key tag '99' L SW1 SW2 SW1 SW2[ tag '81' L Response Data ] tag '8E' L R-MAC R-MACICV = Sequence counter Figure F-13: Secure Messaging: Response message protected for integrity F.3.2.5 APDU Response R-ENC Protection This section applies where response confidentiality (R-ENC) is required but not integrity (R-MAC). No protection shall be applied to a response where status bytes SW1 and SW2 indicate an error or where there is no response data field: in this case only status bytes shall be returned in the response. Otherwise, the Security Domain encrypts the response data field. This includes any data within the data field that has already been protected for another purpose, such as secret or private keys encrypted with the data encryption session key. Prior to encrypting the response data field, DES padding is applied as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. The padded response data field is then enciphered using triple DES in CBC mode as defined in appendix B.1.1.1 CBC Mode, the R-ENC session key established during the Secure Channel initiation process and an ICV of zero. To reflect the R-ENC protection of the response, the unprotected APDU shall be modified as follows: * The encrypted response data shall be preceded by the ISO/IEC 7816 padding indicator '01' and encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '86' and a length field coded according to ISO 8825-1. 336 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The following diagram shows the message reformatting that is performed by the card when a response message is protected for confidentiality. Unprotected APDUResponse Data SW1 SW2 '80 [ 00 ... ] ' Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes R-ENC session key Protected APDU ciphertext encipher indicates ISO/IEC 7816-4 padding SW1 SW2tag '86' L '01' ciphertext Response Data ICV = zero Figure F-14: Secure Messaging: Response message protected for confidentiality F.3.2.6 APDU Response R-MAC and R-ENC Protection This section applies where both response confidentiality (R-ENC) and response integrity (R-MAC) are required. No R-MAC or encryption shall be applied to a response where status bytes SW1 and SW2 indicate an error: in this case only status bytes shall be returned in the response. No encryption shall be applied to a response where there is no response data field: in this case the message shall be protected as defined in section F.3.2.4 - APDU Response R-MAC Protection. Otherwise, the card first encrypts the response data field of the response message being transmitted to the Off-Card Entity as defined in section F.3.2.5. An R-MAC is then generated by the card as defined in section F.3.2.4. Input data to the MAC calculation is first prepared as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4: * The following data is concatenated: - If a response data field is present in the unprotected APDU, a BER-TLV data object with tag '87' containing the ISO/IEC 7816 padding indicator '01' followed by the encrypted response data; - A BER-TLV data object with tag '99' containing the original SW1 - SW2 status word value. * DES padding is applied as defined in appendix B.4 - DES Padding. To reflect the presence of an R-MAC and R-ENC protection of the response, the unprotected APDU shall be modified as follows: * The encrypted response data shall be preceded by the ISO/IEC 7816 padding indicator '01' and encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '87' and a length field coded according to ISO 8825-1; * The status word SW1 - SW2 of the unprotected APDU shall be contained in a BER-TLV data object with tag '99'; March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 337 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. * The R-MAC shall be encapsulated in a BER-TLV data object with tag '8E' and appended at the end of the response data field. No R-MAC padding is present in the transmitted APDU. The Off-Card Entity, in order to verify the R-MAC, shall perform the same processing in order to generate an R-MAC and compare it with the transmitted R-MAC. The following diagram shows the message reformatting that is performed by the card when a response message is protected for integrity and confidentiality. Unprotected APDUResponse Data SW1 SW2 '80 [ 00 ... ] ' tag '87' L '01' ciphertext ' 80 [ 00 ...] ' Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes R-ENC session key Protected APDU ciphertext encipher indicates ISO/IEC 7816-4 padding tag '99' L SW1 SW2 Zero padding to multiple of 8 bytes R-MAC session keyR-MAC tag '99' L SW1 SW2 SW1 SW2tag '87' L '01' ciphertext tag '8E' L R-MAC Response Data ICV = zero ICV = Sequence counter Figure F-15: Secure Messaging: Response message protected for integrity and confidentiality F.3.2.7 Sensitive Data Encryption and Decryption Data encryption is used when transmitting sensitive data to and from the card. For instance all keys transmitted to a card (e.g. in a PUT KEY command) should be encrypted. Data encryption is over and beyond the Current Security Level required for the Secure Channel Session. The encryption process uses the relevant data encryption session key (DEK) for sensitive data in command messages or for sensitive data in response messages. The encryption method uses DES in ECB or CBC mode depending on the Key Type of the DEK Key in the CRT: see appendix B.1.1.1 CBC Mode or appendix B.1.1.2 - ECB Mode. If the key type is omitted for the DEK Key it shall be known implicitly. The sensitive data block length shall be constructed as a multiple of 8-byte long block before the encryption operations: the eventual padding method is application specific. The encryption is performed across the sensitive data and the result of each encryption becomes part of the encrypted data. This encrypted data becomes part of the clear text data field in the command/response message. The decryption is the exact opposite of the above operation: in particular, no padding is removed by the decryption operation. 338 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4 Commands Because certificates, digital signatures and some data fields can be long, command and response chaining as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4 is used to transfer successive data blocks. With command chaining, the command data is sent in multiple APDUs, the command data being segmented arbitrarily. All except the final command in the chain shall indicate command chaining by setting to '1' bit 5 of the class byte according to ISO/IEC 7816-4. With response chaining, the response data is sent in multiple APDUs, the response data being segmented arbitrarily. Secure Channel Initiation Command signature without message recovery signature with message recovery EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE GET CHALLENGE GET DATA [certificate] INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Table F-13: SCP10 Command Support Table F-14 summarizes the minimum security requirements for the APDU commands. Command Minimum Security EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Validated PK.OCE.AUT and card challenge GET CHALLENGE None GET DATA [certificate] None INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Current Security Level is at least AUTHENTICATED or ANY_AUTHENTICATED MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT None PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] None PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] None Table F-14: Minimum Security Requirements for SCP10 commands The following table provides the list of SCP10 command support per card Life Cycle State. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 339 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. OP_READY INITIALIZED SECURED CARD_LOCKED TERMINATED Command AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD AM SD DM SD SD FA SD SD FA SD SD EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE GET CHALLENGE GET DATA [certificate] INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Table F-15: SCP10 command support per Card Life Cycle State Legend of Table F-13 and Table F-15: AM SD: Security Domain with Authorized Management privilege. DM SD: Supplementary Security Domain with Delegated Management privilege. FA SD: Security Domain with Final Application privilege. (Note: command support for an Application with Final Application Privilege which is not a Security Domain is subject to Issuer policy, within the constraints of what is permitted according to the card Life Cycle State.) SD: Other Security Domain. : Support required. Blank cell: Support optional. Striped cell: Support prohibited. F.4.1 EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command F.4.1.1 Definition and Scope This command is used to authenticate the Off-Card Entity by the Security Domain. This command is also used with the key agreement option to support session key establishment. It shall be immediately preceded (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface) by a GET CHALLENGE command. It may be followed (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface) by an INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command. 340 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.1.2 Command Message The EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command message is coded as follows: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03', '40' - '4F', '10' - '13' or '50' - '5F' See section 11.1.4 INS '82' EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE P1 '00' Reference control parameter P1: no information given P2 '00' Reference control parameter P2: no information given Lc 'xx' Length of Entity Signature (key transport) or encrypted Off-Card Entity Signature (key agreement) Data 'xx xx...' Command data field Le - Not present Table F-16: EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message A Security Domain may support other values of Reference Control Parameters P1 and P2 as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. F.4.1.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command message contains the Off-Card Entity Signature (key transport) or encrypted Off-Card Entity Signature (key agreement) - see section F.1.3.4 - Off-Card Entity Authentication for further details. F.4.1.4 Data Field Returned in the Response Message No data is returned by this command. F.4.1.5 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following specific error and warning conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '63' '00' Verification of certificate failed '94' '84' Algorithm not supported Table F-17: Error Conditions March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 341 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.2 GET CHALLENGE Command F.4.2.1 Definition and Scope This command is used to obtain a random challenge from the Security Domain, to support authentication of the OffCard Entity to the Security Domain. It precedes the EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command. It shall have been preceded (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface), immediately or not, by a MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT or PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command. F.4.2.2 Command Message The GET CHALLENGE command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03' or '40' - '4F' See section 11.1.4 INS '84' GET CHALLENGE P1 '00' Reference Control Parameter P1: no information given P2 '00' Reference Control Parameter P2: no information given Lc Absent Data Absent Le '00' Table F-18: GET CHALLENGE Command Message A Security Domain may support other values of Reference Control Parameters P1 and P2 as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. F.4.2.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message There is no command data. F.4.2.4 Data Field Returned in the Response Message Data returned comprises a card challenge, coded on 8 bytes with the key agreement option and 16 bytes with the key transport option. F.4.2.5 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions. 342 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.3 GET DATA [certificate] Command F.4.3.1 Definition and Scope The GET DATA [certificate] command is used to retrieve either information about all certificates that can be retrieved from the card, or a single certificate. This command may be issued at any time, in particular it may be interleaved with PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] commands. If it is issued when a Secure Channel Session is active, it must comply with the Current Security Level of that Secure Channel Session. F.4.3.2 Command Message The following command is used to obtain certificate information or a single certificate from the Security Domain. Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F', '60' - '6F', '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF' See section 11.1.4 INS `CA' or `CB' If CLA = '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F' or '60' - '6F', even or odd instruction code 'CA' or 'CB' If CLA = '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF', even instruction code 'CA' Reference Control Parameters P1 and P2: there are three options: '7F 21' Tag of certificate '50 31' Data object identifier of EF.OD P1 P2 'xx xx' (Any other value) data object identifier of a certificate Lc 'xx' or omitted Not present if P1 P2 = '7F 21', otherwise length of command data Data 'xx xx...' or omitted Not present, or command data Le '00' Table F-19: GET DATA [certificate] Command Message F.4.3.3 Reference Control Parameters P1 and P2 If P1 P2 = `7F 21', the command is a request to retrieve the certificate of the Security Domain's default public key, CERT.SD.AUT. Otherwise, for any value other than those defined in section 11.3 - GET DATA Command, the command is a request to access EF.OD or another certificate and the instruction code shall be set to 'CA' if the class byte indicates a GlobalPlatform command (CLA set to '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF') or 'CB' if the class byte indicates an ISO command (CLA set to '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F' or '60' - '6F'). * If P1 P2 = `50 31', the command is a request to retrieve details of all available certificates held by the Security Domain for retrieval and verification by an Off-Card Entity; * Otherwise, for any other value of P1 P2, the command shall be treated as a request to retrieve a certificate whose pointer is given in P1 P2. This would typically follow a command with P1 P2 = '50 31', where the March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 343 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Cryptographic Information Objects returned in the response have pointers to individual certificates. However, the Off-Card Entity may already know the location of a required certificate, and issue this command directly. F.4.3.4 Data Field Sent in the Command Message When P1-P2 is different from `7F21', the command data shall be present and coded as follows: Name Length Name Presence Tag list tag 1 `5C' Mandatory Tag list length 1 `00' (empty, indicating 'retrieve all data') Mandatory Table F-20: GET DATA [certificate] Command Data Message F.4.3.5 Data Field Returned in the Response Message When the command is issued to retrieve a certificate (P1-P2 different from `5031') and the class byte indicates a GlobalPlatform command (CLA set to '80' - '8F', 'C0' - 'CF' or 'E0' - 'EF'), the certificate shall be returned TLVcoded as follows: Name Length Name Presence Certificate tag 2 '7F21' Conditional Certificate length 1, 2 or 3 '00' - '7F', or '81 80' - '81 FF' or '82 01 00' - '82 FF FF' Conditional Certificate data n 'xxxx...' (as defined in section F.1.2.4). Mandatory Table F-21: GET DATA [certificate] Response Data Field - Certificate When the command is issued to retrieve a certificate (P1-P2 different from `5031') and the class byte indicates an ISO command (CLA set to '00' - '0F', '40' - '4F' or '60' - '6F'), only the certificate value shall be returned. If the command was issued to retrieve certificate information details (P1-P2 = `5031'), the contents of EF.OD listing all the Cryptographic Information Objects for the different certificates held in by the Security Domain shall be returned as defined in section F.1.2.3. F.4.3.6 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following specific error and warning conditions: SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data '6A' '88' Referenced data not found Table F-22: Error Conditions 344 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.4 INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command F.4.4.1 Definition and Scope This command is used to authenticate the Security Domain, by the Off-Card Entity. This command is also used with the key agreement option, to support session key establishment. It shall be immediately preceded (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface) by an EXTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command. F.4.4.2 Command Message The INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03' or '40' - '4F' See section 11.1.4 INS '88' INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE P1 '00' Reference control parameter P1: no information given P2 '00' Reference control parameter P2: no information given Lc 'xx' Length of Off-Card Entity challenge Data 'xx xx...' Command data field Le `00' Table F-23: INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Message A Security Domain may support other values of Reference Control Parameters P1 and P2 as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. F.4.4.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE command message contains the following data: Name Length Name Presence Off-Card Entity challenge 8 or 16 'xxxx...' Mandatory Off-Card Entity id 8 'xxxx...' (part of CERT.OCE.AUT) Mandatory Table F-24: INTERNAL AUTHENTICATE Command Data Field Off-Card Entity challenge is 16 bytes for the key transport option, 8 bytes for the key agreement option. F.4.4.4 Data Field Returned in the Response Message The Card Signature (key transport) or encrypted Card Signature (key agreement) is returned - see section F.1.3.3 for details. F.4.4.5 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 345 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. The command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following specific error and warning conditions: Table F-25: Warning Conditions SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data Table F-26: Error Conditions SW1 SW2 Meaning '61' 'xx' Response data incomplete, 'xx' more bytes available 346 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.5 MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Command F.4.5.1 Definition and Scope This command selects the Secure Channel Protocol `10' and its options as well as defining specific keys to be used by the Security Domain. If a Secure Channel Session is active on this logical channel and card I/O interface, it shall be terminated on receipt of this command, regardless of the validity of the command. F.4.5.2 Command Message The MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03' or '40' - '4F' See section 11.1.4 INS '22' MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT P1 `81' or `C1' Reference Control Parameter P1 `81': External (Off-Card Entity) Authentication only `C1': External and Internal (Mutual) Authentication P2 'A4' or `B6' Reference Control Parameter P2: `A4': Authentication: no certificate verification will be performed by the card `B6': Digital signature: certificate verification will be performed by the card Lc 'xx' Length of command data Data 'xx xx...' Off-Card Entity data Le - Not present Table F-27: MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Command Message F.4.5.3 Reference Control Parameter P1 The value of P1 is based on ISO/IEC 7816-4, as follows: b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 Description 1 - - - - - - - Verification, encipherment, external authentication and key agreement - 1 - - - - - - Computation, decipherment, internal authentication and key agreement - - - - - - - 1 SET - - X X X X X - Values defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4 Table F-28: MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Reference Control Parameter P1 F.4.5.4 Reference Control Parameter P2 This is set according to the template that is appropriate for the subsequent message flow, as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4: 'A4' if certificate verification by the card is omitted, 'B6' if certificate verification is to be performed by the card. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 347 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.5.5 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The command data field is formatted as follows: Tag Length Name Presence '80' 2 Cryptographic mechanism reference: SCP id + options `i' (= scp || i ) Mandatory '83' 0 or 1-n Public key reference Conditional '84' 0 or 1-n Private key reference Conditional Table F-29: MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT Command Data Field The `cryptographic mechanism reference' (tag `80', value '10') designates GlobalPlatform asymmetric Secure Channel Protocol '10' (SCP10) and its options, and distinguishes it from any other protocol that might be supported by the selected Issuer Security Domain, Security Domain or Application. Option 'i' is described in section F.1.1. The `public key reference' (tag `83') designates the public key to be used by the Security Domain in subsequent cryptographic operations during Secure Channel Session initiation. The referenced public key shall have already been validated by the Security Domain or shall be the public key of the Security Domain's Trust Point for External Authentication. If no reference value is provided in the command, the Security Domain shall use by default the public key of its Trust Point for External Authentication, designated PK.TP_EX.AUT, as the first key to use for certificate verification within a session: see section F.1.2.1. The `private key reference' (tag `84') designates the private key to be used by the Security Domain in subsequent cryptographic operations during Secure Channel Session initiation. The referenced private key shall be present and known to the Security Domain. If no reference value is provided in the command, the Security Domain shall use by default its private key designated SK.SD.AUT A Security Domain may support other data elements as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. F.4.5.6 Data Field Returned in the Response Message There is no data returned from this command. F.4.5.7 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following specific error and warning conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning 6A 88 Referenced data not found 94 84 Algorithm not supported Table F-30: Error Conditions 348 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.6 PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] Command F.4.6.1 Definition and Scope This command is used with the session key transport option, and transmits the DES session keys from the Off-Card Entity to the Security Domain. It shall have been preceded (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface), immediately or not, by a MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT or PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command. F.4.6.2 Command Message The PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03', '40' - '4F', '10' - '13' or '50' - '5F' See section 11.1.4 INS '2A' PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] P1 '80' Reference Control Parameter P1: clear text object P2 `84' Reference Control Parameter P2: cryptogram (plain value encoded in BER-TLV) present in the command Lc 'xx' Length of encrypted data Data 'xx xx...' Encrypted data Le - Not present Table F-31: PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] Command Message A Security Domain may support other values of Reference Control Parameters P1 and P2 as defined in ISO/IEC 7816-4. F.4.6.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The data field of the PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [decipher] command message contains the Encrypted Off-Card Entity Session Data. The Off-Card Entity session keys are in control reference templates as defined in section F.3.1.2, one template per session key, concatenated for encryption. Off-Card Entity Session Key Data is formed by padding the session key CRTs to the length of the Security Domain public key modulus as shown in the table below, and encrypting the result with the Security Domain public key (PK.SD.AUT). Meaning Length Meaning Presence Padding 2 '0002' Padding 8-n 'FF'...'FF' Padding 1 '00' Tag of Security Level ('D3') 1 'D3' Mandatory Length of Security Level 1 `01' Mandatory March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 349 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Meaning Length Meaning Presence Security Level 1 `xx' Mandatory CRT tag 1 `B4' (CCT) or `B8' (CT) Mandatory Length of CRT 1 '00' - '7F' Mandatory CRT contents (with session key) n 'xxxx...' Mandatory ..... .... ..... ... CRT tag 1 `B4' (CCT) or `B8' (CT) Optional Length of CRT 1 `00' - `7F' Conditional CRT contents (with session key) n 'xxxx...' Conditional Table F-32: Off-Card Entity Session Key Data - Clear Text before Encryption F.4.6.4 Data Field Returned in the Response Message No data is returned from this command. F.4.6.5 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following specific error and warning conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data Table F-33: Error Conditions 350 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. F.4.7 PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Command F.4.7.1 Definition and Scope This command is used to provide a certificate to the Security Domain for verification. It may be preceded (on the same logical channel of the same card I/O interface) by a MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command or a PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command and may be interleaved with GET DATA [certificate] commands. F.4.7.2 Command Message The PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command message is coded according to the following table: Code Value Meaning CLA '00' - '03', '40' - '4F', '10' - '13' or '50' - '5F' See section 11.1.4 INS '2A' PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] P1 '00' Reference Control Parameter P1: no object in the response P2 `AE' or `BE' Reference Control Parameter P2: input template for certificate verification present in the command `AE': non self descriptive card verifiable certificate (only the concatenated value fields are certified) `BE': self descriptive card verifiable certificate (the TLV data elements are certified) Lc 'xx' Length of certificate data Data 'xx xx...' Certificate data Le - Not present Table F-34: PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Command Message F.4.7.3 Data Field Sent in the Command Message The command data field is certificate data as follows. Name Length Name Presence Certificate tag 2 `7F21' Mandatory Certificate length 1, 2 or 3 '00' - '7F', or '81 80' - '81 FF' or '82 01 00' '82 FF FF' Mandatory Certificate data n 'xxxx...' (as described in section F.1.2.4) Mandatory Table F-35: PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] Command Data Field The Security Domain verifies the certificate presented using the Current Public Key as known to the Security Domain. For the first certificate presented in the session, the Current Public Key is either the default Public Key the Public Key of the Trust Point, or another Public Key as announced in the MANAGE SECURITY ENVIRONMENT command. A series of certificates can be presented to the Security Domain in subsequent PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] commands. For each subsequent PERFORM SECURITY March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 351 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. OPERATION [verify certificate] command, the Current Public Key is the one that was certified in the certificate presented in the previous PERFORM SECURITY OPERATION [verify certificate] command. F.4.7.4 Data Field Returned in the Response Message No data is returned from this command. F.4.7.5 Processing State Returned in the Response Message A successful execution of the command shall be indicated by status bytes '90' '00'. The command may either return a general error condition as listed in section 11.1.3 - General Error Conditions or one of the following specific error and warning conditions. SW1 SW2 Meaning '63' '00' Verification of the certificate failed '68' '83' The last command of the chain was expected '6A' '80' Incorrect values in command data Table F-36: Error Conditions 352 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. G Trusted Framework Inter-Application Communication GlobalPlatform supports a general Trusted Framework scheme for inter-application communication. This general scheme is compatible with the CAT Runtime Environment and secure communication as defined in ETSI TS 102 225, TS 102 241 and related specifications. In summary: * An Application, the Receiving Entity, receives a message from an off-card entity, whose contents is destined to another Application (the Target Application); * The Receiving Entity interacts with a Trusted Framework on the card to communicate with the Target Application; * The Trusted Framework handles the security of the inter-application communication by applying its own rules to the interaction, which may include finding the Security Domain associated with the Target Application and having it handle the security of the incoming message; * The Trusted Framework finds the appropriate interface of the Target Application and passes to it the incoming message contents; * The Target Application processes the event and eventually provides to the Trusted Framework some response message to be returned; * The Trusted Framework, being responsible of the inter-application communication security, applies its own security rules to the response message, which may include requesting the Security Domain associated with the Target Application to handle the response message security; * The Receiving Entity handles the transmission of the response message to the off-card entity. Passing the incoming message through to the Target Application, and returning the Target Application's response to the off-card entity implies security requirements for not only the Trusted Framework but also the Receiving Entity. Each Application present on the card playing the role of a Receiving Entity shall: * Enforce the Issuer's security rules for inter-application communication; * Ensure that incoming messages are properly provided unaltered to the Trusted Framework; * Ensure that any response messages are properly returned unaltered to the off-card entity. The 'Trusted Path' privilege qualifies an Application as a Receiving Entity. To be able to interact with a required Trusted Framework, the Receiving Entity shall obtain a handle to the required Trusted Framework. To be able to receive incoming messages from a Receiving Entity, the Target Application declares its interface(s) to the corresponding Trusted Framework. The Target Application is registered at installation time for each event it is capable of handling. When requested to perform inter-application communication, the Trusted Framework shall check that * The Receiving Entity has the 'Trusted Path' privilege; * The Target Application is registered as being willing to accept the event or incoming message. Trusted Frameworks shall comply with the general requirements stated in this section but are otherwise outside the scope of this version of the specification. March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 353 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. H GlobalPlatform Data Values and Card Recognition Data H.1 Data Values The Object Identifier (OID) assigned to GlobalPlatform is as follows: GlobalPlatform OID ::= {iso(1) member-body(2) country-USA(840) GlobalPlatform(114283)} The hexadecimal representation of the above OID is '2A864886FC6B'. The Object Identifier value for Card Recognition Data {globalPlatform 1} or {1 2 840 114283 1}, which also identifies GlobalPlatform as the Tag Allocation Authority for Card Recognition Data objects has an hexadecimal representation of '2A864886FC6B01' and so on and so forth for all subsequent GlobalPlatform Object Identifiers. The Registered Application Provider Identifier (RID) assigned to GlobalPlatform is as follows: GlobalPlatform RID = 'A000000151' The default AID of the Issuer Security Domain, based on the above ISO assigned RID, is 'A0000001510000'. The encoding of an OID is defined in ISO/IEC 8825-1. The definition of a RID is described in ISO/IEC 7816-4. H.2 Structure of Card Recognition Data All data is TLV encoded. Application tags not defined in this specification are RFU. GlobalPlatform may assign additional Application tags in the future. Many of the data objects contain Object Identifiers (OIDs). An OID is made up of a series of numeric values. Each OID is shown here in curly brackets, with its component values separated by spaces. The actual numeric values of some of the symbolic OID values shown, such as "globalPlatform", are defined in this document and may themselves comprise a series of values. 354 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 March, 2006 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Table H-1: Structure of Card Recognition Data Note 1: Card Data should not exceed 127 bytes. This recommendation is to avoid the complexity of extending the length field of the '66' and '73' data objects and also to minimize the overheads involved in transferring the data. Note 2: Tag '60': The OID {globalPlatform 2 v} identifies a card that conforms to the GlobalPlatform Card Specification version "v". Thus a card conforming to the GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 would use OID {globalPlatform 2 2 2} and a card conforming to the GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.1.1 would use OID {globalPlatform 2 2 1 1}. Note 3: Tag '63': The OID {globalPlatform 3} indicates a GlobalPlatform card that is uniquely identified by the Issuer Identification Number (IIN) and Card Image Number (CIN), as defined in sections 7.4.1.1 - Issuer Identification Number and 7.4.1.2 - Card Image Number. The objective is that an off-card entity is able to construct a globally unique identifier for the card by concatenating this {globalPlatform 3} OID, the IIN and the CIN. Note 4: Tag '64'. The OID {globalPlatform 4 scp i} identifies the Secure Channel Protocol of the Issuer Security Domain. "scp" identifies the Secure Channel Protocol identifier as defined in section 10.7 - Secure Channel Protocol Identifier. "i" identifies the eventual implementation options as defined in appendix D.1.1 - SCP01 Secure Channel for SCP01, appendix E.1.1 - SCP02 Secure Channel for SCP02 or appendix F.1.1 - SCP10 Secure Channel for SCP10. Note 5: The data object with tag '65' may contain information about the GlobalPlatform implementation details or commonly used Card Issuer options. Such information shall be TLV encoded. The structure of this data object is under definition by GlobalPlatform. Tag Explanation Length Value Presence '66' Tag for `Card Data' variable see note 1 Data objects identified in 7816-6, including tag '73' Mandatory '73' Tag for `Card Recognition Data' variable Data objects listed below Mandatory '06' Universal tag for "Object Identifier" (OID) variable {globalPlatform 1} OID for Card Recognition Data, also identifies Global Platform as the Tag Allocation Authority Mandatory '60' '06' Application tag 0 `OIĎ tag variable variable {globalPlatform 2 v} OID for Card Management Type and Version - see note 2 Mandatory '63' '06' Application tag 3 `OIĎ tag variable variable {globalPlatform 3} OID for Card Identification Scheme see note 3 Mandatory '64' '06' Application tag 4 `OIĎ tag variable variable {globalPlatform 4 scp i} OID for Secure Channel Protocol of the Issuer Security Domain and its implementation options- see note 4 Mandatory '65' Application tag 5 variable Card configuration details - see note 5 Optional '66' Application tag 6 variable Card / chip details - see note 6 Optional '67' Application tag 7 variable Issuer Security Domain's Trust Point certificate information - see note 7 Optional '68' Application tag 8 variable Issuer Security Domain certificate information - see note 8 Conditional March, 2006 GlobalPlatform Card Specification 2.2 355 Copyright 2006 GlobalPlatform Inc. All Rights Reserved. The technology provided or described herein is subject to updates, revisions, and extensions by GlobalPlatform. Use of this information is governed by the GlobalPlatform license agreement and any use inconsistent with that agreement is strictly prohibited. Note 6: Tag '66': this data object may contain information about the card and chip implementation, such as the operating system/runtime environment or a security kernel. Such information shall be TLV encoded and may consist of one (or more) OID(s), each OID being introduced by tag `06' and indicating the organization responsible for specifying the operating system, runtime environment or security kernel, and the identification of the corresponding specification and its version number. Note 7: Tag '67': this may contain information on the certification policies, certificate formats and certificate ids associated with the Issuer Security Domain's Trust Point (TP_ISD), primarily relating to the use of a public key Secure Channel Protocol. Such information shall be TLV encoded and may consist of one (or more) OID(s). Note 8: Tag '68': this may contain information such as certificate types, formats and ids associated with on-card Security Domains relating to the use of a public key Secure Channel Protocol. Such information shall be TLV encoded and may consist of one (or more) OID(s) . H.3 Security Domain Management Data The Security Domain management data may be returned in the SELECT response message within template '73' as described in section 11.9.3.1 - Data Field Returned in the Response Message. When present, the Security Domain management data shall be coded as follows. Table H-2: Security Domain Management Data The data objects in this table are equivalent to those in Table H-1, but are specific to this Security Domain and override data objects in Card Recognition Data. See Table H-1 and the notes which follow it for further details of each data object. Tag Explanation Length Value Presence '73' Template variable Data objects listed below Mandatory '06' Universal tag for "Object Identifier" (OID) variable Identifies Global Platform as the Tag Allocation Authority Mandatory '60' '06' Application tag 0 `OIĎ tag variable variable {globalPlatform 2 v} OID for Card Management Type and Version Optional '63' '06' Application tag 3 `OIĎ tag variable variable {globalPlatform 3} OID for Card Identification Scheme Optional '64' '06' Application tag 4 `OIĎ tag variable variable {globalPlatform 4 scp i} OID for Secure Channel Protocol of the selected Security Domain and its implementation options Optional '65' Application tag 5 variable Card configuration details Optional '66' Application tag 6 variable Card / chip details Optional '67' Application tag 7 variable Security Domain's Trust Point certificate information Optional '68' Application tag 8 variable Security Domain certificate information Conditional